Quarterlytics / Industrials / Residential Construction / Barratt Developments / FY2024 Annual Report

Barratt Developments
Annual Report 2024

BDEV · LSE Industrials
Claim this profile
Ticker BDEV
Exchange LSE
Sector Industrials
Industry Residential Construction
Employees 5001-10,000
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Barratt Developments
Loading PDF…
Making sustainable 
living a reality, building 
strong communities
Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Strategic Report
1	
Our purpose 
2	
Our values 
3	
Chair’s Statement 
5	
Investment case 
6	
Redrow acquisition
8	
Our business at a glance 
10	
Business model
12	
Key performance indicators 
16	
Marketplace
22	 Chief Executive’s Statement
39	 Expansion of Oregon
40	 Building sustainably
45 Non-financial and sustainability 
information statement
46	 Section 172 Statement
50	 Stakeholder engagement
58 Chief Financial Officer’s Review 
63	 Risk management 
71	
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities
85	 Viability Statement
Governance
89 Board of Directors and Company Secretary
93	 Executive Committee
94	 Corporate Governance Report 
102	 Nomination Committee Report 
112	 Audit and Risk Committee Report
121	 Safety, Health and Environment 
Committee Report
123	 Remuneration Report 
146	 Other statutory disclosures 
148	 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
Financial Statements
150	 Independent Auditor’s Report
159	 Consolidated Income Statement and 
Statement of Comprehensive Income
160	 Statement of Changes in Shareholders’ 
Equity – Group
161	 Statement of Changes in Shareholders’ 
Equity – Company
162	 Balance Sheets 
163	 Cash Flow Statements 
165	 Notes to the Financial Statements
210 Definitions of alternative 
performance measures and 
reconciliation to IFRS (unaudited)
212	 Five-year record (unaudited) 
214	 Glossary
217	 Integrated reporting approach 
218	 Group advisers and Company information
Inside this report
View more online
 Read more at barrattdevelopments.co.uk
 Download accessible PDF
How to use this report
Read more
Discover online
Alternative performance measures
In addition to the Group using a variety of statutory 
performance measures it also measures performance 
using alternative performance measures (APMs). 
Definitions of the APMs and reconciliations to the 
equivalent statutory measures are detailed on pages 210 
and 211. The definition of net cash is included in note 17 
to the Financial Statements.
Front cover Kingsbrook, Aylesbury – an award-winning development with 60% green space.
Page back
Page forward
Contents
Download accessible PDF

Our purpose
Making sustainable 
living a reality, building 
strong communities
We are well positioned to make a positive contribution to 
society by delivering sustainable homes that are needed 
across the country. We have proven to be resilient over the 
past year and will continue to lead the future of housebuilding 
for customers. 
We will continue to achieve our purpose by living by our values 
that drive day-to-day decision making. 
Read more about our values on page 2
Anson Gardens, Fradley 
1
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our values
We do it for 
our customers
We always put our customers first and 
do everything we can to help them on 
their home ownership journey.
93% of our customers said they 
would recommend us to a friend in 
the latest annual HBF National New 
Homes Customer Satisfaction Survey. 
We have a 5-star rating for customer 
satisfaction, and are the only major 
housebuilder to be awarded this 
accolade for 15 years in a row.
We do it right
We always act with honesty and 
integrity, and work hard to get our 
homes right first time.
The NHBC undertakes independent 
inspections at five stages of the 
home building process and we 
have delivered the lowest rate of 
Reportable Items out of all the 
major UK housebuilders for the 
past five years.
We do it together
We are committed to nurturing a 
diverse workforce that reflects the 
communities where we operate, 
which is key to developing the next 
generation of leaders.
Initiatives such as our dignity and 
respect training programme and 
balanced recruitment shortlists aim to 
give people from all backgrounds the 
chance to succeed in the industry.
We make it happen
We are proud of the great legacy we 
are creating and are taking the lead 
delivering excellence in housebuilding.
Reducing waste drives efficiency 
and reduces our impact on the 
environment. By introducing dedicated 
waste managers and improving our 
waste monitoring, we are continuing 
to reduce the construction waste 
generated by our sites.
93%
of our customers said they would 
recommend Barratt to a friend
0.13
Reportable Items in FY24, the lowest 
rate out of all major UK housebuilders
6
employee networks celebrating our 
diverse identities and collaborating 
towards our shared success
45%
reduction in construction waste 
intensity since FY20
Living our values
Whether we are facing day-to-day challenges or looking to the 
future, our values guide us on how we behave and how we will 
continue to achieve our purpose.
Green space at Drovers Court, Micklefield
Ashridge Grange, Wokingham 
Sales team, Barratt London
Site staff at Kingsbrook, Aylesbury
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
2
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Chair’s Statement
Making a positive 
contribution to society by 
delivering sustainable homes
It is evident that we have a strong culture and a desire 
to ensure colleagues can develop to their full potential 
within a diverse, safe and inclusive workplace and we are 
fully committed to delivering high-quality homes to our 
customers whilst protecting the environment. 
Colleagues across the business are passionate and helped 
in the development and launch, earlier this year, of our 
new purpose: “Making sustainable living a reality, building 
strong communities”. Our new purpose is also supported 
by refreshed values which reflect the ever-changing needs 
of our stakeholders, the environment and our desire to 
lead the future of housebuilding. Input was also sought 
from external stakeholders to help shape our new purpose 
and values. 
 For more details see pages 1 and 2
Our performance
Barratt has delivered a solid operational performance over the 
past 12 months, at the upper end of our expectations against a 
tough trading backdrop encompassing political, economic and 
interest rate instability. Importantly, we have done so whilst 
maintaining our industry-leading quality, customer service 
and sustainability performance. 
Our balance sheet remains strong, with net cash of 
£868.5m, and provides the financial strength and flexibility 
to ensure we can manage and deliver the optimal integration 
of the Redrow business, whilst maintaining a positive and 
proactive approach to organic growth opportunities.
I am incredibly proud of the external recognition we have 
received over the past 12 months: 
	• We were awarded the Home Builders Federation (HBF) 
five-star status for the 15th year in a row, making us the 
only national housebuilder to have achieved this.
	• Our site managers secured 89 NHBC Pride in the Job 
awards, again more than any other housebuilder for a 
record 20th year.
	• We maintained our position as the only UK housebuilder 
on the CDP Climate Change A List for Leadership, one of 
fewer than 365 companies worldwide. 
Sustainability
We have continued to deliver against our Building Sustainably 
framework which is designed to drive positive change for 
nature, places and people. This is enabling us to drive 
innovation, reduce costs and enhance our competitiveness. 
 Please see pages 40 to 44 for further detail
The housebuilding industry’s impact on climate change 
makes it imperative that we continually scrutinise and 
challenge the ways in which we operate and reduce our 
environmental impact. The successful opening of our new 
Oregon Timber Frame manufacturing facility near Derby has 
significantly expanded our capacity to build more homes 
using timber frame and will help towards meeting the 
requirements of the Future Homes Standard and reduce 
on-site labour requirements. It will also deliver benefits to 
the environment by reducing the embodied carbon used 
in build, and through thermal efficiency, reduce emissions 
generated when the home is occupied. 
 More information on our new Oregon factory can be found on page 39
Industry collaboration
I am also pleased that Barratt is playing a leading role in the 
Future Homes Hub with David Thomas, our Chief Executive, 
chairing the organisation. The Future Homes Hub is enabling 
collaboration between Government, housebuilders, supply 
chain partners, mortgage providers, valuers and planners to 
deliver both the country’s legislated targets to 2050 and our 
own carbon emission reduction targets to 2040. 
Caroline Silver
Chair
Since taking over as Chair 
on 30 June 2023, I have met 
many of our stakeholders, 
including employees, customers, 
shareholders, supply chain 
partners and sub-contractors. 
3
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board changes
Nigel Webb joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director in 
October 2023, bringing a wealth of property, construction 
and land experience to the Board. 
Subject to obtaining CMA clearance of the Redrow acquisition, 
Matthew Pratt, Geeta Nanda and Nicky Dulieu will join the 
Board in the coming months. Matthew will join as Chief 
Executive Officer, Redrow and Group Executive Director. Geeta 
and Nicky will join as independent Non-Executive Directors. 
 For details on the composition and diversity of the Board, please see 
page 103
Shareholder returns
The Board paid an interim dividend for FY24 of 4.4 pence 
per share (FY23: interim dividend 10.2 pence per share) and 
is pleased to recommend a final FY24 dividend of 11.8 pence 
per share (FY23: final dividend of 23.5 pence per share) in 
line with our dividend policy of maintaining cover at 1.75 
times adjusted earnings per share. Subject to shareholder 
approval, the final dividend will be paid on 1 November 2024 
to shareholders on the register at the close of business 
on 27 September 2024. The total proposed dividend for 
FY24, including the interim dividend, is 16.2 pence per 
share (FY23: 33.7 pence per share) – lower than last 
year reflecting the reduction in adjusted basic earnings 
per share. 
The Board regularly reviews its capital allocation approach. 
With the Redrow acquisition completed, but CMA clearance 
outstanding, we will assess the capital requirements for 
the enlarged group taking into account current market 
conditions, our obligations with respect to building safety 
and our desire to be active in the land market. We will 
provide an update on our policy along with our first half 
results in February 2025.
CMA Market Study and CMA investigation
The CMA completed its Housing Market Study and issued 
its final report in February 2024. The CMA drew clear and 
fair conclusions on how the planning system has negatively 
impacted the housebuilding industry and its detrimental 
impact on new housing delivery across the country over 
successive decades.
On 26 February 2024, the CMA also launched an 
investigation into suspected breaches of competition 
law, relating to the exchange of competitively sensitive 
information by eight housebuilders, including Barratt and 
Redrow. This investigation remains in its early stages and 
we continue to co-operate with the CMA.
The future
The housing market faces ongoing challenges. The current 
interest rate environment continues to impact mortgage 
affordability and the ability of many first-time buyers to 
unlock mortgage qualification through deposit savings. 
There also remain uncertainties around the speed and 
scale of future economic, employment and earnings growth, 
which will be key determinants on the future direction 
of consumer confidence and spending. We welcome the 
policy changes proposed by the new UK Government which 
suggest a real commitment to unlock the planning system, 
drive national targets for housebuilding growth and support 
the industry in delivering the homes across all tenures the 
country so desperately needs.
The Board recognises that it needs to manage Barratt 
through what may be another challenging year for the 
market, whilst delivering a smooth, efficient and effective 
integration of the Redrow business once CMA clearance 
has been obtained. We remain focused on managing the 
risks and challenges within our control, whilst ensuring we 
are in the best possible position to create long-term value 
for all our stakeholders. Our operating disciplines, forward 
order book and strong financial position provide us with the 
platform to adjust to changes in the operating and political 
environment in the year ahead.
Finally, on behalf of the Board, I would like to express 
our thanks to all our colleagues, subcontractors and our 
supply chain partners for their commitment to the Group, 
both over the last year and as we look forward to the 
exciting opportunities ahead bringing together the Barratt 
and Redrow businesses. I look forward to meeting many 
more colleagues from across the enlarged Group in the 
coming year.
Caroline Silver
Chair
3 September 2024
Chair’s Statement continued
Better together 
We believe the acquisition
of Redrow plc is beneficial to all 
our stakeholders and enhances our 
investment case.
Aligned on values
We share the same values, centred on delivering 
excellent build quality, customer service and leading 
the industry’s sustainability journey.
Addressing a wider market
Through our complementary brands and house type 
ranges, we will be able to offer greater customer 
choice and design variety across our developments.
Accelerating delivery
Through our combined land banks and both the depth 
and strength of our management teams, we will be 
positioned to accelerate growth in new housing delivery. 
 Read more on pages 6 and 7
We do it together
 See more about the benefits of the Combination 
at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
investors/barratt-redrow
Burnmill Grange, Market Harborough
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
4
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Investment case
The backdrop
The country needs more homes 
to be built. This is reflected in 
the ambitious target set by the 
Government to build 1.5 million 
homes over the next five years. 
However, we recognise that we 
are in a challenging period, which 
is a reflection of the impact of 
accumulated inflation on the cost 
of living, discretionary spending 
and saving, as well as the ongoing 
impact on mortgage interest rates. 
These factors have impacted the affordability of housing, 
particularly for first-time buyers, but the critical long-term 
need for additional housing across the country remains.
We continue to manage these near-term challenges and 
through our actions and decisions ensure we emerge a 
stronger business, positioned and ready to deliver more 
sustainable, high-quality, energy-efficient homes.
Strong balance sheet 
and cash generation
With the cyclicality of the housebuilding industry, we 
maintain clear financial disciplines. We are committed 
to maintaining a strong balance sheet with an 
operational focus on cash generation and a clearly 
defined operating framework.
 Read more about our financial performance from page 58
Shorter owned land bank
We run with one of the shortest but most developable 
land banks in the industry, minimising capital 
employed and accelerating development returns, 
thereby creating greater value for our shareholders.
 Read more about our land position from page 33
Leading in sustainability
We are determined to be the leading national 
sustainable housebuilder and we drive sustainability 
through clear plans, delivery, accountability and 
measurement.
 Read more about our Building Sustainably framework from 
page 40
Nationally diversified
We operate throughout Great Britain, providing 
geographic diversification and the ability to manage 
our land buying and development activity relative to 
changing regional demand.
 See our completions by region on page 9
A portfolio of housing brands 
and distinct house types
Our brands, Barratt Homes, David Wilson Homes and, within 
the M25, Barratt London have strong customer recognition 
and distinct house type ranges, creating greater choices 
for our customers. Dual branding on appropriate sites 
creates even greater choice and accelerates development.
 Read about the choices for our customers more on page 28
Industry-leading build quality
Our build quality is recognised as “industry-leading” 
by independent inspection of our homes throughout 
the build process. Our site managers hold a 20-year 
record of achieving more “Pride in the Job Awards” 
than any other housebuilder.
 Read more on our build performance from page 35
Industry-leading 
customer service
We strive to deliver exceptional customer service. 
We are the only major housebuilder to be awarded 
a five-star rating for customer satisfaction for 15 
consecutive years.
 Read more about our offer to our customers from page 28
Multi-channel sales strength
Our sales teams promote our reputation for build 
quality and customer service to our traditional 
homebuyers, as well as our national scale and financial 
strength to alternative channels including the private 
rental sector and registered social housing providers.
 Read more about our sales channel delivery on pages 26 and 27
5
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Redrow acquisition
Accelerating growth
On 21 August 2024, the Company acquired the full share 
capital of Redrow plc in an all share transaction. In 
accordance with standard practice, the Competition 
and Markets Authority (the CMA) has issued an Initial 
Enforcement Order requiring the Barratt and Redrow 
businesses to continue to operate independently until the 
CMA has formally accepted the undertakings proposed 
by the parties in response to their limited concerns, or 
otherwise agrees to integration taking place.
Once approved, the combination of Barratt and Redrow 
(“the Combination”) will create an exceptional UK 
homebuilder in terms of quality, service and sustainability. 
It will bring together three high-quality, complementary 
brands – Barratt, David Wilson, and Redrow – offering a 
variety of sustainable homes for customers across the UK, 
addressing the country’s need for homes. 
Barratt and Redrow share a commitment to quality, putting 
customers firmly at the heart of everything they do. The 
Combination will use the strengths of both companies to 
deliver significant benefits to our people, supply chains 
and customers.
	• People – employees will benefit from additional 
opportunities for development and from being part of 
an industry-leading homebuilder.
	• Supply chain – supply chain partners will have greater 
visibility and certainty of delivery and benefit from the 
acceleration of delivery of homes across the country.
	• Customers – customers and communities will benefit 
from our ability to deliver more high-quality homes, across 
a broader product range, and accelerate the creation of 
strong, sustainable communities across the UK.
A uniquely compelling opportunity 
The creation of Barratt Redrow is a uniquely compelling 
opportunity to:
	• bring together complementary offerings to create an 
exceptional UK homebuilder; 
	• create a strong brand portfolio – including Redrow 
positioned as its premium brand – offering customers 
a wider range of house types and price points as well 
as accelerating housing delivery. Barratt has already 
successfully executed this strategy through the 
acquisition of David Wilson Homes in 2007;
	• realise significant cost synergies from procurement 
savings and a rationalisation of divisional and central 
functions, which will drive a lower combined cost base;
	• maintain a robust balance sheet, better protected to 
operate through the cycle, and provide a strong platform 
from which to deliver improved shareholder returns over 
the medium term; and
	• deliver significant benefits for all stakeholders. 
Redrow
We make it happen
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
6
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

The deal
The Boards of Barratt and Redrow reached agreement in 
February 2024 on the terms of a recommended all-share 
offer for the combination of Barratt and Redrow. Barratt 
acquired the entire issued and to be issued ordinary 
share capital of Redrow on 21 August 2024. Each Redrow 
shareholder received 1.44 Barratt shares for each Redrow 
share they held.
Immediately following completion, Redrow shareholders 
held approximately 32.8% of the combined Group 
and Barratt shareholders approximately 67.2% of the 
combined Group.
Barratt Redrow plc will be an exceptional homebuilder in 
terms of quality, service and sustainability that will help 
deliver the homes this country needs. The new business will 
build on the excellent reputations for quality, service and 
sustainability that both Barratt and Redrow have developed.
Key financial information for the 
combined group 
Barratt and Redrow generated aggregate revenue of 
£7.4bn1 in FY23, delivering total completions of 22,6421. 
The combined group is expected to benefit from a robust 
aggregated balance sheet, building on Barratt and Redrow’s 
aggregate net cash position of £874m as at 31 December 20232, 
providing the combined group flexibility to manage the 
business for the long term, resilience through the cycle 
and flexibility to respond to changing market conditions.
The combined group will continue Barratt’s and Redrow’s 
existing practice of prudently managing a robust balance 
sheet and maintaining a highly selective approach to land 
buying, allowing the combined Group to capitalise on future 
land opportunities.
We believe the combined group will achieve pre-tax cost 
synergies of at least £90m on an annual run-rate basis by 
the end of the third year following completion, of which 
approximately 90% should be delivered by the end of the 
second year following completion. The one-off costs of 
delivering these savings should total approximately £73m, 
with approximately 57% incurred in the first year following 
completion, approximately 32% incurred in the second year 
following completion and the remainder by the end of the 
third year following completion. The Combination should 
be accretive to Barratt and Redrow’s respective adjusted 
earnings per share in the first year after completion 
(excluding one-off costs of delivering synergies). 
Creating value 
through acquisitions 
We have a strong record of growing and investing in 
brands that have joined the Group in recent years:
	• Since the acquisition of David Wilson Homes In 
2007, it has grown into a nationally-recognised 
brand, with, improved service and quality metrics, 
and increased its share of Group business from 26% 
to 34% of Barratt completions.
	• We supported Oregon Timber Frame after we 
acquired the company in 2019. Together, we have 
doubled Oregon Timber Frame’s kit volume while 
providing new jobs at development sites and 
supported the opening of a new state-of-the-art 
factory in Derby last year.
 See page 39 for more detail on Oregon
	• We acquired Gladman in 2022 and have successfully 
integrated Gladman’s land promotion and planning 
capabilities into the Barratt Group.
The combined group expects to be able to increase 
volumes through a three-brand strategy, with the 
potential to accelerate the delivery of homes from 
the combined and complementary land pipeline 
by introducing the Redrow brand on appropriate 
Barratt sites and vice versa. The combined group will 
take advantage of the complementary geographical 
footprints of Barratt and Redrow, with a total land 
pipeline of 92,345 plots as at 31 December 20233. 
1	
The aggregated revenue of £7.4bn reflects the total revenue of Barratt and Redrow during 
FY23, being £5.3bn and £2.1bn, respectively, and calculated in accordance with Barratt and 
Redrow’s respective accounting policies. The aggregated completions of 22,642 reflects the 
total completions of Barratt and Redrow during FY23, being 17,206 and 5,436, respectively.
2	 The aggregated net cash position of £874m reflects the total of the net cash positions 
of Barratt and Redrow as at 31 December 2023, being £753m and £121m, as stated in the 
Barratt HY24 Results and Redrow HY24 Results, respectively, and calculated in accordance 
with Barratt and Redrow’s respective accounting policies.
3	 The total land pipeline of 92,345 plots reflects the total of the land pipeline positions of 
Barratt and Redrow as at 31 December 2023, being 67,780 plots and 24,565 plots, as stated 
in the Barratt HY24 Results and Redrow HY24 Results, respectively.
Redrow acquisition continued
“This is an exciting opportunity to bring together two highly complementary 
companies, creating an exceptional homebuilder in terms of quality, service and 
sustainability, able to build more of the high-quality homes this country needs.” 
David Thomas, 
Chief Executive
7
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our business at a glance
Our business at a glance
Our purpose
Making sustainable living a reality, 
building strong communities
Our strategic priorities
Drive revenue
Optimise 
land buying
Control 
build activity
Lead 
the industry
Our sustainability strategy
 Read more on page 2
We do it for our customers
We do it right
We do it together
We make it happen
To achieve our purpose, we focus on the three key pillars of our environmental 
and social ambitions that form our sustainability framework:
 Read more on pages 40 to 44
Nature
We preserve and enhance the natural world 
by using resources responsibly, building 
resilient, low-carbon homes, and by creating 
places where people and nature can thrive.
Places
We design and build great places that meet 
the highest standards, and that promote 
sustainable, healthy and happy living for 
our customers.
People
We believe everyone has the right to be 
respected and treated fairly at work. We 
do the right thing, nurturing diverse talent 
and prioritising the health and safety and 
wellbeing of our people and partners.
Alignment with the UN Sustainable Development Goals
 Read more on page 23
 Read more on page 1
Our values
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
8
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Leading in build quality
We are determined to be the UK’s leading national sustainable housebuilder, 
delivering the homes the country needs, whilst leading the industry in build quality 
and customer service.
Completions by region
Scotland
1,613
2023: 1,951
Central
2,652
2023: 3,189
Five-star 
customer 
satisfaction 
West
1,588
2023: 2,091
London and Southern
2,416
2023: 3,754
East
2,962
2023: 3,400
Northern
2,773
2023: 2,821
Completions by unit type 
 1 and 2-bedroom homes
13%
 3-bedroom homes 
38%
 4-bedroom homes
34%
 5 and 6-bedroom homes
2%
 Apartments London 
2%
 Apartments non-London
11%
Completions by deal type
 Traditional private
54%
 Part-exchange
11%
 Investor
14%
 Affordable
21%
Awards and recognition in 2024
Our brands
Climate – A
Water – B
Forests – B
89 NHBC pride 
in the job awards 
89
Our business at a glance continued
9
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Business model
How we build value
What we do
We build a high-quality product which our customers love. 
We develop homes which minimise our environmental footprint and lower ongoing costs for our customers. 
We deliver returns, operating a short owned land bank to convert investments rapidly to cash.
Our resources
People
We recruit, train and retain 
a skilled and committed 
workforce. Our people’s 
experience supports delivery 
of a high-quality product. 
Our team does things 
together and we do it right. 
Land and planning
We operate a short owned 
land bank, minimising 
the amount of capital 
locked up on the balance 
sheet in advance of 
land development. 
This is complemented 
by investment into 
strategic land and 
promotional agreements 
to enhance margin. 
Read more on pages 50 to 57
Read more on page 28
Read more on page 30
Read more on pages 58 to 62
Read more from page 30
Read more on pages 33 and 34
Expertise
Barratt was founded over 
60 years ago and has deep 
knowledge and experience 
of both the different 
housing markets in Great 
Britain and the different 
products that work in 
those markets. 
Stakeholder 
relationships
We build great places 
to live, supported 
through partnerships 
with our stakeholders. 
Our strong relationships 
with our stakeholders 
are critical in developing 
the products that our 
customers want. 
Finances
We hold a robust balance 
sheet. This gives us 
confidence, irrespective of 
market conditions, to deliver 
homes into the market 
at the right price and to 
engage in the land market 
with value-accretive bids.
Brands
We invest in developing 
and maintaining a portfolio 
of complementary brands, 
offering a wider choice of 
designs and customer price 
points to better serve our 
customers’ needs. Offering 
multi-brand developments, 
we can accelerate delivery 
of high-quality homes.
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
10
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Our competitive edge
Stakeholder value
Products 
We build the homes and 
communities that our 
customers want to live in.
People
We have an experienced 
team that understands 
housebuilding. 
We deliver the best 
homes on the market.
Portfolio of brands
We offer through our 
brand portfolio, homes 
to first-time buyers and 
mover-uppers. With the 
Redrow acquisition, 
this will extend to 
premium purchasers.
Locations
We operate nationally, and 
at scale, rapidly converting 
our land bank to cash. Our 
national footprint means 
we can optimally deploy 
our brands throughout 
Great Britain.
Sustainability
We see sustainability 
as a differentiator and 
a way to create value.
Customer focus
Our experienced sales teams 
deliver exceptional customer 
service, resulting in us being 
the only major housebuilder to 
be awarded a HBF 5 star rating 
for customer satisfaction for 
15 consecutive years.
14,004
new home completions (including joint 
ventures) with a total market value of £4.1bn
£3.0bn
of gross value added (GVA), the Group’s 
contribution to UK economic output
£385.0m
Adjusted profit before tax
1.26
tonnes of market-based CO2e emissions per 
100m2 completed build area (scope 1 and 2). 
A reduction of 34% from our 2018 benchmark
11,014
supplier and subcontractor companies 
supported (including through joint ventures)
£318.7m
tax generated by our activities
14,515
hours of employee volunteering
 For further detail on the value we create for 
stakeholders, please see our socio-economic 
footprint: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/media/
Files/B/Barratt-Developments/sustainability/
fy24-group-socio-economic-footprint.pdf
Business model continued
11
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Key performance indicators
Measuring our progress
HBF five-star customer satisfaction
5 star
2023: 5 star
Land approvals
12,439
2023: (812)
Scope 1 and 2 carbon emissions (tCO2e)
16,458
2023: 24,909
Target
HBF 5 star customer satisfaction.
Status
Achieved
Definition
The percentage of homebuyers who would recommend us to family 
and friends taken from the HBF Homebuilder Survey.
Why it’s a KPI
Customer satisfaction is a strategic priority and is fundamental to 
our business.
The HBF Homebuilder Survey is an industry recognised independently 
measured indicator of our customer service and build quality.
Key metric for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
Link to strategy
Drive revenue
Lead the industry
 See more about our performance on page 28
 See more about our strategic priorities on page 23
Target
Reduce absolute scope 1 and 2 greenhouse gas emissions by 29.0% 
by 2025 and 54.7% by 2030 from 2018 levels (2018: 32,657 tCO2e).
Status
On track
Definition
Tonnes of greenhouse gas emissions associated with our scope 1 and 
market-based scope 2 emissions, which includes energy and fuel use 
on our sites, in our offices and in our company vehicles.
Why it’s a KPI
Monitors the environmental impact of our business activities and our 
exposure to climate-related transition risk.
Scope 1 and 2 carbon emissions intensity is a key metric for assessing 
performance for Executive Directors’ remuneration.
Link to strategy 
Lead the industry
 See more about our performance on page 80
Target
Replace plots utilised in year.
Status
Monitor
Definition
The number of plots approved for purchase, less the number 
of approvals withdrawn.
Why it’s a KPI
Monitors whether the Group is approving the appropriate 
amount of land for purchase to support future business activity.
Link to strategy
Optimise land buying
 See more about our performance on pages 33 to 34
1
2
3
5 star
5 star
5 star
5 star
2023
2022
2021
2020
5 star
2024
19,089
18,067
9,441
2023
2022
2021
2020
(812)
12,439
2024
25,074
29,265
21,963
2023
2022
2020
2021
24,909
16,458
2024
Non-financial
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
12
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Waste intensity (tonnes per 100m2)
3.83
2023: 4.34
SHE audit compliance
97%
2023: 96%
Employee engagement score
74.9%
2023: 84.4%
Target
Reduce construction waste intensity (tonnes per 100m2 of housebuild 
equivalent build area) to 4.54 by 2025.
Status
On track
Definition
Tonnes of waste generated from above ground construction for 
every 100m2 of housebuild equivalent build area.
Why it’s a KPI
Monitors the efficiency of operations and the use of materials 
in the construction process.
Key metric for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
This KPI has been changed from legally completed build area to 
housebuild equivalent build area to align with remuneration targets.
Link to strategy 
Control build activity
 See more about our performance on page 37
Target
Exceed 75th percentile score in the engagement survey.
Status
Below target
Definition
The percentage level of satisfaction of our people measured using 
an annual independently conducted survey.
Why it’s a KPI
Monitors employee engagement and satisfaction, whilst also providing 
a forum for view sharing, to ensure we retain and invest in the best 
people and focus on their development and success.
Link to strategy 
Lead the industry
*	 No survey completed for 2021.
 See more about our response to employee feedback and improvement 
in employee engagement to 78.9% in a follow-up survey, on page 30
Target
Over 94% SHE audit compliance.
Status
Achieved
Definition
The percentage of internal inspections which are compliant with 
SHE guidelines.
Why it’s a KPI
Demonstrates compliance with safety standards on our sites. 
Lead indicator highlighting areas of SHE focus.
Used as a gateway for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
Link to strategy 
Control build activity
 See more about our performance on page 24
4
5
6
4.34
4.83
6.29
6.93
2023
2022
2021
2020
3.83
2024
97%
79.4%
97%
N/A*
96%
84.2%
2023
2023
2022
2022
2021
2021
2020
2020
96%
84.4%
97%
74.9%
2024
2024
Non-financial continued
 See more about our strategic priorities on page 23
Key performance indicators continued
13
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Key performance indicators continued
Total home completions
14,004
2023: 17,206
Adjusted gross margin/Gross margin
16.5%/12.2%
2023: 21.2%/18.3%
Adjusted profit before tax (£m)/Profit before tax (£m)
385.0/170.5
2023: 884.3/705.1
Target
Growth to 21,500 in the medium term.
Status
Monitor
Definition
Legally completed homes during the year, including JV homes 
legally completed in which the Group has an interest.
Why it’s a KPI
Reflects activity and growth.
Monitors business capacity.
Target
Achieve minimum 23% adjusted gross margin.
Status
Below target
Definition
Adjusted gross profit/gross profit divided by total revenue, 
expressed as a percentage.
Why it’s a KPI
Key internal metric for assessing site profitability.
Enables consistent comparison of land acquisitions.
Target
Informed by consensus at the start of the financial year.
Status
Achieved
Definition
Adjusted profit before tax/profit before tax, including the applicable 
share of profits from JVs and associates.
Why it’s a KPI
Shows the profitability of the Group relative to market expectations.
Key metric for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
1
2
3
17,206
17,908
17,234
12,604
2023
2022
2021
2020
14,004
2024
18.5%
505.7
23.2%
919.7
24.8%
1,054.8
21.2%
884.3
16.5%
385.0
18.0%
491.8
21.0%
812.2
17.1%
642.3
18.3%
705.1
12.2%
170.5
2023
2023
2022
2022
2021
2021
2020
2020
2024
2024
Financial1
1	
In addition to the Group using a variety of statutory performance measures, it also measures performance using alternative performance measures (APMs). Definitions of the APMs 
and reconciliations to the equivalent statutory measures are detailed on pages 210 and 211.
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
14
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Return on capital employed
9.5%
2023: 22.2%
Net cash (£m)
868.5
2023: 1,069.4
Total shareholder return
(20.9)%
2023: 10.6%
Adjusted basic EPS (p)/Basic EPS (p)
28.3/11.8
2023: 67.3/53.2
Target
Minimum 25%.
Status
Below target
Definition
Earnings before amortisation, interest, tax, and 
operating adjusting items for the year, divided 
by average net assets adjusted for goodwill and 
intangibles, tax, net cash, derivative financial 
instruments and provisions in relation to legacy 
properties.
Why it’s a KPI
Ensures efficient and effective use of capital.
Key metric for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
Target
Year-end net cash.
Status
Achieved
Definition
Cash and cash equivalents, bank overdrafts, 
interest-bearing borrowings and prepaid fees.
Why it’s a KPI
Monitors business liquidity, resilience to risk and 
ability to take advantage of opportunities, including 
investments and land acquisition.
Allows for distributions to shareholders.
Target
To grow total shareholder return against 
FTSE companies (those within 50 above and 
50 below the Company in the index) and the 
housebuilding sector.
Status
Below target
Definition
Measure of the performance of the Group’s share 
price over a period of three financial years. It 
combines share price appreciation and dividends 
paid to show the total return to the shareholders 
expressed as a percentage.
Why it’s a KPI
Shows the appreciation and income a shareholder 
receives from holding each share.
Key metric for assessing performance for Executive 
Directors’ remuneration.
Target
Informed by consensus at the start of the 
financial year.
Status
Achieved
Definition
Adjusted profit/profit for the year attributable to 
ordinary shareholders divided by the weighted 
average number of ordinary shares in issue during 
the year, excluding those held by the EBT on which 
no dividend is paid.
Why it’s a KPI
Shows profit attributable to each share.
Key metric for assessing performance for 
Executive Directors’ remuneration.
4
5
7
6
22.2%
1,069.4
10.6%
30.0%
1,138.6
(4.9)%
27.8%
317.4
59.8%
15.5%
308.2
6.1%
2023
2023
2023
2022
2022
2022
2021
2021
2021
2020
2020
2020
9.5%
868.5
2024
2024
(20.9)%
2024
40.5
73.5
83.0
67.3
28.3
39.4
64.9
50.6
53.2
11.8
2023
2022
2021
2020
2024
Financial1 continued
1	
In addition to the Group using a variety of statutory performance measures, it also measures performance using alternative performance measures (APMs). Definitions of the APMs 
and reconciliations to the equivalent statutory measures are detailed on pages 210 and 211.
Key performance indicators continued
15
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Marketplace
The future landscape
The UK economy
The UK slipped back into a technical recession during 
the second half of 2023, reflecting the impact of the 
cost-of-living crisis and higher borrowing costs for both 
businesses and consumers. 
Activity during the first half of 2024 showed a slight 
improvement, with GDP growth estimated at 0.2% in the 
first quarter1 and GDP up 0.7% and 1.4% respectively, 
year on year, in April and May 20242. Notwithstanding 
an improving second half of FY24, UK economic growth 
remains stubbornly anaemic, reflecting in part the 
uncertainty generated by the previous Government’s 
policy, limited business confidence and the crimped 
state of both consumers’ confidence and real household 
disposable income.
The projected pace of any future acceleration in the 
economy remains lacklustre, with the Office for Budget 
Responsibility forecasting GDP growth of just 0.8% in 
2024 and 1.9% in 2025 in its Economic and fiscal outlook 
in March 20243. HM Treasury’s July Bank of England 
consensus of economic forecasts4 implies GDP growth 
of 0.9% in 2024 and 1.3% in 2025. 
Land supply, the planning system 
and housing delivery
The delivery of new homes and growth in housebuilding 
are linked to the land market and, crucially, the planning 
system, which delivers the permissioned land upon which 
housebuilding activity relies.
In February 2024, following an extensive study of the 
housebuilding industry, the Competition and Markets 
Authority (CMA) published its final report5, which concluded 
that: “Over the long term, the number of permissions being 
given has been insufficient to support housebuilding at the 
level required to meet Government targets and measures 
of assessed need.”
The CMA Report highlighted three key concerns with the 
planning system that limit its ability to support the level 
of housebuilding needed:
	• a lack of predictability;
	• the length, cost and complexity of the planning process; and
	• insufficient clarity, consistency and strength of local 
planning authority targets, objectives and incentives to 
meet housing demand.
The CMA concluded that “the nature and operation of the 
planning systems is a key driver of the under-delivery of 
new housing.” These findings align with the conclusions of 
numerous industry reviews and reports commissioned over 
the past 20 years, dating from the Barker Review in 2004. 
The housebuilding industry’s past success, and current 
challenges, with respect to planning and land supply, 
are highlighted in the chart to the right. 
 England – net new build home additions (RHS)
 England – planning consents (‘000s) – revised series (RHS)
 Savills UK Greenfield Development Land Price Index (LHS)

Planning and the UK land market
110
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
360
300
240
180
120
60
0
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
	• the industry’s past recovery in housing output from a low 
point of 117,700 homes in 2011 to 219,100 new homes in 2020, 
expanding output by more than 86% over this period6;
	• growth in annual planning consents, which began 
to expand ahead of the plots consumed on new 
homes, under planning policies adopted with the 
National Planning Policy Framework (NPPF) from 2012;
	• the decline in planning consents from the middle of 2021, 
following the publication in August 2020 of the “Planning 
for the Future” white paper, which created significant 
planning policy uncertainty;
	• constraints in the supply of consented land have limited 
adjustments to broader market land values, despite 
a decline in house prices and a significant step up in 
housebuilding costs since 2022; and
	• this has dramatically reduced the opportunities for the 
industry to reinvest back into land at acceptable returns 
relative to risk, to support a rapid housebuilding recovery.
The chart highlights the developing crisis in permissioned 
land supply and the critical need for the UK Government 
to address the sharp decline in planning consents over 
the past three years. Early indications from the new 
Government on planning are encouraging, but time will tell 
if this converts to planning consents.
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
16
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Land supply, the planning system 
and housing delivery continued
The steady and consistent supply of land within a predictable 
planning framework is critical to the housebuilding industry’s 
ability to deliver growth in housing output. This planning 
framework must deliver the quantity of permissioned land 
required to support build activity given:
	• the typical timeframe of development sites, which may 
be three to five years or more;
	• uncertainty on when construction activity can commence 
on a site, as pre-development clearances are required 
from multiple stakeholders after planning permission has 
been granted; 
	• availability of both local labour and building materials, and 
the scheduling thereof, to allow site development to begin; 
	• the frequent delays and extended periods of time taken 
by key utility providers to deliver connections of electricity, 
gas and water supply as well as sewerage system access;
	• the need to develop a consistent ongoing workload, 
at a local level, to support both employees and the 
sub‑contractor labour resources required to sustain the 
local industry over the short, medium and long term; and
	• the need to ensure build activity is delivered to 
demanding quality standards, whilst never compromising 
the health and safety of the workforce, customers and 
new homeowners, on housing development sites.
Relative to a peak of 335,8027 planning consents in the 
year to 30 June 2021, a level in line with the previous 
Government’s target to deliver more than 300,000 homes 
annually by the mid-2020s, just 236,6447 new build planning 
permissions were approved in England in the year to 31 
March 2024, 29.5% below the mid-2021 peak. 
Log-jams in the planning system have become increasingly 
acute, reflecting differing proposals for national planning 
policy reform since August 2020, as well as a lack of consensus 
within the previous Government. This stalemate has resulted 
in uncertainty for local authorities, housebuilders and other 
stakeholders.
The former Government’s decision in December 2023 
to make local housing targets “advisory” rather than 
“mandatory”, as well as ending the obligation on local 
authorities to maintain a rolling five-year land supply, if 
they have an up-to-date Local Plan, has compounded the 
challenging planning system, allowing 60 local authorities to 
stall their local housing delivery plans through FY248.
Interventions, with respect to nutrient neutrality, by Natural 
England have also created moratoria on housebuilding 
across significant areas of the country. In June 2024, more 
than 160,0009 planning consents have been halted across 
the 74 local authority areas impacted by Natural England’s 
position on nutrient neutrality, with new housebuilding 
effectively blocked and smaller housebuilders facing 
business closure unless they can demonstrate adequate 
mitigation for recreational, nutrient, or water impacts.
Despite the increasing complexity of planning applications, 
the resourcing of both local authority planning departments 
and other regulatory bodies with a role in planning remains 
an issue and has failed to match growing planning demands. 
Whilst the Government has introduced increases in planning 
fees, these changes are not delivering additional planning 
capacity and capabilities.
These issues have perpetuated a continuing decline in 
planning consents which, in the first quarter of calendar 
2024, declined by 13.3% to 53,862 compared with the 62,1377 
consents granted in the first quarter of 2023.
The recent announcements by the Secretary of State 
for Housing, Communities and Local Government are 
encouraging, not least the reintroduction of mandatory 
housing targets. We will continue to watch the new 
Government’s housing policy with interest.
Our solutions to unlock the poor state of the planning 
system centre on five key changes, looking to the future: 
	• the re-introduction of centrally set, mandated 
housing targets;
	• the re-introduction and strengthening of the five-year 
housing land supply requirements for local planning 
authorities;
	• the re-introduction of mandatory Local Plan requirement 
and faster creation of Local Plans;
	• the ring-fencing of planning fees for planning 
departments to drive greater levels of financial 
resourcing; and
	• a full review of the involvement, role and remit 
of statutory consultees.
 Read about our land position on pages 33 and 34
Marketplace continued
17
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Building materials
Over the past five years, the housebuilding industry 
has experienced very significant inflation in the cost 
of materials. The next chart highlights the significant 
escalation in housebuilding materials costs since FY19, 
with a cumulative increase of around 36%10 over the five 
years through FY24 and almost 30% over the past three 
years to FY24. Commodity cost inflation was driven initially 
by COVID-19 dislocations in the supply chain, and then 
a dramatic increase in energy costs, a significant cost 
component in the manufacture and transportation of many 
building materials, triggered by the conflict in Ukraine.
The inflationary impact of these “spot” costs for housebuilding 
materials is reflected in our income statement on a lagging 
basis, as the homes we build move through to completion 
and sale to our customers (see page 58 in the CFO Review 
for our cost inflation experienced in FY24). 
But, as can be seen from the chart, building material cost 
inflation slowed dramatically during FY24, with building 
materials costs deflating during the first half of the year, 
before showing slight inflation during the second half. 
Reflecting our work in progress and current supply terms, 
we anticipate building material costs will be slightly 
deflationary in FY25. 
Marketplace continued
Building materials for housing
140
130
120
110
100
90
80
30%
25%
20%
15%
10%
5%
0%
(5%)
FY19
FY20
FY21
FY22
FY23
FY24
3.8%
0.0%
4.5%
8.9%
19.6%
0.0%
 Annual change in New Housing Construction Material Price Index (RHS)
 New Housing Construction Material Price Index (LHS)

100.0
100.0
104.5
125.0
136.1
136.0
Housing delivery
New build housing additions in England were 212,570 during 
the year to 31 March 2023, growth of 0.4% on the 211,670 
added in the year to 31 March 2022. As a result, new home 
additions remained 3% below the 219,120 homes completed 
in the year to 31 March 20206. Net new build additions for 
the year to 31 March 2024 are likely to register a decline 
when data is released in late 2024. This decline will reflect 
the material changes in mortgage affordability for all 
homebuyers requiring a mortgage, as well as the absence of 
homebuyer support since the end of Help to Buy, which has 
compounded affordability challenges for first-time buyers. 
After peaking in summer 2022, house prices reduced 
through FY23 and firmed slightly in FY24 (in nominal if 
not real terms). Over the 12 months to 30 June 2024, the 
average UK house price increased by 1.5% according to 
the Nationwide Building Society and by 1.6% according 
to Halifax. 
The housing shortage is a critical issue for the UK economy, 
its competitiveness and the economic health and wellbeing 
of a growing proportion of the UK population. 
The combination of new household formation, a sharp 
increase in inward migration and existing rental households 
being stymied from moves into home ownership through 
mortgage affordability and qualification constraints, is 
funnelling a greater proportion of incremental housing 
demand to the rental sector, creating continued inflationary 
pressure on rental costs. 
According to the HomeLet Rental Index, the average household 
rent increased by 5.7% over the year to 30 June 2024, with 
all regions of the UK experiencing continuing rent cost 
increases. Based on HomeLet Rental Index data, rents have 
increased by 29.0% over the past three years to June 2024 
and, without a significant and sustained reduction in mortgage 
interest rates, rental demand looks set to outstrip supply, 
as potential homebuyers remain locked out of moving into 
home ownership.
What this means and how we 
are prepared 
Key determinants of future housebuilding materials 
pricing will be movements in energy costs, global 
commodity demand and housebuilding activity levels, 
as well as the supply chain’s capacity and willingness 
to either re-open capacity or invest in new production. 
We engage with our supply chain partners to understand 
their costs and supply chain sensitivities, and to drive 
efficiencies and negotiate supply terms that recognise 
the economic impacts across the value chain. We also 
engage with our suppliers around our future plans in 
support of housebuilding growth and the innovation 
required to meet future regulatory requirements. 
 Read more about supplier engagement on page 56
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
18
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Workforce challenges
The construction of our homes relies on our direct and sub-
contractor workforce. However, an ageing workforce and 
alternative, less physically demanding, career opportunities 
are limiting new entrants. As a result, the industry faces 
labour cost pressures and people employed in construction 
have seen significant wage growth. Average wage growth 
has equated to 19.0%11 over the last five years to May 2024 
and 15.1% over the last three years from FY21 to May 2024 
(see graph below). 
Labour cost inflation has been driven by both the 
wider cost-of-living crisis, limitations on access to 
construction workers from outside the UK, the ability 
of certain tradespeople to move between the new build 
and home repair and improvement market to meet the 
post‑COVID-19 uptick in homeowner spending, and the 
limited number of people entering the wider construction 
and housebuilding industry.
What this means and how we 
are prepared 
Reflecting labour costs capitalised into work in 
progress and ongoing trade-related inflationary 
pressures, we anticipate labour build cost inflation 
will be a continuing feature in FY25.
In the future, labour cost inflation will be determined 
by the speed and scale of recovery in housebuilding 
activity, the industry’s success in attracting a larger 
workforce and the wider economic inflationary backdrop.
We are placing increasing emphasis on promoting the 
career advantages and opportunities in housebuilding 
to attract young people to the industry. We are also 
increasingly adopting modern methods of construction 
(MMC), most notably through our increasing adoption 
of timber frame for the homes we build, reducing the 
demand for on-site construction labour.
 Read more about our new Oregon factory on page 39
120
115
110
105
100
95
90
85 
80
9%
8%
7%
6%
5%
4%
3%
2% 
1%
0%
FY19
FY20
FY21
FY22
FY23
FY24
4.5%
0.2%
3.2%
5.0%
5.7%
3.6%
100.0
100.2
103.4
109.3
114.8
119.0
Labour costs
	Annual change in average weekly construction index earnings (%) (RHS)
 	Construction average earnings index (FY19 = 100) (LHS)

Jamie Fox, Senior Site Manager for David Wilson Homes
Marketplace continued
19
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Marketplace continued
Nominal wage growth remains positive and ahead of 
inflation, which should impact positively on house price 
affordability. With inflation returning to 2% in June 2024 
and base rates being lowered by 25 basis points to 5% 
in August, the mortgage market is starting to respond 
positively, giving customers some respite from high 
borrowing costs.
Mortgage rates
7%
6%
5%
4%
3%
2%
1%
0%
Jun
19
Dec
19
Jun
20
Dec
20
Jun
21
Dec
21
Jun
22
Dec
22
Jun
23
Dec
23
Jun
24
 Average mortgage interest rate – all new mortgages
 Two-year fixed mortgage interest rate at 75% LTV
The Halifax Mortgage Affordability Index combines the 
prevailing available mortgage interest rate on new advances 
with the Halifax House Price Index and monthly average 
take home pay. Notably, the purchase of a new home in the 
first quarter of 2024 equated to 43.1% of average after tax 
income, still significantly above the long-term average at 
33.1% (see chart below). 
Affordability
60%
55% 
50%
45%
40%
35%
30%
25%
20%
 Halifax Affordability Index
 Average Affordability Index (1985–2023)
1985
1987
1989
1991
1993
1995
1997
1999
2001
2003
2005
2007
2009
2011
2013
2015
2017
2019
2021
2023
The mortgage market and 
housing affordability
Movements in mortgage interest rates over the last 
five years, specifically two-year fixed rates at 75% loan 
to value12, and the average actual mortgage rate on all 
new monthly mortgage advances13 are included in the 
following chart.
Visible from the chart is the benign interest rate backdrop 
through to November 2021, with the actual interest rate on 
mortgage advances drawn at between 1.5% and 2.0% over this 
period. There then followed the period of steep mortgage 
rates increases which, despite the volatility in two-year rates 
available from November 2022, saw the average interest rate 
on UK mortgage advances continue rising through to November 
2023. Only since December 2023 has the average rate on new 
advances eased lower, to 4.84% in June 2024. 
5 star for fifteen years in a row
93% of our customers said they would recommend us to 
a friend in the latest annual Home Builders Federation 
(HBF) National New Homes Customer Satisfaction Survey. 
We have a 5-star rating for customer satisfaction, and 
are the only major housebuilder to be awarded this 
accolade for fifteen years in a row. 
The HBF New Homes Survey is completed by around 
50,000 people who have recently bought a new 
build home. The simple 1 to 5 star rating system was 
developed to give customers an easy-to-view ranking of 
which housebuilders have the most satisfied customers.
 Read about the HBF New Homes survey online:
www.hbf.co.uk/policy/customer-satisfaction-survey/results
We do it for our customers
The Chamund family outside of their home at the Thorpebury in the Limes development
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
20
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Regulatory changes in the year
Biodiversity net gain 
Biodiversity net gain (BNG) legislation, introduced in 
the Environment Act 2021, came into legislative effect 
on 12 February 2024. This requires all new planning 
permissions to deliver at least 10% biodiversity net gain 
in England, excepting selected smaller sites for which 
the requirement was delayed until April 2024. 
What this means and how we are prepared 
Inherent in the legislation is an approach to development 
whereby biodiversity should be left in a measurably better 
state than if the development had not taken place, with 
this improvement set at a minimum 10%. 
We consider BNG at each stage of our land buying and 
planning process, from the best design configuration for 
a development, to the integration of open green and blue 
space, along with the positioning of site infrastructure, 
so as to achieve optimal planning, biodiversity and land 
viability outcomes.
Reflecting our commitment to sustainable development 
and to ensure we had the necessary skills and disciplines 
in place, we committed to ensuring all new development 
designs submitted for planning from January 2023 would 
identify a minimum BNG of 10%, 12 months ahead of the 
legislation coming into force. 
All of our sites submitting their first principle planning 
application since January 2023 have biodiversity plans 
in place, demonstrating a minimum BNG of at least 10%. 
We have achieved this through:
	• avoiding development impact on the areas of greatest 
biodiversity value;
	• minimising the environmental impacts of our 
development operations; and
	• both enhancing existing and creating new habitats on 
our developments. 
When Barratt secures planning approval on a site, the 
landowner and local planning authority can be assured 
that the ecological value of the land will be increased, 
creating a legacy of which all stakeholders can be proud.
Future regulatory changes
Future Homes Standard
The Future Homes Standard (FHS) encompasses new 
regulations around the energy efficiency and the emissions 
created by new homes. The government has completed 
a consultation in which we were an active participant, 
on 24 March 2024.
The FHS requires new homes to produce between 75% and 
80% less carbon emissions than homes built to standards 
applicable through to June 2022. Homes built under FHS 
will be essentially “zero carbon ready” meaning no further 
work is needed to ensure these homes are net zero once 
the electricity grid has fully decarbonised. 
The Future Homes and Building Standards legislation 
is expected to be laid before Parliament during 2024, 
with either a six-month or twelve-month period before 
the legislation will come in to force, followed by a 
twelve‑month transitional period.
Marketplace continued
What this means and how we 
are prepared 
The FHS involves changes in building fabric, the 
adoption of low-carbon heating and the use of 
additional technologies including photovoltaics, smart 
meters and other developing technologies. Our Group 
Design and Technical team is leading the development 
and testing of materials and products that we will 
use to deliver the house types and build solutions to 
meet the FHS requirements. Through a combination 
of research projects encompassing the Zed House, 
eHome2 and live development trials, the team is 
creating optimal solutions to meet this new standard. 
Sources and references
1	
ons.gov.uk/economy/grossdomesticproductgdp/bulletins/gdpfirstquarterlyestimateuk/latest
2	 ons.gov.uk/economy/grossdomesticproductgdp/bulletins/gdpmonthlyestimateuk/may2024
3	 obr.uk/efo/economic-and-fiscal-outlook-march-2024/
4	 assets.publishing.service.gov.uk/media/66969d95fc8e12ac3edafde9/Forecasts_for_the_UK_
Economy_-_July_Cover.pdf
5	 assets.publishing.service.gov.uk/media/65d8baed6efa83001ddcc5cd/Housebuilding_market_
study_final_report.pdf
6	 gov.uk/government/statistics/housing-supply-net-additional-dwellings-england-2022-
to-2023/housing-supply-net-additional-dwellings-england-2022-to-2023
7	
hbf.co.uk/documents/13634/HPL_REPORT_2024_Q1.pdf
8	 hbf.co.uk/news/councils-spend-50-million-opposing-development-of-new-homes/
9	 hbf.co.uk/documents/13626/HBF_Election_Manifesto_2024__For_Publishing.pdf
10	 gov.uk/government/statistics/building-materials-and-components-statistics-july-2024
11	 ons.gov.uk/employmentandlabourmarket/peopleinwork/earningsandworkinghours/datasets/
averageweeklyearningsbyindustryearn03
12	 bankofengland.co.uk/boeapps/database/fromshowcolumns.asp?Travel=NIxSUx&FromSeries=1
&ToSeries=50&DAT=RNG&FD=1&FM=Jan&FY=2014&TD=7&TM=Aug&TY=2024&FNY=&CSVF=TT&ht
ml.x=166&html.y=46&C=EOT&Filter=N
13	 bankofengland.co.uk/boeapps/database/fromshowcolumns.asp?Travel=NIxSUx&FromSeries=1
&ToSeries=50&DAT=RNG&FD=1&FM=Jan&FY=2014&TD=7&TM=Aug&TY=2024&FNY=&CSVF=TT&ht
ml.x=128&html.y=46&C=IPF&Filter=N
Pollination education station at Ersham Park, Hailsham
21
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement
Building for the future
Introduction
The past year has proved challenging for both the housebuilding 
industry and homebuyers, with cost‑of‑living pressures, 
much higher mortgage rates and limited consumer confidence 
having a negative impact on housing market activity. Against 
this backdrop, we have remained focused on delivering 
high‑quality, energy-efficient and sustainable homes across 
the country. We have driven revenue to support our business 
as well as our supply chain partners to position us to meet 
the growing shortfall in new homes supply. We have been 
rigorous in controlling our build activity, managing our cost 
base and being highly selective in our land buying, whilst 
ensuring we continue to lead the industry through our 
unwavering commitment to build quality, customer service, 
social responsibility and sustainability.
We also launched our new purpose during the year which is 
anchored around sustainability and building strong communities. 
Our new values are focused on our customers, on doing it 
right and doing it together, and making things happen. This 
framework formalises the culture and principles which have 
driven our success to date.
The acquisition of Redrow
Against this challenging backdrop, we have proactively 
considered opportunities to strengthen our business and 
give us an even stronger platform from which to deliver 
sustainable growth and meet housing needs throughout 
Great Britain. This process culminated in the announcement 
in February 2024 of the proposed acquisition of Redrow 
plc, which completed on 21 August 2024. We are working 
with the CMA to address the findings of its Phase 1 
competition review which is expected to be complete by 
mid-October 2024. We are excited about the opportunities 
for the combined group, which creates an exceptional UK 
housebuilder with strong quality, customer service and 
sustainability credentials.
 More details on the Redrow acquisition and the benefits of the new 
entity are on pages 6 and 7
David Thomas
Chief Executive
In this section
 Performance summary on pages 23 and 24
 Responsible development on page 24
 Charitable giving and the Barratt Foundation on pages 25 and 26
 Operational review on pages 26 and 27
 Our customers on pages 28 and 29
 Our people on pages 30 to 32
 Our land position on pages 33 and 34
 Our build performance on pages 35 to 37
 Current trading and outlook on page 38
We delivered a solid 
operating performance 
in FY24, supported by the 
commitment, flexibility 
and determination of our 
employees, sub-contractors 
and supply chain partners.
22
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Performance summary
Our strategic priorities supported our solid operational and 
financial performance during FY24, protected our balance 
sheet and our strong financial position, and strengthened 
our credentials with our customers, building materials 
suppliers, landowners and wider stakeholders.
We delivered a solid operating performance in FY24, 
at the upper end of our expectations, supported by 
the commitment, flexibility and determination of our 
employees, sub-contractors and supply chain partners, 
including:
	• Total home completions of 14,004 (FY23: 17,206). 
	• 16.5% adjusted gross margin (FY23: 21.2%) and adjusted 
gross profit of £689.0m (FY23: £1,130.4m). The reduction 
in adjusted gross profit reflected:
•	 stabilisation of customer demand at lower levels; 
•	 softening house prices; 
•	 ongoing, but moderating, build cost inflation; and
•	 the operational gearing impact of lower home completions.
	• The impact of adjusting items, which reflected legacy 
property costs associated with building safety-related 
remediation activities resulted in a reported gross profit 
of £509.5m (FY23: £974.9m) and a reported gross margin 
of 12.2% (FY23: 18.3%).
	• Adjusted profit before tax of £385.0m (FY23: £884.3m).
	• Reported profit before tax, after deducting adjusting 
items, of £170.5m (FY23: £705.1m).
	• Maintained balance sheet strength with year-end net cash 
of £868.5m (FY23: £1,069.4m) after dividend payments of 
£270.6m (FY23: £360.0m), legacy property related cash 
expenditure of £91.5m (FY23: £32.9m) and a £33.9m 
reduction in land creditors (FY23: £226.9m reduction). 
	• ROCE reduced to 9.5% (FY23: 22.2%), reflecting reduced 
profitability.
Drive revenue
Driving revenue through the targeted use of incentives 
for private purchasers and increased sales into the 
private rented and social housing sectors
FY24 progress
	• Price deflation slowed on our underlying private home 
reservations, from 5.6% in H1 to 2.7% in H2. 
	• Private rented sector home completions increased by 
306.2% to 1,048 homes (FY23: 258 homes).
	• Multi-unit sales, including those to registered providers, 
increased by 46.9% to 767 homes (FY23: 522 homes).
Control build activity
Controlling build activity and managing our costs
FY24 progress
	• We aligned our site-based construction activity to lower 
reservations, with an average of 257 equivalent homes 
(including JVs) constructed each week in FY24, 20.2% below 
the 322 average equivalent homes, built weekly, in FY23.
	• We reduced our headcount by a cumulative 12% through to 
30 June 2024 from 30 September 2022, delivered through 
our ongoing recruitment freeze. This compared with a 6% 
cumulative reduction from 30 September 2022 through to 
30 June 2023.
Optimise land buying
Maintaining our highly selective approach to land buying
FY24 progress
	• We approved 58 net site additions, equating to 12,439 plots in 
the year with activity weighted to the second half of the year.
	• We continued to rigorously apply our long-standing hurdle 
requirements for new land investment, at a minimum gross 
margin of 23% and ROCE of 25%.
	• Through our long-standing relationships, and industry-leading 
reputation, we have concluded important deals with both 
public and private landowners, which will deliver significant 
development pipelines over the coming years.
Lead the industry
Leading the industry around customer service, build 
quality, social responsibility and sustainability
FY24 progress
	• We maintained our five-star HBF customer satisfaction status 
with the latest rolling annual recommend score of 93%, the 
highest score for UK national housebuilders.
	• We also maintained our industry leadership position among 
the major UK housebuilders, registering the lowest NHBC 
Reportable Items per inspection at 0.13 through FY24 
(FY23: 0.16).
	• The Barratt Foundation reached a significant milestone, 
delivering more than £10m of funding for local and national 
charities since its launch in 2021.
	• We were recognised, once again, as the leading national 
sustainable housebuilder by NextGeneration and received their 
Gold Award for the eighth consecutive year.
Strategic priorities
Anticipating a challenging backdrop, we set four strategic priorities in summer 2023, 
which supported our performance through FY24.
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
23
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Responsible development
Keeping people safe
Our first priority is always to provide a safe working 
environment for all of our employees and sub‑contractors, 
and we are committed to achieving the highest industry 
health and safety standards.
We were deeply saddened by the tragic accidental death 
of a sub-contractor at one of our sites in November 2023. 
Further details can be found in the Safety, Health and 
Environment Committee Report on page 121. 
During FY24, despite concerted campaigns to raise health 
and safety issues, our injury incidence rate increased to 302 
(FY23: 289) per 100,000 workers whilst we improved our 
SHE audit compliance to 97% (FY23: 96%). 
We remain focused on improving our site-based processes 
and procedures, challenging unsafe behaviours and building 
on our health and safety performance through on-site 
induction training, safety awareness for all personnel and 
developing our site managers’ vigilance to health and safety 
risks on site.
Fire safety and external wall systems
We continue to make progress with the assessment and 
remediation of buildings covered under the Building Safety 
Self-Remediation Terms and Contract, to which the Group 
became a signatory on 13 March 2023. 
Around 53% of our portfolio under review has been 
assessed under the Fire Risk Assessment of External Walls 
(FRAEW) and has an appropriate PAS 9980 assessment 
in place. Through inspections and testing in FY24, we 
identified a further 26 buildings requiring potential remedial 
works (FY23: 65 buildings) and 42 buildings were either 
successfully remediated or were assessed as not requiring 
remediation (FY23: 10 buildings). As a result, at 30 June 2024, 
we have an ongoing portfolio of 262 buildings across 92 
developments under review (30 June 2023: 278 buildings 
across 89 developments). 
Reflecting our commitment to dealing with these buildings 
as quickly and efficiently as possible, of the 262 buildings 
under review at 30 June 2024, 137 were in progress at 
tender, site mobilisation or remediation stage.
In the first half of the year, we recognised a charge of 
£56.4m to reflect higher than expected tender returns 
and cost increases on buildings being remediated by the 
Building Safety Fund. These generally related to buildings 
with atypical features and costs in relation to the remaining 
buildings are broadly in line with our initial estimates.
During the second half of the year, we recognised a charge 
of £64.5m, following an initial £5.0m for fire testing 
recognised in the first half, in relation to a development 
of three buildings which we had previously disclosed as 
a contingent liability. We have been unable to develop a 
testing methodology under the FRAEW for these buildings 
due to the unique unitised wall system in place, which we 
now assess will need to be replaced. The provision is based 
on the current expected method of remediation, designed 
to minimise disruption to residents, though due to the 
unique nature of the buildings, this estimate may vary as 
the process is further developed.
After incorporating the additional adjusted item charges 
for fire safety and external wall systems of £125.9m, as 
well as with remediation costs incurred during FY24 and 
time discounting adjustments, the provision in relation to 
fire safety and external wall systems totalled £628.1m at 
30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: £535.9m). This reflects our 
current best estimate of the extent and future costs of 
remediation work required and we will continue to review 
these estimates as we gather data and complete the 
remediation of buildings within our portfolio.
We signed the Scottish Government’s Safer Building Accord 
on 31 May 2023. The process to agree a legally binding, 
long-form contract to give effect to the Principles of the 
Accord remains in progress with Homes for Scotland and 
the Scottish Government. As a result of this uncertainty, 
our existing provisions for Scottish buildings have been 
made on a consistent basis with England and Wales but 
are subject to change depending on the outcome of the 
contract negotiations. 
Reinforced concrete frames
We continued our remediation activities for concrete 
frame design and construction during FY24. Work on 
our developments proceeded in line with our plans and 
remediation is well advanced.
During FY23, structural issues were identified at two 
developments where reinforced concrete frames were 
designed for us by a different engineering firm to that 
employed at Citiscape. Having initially disclosed these as 
contingent liabilities, following further analysis during the 
second half of FY24, we now expect that remediation work 
will be required. Based on our current assessment of the 
required work, a further £56.6m has been provided for and 
an additional £7.6m recognised as our share of the costs 
within joint ventures in respect of these two developments.
After the additional charge of £56.6m, as well as the costs 
incurred on concrete frame remediation during FY24 and 
time discounting adjustments, the provision for reinforced 
concrete frames totalled £102.2m at 30 June 2024 (30 June 
2023: £76.4m) and reflects our current best estimate of the 
scope and future costs of remediation work required. 
Building safety considerations are paramount in prioritising 
and scheduling remediation works. Our dedicated Building 
Safety Unit manages our ongoing building safety remediation 
programme, which we expect to deliver over the next five years.
Wigmore Park, New Waltham
 Further details on our approach to building safety are on 
our website at: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/about-us/
our-approach-to-building-safety
24
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Charitable giving and the 
Barratt Foundation
As part of our purpose, building strong communities, we 
recognise we have a role to play both as a business and 
through the efforts of our employees in the communities 
in which they live and work across the country. We work 
with the Barratt Foundation to focus our charitable work 
on improving our impact across the communities we 
support. Thanks to Barratt Developments’ core funding, 
every pound raised by the Foundation is available for 
charitable purposes.
The year has been an exceptional one for charitable giving, 
thanks to the Barratt Foundation and the fundraising and 
volunteering efforts of individuals and teams across the Group.
In November 2023, the Barratt Foundation celebrated a 
significant milestone: it has now delivered more than 
£10m of funding to more than 1,000 local and national 
charities since it launched in January 2021. In FY24, we 
donated £6.4m (FY23: £6.3m) to charitable causes through 
the Barratt Foundation and employee fundraising. 
Our impact and reach
In FY24, the Foundation has:
	• supported over 500 charities, with more than £4m 
funds donated;
	• supported around 400 local communities through funding 
and employee volunteering; and 
	• positively changed the lives of over 90,000 children and 
young people through national partnerships and grants.
The Barratt Foundation’s activities – 
three areas of charity support:
1. Our national charity partners 
The Foundation supports national charities that positively 
affect the lives of children, young people and those most 
disadvantaged in communities across the UK. During FY24, 
the Foundation donated over £2.5m to national partnerships 
and grants, including our six national charity partners: 
Whizz Kidz, Place2Be, The Outward Bound Trust, Bookmark 
Reading, Magic Breakfast and Street League.
2. The Barratt and David Wilson Community Fund
Through this fund, our divisions and Group offices can 
donate £1,500 each month to different local charities 
and organisations that really matter to them and which 
enhance the lives of people living in their area. Reflecting 
the additional challenges that communities face in the 
winter, we also provided a Winter Support Fund in FY24. Our 
divisions and teams supported 66 selected small and local 
charities such as hospices, homeless charities and food 
banks, which each received a donation of £3,000. 
3. Match funding for our employees fundraising activities
In FY24, our employees and divisions raised a record £1.4m 
(FY23: £1.3m) to support local or national charities and good 
causes, with an additional £0.6m (FY23: £0.8m) from the 
Barratt Foundation, which provides matched funding of up 
to £12,000 per division and up to £1,000 per employee. We 
also partner with Payroll Giving in Action so our employees 
can make regular, tax-free donations to their chosen 
charities – UK or international.
Street League
Street League, our new national charity partner, 
uses the power of sport to support young people into 
employment. With operations in 35 locations spanning 
London to Edinburgh, the charity works with unemployed 
16 to 24 year olds who face tough life challenges and 
personal barriers. Many of the deprived areas where 
Street League operates are the most disadvantaged 
communities in the UK, where youth unemployment is 
three times the national average and can exceed 20%. 
The Foundation’s initial donation of £300,000 in FY24 
is targeted to fund at least 700 young people into 
employment, and is vital to enhancing their life chances, 
social inclusion and sense of worth and wellbeing.
Our new national charity partner 
We make it happen
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
 For further details on the value we create in the communities 
in which we operate please see our socio-economic 
footprint at: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/media/
Files/B/Barratt-Developments/sustainability/fy24-group-
socio-economic-footprint.pdf
25
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Charitable giving and the 
Barratt Foundation continued
Employee volunteering 
A key component to our charitable activities is our 
employee volunteering, where we made significant strides 
in FY24, notwithstanding a 100% increase in volunteering 
days during FY23. In FY24, our employees gave up 1,935 
days to volunteer with projects in their local communities, 
an advance of 73% on FY23. The Big Barratt Cleanup in 
April 2024 was our first national volunteering campaign 
with CleanupUK. It gave our employees the opportunity to 
take part in a local litter pick to help transform their local 
community. More than 430 volunteered their time to take 
part in 25 Big Barratt Cleanup events, removing more than 
500 bags of rubbish and litter from local landscapes – 
equivalent to 2.7 tonnes.
Working together with our charity partners 
to help the Group deliver for our customers
As part of our drive to create inclusivity and build stronger 
communities, we aim to improve and enhance the play 
areas in our developments for children and young people 
with physical disabilities and neurodiverse conditions.
Through Whizz Kidz and the generous help of families 
supported by the charity, our designers were able to 
research, develop and test our newly enhanced play 
area designs for children with different needs. Specifically 
designed play areas and tailored play area equipment are 
set for roll-out at various Barratt developments around 
the UK in FY25.
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Getting involved 
“Barratt Developments’ employees have 
made a significant impact, creating cleaner, 
safer, and healthier spaces in their local 
communities across the UK, from Aberdeen 
to Exeter – we could not be more delighted. 
We are very proud of the partnership we 
have with the Barratt Foundation. It has 
been transformational and has enabled us to 
expand our CleanupUK Community Partners 
initiative by setting up community cleanup 
hubs in some of the most disadvantaged 
wards across the UK. Together, we are making a 
tangible difference in communities nationwide.”
George Monck, 
CleanupUK Chief Executive
Operational review
Reservation activity
Our net private reservation rate in FY24 was 0.58 (FY23: 0.55). 
The 5.5% improvement across FY24 reflected a pick-
up in activity as mortgage interest rates moved lower 
from August 2023. Month-to-month reservation rates 
thereafter showed relative stability, but with a greater 
degree of sensitivity to mortgage interest rate movements. 
This sensitivity reflected the mortgage affordability and 
qualification challenges faced by prospective homebuyers, 
the majority of whom depended on access to mortgages.
Net private reservation rate
H1
H2
FY
FY24 – reported private 
reservation rate
0.48
0.69
0.58
Of which: PRS and other
multi-unit sales
0.06
0.10
0.08
Private reservation rate 
excluding PRS and other
multi-unit sales
0.42
0.59
0.50
FY23 – reported private 
reservation rate
0.44
0.65
0.55
Of which: PRS and other
multi-unit sales
0.05
0.13
0.10
Private reservation rate 
excluding PRS and other
multi-unit sales
0.39
0.52
0.45
Change FY24 vs FY23
Reported private 
reservation rate
9.1%
6.2%
5.5%
Of which: PRS and other
multi-unit sales
20.0%
(23.1)%
(20.0)%
Private reservation rate 
excluding PRS and other
multi-unit sales
7.7%
13.5%
11.1%
We do it together
Barratt beach clean up in Aberdeen
 More details on the Barratt Foundation and its activities 
are at: barrattfoundation.org.uk/ 
26
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Operational review continued
Reservation activity continued
Reservation activity during the year reflected stabilising 
demand from first-time buyers. This, despite many 
first-time buyers finding it hard to both raise deposits, 
given cost-of-living pressures, and secure income and 
affordability qualification, given the higher mortgage rates 
available. Rental cost inflation has, however, also been 
a continuing challenge for first-time buyers and a key 
driver for those in rental accommodation looking to move 
into home ownership as and when mortgage qualification 
metrics are met.
There was resilient demand from existing homeowners 
with accrued equity in their current homes. Reservation 
activity from existing homeowners did, however, require 
additional sales support with 16% (FY23: 11%) of the Group’s 
reservations in the year utilising part-exchange. At the end 
of the year we held 120 unsold part-exchange homes, lower 
than the 146 held at the end of the prior year.
Increased sales into the private rented sector, along with 
additional multi-unit sales to registered providers of social 
housing and others, partly mitigated the weakness in 
traditional private reservations, supported our construction 
activity and ensured more of our homes were made 
available for both the private rented and affordable 
homes markets. The net private reservation rate into the 
private rented sector, along with additional multi-unit 
sales contributed 0.08 (FY23: 0.10) to the reservation rate 
in the year.
Sales outlets
During the year, we operated from an average of 346 active 
sales outlets (FY23: 367), including 9 active JV sales outlets 
(FY23: 8). Whilst average sales outlets were ahead in the 
first half, the decline in active outlets through the second 
half reflected two factors:
	• A conscious decision within the Group to slow site 
openings to ensure our new sales outlets were launched 
to create maximum market impact. Notwithstanding this 
decision, as well as ongoing planning delays, we launched 
a total of 57 new sales outlets (including JVs) in the year 
(FY23: 104).
	• Whilst the average life of our sales outlets has been 
extended by the lower private sales rate experienced 
since Autumn 2022, we saw a significant proportion of 
these “extended” outlets close, as they sold through from 
late 2023 through to June 2024.
At 30 June 2024 we were operating from 326 active sales 
outlets (FY23: 389), including 10 JV outlets (FY23: 9).
As previously announced, in FY25 we expect average active 
sales outlets will reduce by approximately 9% due to lower 
land buying activity in 2022 and 2023 and the annualised 
impact of sales outlets closing in the second half of FY24. 
We expect this reduction to be temporary with significant 
net sales outlet growth in Q4 FY25 and throughout FY26 
supporting average sales outlets for FY26 above FY24 levels.
Home completions
Total home completions including JVs reduced by 18.6% in 
FY24 to 14,004 (FY23: 17,206). Our reduced private forward 
order book at the start of FY24, in combination with the 
ongoing rate of weekly reservation activity, crystallised a 
24.2% decline in our private wholly owned home completions 
(excluding homes for PRS and other multi-unit sales). 
Our deliberate decision to seek growth through PRS and 
other multi-unit sales limited the decline in total home 
completions, with PRS home sales advancing 306.2% and 
other multi-unit sales completions increasing by 46.9%.
The affordable housing share of wholly owned home 
completions reduced to 20.8% (FY23: 23.9%). Many 
registered providers are facing operational and financial 
constraints due to the higher interest environment, as 
well as increased scrutiny on maintenance, repair and 
improvement of their existing housing portfolios. As a result, 
registered providers are less eager to secure additional 
affordable housing through the homes we deliver through 
Section 106 arrangements. In FY25, we anticipate the 
affordable housing share of wholly owned completions 
will be in the high teens.
Completions (homes)1
FY24
FY23
Change
Private excluding PRS 
and other multi-unit sales
8,851
11,676
(24.2)%
PRS
1,048
258
306.2 %
Other multi-unit sales
767
522
46.9 %
Total private
10,666
12,456
(14.4)%
Affordable
2,802
3,922
(28.6)%
Wholly owned
13,468
16,378
(17.8)%
JV
536
828
(35.3)%
Total2 (including JVs)
14,004
17,206
(18.6)%
The average selling price (ASP) of wholly owned completions 
reduced by 4.0% to £306.8k (FY23: £319.6k). The total 
private ASP reduced by 6.4% to £343.9k (FY23: £367.6k). 
Within our total private completions, we completed 1,048 
PRS homes (FY23: 258). The ASP of these PRS completions 
was £285.1k (FY23: £280.9k), with the ASP movement 
reflecting the diverse geographic spread of the homes 
completed in the period. 
We also completed 767 other multi-unit home sales (FY23: 522) 
including home completions for registered providers, meeting 
their demand for additional homes using Government grant 
funding, and incremental to affordable homes provided under 
Section 106 requirements. The ASP of other multi-unit sales 
completions was £292.3k (FY23: £284.7k), with geographic mix 
accounting for the larger part of the ASP movement.
The ASP of our affordable home completions reduced 
by 1.1% to £165.3k (FY23: £167.2k), reflecting a reduced 
proportion of completions from our London operations, 
offset by site mix. 
We expect the affordable ASP in FY25 will be similar to that 
reported in FY24.
1	
Unless otherwise stated, all numbers quoted exclude JVs.
2	 Including JVs in which the Group has an interest.
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
27
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our customers
Back in 2014, we first introduced Barratt Developments’ 
vision. It cemented our commitment to our customers by 
setting down our aims and ambitions: “To lead the future 
of housebuilding by putting customers at the heart of 
everything we do”. Over the past decade, this vision has 
been a constant: driving our actions and behaviours, our 
culture and our decision making – but first and foremost, 
it prioritised our unwavering commitment to our customers. 
Yet, we recognise that the needs of our many customers 
are constantly changing, as well as the communities in 
which we operate and play a key role in creating, and 
that we have an increasing responsibility to protect our 
environment. Through engagement with customers, our 
employees and teams, as well as our wider stakeholders, 
we have formulated our new purpose: “Making sustainable 
living a reality, building strong communities.” 
This evolution in our purpose is supported by our 
new values centred on “We do it for our customers” 
and “We do it right”. These values reflect not only the 
unwavering focus we have on our customers, but also a 
broadening of the expectations set by our customers and 
upon which we ourselves should aspire to meet and exceed. 
We put our customers and their new homes, as well as 
their communities and local environment, at the heart of 
everything we do. 
Great choice for potential customers
Through our existing housebuilding brands, we offer a wide 
range of homes for our customers: from one-bedroom 
apartments to five and six-bedroom homes. Barratt 
London is our award-winning operation within the M25. 
Barratt Homes and David Wilson Homes operate across 
Great Britain outside London. Depending on the size of 
the development and local market dynamics, they operate 
single-branded sites or as dual-branded locations, creating 
greater variety and choice for potential homebuyers through 
development design, street scenes, house types and price 
points. As a result, dual-branded developments generate 
higher sales rates than those offering a single brand.
During FY24, we operated with 252 developments on 
average across Great Britain: 97 developments under the 
Barratt Homes brand; 54 under the David Wilson Homes 
brand; and 101 dual-branded developments with both 
Barratt and David Wilson Homes. We are continually looking 
to enhance choices for our customers and increase the 
variety and diversity of our developments through our 
branded house types.
The acquisition of Redrow, along with CMA approval, 
will support the further development of our portfolio 
of strong brands, with recognisable house types and 
reputations for great quality and customer service. It will 
also create greater choice for both Redrow and Barratt 
customers, accelerate the pace of housebuilding across our 
developments and is a key ingredient in making our land 
banks work efficiently for all stakeholders.
Great service through the buying process 
and beyond
We believe our industry leadership in customer service 
is fundamental to our success. We are the only major 
housebuilder to have been awarded the maximum five-star 
rating by our customers in the HBF Customer Satisfaction 
Survey for 15 consecutive years, with our latest customer 
satisfaction rating at 93%.
We want our customers to receive the best possible 
service, not only throughout their home buying journey but 
also post-completion. We invest in training and workshops 
to enhance our service and our customers’ experience 
beyond the handover of their new home.
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
First home buyers, George, Hayley and Digby
28
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our customers continued
New Homes Quality Code
We operate under the New Homes Quality Code (the Code) 
as a registered developer with the New Homes Quality 
Board. Introduced in 2022, the Code covers the period from 
initial homebuyer enquiry through to completion and then 
two years post-occupation of the new home. It centres on 
fairness throughout the customer journey, and not simply 
the achievement of technical standards around build quality 
and defects.
New build advantages for our customers 
We are continually seeking to improve the energy and water 
efficiency, as well as the sustainability of our homes and 
adapting our home designs to respond to both changing 
homebuyer demands, as well as the Future Homes Standard 
and other changes to building regulations. We aim to build 
high-quality homes that optimise internal space, deliver 
excellent energy and water efficiency and, as a result, 
unlock lower lifetime costs for our customers.
We actively promote the lower running costs and wider 
environmental benefits such as biodiversity features 
and transport connections of our homes across all our 
communication channels and in our sales centres. This is 
an increasingly important purchasing consideration for our 
customers. A typical Barratt or David Wilson house, built 
from June 2023 under latest Building Regulations, can 
unlock annual energy bill savings estimated at more than 
£2,5701 annually when compared to an average existing 
house. In FY24 more than 99% of our home completions 
were EPC rated “B” or above, a level of energy efficiency 
shared by just 3.3%2 of the existing housing stock. 
In addition, all of our homes are designed to a water use 
standard of 105 litres per person per day, creating the 
potential to reduce consumption by 25% when compared to 
the national average3 and creating further cost savings for 
our homeowners.
Green mortgage development reflecting 
new build advantages
The financial and environmental advantages of new build 
homes have never been as significant as they are today, 
and we are committed to enhancing both the access and 
affordability of our new homes in partnership with both 
mortgage lenders and surveyors.
Mortgage lenders, driven by their own sustainability 
initiatives, the growing recognition of future retrofit costs 
in relation to energy efficiency for existing homes, and the 
scale of annual savings from new build home ownership 
are increasingly engaging with the housebuilding industry 
around green mortgages. 
The surveying industry is critical in developing a consistent 
and enduring valuation framework that will allow the 
recognition of the financial and environmental advantages 
of high-quality, new build homes. 
As the leading national sustainable housebuilder, we have 
a dual approach to green mortgage development. 
	• We work directly with mortgage lenders to develop 
enhanced mortgage products that recognise the 
advantages of our new build, energy-efficient homes. 
During FY24, Accord (The Yorkshire Building Society) 
joined The Leeds Building Society with the launch of a 
new green mortgage product. Both mortgage lenders 
recognise the advantages inherent in new energy-efficient 
homes, and their mortgage products have the potential to 
unlock up to a 10% uplift in lending.
	• We collaborate with the wider industry and the 
Government, notably through the Future Homes Hub. 
Barratt’s Head of Mortgage Lender Relations also chairs 
the “Valuation Group”, which is considering how the value 
of sustainable benefits of new homes can be recognised 
in the mortgage valuation process.
1	
Data based on HBF “Watt a Save” report updated and published 19 August 2024, available at: 
www.hbf.co.uk/policy/wattasave/
2	 Based on EPC registrations to 30 June 2024, published 30 July 2024.
3	 Statista data at: www.statista.com/statistics/1211708/liters-per-day-per-person-water-
usage-united-kingdom-uk/
Water resilience
We recognise that water is at the core of adaptation to 
climate change, and is a crucial link between society and 
environment. We have responded to this by designing 
water-efficient homes ahead of regulation and we are 
increasing the resilience of our sites to water scarcity 
and flooding through careful design and development 
of landscaping. We are underway with the Group’s first 
water value chain assessment to identify risks and 
opportunities and how we can manage and reduce 
our water footprint. 
 Read more about our sustainability roadmap on pages 43 and 44
We do it right
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
A balancing pond enjoyed by local wildlife
29
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Our people
We are seeking to build a diverse and inclusive workforce 
that reflects the communities in which we operate, 
delivering excellence for our customers by drawing on 
a broad range of life experience, talents and skills. This 
approach is embedded within our new purpose and values, 
our Building Sustainably Framework and in our Diversity and 
Inclusion Strategy, through which we aim to improve the 
representation of all groups across the business and drive 
an inclusive culture, where difference is valued. 
Engaging with our employees
Our annual employee engagement survey was completed in 
October 2023. It delivered an engagement score of 74.9% 
(2022: 84.4%), reflecting:
	• our ongoing recruitment freeze, which has created 
additional workload and responsibilities;
	• the lower FY23 bonus compared to previous years; and
	• a return to more normal engagement levels following a 
strong score in 2022 which was supported by two cost-
of-living support payments that ended in July 2023.
Following the 2023 engagement survey, we conducted 
workshops and consultations, reflecting our desire to 
respond positively and engage with our workforce to 
improve engagement. A follow-up shorter ‘pulse’ survey 
conducted in April 2024 showed a positive impact on 
engagement, which improved to 78.9%.
Investing in development and training
Against a skills shortage backdrop in the industry, it is 
important we not only attract and retain the best people 
with a diverse range of skills and experience but also 
play a leading role in tackling industry recruitment and 
retention challenges.
We invest for the future through our numerous award-
winning schemes including those for graduates, apprentices 
and former Armed Forces personnel. We have four Degree 
Apprenticeships delivered in partnership with Sheffield 
Hallam University, encompassing Construction, Quantity 
Surveying, Technical Design and Real Estate. Our development 
programmes included 353 participants at 30 June 2024 
(FY23: 483), around 6% (FY23: 7%) of our workforce, 
highlighting our commitment to future talent development.
Retaining the best talent
It is vital for us to retain the most talented people within 
our business to ensure we have the necessary skills 
for continued operational delivery and future growth. 
Identifying and supporting our leaders of the future, along 
with effective succession planning, are important elements 
in our long-term success. Our “Rising Stars” programme 
seeks to identify, motivate and develop our high-potential 
employees and in total 344 employees have attended our 
“Rising Stars” programme.
With the ongoing pause in recruitment, we continue to work 
to improve the visibility of our employees’ career paths 
across all functions, through individual development plans, 
line manager development, developing over 500 managers 
through our management development programme to date, 
and the prioritising and tracking of internal promotions. 
Remuneration and benefits are an important element of 
employee retention. We continue to review our employee 
packages to ensure they are effective and industry competitive.
Expanding share ownership for our employees
In April 2024, we invited all eligible employees to participate 
in the 16th grant under the Group’s Sharesave scheme, 
which allows eligible employees to contribute a maximum 
of £500 per month in one or more Sharesave schemes. 
As at 30 June 2024, approximately 52.1% (FY23: 51.4%) 
of our employees participated in one or more of the 
active schemes.
In recognition of the continued dedication and commitment 
of our employees, in FY24 the Board agreed that an annual 
share award would be made to all employees below Managing 
Director level. Accordingly, in July 2024, an award of shares 
equating to £750 (FY23: £1,250) was made to all qualifying 
employees. This award will vest in July 2026.
Reflecting the challenges faced by our industry and as 
well as our recruitment freeze throughout FY24, our total 
employee turnover reduced to 13% for the year to 30 June 2024 
(FY23: 15%). Our target over the medium term remains at 15%.
Accredited Living Wage Employer
We continue to operate as an accredited Living Wage 
Employer and we promote the payment of the real Living 
Wage within our UK supply chain through our standard 
sub‑contractor terms and conditions.
Our standard sub-contractor terms and conditions also 
mandate the payment of the real Living Wage within our 
supply chain. To ensure this real Living Wage commitment is 
adhered to, we implement spot checks on higher risk trades 
and operate internal remediation feedback reporting. Where 
we find instances of non-compliance, we require this to 
be rectified, with follow-up audits conducted to ensure full 
compliance. For those working in jurisdictions other than the 
UK, our expectation, included within our contract requirements, 
is that local statutory minimum wage terms are met.
Employee networking
Our employee networks remain a key element of the wider 
work to listen to our people, helping us create a truly 
inclusive culture through peer-to-peer support, learning and 
feedback. We have six employee network groups: Gender; 
Women on sites; Ethnicity, Culture and Religion; Disability; 
Families (including carers); and LGBTQ+, offering a range 
of activities from webinars, face-to-face events, leading 
discussions, marking of key calendar events, religious 
festivals and signposting support.
All our networks are open to allies, and we have seen a 
strong increase in membership over the year. A member 
of the Executive Committee sponsors each network.
We recognise that our employees are all a unique blend of 
different identities. We encourage our networks to combine 
on actions in support of this.
 More information on our career and apprenticeship 
opportunities are available to view on our website: 
www.barrattcareers.co.uk
30
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our people continued
Gender and ethnicity pay gap reporting
In December 2023, we published our annual Gender Pay 
Gap Report and, for the second year, our Ethnicity Pay Gap 
Report, as part of our commitment to transparency and to 
support our Diversity and Inclusion Strategy to improve the 
representation of all groups across the business. 
Despite our ongoing commitment to gender pay equality 
both our mean and median gender pay gaps increased 
compared to 2022, rising to 9.6% (from 8.8%) and 
7.4% (from 6.3%), respectively. Challenging conditions 
in the wider housing market led to a 17% reduction in 
sales commissions, predominantly affecting our sales 
teams, where the majority of colleagues are female. The 
construction skills shortage also continues to impact 
the industry as a whole, with increasing demand for, and 
scarcity of, skilled site-based tradespeople, triggering a 
wage increase in the UK. This prompted us to raise hourly 
rates for trade roles in some of our regions, primarily 
occupied by male site-based colleagues. This helped to 
address external economic pressures but contributed to the 
pay gap increase.
Although our mean gender pay gap is smaller than the 
average for UK businesses in 2023 at 13.2%, as we navigate 
changes in the market, we remain committed to continuous 
improvement, implementing proactive measures to address 
any pay disparities and delivering against our 2025 Diversity 
and Inclusion Strategy.
Although we are not statutorily required to disclose our 
ethnicity pay gap data, we are committed to diversity and 
inclusion, as well as being transparent with our people and 
ensuring we measure our impact. 
In 2023 the mean ethnicity pay gap decreased to 6.6% from 
7.7%, and the median gap decreased to 3.6% from 5.9%. 
This shift was partly attributed to an increased willingness 
from colleagues to identify their self-declared ethnicity, 
notably a change in declaration from “Do not wish to state” 
to identifying with an Ethnic Minority Community (EMC). 
The median ethnicity pay gap has also reduced due to 
comparatively larger salary increases for middle managers 
within the EMC community compared to white colleagues.
To deliver change in both areas, we will continue to build 
on the work in place to support our teams through our 
recruitment processes, talent programmes, employee 
networks, succession planning and early careers development. 
We also remain committed to implementing proactive 
measures to address any pay disparities based on either 
gender or ethnicity.
Physical health and mental wellbeing
As a market leader and responsible employer, we are 
continually exploring how we can best support our 
employees whilst positively influencing the construction 
industry and beyond. We have delivered programmes and 
services for a number of years to support and enhance the 
health and wellbeing of our people, including mental health. 
We have been signatories of the Building Mental Health 
Charter since 2022, a member of the Zero Suicide Alliance 
since 2023 and we are active members of the Home 
Building Skills Partnership Mental Health Awareness Group.
We also support our employees through a sector-leading 
benefits package, including pension with death in service 
benefit, access to discounts on fitness memberships, high 
street savings, the ability to purchase additional holiday, 
financial education, access to savings and loans through 
payroll and a suite of family-friendly policies. 
Our new purpose and, in particular, the new values we seek 
to extol, emphasise a supportive culture based on positive 
behaviours, inclusion and respect. 
 The latest Gender and Ethnicity Pay Gap Report can 
be viewed at: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/
media/Files/B/Barratt-Developments/documents/
Publications/barratt-developments-plc-gender-and-
ethnicity-pay-gap-report-2023.pdf
Diversity and inclusion
We are committed to developing an environment that is 
inclusive for everyone. We want everyone who works with 
us or for us to feel valued, that they are treated equally and 
fairly, and that they can succeed in their role – regardless 
of their background. We believe there are two elements that 
create a workplace where everyone feels valued and that 
they belong: 
	• Diversity is the representation of all of our differences, 
and how we differentiate ourselves as individuals and 
as groups. Striving for diversity provides the widest 
access to talent and reflects our customers and the 
communities we serve. We know our people want to see 
role models that reflect them across the organisation. 
	• Inclusion is about building a culture of belonging by 
actively inviting colleagues to contribute and participate, 
which is proven to increase business performance. We 
believe every person’s voice adds value and it is vital 
that all our current colleagues, and any prospective 
colleagues, feel respected and valued.
	• We are committed to giving full, fair and transparent 
consideration to applications for employment made 
by those with disabilities and ensuring continued 
employment of those who may become disabled during 
their employment. As an organisation we seek to ensure 
that training, career development and promotion is fair in 
all circumstances.
 Our Diversity and Inclusion Policy can be viewed at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/media/Files/B/
Barratt-Developments/policies/2023/diversity-
inclusion-policy-summary.pdf
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
31
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Our people continued
Diversity and inclusion continued
Our Diversity and Inclusion Strategy
Our Diversity and Inclusion Strategy aims to improve both 
the representation of all groups across the business, as well 
as our ability to listen and communicate to them all, and is 
focused on three key areas:
	• Talent: increasing our representation through the 
attraction, recruitment and development of diverse skills 
and experience at all levels. 
	• Leadership: taking accountability for change and creating 
an inclusive environment where everyone can thrive. 
	• Attitudes: supporting our people to understand and value 
difference, with respect and kindness.
Gender and ethnic diversity
Improving our gender and ethnic diversity is a key focus 
and we continue to ensure we have gender balanced and 
diverse recruitment shortlists, and provide inclusive hiring 
training for all recruiting managers. Additionally, to drive 
improvement, we:
	• are measuring gender and ethnic representation in 
each function and level within the Group on a quarterly 
tracking basis;
	• are operating with a specified group of preferred 
recruiters, who have all committed to provide balanced 
and diverse short-lists; and
	• have increased the female and ethnic minority 
background cohorts on our Accelerated Leadership 
Programme, which is designed to identify our future 
Managing Directors.
Catalyst
“Catalyst”, our long-standing development and support 
programme, designed to help high-potential female 
employees develop their careers within the Group, is a 
key part of our gender diversity strategy. This programme 
continues to show positive results with eight divisional 
directors who are alumni from the programme and 18% of 
the last cohort, in FY23, already promoted or having their 
roles extended. Our Catalyst programme in FY24 has been 
our largest, since inception, with 110 participants.
As at 30 June 2024, women held 20% (FY23: 18%) of senior 
manager roles within the Group. The gender diversity 
statistics for our employees as a whole, our senior managers 
and the direct reports to the Executive Committee and 
PLC Directors are shown on page 32. Further information 
regarding the diversity (including ethnicity) of our PLC 
Directors and Executive Committee members can be found 
in the Nomination Report on page 103.
Increasing the ethnic diversity of our organisation 
remains a clear target for the Group’s leadership teams 
and as at 30 June 2024, 8% (FY23: 7%) of employees 
were from ethnic minority backgrounds and 3% (FY23: 
3%) of senior leadership positions were held by ethnic 
minority employees. 
Human rights and anti-bribery
Our respect for human rights is embedded within our new 
purpose and values. Our policies and procedures support 
the core values of the UN Universal Declaration of Human 
Rights and the UN Guiding Principles of Business and 
Human Rights, and we act in accordance with our principles 
regarding diversity and the Modern Slavery Act 2015. 
Our non-financial KPIs for health and safety and employee 
engagement reflect our belief that it is a fundamental 
human right to work in a safe and supportive environment. 
Our employees undertake training on modern slavery, which 
was updated this year ready for launch in FY25. Concerns 
can be raised anonymously via our externally managed 
whistleblowing process which is available to agency 
staff and sub-contractors as well as our employees and 
promoted in site welfare cabins.
This year we began to develop a framework for risk assessing 
and managing our supply chain human rights risks. 
We have a strict Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy and 
conduct our business in a fair, open and transparent 
manner. All our employees are required to undertake regular 
training on our Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, and it is 
a condition of all our supplier and subcontractor contracts 
that they comply with the Bribery Act and this policy.
 Our Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy can be viewed 
at: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/media/Files/B/
Barratt-Developments/policies/2023/anti-bribery-
and-corruption-policy.pdf
PLC Directors
Male and female employees 
Senior Managers
Employees
Executive 
Committee
Reports to Executive 
Committee
	
	
2024	
2023
	 Male	
67%	
63%
	
Total	
6	
5
	 Female	 33%	
37%
	
Total	
3	
3
	
	
2024	
2023
	 Male	
80%	
82%
	
Total	
265	
272
	 Female	 20%	
18%
	
Total	
67	
59
	
	
2024	
2023
	 Male	
68%	
68%
	
Total	
4,007	
4,345
	 Female	 32%	
32%
	
Total	
1,922	
2,044
	
	
2024	
2023
	 Male	
50%	
71%
	
Total	
4	
5
	 Female	 50%	
29%
	
Total	
4	
2
	
	
2024	
2023
	 Male	
66%	
69%
	
Total	
25	
27
	 Female	 34%	
31%
	
Total	
13	
12
32
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

26,000
24,000
22,000
20,000
18,000
16,000
14,000
12,000
10,000
8,000
6,000
4,000
2,000
0
(2,000)
FY15
FY16
FY17
FY18
FY19
FY20
FY21
FY22
FY23
FY24
19,956
24,387
18,497
20,951
18,448
9,441
18,067
19,089
(812)
12,439
Our land position
Since stepping back from the land market in September 
2022, we have adopted a highly selective approach to 
incremental investment in land. Our stance reflects our 
strong land bank position, uncertainty on house prices, 
build cost inflationary pressures and limited movement in 
wider market reported land prices to reflect these changed 
market dynamics. However, since the start of 2024, we have 
seen an uptick in the quantity of land made available that 
meets our rigorous land buying requirements and is centred 
on a minimum gross margin of 23% and 25% ROCE. 
Gross and net land approvals
As a result, gross site approvals have increased to 69 
new sites during the year. These were partially offset by 11 
previously approved sites no longer proceeding to purchase, 
resulting in a net increase of 58 site approvals in FY24 
(FY23: net cancellation of two sites). 
Approved sites along with planning amendments added 
15,233 plots (FY23: 4,821), at a cost of £771.7m (FY23: £345.2m), 
with 2,794 plots (FY23: 5,633) removed for sites no longer 
proceeding at an agreed cost of £124.8m (FY23: £360.1m). 
This resulted in a net increase of 12,439 plots in FY24 
(FY23: net reduction of 812 plots) and a net increase in 
our land approval commitments of £646.9m (FY23: net 
decrease of £14.9m).
Given the subdued but more stable market backdrop and the 
growing number of land opportunities available we expect 
to increase our land approvals significantly in FY25 whilst 
maintaining our rigorous land investment requirements. 
Planning and ownership or control status
30 June
 2024
30 June
 2023
Plots with detailed planning consent
40,030
48,270
Plots with outline planning consent
15,239
9,658
Plots with resolution to grant and other
2,363
1,320
Owned and unconditional land bank 
(plots)
57,632
59,248
Conditionally contracted land bank 
(plots)
8,607
11,142
Total owned and controlled land 
bank (plots)
66,239
70,390
Number of years’ supply
4.9
4.3
JVs owned and controlled land 
bank (plots)
4,631
4,356
Strategic land bank (acres)
16,865
16,431
Strategic land bank (plots)
106,516
101,784
Promotional land bank (plots)
105,359
96,844
Land bank carrying value (£m)
3,233.6
3,139.9
At 30 June 2024, the estimated ASP of plots in our owned 
land bank was £328k (30 June 2023: £331k) and the 
estimated gross margin in our land bank, based on current 
estimated sales prices and build costs at 30 June 2024 was 
18.6% (30 June 2023: 19.7%). 
Land market activity
Notable development transactions in FY24:
	• ASDA Park Royal, London: a major regeneration scheme 
in Ealing which, over a number of years, will see the 
development of 1,505 mixed tenure homes as well as a 
new ASDA superstore.
	• Fort Halstead, Kent: a significant redevelopment of former 
MOD research facility to deliver 635 homes near Sevenoaks.
	• Durieshill village, Stirling: a major new village development 
on the outskirts of Stirling to develop more than 1,500 
homes in a 50:50 partnership with Springfield Properties.
Net land approvals (plots)
Land investment
We invested £674.3m (FY23: £822.8m) on land acquisitions 
and the settlement of land creditors during FY24, and we 
currently expect to spend c. £800m on land in FY25.
We continue to target a regionally balanced land portfolio in 
the medium term with a supply of owned land of c. 3.5 years 
and a further c. 1.0 year of controlled land. We are broadly in 
line with this target, with our land bank comprising 4.3 years 
of owned land (30 June 2023: 3.6 years) and 0.6 years of 
controlled land at 30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: 0.7 years). 
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
33
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Our land position continued
Planning permission activity
Despite the challenging planning backdrop across the 
country, we secured planning consents on 9,026 plots 
across 54 developments during the year (FY23: 12,969 plots 
on 81 developments). As well as standard applications, 
which received planning approval at a local level, we took 
three planning refusals to appeal and were successful in 
overturning them. 
Whilst our business and the wider industry continue to 
experience significant challenges with the ineffective 
and highly unpredictable state of the planning system, 
more than 69% (30 June 2023: 81%) of our owned and 
unconditional land bank plots have detailed planning 
consent, supporting our sales outlets position and future 
home completions. We are also well positioned for the 
coming financial year with almost all budgeted FY25 home 
completions (FY24: all budgeted FY24 home completions) 
having outline or detailed planning consent.
Strategic land
Our strategic land teams were focused on securing 
additional strategic land to support future growth and 4,477 
plots across 30 strategic sites were approved during FY24 
(FY23: 21,802 plots and 70 sites). Plots secured through 
our strategic land bank delivered 3,290 (FY23: 3,938) or 
24% (FY23: 24%) of our wholly owned home completions in 
FY24. We converted 3,723 plots (FY23: 777) of strategic land 
into our owned and controlled land bank during FY24. After 
significantly expanding our strategic land bank over the 
past few years, our strategic land and planning teams (with 
input from Gladman) will now increasingly focus on securing 
planning consent by promoting strategic land through Local 
Plan reviews, as well as speculative planning applications. 
At 30 June 2024, around 20% (30 June 2023: around 23%) 
of our strategic land is allocated or included in draft 
Local Plans. 
We target around 30% of wholly owned completions 
from strategic and promotional land in the medium term. 
This reflects the development and planning prospects in 
our strategic land portfolio, our business model and our 
targeted land bank length and focus on ROCE.
Land promotion
Our promotional land portfolio is held through Gladman 
Developments Limited (Gladman) and consists of 105,359 
plots (30 June 2023: 96,844 plots), with Gladman operating 
at arm’s length and as a standalone business within 
the Group.
Over FY24, Gladman secured an estimated 9,239 plots, 
(FY23: 9,453 plots) through new promotional agreements 
with landowners. Following several successful planning 
applications, Gladman received planning consents on 2,804 
plots during the year (FY23: 2,437 plots). Whilst wider 
market demand for land remained weak in FY24, Gladman 
secured land sales equating to 773 plots (FY23: 1,813 plots), 
dominated by demand from smaller developers. 
Gladman generated revenue of £13.1m and an operating 
profit, before amortisation of intangible assets, of £0.2m 
during FY24 (FY23: sales of £20.4m and operating profit, 
before amortisation of intangible assets, of £3.8m). The 
reduction in revenue and profitability reflected the low 
level of land market activity across the year as many 
housebuilders limited or paused their land buying plans. We 
expect Gladman’s performance to recover as land market 
activity increases over the coming months.
Gladman, with the benefit of the Group’s financial, legal and 
development resources, continues to engage with new and 
existing land promotion partners around the most attractive 
routes to unlock value from their land positions. Gladman 
also offers the ability to convert promotional agreements 
into option, hybrid or freehold sale arrangements for all, 
or part, of their land promotion partners’ holdings, to meet 
their changing needs and aspirations.
Kingsbrook, Aylesbury
34
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our build performance
Maintaining the efficiency of our operations and controlling 
costs, whilst also retaining our capacity to deliver the 
homes that the country needs, has remained a key area 
of consideration throughout the year. 
Managing site-based construction
Coming into FY24, our reduced order book and limited 
improvement in the reservation rates necessitated further 
adjustments to construction activity. We also sought to 
manage customer commitments for home completions, our 
finished homes inventory and the investment in new site 
infrastructure to support future sales outlet openings. As 
a result, our annual build activity reduced by 20.2% to an 
average 257 (FY23: 322) equivalent homes (including JVs) 
built per week. 
In FY25, we will seek to balance construction activity 
between the expansion in sales outlets for FY26 and the 
anticipated reduction in completion volumes.
Controlling our cost base
We proactively managed our operating cost base throughout 
FY24, particularly in areas where activity levels have stepped 
materially lower. Our site-based teams have inherent flexibility 
through the use of our sub-contractor workforce. With respect 
to our directly employed team members, we began a headcount 
freeze in September 2022, which has reduced our number 
of employees by 12.2% cumulatively through to the year end 
(30 June 2023: 6.0% cumulatively). 
Headcount reductions have been most significant across 
our divisional network of offices, where reduced activity has 
not warranted recruitment as team members have moved 
either to new opportunities or reached retirement. We have 
continued to invest in priority areas, including sustainability, 
building safety and our IT infrastructure. However, we are 
only recruiting where we need additional skills. We continue 
to scrutinise and limit discretionary spend in all areas. 
Build quality
Throughout FY24, we maintained our unwavering attention 
to build quality throughout our divisions. Once again – and 
for a fifth consecutive year – we were rated industry leader 
among the major housebuilders by the NHBC, registering 
the lowest Reportable Items (RIs) per NHBC inspection at 
0.13 (FY23: 0.16)1.
The NHBC has also introduced a new Construction Quality 
Index (CQI), which takes into consideration the Reportable 
Items index, based on the five-stage inspection of our new 
homes as well as Construction Quality Reviews, which are 
an in-depth review of quality across a site and focus only 
on build stages available at the time of the review. NHBC 
views this new CQI measure as a valuable tool in managing 
quality across housebuilders’ operations. On this additional 
metric, we have ranked a clear industry leader among the 
major housebuilders throughout FY24.
Our build quality was also recognised through the NHBC 
Pride in the Job Awards for site management. At the 2023 
Regional NHBC Pride in the Job Awards, 30 of our site 
managers won “Seals of Excellence”. At the NHBC Pride in 
the Job Supreme Awards in January 2024, Sean O’Regan, Site 
Manager at Waldmers Wood in our Manchester division, was 
named “Supreme Runner Up” in the “Large Builder” category. 
At the 2024 National NHBC Pride in the Job Awards, 89 of 
our site managers secured awards, more than any other 
housebuilder for the 20th consecutive year. No other major 
housebuilder has achieved this level of consistent success, 
recognising our management of excellent site standards and 
build quality. All our sites operate under our certification to 
the Environmental Management System standard ISO 14001, 
and Health and Safety standard, OHSAS 18001. 
1	
Measured by the NHBC amongst the 14 major housebuilders constructing more than 1,000 
homes annually over the year to 30 June 2024.
Anson Gardens, Fradley
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
35
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive’s Statement continued
Our supply chain and cost inflation
Our supply chain, on which our build activity relies, is 
robust and carefully managed. Approximately 95% of 
our building materials are sourced by our centralised 
procurement function and approximately 90% of our 
building materials are either manufactured or assembled in 
the UK. We are committed to our supply chain partners and 
seek to secure not only sustainable but also competitive 
pricing, whilst maintaining security of supply to support our 
site-based operations.
During FY24, overall building material cost inflation slowed 
sharply on a spot purchasing basis, moving to a relatively 
flat to slightly deflationary position at the half year with 
this position being broadly maintained through to year 
end. This recent purchasing position is complemented 
by our future supply agreements which cover 85% of our 
material requirements to 31 December 2024 (FY24: 73% 
to 31 December 2023) and 19% of our requirements until 
30 June 2025 (FY24: 14% to 30 June 2024).
Whilst we saw the inflationary pressures around skilled 
labour recede during the year, the industry still has a long-
standing need for skilled tradespeople, combined with 
limited access to overseas labour and more opportunities 
for workers to either shift to alternative sectors or to leave 
the industry. These factors, along with the broader cost-
of-living backdrop, meant wage inflation proved stickier 
and we anticipate labour inflation will remain the more 
inflationary component of our total costs in FY25.
During FY24, total build cost inflation (including 
infrastructure costs, materials and labour) reported through 
our income statement was approximately 5%, with the rate 
of inflation moving sequentially lower throughout the year. 
Reflecting the current market backdrop, and assuming no 
further significant changes in the costs of key commodities 
or energy, we anticipate total costs will be broadly 
flat in FY25.
Benefits of MMC 
Embodied carbon emissions
5 tonnes less
Timber frame homes produce up to five less tonnes of carbon over 
their life (compared with masonry homes)1, which is projected to 
reduce our carbon footprint by 6% by FY40. This is a key component 
in achieving our net zero goal (see page 82). We are also working to 
capture our suppliers’ carbon emissions data and transition plans 
and have identified that 53% of our timber frame suppliers have 
carbon targets in place.
Build speed
c.40% faster
Time taken to progress from foundation to build completion 
reduced by up to 40%, reducing overhead costs on site and 
decreasing the risks of delivery.
Off-site construction 
Manufacturing components offsite is less labour intensive and 
allows us to recruit from a more diverse labour pool. Limiting time 
on site also reduces exposure to weather disruption, increasing 
the resilience of our build programmes as severe weather becomes 
more frequent (see page 77).
Waste 
27% less
Studies show that MMC approaches result in up to 27% less waste 
compared to traditional construction, especially in concrete, 
cement and ceramics2. This is due to consistent factory-based 
processes leading to efficiencies in materials use and the avoidance 
of sometimes unavoidable weather-related damage to building 
materials on site. 
1	
www.aimch.co.uk/outputs/whole-life-carbon-assessment#:~:text=Timber%20frame%20
outperforms%20masonry%20construction%20on%20a%20whole,sequestration%20during%20
the%20life%20cycle%20of%20the%20building
2	 WRAP case study: Benefits of off site manufacture
Our build performance continued 
MMC expansion through timber frame
We are looking to drive construction efficiency through 
standardising our house types and increased use of 
modern methods of construction (MMC). The adoption 
of MMC, particularly timber frame construction, helps to 
mitigate the long-term challenges posed by the shortage 
of skilled workers within the industry, as well as increasing 
build efficiency, reducing embodied carbon and on-site 
construction waste. Our new timber frame facility, near 
Derby, continued to grow its timber frame production to 
support our growing migration to timber frame construction.
MMC
FY24
FY23
Timber frame
4,107
4,564
Roof cassettes
199
224
Offsite ground floors
268
560
Large format block
94
230
TotalA
4,668
5,578
Percentage of completionsA
33%
32%
A	 Total and percentage of completions includes JVs and has been adjusted for homes where 
more than one technology has been used.
We do it right
36
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our build performance continued
Further improvement in our 
waste performance
Waste reduction and resource efficiency remain clear 
priorities within the Group targets. In FY24 we delivered 
a further improvement in our waste intensity with a 12% 
reduction to 3.83 tonnes per 100m2 of housebuild equivalent 
build area (FY23: 4.34 tonnes per 100m2 of housebuild 
equivalent build area). Over FY24, our absolute waste 
tonnage decreased by 29.1% (FY23: decreased by 17.1%).
We promote the segregation of waste and the efficient 
use of skips across our sites; our diversion of waste from 
landfill increased during the year to 97% (FY23: 96%).
Future homes for our customers
Our Group Design and Technical team continues to develop 
plans to meet the requirements of the Future Homes 
Standard in 2025/2026. The team is developing and evolving 
our house types to meet a step change in the materials 
used in the homes we build, as well as the design of them, 
as a result of the new standard. 
Our eHome2 project continues to provide invaluable 
insights and solutions. It is now providing data on how it 
is performing across various external temperatures and 
weather conditions, controlled within the Energy House 2.0 
chamber at the University of Salford. 
 Read our summary of key findings on our website:
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/~/media/Files/B/
Barratt-Developments/documents/ehome2-phase-1-
research-report.pdf
eHome2 launched within Energy House 2.0 in January 2023
eHome2
In January 2023, Barratt Developments launched 
eHome2 within the world-leading Energy House 
2.0, one of the most significant research and 
development projects ever undertaken by 
the Group. 
Energy House 2.0 is a climate chamber that can 
recreate temperatures ranging from -20˚C to 
+40˚C, as well as simulating wind, rain, snow and 
solar radiation. The climate chamber is the largest 
of its kind in the world. 
Inside Energy House 2.0, we worked with Saint-
Gobain, a leading building materials manufacturer, 
to build a three-bedroom family home, known 
as eHome2, to test innovative building products 
designed to meet the Future Homes Standard. The 
house is also testing zero carbon performance in 
different temperatures and weather conditions to 
replicate extreme changes in the climate. 
The data will help to inform how we, and the 
housebuilding sector, can design homes that are 
future-proof, whilst cutting bills for consumers.
 Read more about our sustainability roadmap on pages 43 
and 44
We make it happen
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
37
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Current trading and outlook1
Long-term housing market fundamentals reflect a 
significant imbalance between housing supply and demand. 
Despite this imbalance, the market in FY24 remained 
constrained by significant macroeconomic headwinds, 
most notably higher interest rates and inflation. The 
higher interest rate environment is impacting mortgage 
affordability and qualification, as well as the cumulative 
cost-of-living squeeze, which has depressed real disposable 
incomes and constrained economic growth, employment, 
consumer confidence and discretionary spending.
Whilst the new Government has only been in place for two 
months, we are encouraged by early activity on housing 
and the focus on improving the planning system, as 
well as tackling the funding challenges in the affordable 
housing sector. They will create greater permissioned land 
supply, mortgage access, predictability and confidence for 
homebuyers. However, these supply-side changes will take 
time to be implemented effectively. 
We entered FY25 with a solid forward sales position, and 
at 25 August 2024 we are 42% forward sold with respect 
to private wholly owned home completions for FY25 
(27 August 2023 for FY24: 45%), with 52% of the private 
order book exchanged (27 August 2023: 51%). 
Since the start of FY25, our net private reservation rate 
per active outlet per week through to 25 August 2024 
has been 0.58 (FY24: 0.42). Whilst the prior year period 
was particularly impacted by available mortgage rates, 
the current year reservation rate reflects the continuing 
affordability challenges faced by potential homebuyers. 
25 August 2024
27 August 2023
Variance %
Forward order book
£m
Homes
£m
Homes
£m
Homes
Private
1,467.0
4,159
1,527.6
4,440
(4.0)%
(6.3)%
Affordable
579.6
3,519
752.0
4,691
(22.9)%
(25.0)%
Wholly owned
2,046.6
7,678
2,279.6
9,131
(10.2)%
(15.9)%
JVs
151.1
399
157.7
477
(4.2)%
(16.4)%
Total
2,197.7
8,077
2,437.3
9,608
(9.8)%
(15.9)%
During the period to 25 August 2024, reservations into the 
private rented sector and other multi-unit sales contributed 
0.03 (FY24: 0.02) to the weekly reservation rate.
Based on trading year to date and current market 
conditions, we continue to target total home completions 
of between 13,000 and 13,500 in FY25, including c. 600 
completions from our JVs, whilst ensuring we maintain our 
industry-leading standards of build quality and customer 
service. We also currently estimate that around 42% of 
our completions will be delivered in the first half of the 
financial year.
We were delighted to complete the acquisition of Redrow 
plc in August 2024 and are working with the CMA to obtain 
competition clearance. We look forward with confidence; 
we have created a leading UK housebuilder focused on 
quality, service and sustainability which will deliver more 
homes across the UK than the two companies on a stand-
alone basis, as well as delivering significant cost synergies 
from the Combination.
David Thomas
Chief Executive
3 September 2024
Chief Executive’s Statement continued
1	
The information presented on this page excludes the newly acquired Redrow group.
38
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Innovation through modern methods of construction
Expansion of Oregon
As we evolve how we build, tackle the skills challenge 
and move towards zero carbon homes, modern methods 
of construction (MMC) will play a significant role in the 
future of housebuilding. We are committed to increasing 
the number of homes we build using off site construction. 
We are the UK’s largest timber frame manufacturer through 
Oregon Timber Frame and have continued to develop 
our use of timber frame construction as MMC across our 
sites. In FY24, the Group built 4,107 timber frame units out 
of its 14,004 completions, supplied from its factories in 
Burton‑upon-Trent and Selkirk. 
4,107
timber framed homes delivered to our sites by 
Oregon in FY24 (FY23: 4,564)
99.9%
of the timber sourced by Oregon is sustainability certified
This equated to 29.3% (FY23: 26.5%) of total homes 
delivered in the year, contributing to us already exceeding 
our target for 30% of homes to be built using modern 
methods of construction by FY25 (see page 36). 
Our accelerated delivery of timber frame homes has been 
facilitated by the expansion of our new energy-efficient 
Oregon timber frame production facility at Infinity Park, 
Derby, which opened in 2023 and can produce a timber 
frame kit for one home every hour. 
Our timber frames are carefully designed and tested 
through detailed 3D modelling, produced in our factories 
and then transported to sites for assembly.
A factory for the future
Built through Wilson Bowden Developments, 
our 186,000 sq. ft. Oregon facility has a BREEAM 
“Very Good” rating and an EPC “A” rating. It 
uses air source heat pumps, photovoltaic cells 
and LED lighting to minimise its environmental 
impact, and electric vehicle charging points in 
10% of car park spaces to encourage colleagues 
to adopt electric vehicles. 
As well as enabling new lower-carbon timber 
frame homes, the facility has a positive impact in 
the local community and has provided new local 
employment opportunities, creating c. 200 jobs 
and we expect further expansion to create an 
additional 60 jobs.
“Increasing our use of modern methods 
of construction, including timber frames, 
is a key part of Barratt’s road to net zero 
carbon. Our industry-leading innovation 
and sustainability teams are working 
with our suppliers to challenge every 
aspect of construction to reduce carbon 
in the manufacture, transportation and 
build process.” 
David Thomas, 
Chief Executive 
Expansion of Oregon
The new Oregon Timber Frame factory in Derby
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
39

As the leading national sustainable housebuilder, we 
strive to design and build resilient, low-impact homes 
and communities for better living. 
We were the first national housebuilder to set science‑based 
carbon emissions targets and are proud to create a legacy 
for the industry. Our strong reputation in the sector is 
highlighted by our award-winning developments, our 
national and local socio-economic contributions, our 
collaboration with our supply chain and across the industry, 
our research and innovation and our investment in skills. 
All information on our strategy, targets and performance is 
publicly available through our website and other publications 
to allow our stakeholders to track our progress consistently 
and in order to share knowledge and data to benefit the 
wider industry. 
Our Building Sustainably Framework
Our Building Sustainably Framework is our integrated 
response to rapidly changing political and environmental 
events which have continued to shape how we think about 
sustainability. It is built around three pillars: nature, places 
and people. It brings together our sustainability ambitions, 
targets, activities and metrics to ensure that important 
issues and solutions are deeply rooted in every business 
decision and day-to-day action we take. Creating a positive 
environmental, social and economic legacy for future 
generations supports our purpose and values. 
We launched our sustainability strategy in 2021, with clear 
targets for nature, places and people, and against which 
we are continuing to deliver. Our carbon and waste targets 
are embedded in executive remuneration and bonuses; 
governance and working practices are driving operational 
improvements; and we are working with our value chain 
partners to meet our commitments.
Building sustainably
Continuing to deliver
Our purpose is to make sustainable living a 
reality, building strong communities.
Nature
We preserve and 
enhance the natural 
world by using resources 
responsibly, building 
resilient, low-carbon 
homes, and by creating 
places where people and 
nature can thrive.
Places
We design and build 
great places that meet the 
highest standards, and 
that promote sustainable, 
healthy and happy living for 
our customers. 
People
We believe everyone has 
the right to be respected 
and treated fairly at work. 
We do the right thing, 
nurturing diverse talent and 
prioritising the health and 
safety and wellbeing of our 
people and partners.
Bi
o
d
iv
e
r
si
t
y 
a
n
d
 
n
a
t
u
r
e,
 
N
at
u
r
a
l 
r
e
s
o
u
rc
e
s
, 
C
a
r
b
o
n
 
re
d
u
c
ti
o
n
, 
R
e
s
il
i
e
n
c
e
Building 
Sustainably
H
u
m
a
n 
ri
g
h
t
s,
 
K
e
e
p
in
g 
p
e
o
p
le
 
sa
f
e,
 
O
ur
 
p
e
o
p
le
P
la
c
e
m
a
ki
n
g,
 G
r
ee
n 
fi
n
a
n
c
e
 For further data regarding our 
sustainability performance, visit: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
building-sustainably/performance-
data/data
 For more information on our 
sustainability targets and our 
performance against our framework 
under each pillar, visit: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
building-sustainably
40
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

How we do it together
Our supply chain partners are critical to our long-term 
success, both delivering our growth plans and on our 
shared journey to net zero. Our Board, Executive team 
and procurement specialists engage annually with our 
supply partners, sharing our plans and seeking out 
sustainable improvements.
Chief Executive, David Thomas speaking at the supplier conference in Birmingham
Leadership and collaboration
	• We have established relationships with leading 
organisations including NGOs, landowners, financial 
institutions and lenders, as well as our supply chain. 
We are also actively engaging Government via the Net 
Zero Council, UK Business Council, Net Zero APPG, the 
Missions Network and one-to-one meetings.
	• The years ahead will be turbulent and it is important 
that we navigate political and societal changes. There 
is political uncertainty around ‘net zero’, a shortfall in 
skills needed to achieve a just transition (a transition to a 
green economy that is fair and inclusive) and not enough 
consumer understanding of the benefits of and incentives 
for purchasing energy-efficient homes.
	• We are providing leadership and expertise to the Future 
Homes Hub, a joint industry and Government initiative, 
designed to deliver a whole industry transition to net 
zero. A key focus of the Future Homes Hub this year 
has been whole life carbon in new homes, species 
enhancement measures and water efficiency. 
	• Our Chief Executive chairs the Hub and our Head of 
Mortgage Lender Relations chairs the Valuation group, 
whilst our Head of Biodiversity chairs the Biodiversity Net 
Gain working group.
We do it together
As of May 2024, we have, 
for the first time, received 
a Negligible ESG Risk 
rating by Sustainalytics – 
the only homebuilder to be 
rated as this. We are first 
out of 83 homebuilders, 
and in the third percentile 
in the “global universe” 
of all the companies that 
Sustainalytics assesses 
(375th out of 16,009).
Assessed as AAA by MSCI 
which categorises us 
as a ‘leader’ in the Real 
Estate Development 
and diversified 
activities industry.
We achieved Prime 
Status in the 2024 ISS 
ESG ratings and ranked 
joint first in the global 
construction industry.
In 2024 we submitted our 
Enhanced Communication 
on Progress. We are one of 
only two UK housebuilders 
to participate in the UN 
Global Compact and the 
only one to submit an 
enhanced disclosure.
Building sustainably continued
41
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Building sustainably continued
Leadership and collaboration 
continued
Sustainability governance
An established and robust governance structure 
underpins our sustainability strategy. We continue to 
embed sustainability into our leadership decisions and 
day-to-day business activities. We have a clear process, 
from identifying our most material issues to the operational 
delivery of action plans, across each of the three framework 
pillars and their corresponding priorities. Our approach 
allows us to create supporting work streams, which drive 
our implementation plans and create clear accountability 
around each priority.
The Board delegates day-to-day delivery of our framework 
to the Sustainability Committee, which is supported by 
operational cross-business working groups. In 2024, the 
Board was updated on human rights risk, our science-
based targets review and the activities of the Sustainability 
Committee. Regular monitoring of targets enables us to 
continually identify and re-prioritise areas for improvement. 
Materiality
In FY24, we finalised our latest materiality assessment 
to evaluate the relative importance of key sustainability 
issues to our stakeholders, ensuring our building 
sustainability strategy remains relevant and fit for the 
future. Our review involved comprehensive engagement 
with a wide range of internal and external stakeholders, 
including in-depth interviews and online surveys to 
understand the issues that mattered to them. This 
was complemented by an independent review of the 
strengths, weaknesses, opportunities and threats 
of our sustainability strategy and a review of the 
regulations that are likely to impact us. The outputs 
were then further validated using an independent 
expert. We are integrating the outcome of our 
materiality assessment into our strategy.
 Read our Materiality Report at 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-
sustainably/stakeholder-engagement/what-
matters-most
Creating wildlife-friendly spaces
What Matters Most
Our Materiality Report 2024
 For more detail on sustainability governance 
see www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
building-sustainably/managing-sustainability
During FY24, we further developed our internal reporting 
mechanisms, enabling divisional management teams to 
benchmark and monitor carbon and energy performance at 
site level via dashboards to put performance improvements 
in place where they are most needed. Our Human Rights 
Steering Committee also met for the first time. Its purpose 
is to provide ongoing oversight of our Human Rights 
Implementation Framework.
42
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Carbon reduction
Driving carbon emissions 
reduction across our 
homes, our own operations 
and our supply chain 
through innovation, 
collaboration and high-
quality design.
Biodiversity 
and nature
Creating a legacy of 
resilient landscapes and 
communities, delivering 
net gains for biodiversity 
and contributing to the 
conservation of local 
biodiversity priorities.
Natural 
resources
Maximising the value of 
materials and preserving 
natural resources at each 
stage of our value chain 
through responsible 
sourcing and efficient 
management.
Our journey on nature, 
places and people
	• Over 7,500 swift bricks 
installed to date ahead of our 
target for reaching this at the 
end of FY25.
	• RSPB wildlife-friendly 
Show Home Garden 
Schemes launched.
	• All of our sites submitting 
their first principle planning 
application since January 
2023 have biodiversity plans 
in place, demonstrating a 
minimum Biodiversity Net Gain 
(BNG) of at least 10% – ahead 
of regulation which came into 
effect in February 2024.
	• In 2024, celebrated ten‑year 
partnership with RSPB.
	• Nature-related supply chain 
risks and opportunities 
discovery work underway.
	• Sponsored RSPB’s Nature on 
Your Doorstep scheme.
	• Develop species enhancement plans
to provide supportive habitats for 
priority species on developments.
	• Install hedgehog highways and 
bat bricks on sites.
	• Taskforce on Nature-related Financial 
Disclosures partial disclosure in 2025.
	• Achieved elimination of single 
use plastic merchandising 
products from Group suppliers.
	• Homes designed to use a 
maximum of 105 litres of water 
per person per day – 16% lower 
than building regulations.
	• Water footprinting programme 
commenced in 2024.
	• Construction waste intensity 
reduced by 46% since 
2015. Construction waste 
performance incorporated 
into the Company 
bonus in 2020.
	• 98.8% of timber 
certified sustainable.
	• Timber frame now standard on 
new Barratt home designs.
	• Offsite-based products and 
systems in 33% of homes.
	• Establish a best-in-class water 
resilience roadmap.
	• Improve measurement of water 
consumption on sites and 
target reductions.
	• Implement opportunities 
identified to reduce product 
and materials packaging.
	• 100% of car fleet diesel and petrol 
free by 2028.
	• 100% of completed homes zero 
carbon by 2030.
	• Net zero across our value 
chain by 2040.
 See further detail in our transition plan on 
page 82
Journey to date
2025–2030
Nature
	• First housebuilder to set carbon 
reduction targets validated 
by the Science Based Targets 
initiative in 2020.
	• Scope 1 and 2 carbon 
performance is incorporated 
into the Group LTPP in 2021.
	• 94% of own electricity 
on renewable tariffs.
	• Scope 1 and 2 (operational) 
carbon emissions reduced by 
50% from 2018 levels.
	• Our flagship zero carbon 
concept home – Zed House – 
opens in 2021.
	• eHome2 opens in 2022.
	• 78% of car fleet are electric or 
hybrid vehicles.
Building sustainably continued
43
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our socio-economic footprint
Building sustainably continued
Places
People
	• Great Places design 
manual, which 
reflects the Building 
for Life 12 guidance, 
launched in 2009. 
	• Landscape handbook 
launched in 2022 to 
guide the development 
process towards 
creating landscapes 
that will enhance our 
developments, and 
successfully deliver 
biodiversity net gain.
	• Worked to bring the UK’s 
first green mortgage 
product to the market 
recognising the advantages 
inherent in new homes – 
we continue to promote 
the advantages of 
these to policy makers 
and customers.
	• Inclusive Play Guidance 
developed in partnership 
with Whizz Kidz launched 
in 2024. Inclusive show 
homes launched the 
same year.
	• Update Great Places 
criteria to be in line 
with Building for a 
Healthy Life.
	• Launch Social 
Value Toolkit.
	• Publish our Human 
Rights Policy.
	• Focused delivery of our 
People Promise.
	• Target to increase 
ethnicity representation 
in the direct reports 
to the Executive 
Committee.
	• Future/green skills 
development.
	• Engaged with 10,000 
secondary school 
and college students 
in-person, through 
classroom workshops, 
assemblies, and careers 
fairs, in 2023-2024.
	• Leading inclusively 
workshops delivered 
to all 300 top leaders 
across the Group.
	• Gender pay gap below 
UK average, ethnicity pay 
gap also reported.
 For further detail on our 
progress and achievements 
on our people strategy, see 
pages 30 to 32
Great places
Designing and building 
great places that meet 
the highest standards, 
and that promote 
sustainable, healthy 
and happy living for 
our customers. 
Building 
communities
We commit to our 
belief that everyone 
has the right to be 
respected and treated 
fairly at work. We 
do the right thing, 
nurturing diverse 
talent and prioritising 
the health and safety 
and wellbeing of our 
people and partners.
Journey to date
Journey to date
2025–2030
2025–2030
Discover more about our 
sustainability performance:
Our Sustainability Accounting 
Standards Board (SASB Disclosure)
 For further details on the 
positive impact we have on 
the communities in which 
we operate, please see our 
Socio-economic footprint at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
~/media/Files/B/Barratt-
Developments/sustainability/
fy24-group-socio-economic-
footprint.pdf
 Please see our SASB 
Disclosure for industry-specific 
sustainability metrics published 
under SASB guidelines at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
~/media/Files/B/Barratt-
Developments/sustainability/
fy24-sasb-disclosure.pdf
Employment and skills development
Barratt Developments PLC 2024 Socio-Economic Footprint
The infographic below provides an illustration of the social and economic contribution made by the Barratt Group to people, places and nature for the financial year 2024. 
The assessment was carried out by independent experts who analysed socio-economic impacts through the delivery chain for new housing based upon Barratt Developments datasets, published research 
and national statistics. All figures are based in the financial year ending 30th June 2024 and include joint venture home completions in which the Group has an interest. For full details of the methodology 
used please see www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/our-publications-and-policies/publications.
In 2024, 100% of our developments actively contributed to community infrastructure. The Group totals are outlined below: 
✽ EPC (Energy Performance Certificate) measures the energy efficiency of homes on a scale of A to G. 
 ♦ PEFC (Programme for the Endorsement of Forest Certification) and FSC (Forest Stewardship Council) are the two leading sustainable forestry certifications.
Places
Support for charities
Investment in local infrastructure
£150m
local contributions including 
s106 and equivalent 
contributions such as the 
Community Infrastructure Levy
4,632 
school places  
provided
8
local facilities including 
sports and leisure, 
health, youth and 
community centres
£6.4m
charitable donations including company 
donations, employee fundraising and 
supplier sponsorship, made directly or via 
the Barratt Foundation
14,515
hours of employee 
volunteering
£253m
spending in shops and services 
by residents of new homes 
(p.a.) supporting 2,488 retail 
and service-related jobs (p.a.)
£536m
expenditure on physical works benefitting 
local communities (including highway and 
environmental improvements, affordable 
homes and community facilities)
Investing in new homes
Sustainable places
Supporting public services
£42.9m
New Homes Bonus paid 
by Government to Local 
Authorities as a result of 
homes built by the Group
£318.7m
tax generated by our 
activities through 
Corporation tax, NI, PAYE, 
SDLT and local council tax
£647m
of land approved  
for investment
2,990
affordable new homes (including joint 
ventures) with a total market value 
of £507.7m, sold at 50.9% below the 
average private new house sold
14,004
new homes (including 
joint ventures) with a 
total market value of 
£4.32bn
99.8%
homes built to 
EPC✽ A and B
4,732
electric vehicle 
charging points 
installed
3,449
homes with access to 
renewable energy sources, 
including solar thermal 
panels, solar PV and air 
source heat pumps 
7,434 
homes with 
cycle storage
3.64
tonnes of construction 
waste per 100m.sq. 
house build equivalent, 
a 46% reduction against 
our 2015 benchmark of 
7.09 tonnes/100m.sq.
98.78% 
sustainably certified 
timber♦
Enhancing biodiversity and greenspace provision
Managing our impact
70% 
of developments 
designed with 
landscape-led, above 
ground, Sustainable 
Urban Drainage Systems
9,486
priority species 
enhancements installed, 
including 1,730 swift 
nesting bricks, 6,090 
hedgehog highways and 
897 bat boxes
16
sites (100% of sites excluding JVs) with 
a 10% minimum biodiversity net gain 
submitted for planning:
22% for  
area habitats
41% for hedgerow 
habitats
125% for 
river habitats
1.26
tonnes of CO2e emissions 
per 100m.sq. completed 
build area (scope 1 and 2). 
A reduction of c.21% on the 
previous year and c.34% 
from our 2018 benchmark
30
RSBP 
showhome 
gardens 
certified
Nature
407ha
of green space created 
through public open 
space and private 
gardens (the equivalent 
of 581 football pitches)
People
£2.95bn
of Gross Value Added (GVA), 
the Group’s contribution to 
UK economic output
40,157 
direct, indirect and induced 
employment through the Group, 
its sub-contractors and suppliers. 
Equivalent to 2.9 jobs per dwelling
5,434
sub-contractor 
companies supported 
(including through 
joint ventures)
5,580
supplier companies 
supported (including 
through joint ventures)
Supply chain partnerships
90%
centrally sourced components which 
are assembled or manufactured in 
the UK, supporting local jobs
353
graduates, apprentices and 
trainees on programmes.  
This contributes an estimated 
£3.84m to wider economy
£3.14bn
total value of spend with suppliers 
and sub-contractors, contributing 
£4.16bn to the national economy
44
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

The information below is intended to help stakeholders 
understand our position on these key non-financial 
matters. We have considered these non-financial 
matters and disclosed in the relevant sections, when 
determining what information should be included in 
the Annual Report and Accounts, the information needs 
of different stakeholders and their relative importance 
as well as the relevant time horizons in each matter. 
The following complies with the non-financial reporting 
requirements contained in Sections 414CA and 414CB 
of the Companies Act 2006.
Description of the business model
Our business summary 
8
Our business model
 10
Non-financial key performance 
indicators relevant to 
the company’s business
12
Social matters
Market review
 16
Our sustainability 
focus areas
40
Affordability
20
Employees
Development and training 
30
Diversity
31
Wellbeing 
31
Gender pay gap 
31
Employee engagement
50
Board diversity 
106
Human rights
Human rights 
32
Third parties 
32
Anti-bribery and corruption
Group policy 
32
Working with suppliers 
56
Environmental matters
Waste
 37
Building sustainably
40
Climate-related financial 
disclosures 
71
Greenhouse gas 
emissions disclosure
 80
Policy, due diligence 
and outcomes
Risk management
63 
Principal risks
65
Long-term viability 
statement 
85
Audit and Risk Committee 
112
Our sixth integrated report
We are committed to being a sustainable and responsible business. 
This is demonstrated in this integrated Annual Report. Our focus is the 
connection of economic, environmental, social and governance matters 
to create and preserve long-term value for all our stakeholders.
 For a detailed description of our approach to integrated reporting, 
go to page 217
Notice regarding limitations on Directors’ 
liability under English law
Under the Companies Act 2006, a safe harbour limits the liability 
of Directors in respect of statements in, and omissions from, the 
Strategic Report contained on pages 1 to 87 and the Directors’ Report 
contained on pages 88 to 148. Under English Law, the Directors would 
be liable to the Company (but not to any third party) if the Strategic 
Report and/or the Directors’ Report contains errors as a result of 
recklessness or knowing misstatement or dishonest concealment of 
a material fact, but would not otherwise be liable.
Strategic Report and Directors’ Report
Pages 1 to 87 inclusive comprise the Strategic Report and pages 88 
to 148 inclusive comprise the Directors’ Report, both of which have 
been drawn up and presented in accordance with, and in reliance on, 
English Company Law. The liabilities of the Directors in connection 
with the reports shall be subject to the limitations and restrictions 
provided by such law. 
Cautionary statement regarding 
forward‑looking statements
The Group’s reports, including this document and written information 
released, or oral statements made, to the public in the future by, or 
on behalf of, the Group, may contain forward-looking statements. 
Although the Group believes that its expectations are based on 
reasonable assumptions, any statements about future outlook may be 
influenced by factors that could cause actual outcomes and results 
to be materially different. Nothing contained in this Annual Report or 
on the Group’s website should be construed as a profit forecast or an 
invitation to deal in the securities of the Company. 
Assurance over non-financial data
Deloitte LLP have provided independent third-party limited assurance 
in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance 
Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and Assurance Engagements on 
Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the International 
Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over selected non-
financial metrics. For Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, 
which includes details of the selected metrics assured, our full 
Carbon Reporting Methodology Statement, our ESG Basis of Reporting 
and a full breakdown of scope 3 GHG emissions, see our website: 
 www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/our-publications-
and-policies/publications
Anson Gardens, Fradley
Non-financial 
and sustainability 
information statement
Non-financial and sustainability information statement
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
45
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Section 172 Statement
When setting and pursuing our strategy, it is essential that 
we consider the interests of our key stakeholders and the 
consequences of our decisions in the long term. Our strong 
governance framework and robust decision-making process 
ensure that the interests of our key stakeholders are 
considered and debated to determine the best course of 
action to promote the long-term success of the business.
Our stakeholders
Whilst we engage with a wide range of stakeholders in the 
day-to-day running of our business, we consider our key 
stakeholders to be those:
	• which are significantly affected by our actions and 
decisions; and/or
	• whose actions and decisions significantly affect our 
business model and strategy. 
The Board reviews the Company’s key stakeholders on an 
annual basis to ensure that they remain appropriate and 
consider whether there are any new stakeholders which 
should be taken into consideration as part of the Board’s 
decision-making process. The Board conducted this review 
in May 2024 and confirmed that the key stakeholders 
continue to be those set out on pages 50 to 57. 
We recognise that effective engagement is 
essential to: 
	• understand what matters most to our key 
stakeholders;
	• understand the likely impact of key decisions on our 
key stakeholders; and
	• influence their decisions that could affect our 
business model and strategy.
 Details of how we engaged with our key stakeholder groups 
during the financial year can be found on pages 50 to 57
Section 172 Statement
Stakeholder relationships are a key source of value 
that help us to ensure the long‑term sustainable 
success of the Company.
To ensure that engagement remains effective, the Board 
reviews key metrics and performance indicators for the 
various engagement activities throughout the year. In 
addition to this, in May 2024 the Board considered the 
overall effectiveness of the engagement activities as part 
of its key stakeholder review process and as part of the 
Board evaluation process described on page 109 and, whilst 
satisfied that engagement remained effective for fostering 
the Company’s business relationships, the Board agreed 
that it would be useful to strengthen its understanding of 
stakeholder interests and concerns during uncertain market 
conditions and the integration period. 
Furthermore, as part of the annual Board evaluation 
process, Board members considered the effectiveness 
of the Designated Non-Executive Director for workforce 
engagement mechanism and concluded that, whilst the 
process remains appropriate, it would be useful for all 
Non‑Executive Directors to have more direct engagement 
with employees across the organisation. 
We appreciate that there may be times when conflicts 
arise between different stakeholder groups and that it is 
not always possible to provide positive outcomes for all of 
them. In such circumstances, we seek to understand the 
needs and priorities of each stakeholder group and decide 
from the perspective of the long-term sustainable success 
of the business. Our engagement activities, as described on 
pages 50 to 57, enable us to understand what matters most 
to our key stakeholders so that we carefully consider all 
relevant factors during our decision-making process. 
Most of the day-to-day decision making and stakeholder 
engagement is carried out at operational level by members 
of our Executive Committee and senior management team. 
Our values, as set out on page 2, are closely aligned to 
the matters set out in Section 172 and are embedded 
in our culture and all that we do, ensuring that our key 
stakeholders and the Section 172 principles are considered 
during the decision-making process at all levels of 
the business.
Each member of the Board is mindful of:
	• their duty to promote the long-term sustainable 
success of the Company for the benefit of its 
shareholders; and 
	• the matters encompassed in Section 172 of the 
Companies Act 2006, as set out on the following 
page, to which they must have due regard when 
making decisions.
46
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Section 172 Statement continued
You can read more on how the Board had regard to each Section 172 principle, during the year, as follows:
Section 172 principles
The likely consequences 
of any decision in the 
long term
The interests of the 
Group’s employees
The need to foster the 
Group’s business 
relationships with 
suppliers, customers 
and others
The impact of the 
Group’s operations on 
the community and the 
environment
The desirability of the 
Group maintaining a 
reputation for high 
standards of business 
conduct
The need to act fairly as 
between shareholders of 
the Company
How the Board had regard to the principle
Relevant disclosures
	• Business model: pages 
10 and 11 
	• Trends in our market: 
pages 16 to 21 
	• Building sustainable 
homes for the future: 
pages 40 to 45 
	• Our principal risks 
and risk management: 
pages 63 to 70 
	• Climate-related risks 
and opportunities: 
pages 76 to 78
	• Viability Statement: 
pages 85 to 87
Relevant disclosures
	• Investing in our 
people: page 30 
	• Employee engagement: 
pages 50 and 51 
	• Our purpose and values: 
pages 1 and 2 
	• Our culture: page 98 
	• Whistleblowing: page 118 
Relevant disclosures
	• Business model: 
pages 10 and 11
	• Stakeholder engagement: 
pages 50 to 57 
	• Our values: page 2
	• Non-financial and 
sustainability information 
statement: page 45
Relevant disclosures
	• Climate-related risks 
and opportunities: 
pages 76 to 78 
	• Our purpose and values: 
pages 1 and 2
	• Stakeholder engagement: 
pages 50 to 57 
	• SHE Committee Report: 
pages 121 and 122 
	• Building sustainably: 
pages 40 to 44
Relevant disclosures
	• Our purpose and values: 
pages 1 and 2
	• Culture: page 98 
	• Non-financial and 
sustainability information 
statement: page 45 
	• Business model: pages 
10 and 11 
	• Internal controls: pages 
117 and 118
	• Modern slavery: page 32
	• Risk management: 
pages 63 to 70
	• SHE Committee Report: 
pages 121 and 122
	• Audit and Risk Committee 
Report: pages 112 to 120 
Relevant disclosures
	• Resolutions proposed 
at the AGM: pages 
146 and 147 
	• Dividend Policy: page 61
47
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Decision making in practice
Governance framework
The Board sets the purpose, values and 
strategic direction of the Company. 
The Board sets key Group policies to 
mandate how business is conducted at 
all levels of the organisation and 
delegates certain responsibilities to 
Board Committees and management. 
The Board sets the matters reserved for 
the Board to ensure key issues of the 
utmost importance are considered at 
Board level.
Board composition
The Directors collectively have a diverse 
set of skills, knowledge, experience and 
stakeholder expertise, which assists the 
Board in making well informed decisions 
that promote the Company’s long‑term 
sustainable success.
The Board comprises five independent 
Non-Executive Directors to ensure 
effective challenge of key decisions and 
safeguard stakeholder interests. 
The Board maintains a clear division of 
responsibilities, with the roles of Chair 
and Chief Executive exercised by 
different individuals.
Board discussion and decision
The Board provides rigorous evaluation 
and challenge to ensure decisions made 
promote long-term sustainable success. 
The Board continues to receive updates 
on engagement activities to understand 
the impact of the decisions on key 
stakeholders. 
The Board receives updates on key 
decisions, the actions taken to 
implement them and the impact on key 
stakeholders.
Board information
During their induction, 
Directors receive a 
detailed briefing on 
their duties.
All Directors have 
access to the advice of 
the Company 
Secretary, who is 
responsible for 
advising the Board on 
all governance matters.
The Board receives 
regular updates from 
stakeholder 
engagement activities 
which feeds into the 
decision-making 
process.
The Board also 
receives detailed 
papers from 
management and 
external advisers 
setting out key matters 
to be considered. 
Access to employees 
and business 
operations
How the Board makes decisions
We adhere to a strong governance framework and follow a robust decision-making process to ensure 
that the requirements of s172 are met and that the interests of our stakeholder groups are considered. 
Significant decisions
The main activities and decisions of the Board are set out 
on page 97. The following is an example of a significant 
decision made by the Board during the financial year, 
including details on how the decision was made and, where 
applicable, how conflicts between different stakeholders 
were managed. 
The acquisition of Redrow 
On 7 February 2024, the Board announced that it had 
reached an agreement on the terms of a recommended 
all-share offer for the acquisition of Redrow plc, which 
completed on 21 August 2024, with integration of the 
businesses subject to the CMA formally accepting the 
undertakings proposed in response to its limited concerns. 
 The key strategic rationale for the combination can be found on pages 6 
and 7
Key inputs:
Detailed Board packs including:
	• Strategic rationale
	• Modelling of the 
potential structure 
and characterisation of 
the Combination
	• Synergy assessments
	• Legal advice and due 
diligence reports from 
external counsel
	• Advice from the 
Company’s brokers
	• Takeover Code 
considerations
	• The likelihood that the 
decision will promote 
the long-term success 
of the business
	• The need to foster business 
relationships with suppliers, 
customers and others
	• Overview of potential targets
	• Valuation considerations
	• Analysis from external 
competition consultants
	• Analysis from financial 
market consultants
	• Shareholder analysis
	• Directors’ duties and 
obligations under the 
Takeover Code
	• The interests of Barratt
and Redrow employees
	• The impact of our 
business on the 
community and environment
Section 172 Statement continued
48
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Section 172 Statement continued
Decision making in practice 
continued
Decision-making process
In addition to scheduled meetings, the Board (or a 
Committee of the Board) convened on seven occasions 
specifically to approve matters relating to the Combination 
between January 2023 and February 2024. During those 
meetings, the Board debated the best course of action 
to promote the long-term success of the Company and 
amongst other things:
	• considered how Barratt could increase the volume of 
homes built per annum and identified a number of 
potential targets to drive growth through augmentation of 
the land bank, broadening access to talent and providing 
opportunities for brand diversification; 
	• reviewed the strategic rationale for pursuing M&A opportunities;
	• considered potential targets and directed management 
to focus on maintaining the Company’s differentiators 
in terms of quality, service and sustainability and how 
these could be evolved to deliver more high-quality 
homes for customers; 
	• assessed and scrutinised Redrow’s strategic and cultural 
fit with the Company;
	• challenged why the Combination was being pursued in 
preference to other M&A opportunities;
	• questioned the differentiators between Barratt and Redrow 
products, customer perception of the Redrow brand and 
the value of adding it to the Company’s portfolio;
	• considered and sought further assurance on competition 
law analysis;
	• discussed potential structures of the Combination 
and any dilutive impacts on shareholders’ interests;
	• considered the value of potential synergies and 
challenged assumptions made;
	• considered and discussed proposed financing arrangements;
	• via the Disclosure Committee, determined when the 
transaction had met the requisite threshold for inside 
information and the steps to be taken to protect the 
information from leaks and unlawful disclosure; 
	• considered the desirability of engaging with key 
stakeholders balanced against the regulatory restrictions 
on disclosing details prior to the Combination being 
announced and requested that an engagement strategy 
be prepared and actioned post-announcement; 
	• established a dedicated Committee of the Board 
comprising at least two Executive Directors and two 
Non-Executive Directors, one of which must be the Chair 
or the Senior Independent Director, to make decisions on 
the transaction as and when required; and 
	• considered the short and long-term impact of the 
Combination on the Company’s stakeholders. 
Key stakeholder considerations
The Board was mindful of the restrictions under the 
Takeover Code on limiting discussions in respect of the 
transaction to a limited number of parties and requested 
management prepares key stakeholder communications for 
release as soon as practicable after the Combination had 
been announced to gain feedback and insights from our 
key stakeholders on the decision.
Suppliers and sub-contractors: The Combination 
will provide the opportunity to realise the benefits of 
significant procurement-related cost savings driven by 
price harmonisation and volume-based pricing savings 
across the combined group. In the long term, the combined 
group’s supply chains will benefit from greater visibility and 
certainty of delivery and the acceleration of development 
through the deployment of the different brands and land 
pipelines. This should give sub-contractors confidence to 
invest in developing the skilled labour pool and production 
facilities needed for the future of the sector. 
Customers, local communities and the environment: 
When reviewing potential targets, the Board focused on 
bringing together two organisations with like-minded 
cultures and a shared commitment to customers, quality 
and sustainability. The combined group will enable the 
Company to deliver more high-quality homes, across a 
broader product range, and to accelerate the creation of 
sustainable, thriving communities across the UK. 
Shareholders: When considering the Combination, the 
Board paid due regard to how it would likely be perceived 
by shareholders, the dilutive impact on their shareholding 
and the value added to their investment. The Board also 
considered the likely impact on the share price and the 
perception of potential investors.
Employees: Mindful of the uncertainty that our employees 
are feeling due to the Combination, a comprehensive 
employee engagement strategy has been implemented to 
keep them updated on progress and to seek feedback on 
their concerns. Further details of employee engagement 
in respect of the Combination can be found on page 51. 
The Board believes that, in the longer term, employees will 
benefit from additional opportunities the combined group 
will provide for development and from being a part of an 
industry‑leading homebuilder with an industry-leading 
employee reward programme. 
Banks: The Board were mindful of the need for the 
Combination to be approved by the lenders under the 
terms of the existing RCFs but understood the restrictions 
on the Company’s ability to engage with them prior to the 
Combination being announced to the market. A tailored 
engagement programme was established to obtain the 
necessary consent after the Combination was announced. 
A financial back‑stop facility was put in place to cover the 
possibility of the RCF lenders withholding consent. This 
was cancelled following consent from the RCF lenders 
being received. 
Government, opposition and regulators: The Government 
and opposition’s ambition to increase the number of homes 
built per year was a driver behind the Board’s decision to 
look at M&A opportunities to grow the business. During the 
decision-making process, the Board was mindful of the CMA’s 
market study into housebuilding. Advice was sought from 
external counsel and competition consultants as appropriate 
and the Board was satisfied that the proposed Combination 
is overall beneficial to customers and does not breach 
competition restrictions. 
The required information was submitted to the CMA as part 
of the clearance process and the Board was kept updated 
on progress throughout the transaction.
Outcome
Following careful consideration of all matters relating to the 
long-term success of the Company, the Combination was 
approved on 6 February 2024. The Board has continued to 
receive updates on the transaction and will continue to do 
so to monitor its progress and the integration of Redrow 
into the Group.
49
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Stakeholder engagement
Employees
It is important that we provide our workforce systemically with 
information on matters of concern to them. We consult with our 
workforce or their representatives on a regular basis so that their 
views can be taken into account during our decision making.
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• Workforce Forum provides insight into 
employee thoughts and opinions
	• Emails, newsletters, webinars and 
video messages
	• Townhall meetings with employees and 
the Board 
	• Annual engagement survey and pulse 
surveys, with resulting action plans
	• Our Place intranet site 
	• Our six employee networks (see page 
30 for more details)
Board engagement:
	• Caroline Silver, as the Designated NED 
for Workforce Engagement, provides 
regular updates on workplace matters 
	• Regular updates from:
•	 the CEO on topics discussed and 
decisions made by the Sustainability 
Committee;
•	 the SHE and Construction Director 
on health and safety matters; and
•	 the Group HR Director on output 
from employee surveys, the people 
strategy and diversity and inclusion. 
	• Site visits (collectively and individually)
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Clarity and transparency 
around bonus payments
We now provide explanations of bonus 
payments and have introduced regular 
“Where are we?” updates on performance 
against our targets.
Interest: Open and honest two-
way communication
We use Town Halls and the Workforce 
Forum to facilitate two-way communication. 
During FY24, we scheduled two additional 
meetings to discuss key topics including 
the output from the employee engagement 
survey and the Redrow combination. 
In FY24, we created a Redrow microsite to 
keep employees updated on the Barratt-
Redrow combination with FAQs from our 
workforce. To date, this site has had over 
8,000 views. 
Interest: Collaboration
To strengthen collaboration among our 
employees, we are pulling best practice 
ways of working into a toolkit to share 
across our divisions. Divisional Directors 
now share their teams’ key deliverables and 
are hosting Regional Managing Director/
Managing Director breakfast meetings to 
facilitate cross-team collaboration.
Our performance
77%
completion rate for the annual 
engagement survey
67%
completion rate for the pulse survey
27
reports by whistleblowers
302
injury incidence rate per 100,000 persons
c. 2,000
colleagues joined Town Hall events
Key engagement activities 
throughout the year
6 Sept 2023 
Pride in the Job celebration dinner
21 Sept 2023 
Annual employee recognition awards
25–30 Sept 2023 
Engagement survey
25 Oct 2023 
Town Hall event
2 Nov 2023 
Workforce Forum
6 Nov 2023 
Long service dinner
8 Feb 2024 
Workforce Forum
13 Feb 2024 
Town Hall event
26 Feb 2024 
Workforce Forum
14 Mar 2024 
Workforce Forum
20 Mar 2024 
Board site visit
8 April 2024 
Town Hall event
1 May 2024
Pulse survey
22 May 2024 
Board site visit
50
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Keeping our employees updated on the Combination with Redrow
7 Feb
Redrow 
combination 
is announced 
to the market
7 Feb
Townhall with Senior 
Leadership Team (SLT)
SLT provided with a 
toolkit to support 
ongoing discussions 
with employees 
regarding the 
Combination
8 Feb
Specially 
convened 
Workforce 
Forum (WFF)
13 Feb
All-employee
Townhall to 
discuss the 
Combination
14 Feb
CFO hosts 
Townhall in 
Group head 
office
8 April
All-employee 
Townhall 
including 
update on the 
Combination
15 May
Update from 
CEO confirming 
approval of 
Combination by 
Barratt and 
Redrow 
shareholders
24 July
Update 
on the 
Combination 
given at a 
scheduled 
WFF
14 June
Update from 
CEO, with details 
of Competition 
and Markets 
Authority (CMA) 
starting Phase 1 
review and what 
this means 
19 August
Update from 
the CEO on 
completion 
of the 
Combination 
8 August 
Update from 
the CEO on 
the CMA’s 
Phase 1 
review
14 Mar
Update 
on the 
Combination 
given at a 
scheduled 
WFF
19 April
Update from 
CEO confirming 
the prospectus 
and circular 
issued
10 June
Update from 
CEO detailing 
next steps 
and new 
integration 
team
Keeping our employees updated
After we announced our combination with Redrow, we rolled 
out a comprehensive employee engagement programme for 
all our colleagues. 
Any period of change can cause feelings of uncertainty, 
anxiety and confusion, so we wanted to keep them updated 
throughout the transaction process, as well as answering 
their questions and concerns. Our Workplace Forum and 
Townhall meetings were key to keeping open dialogue 
with employees on the Combination. We reassured them 
that they would be updated with progress regularly and 
were open and transparent if we were unable to answer 
specific queries.
Our proactive approach helped to mitigate the risk of 
rumour and speculation and avoid undue distress, so our 
employees could focus on their role and deliver for the 
business as usual. The timeline below summarises our key 
employee engagement activities ahead of the combination.
Employees continued
Designated Non-Executive Director 
for workforce engagement
Following her appointment as Chair in June 2023, Caroline 
Silver took on the role as the Designated Non-Executive 
Director for workforce engagement in July 2023 to facilitate 
the ongoing communication channels between the Board 
and our employees. She also ensures that employees’ 
views are communicated to the Board and taken into 
consideration when making decisions. As part of her 
role as Designated Non-Executive Director for workforce 
engagement, she regularly meets with the workforce to 
gather their views through a variety of formal and informal 
channels to identify areas of concern and feed them back 
to the Board to consider.
Employees can directly contact the Designated NED 
for Workforce Engagement on any matters relating 
to the workplace on a confidential basis through a 
dedicated email address.
We do it together
Workforce Forum
Our Workforce Forum is an important tool for providing insight to 
what matters most to our employees. We have 23 Forum members 
including Chief Executive David Thomas, Chief Operating Officer 
Steven Boyes and Group HR Director Sally Austin. In selecting 
members of the Forum, we aim for diversity in terms of grade, 
region, gender and ethnicity. In FY24, we appointed six additional 
Forum members to strengthen its overall composition. Each 
member serves for three years before they are replaced. 
The Forum agrees an annual agenda, which includes matters 
raised by employees either through Forum representatives or via a 
dedicated email account. Caroline Silver, our Designated NED for 
Workforce Engagement, attends at least one meeting each year. 
Examples of topics raised recently include communications and 
how to best reach employees at site level, our health and wellbeing 
offer, female PPE and the Redrow combination. 
The Forum usually holds three scheduled meetings a year; in FY24, 
we amended the timing to align better with our business timetable, 
meaning that the third scheduled meeting was rescheduled for July 
2024 to tie in with the end of the financial year. During FY24, the 
Forum held two ad hoc meetings to discuss the Combination and 
our employee engagement survey outcomes. 
Making positive change through the 
Workforce Forum
Following Forum discussions, in FY24 we have:
Communications
	• Piloted giving our site employees without a work email or 
equipment access to “Our Place” intranet 
	• Implemented HR roadshows across sites to talk through employee 
benefits we offer, resulting in an increased uptake of our pension 
	• Started to summarise Forum meetings, for members to share 
with their colleagues
Health and wellbeing
	• Reviewed the process for our mental health first aiders, and 
developed support via regional leads to ensure they receive 
independent support
Female PPE
	• HSE and procurement teams have updated PPE provisions, 
resulting in an updated catalogue for employees, including 
provisions for women
Stakeholder engagement continued
51
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Stakeholder engagement continued
Customers
It is important that we listen to our customers so that we are able 
to meet their needs and continue to deliver high standards for 
quality and service.
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• Trustpilot and National New Homes 
Customer Satisfaction Survey 
	• Social media community management 
and listening 
	• Focus groups to identify design 
features and benefits that 
customers value
	• Interviews 
Board engagement:
	• Receives annual updates on 
the customer journey from the 
Chief Executive and the Sales 
and Marketing Director, covering 
customer engagement and experience
	• Receives updates on customer 
satisfaction ratings, resolutions 
and insights
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Affordability
We have determined new ways of helping 
customers to better understand cost 
savings through purchasing a new build 
home. We have also introduced new 
incentives and selling schemes to help 
customers with affordability challenges, 
such as the Kickstart Shared Ownership 
Scheme and the Own New Rate Reducer. 
We have upskilled our sales teams and 
provided them with tools to guide our 
customers facing a range of financial 
circumstances through the homebuying 
process and to explore purchase 
options available. 
Interest: Lower energy bills
We are prioritising lowering energy 
bills for our customers and maximising 
energy‑efficiency communications at key 
points in the customer journey.
We have trained our sales advisers and 
marketing teams so that they are equipped 
to give high-quality, accurate and consistent 
information on the sustainability attributes 
of our homes and developments. 
During FY24, we developed an easy-to-use 
sustainability toolkit for our colleagues, and 
a customer-facing sustainability brochure 
which we will launch in FY25.
First-time buyer Louise Kellaway-Moore in her new home
How we measure effectiveness
5 star
on the eight-week HBF National New 
Homes Customer Satisfaction Survey for 
the 15th consecutive year – meaning at 
least 90% of our customers are willing to 
recommend us to a friend
Nine-month
NHBC National New Homes Survey 
measures the satisfaction of our 
customers after being in their new home 
for a period of nine months. This is 
included as a metric in the annual 
bonus scheme
4.4
Trustpilot score 
(FY23: 4.4)
Over 9,600
interactions with in-market consumers 
Helping customers 
through the 
homebuying process
Louise Kellaway-Moore had always 
dreamed of buying her own home and 
finally found the perfect place to live 
with help from our Kickstart scheme. 
Louise said:
“I had always wanted to buy a new-build house. 
I did my research and came across the David 
Wilson Homes development at Niveus Walk. In 
discussion with Katrina, the sales manager, I 
found out about David Wilson Homes’ Kickstart 
scheme, which offers customers the chance to 
buy a share of the property, meaning that the 
deposit and mortgage are lower, which makes 
it more affordable for first-time buyers. The 
whole process has been amazing. The way in 
which David Wilson Homes helped me through 
the paperwork and explained each part of the 
process couldn’t have been better. They have 
been phenomenal every step of the way.”
 For more information on Kickstart, David Wilson 
Homes’ shared ownership scheme, visit: 
www.dwh.co.uk/offers/shared-ownership-
kickstart/ 
We do it for our 
customers
52
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

How we engage 
Company engagement: 
	• Investor roadshows 
	• Individual investor meetings
	• General meetings 
	• Shareholder circulars
	• Responding to individual 
shareholder queries
	• Development site visits for 
shareholders and investors
Board engagement:
	• The Board receives regular updates 
from the Investor Relations Director, 
including feedback from shareholders 
and analysts
	• Board members sought feedback from 
shareholders following the Redrow 
combination announcement 
	• The Chief Executive updates 
shareholders on our performance at 
our Annual General Meeting, where 
the Board is also available to answer 
questions 
Shareholders
Investor interactions in FY24
July
August
September
October
November
December
January
February
March
April
May
June
9
7
0
0
94
29
7
4
127
41
51.9%
48.1%
7.6%
46.1%
46.3%
4
2
111
28
0
0
38
20
12
3
27
9
40
13
 Meetings with investors 
 Number of investors attending
Our performance
65.7%
of the share register voted at the AGM
70.4%
of the share register voted at the GM
156 
meetings with investors
469
individual investors met
53.7%
of our shareholder base engaged 
in meetings
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Changes in homebuyer demand
We research local market conditions and 
build in locations with strong customer 
demand. The Board is focused on growing 
our land portfolio and securing planning 
consents to build a portfolio of attractive 
sites ready to market once demand recovers. 
Interest: Dividend strategy and the 
potential to return surplus capital
The Board believes that excess capital should 
be returned to shareholders when appropriate 
and periodically reviews our Dividend Policy 
and potential surplus capital returns. 
The Board approved an interim dividend 
of 4.4 pence per ordinary share and 
recommended a final dividend of 11.8 pence 
per ordinary share. 
Interest: Issues related to legacy 
properties and associated 
financial impact
Our dedicated Building Safety Unit 
investigates legacy buildings and reviews 
ongoing remedial work, investigations and 
valuations. During FY24, we identified 
26 buildings requiring potential remedial 
works. Provisions held in respect of legacy 
buildings at 30 June 2024 totalled £730.3m 
(30 June 2023: £612.3m).
 See pages 24 and 116 for further details
Our Audit and Risk Committee tests and 
challenges assumptions on estimated costs 
and we keep shareholders updated via 
regular market announcements.
Interest: Sustainability matters 
and the potential impact of the 
Future Homes Standard
During FY24, we responded to the Future 
Homes Standard consultation to inform 
future standards, based on our extensive 
research into different fabric efficiency 
standards and new technology. We also 
referred to our industry-leading research 
and innovation function and the findings 
from the Zed House and eHome2.
Investor meetings 
attended
Shareholder base meeting 
engagement
 Board members and Group IR Director
 Group IR Director and/or senior management team
 Shareholder base not met including passive and 
index-related shareholdings
Listening to our shareholders is key for retaining long-term 
investment and attracting new investors to the Company.
Stakeholder engagement continued
53
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Stakeholder engagement continued
During FY24, our Chief Executive 
continued to Chair the Future 
Homes Hub.
 Find out more about the Future Homes Hub 
and how it facilitates collaboration between 
businesses in the new homes sector and the 
Government to meet the climate and 
environmental challenges ahead by visiting 
its website www.futurehomes.org.uk/
Our performance
20
site visits
Government, 
opposition parties 
and regulators
It is essential that we engage with the Government, 
opposition parties and regulators so that they understand the 
challenges faced in the construction industry and the likely 
implications of current and proposed policies.
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• Membership of organisations 
that facilitate engagement with 
political stakeholders 
	• Site visits from key political 
stakeholders
	• Writing to political stakeholders
	• Participating in policy consultations
Board engagement:
	• Meetings between our Chief Executive 
and senior politicians (Government and 
opposition parties)
	• The Chief Executive provides updates 
at each Board meeting on engagement 
activities, including the extent policy 
and legislative changes accord with 
our representations
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Energy efficiency and reducing 
carbon emissions 
The Board supports more research and 
development on sustainability in housing 
to better understand Barratt’s appetite 
and ability to innovate and set its strategic 
direction. During FY24, the Board approved 
revised science-based targets for all three 
scopes of greenhouse gas emissions. 
 See page 81 for more details 
We do it together
Sir Keir Starmer and Angela Rayner on a site visit
Helping Government 
understand the industry
In February 2024, Sir Keir Starmer and Angela 
Rayner visited our Rose Place and The Lilies 
in Shrewsbury to showcase their support 
for the housebuilding industry. During the 
visit, they spoke about their plans for the 
economy, the ineffective planning system and 
how hard it is for many first-time buyers to 
afford a home. Operations Director Michaela 
Lancaster and Regional Managing Director 
David Hesson spoke with both politicians 
about the support we offer customers 
through schemes such as the Kickstart 
Shared Ownership Scheme and the new Own 
New Rate Reducer Scheme. During the tour, 
they were shown homes in different stages 
of the build process and met apprentices 
working on site. The visit provided a good 
opportunity to explore what new policies 
could help boost housebuilding to address 
the shortage of homes in the UK.
Interest: Construction quality 
The Board recognises construction quality 
and innovation as a principal risk and 
takes appropriate steps to ensure that 
Barratt manages and mitigates any quality 
concerns effectively. 
 See page 67 
Throughout FY24, we maintained our 
unwavering attention to build quality. 
For a fifth consecutive year, we were 
rated industry leader among the major 
housebuilders by the NHBC, registering 
the lowest Reportable Items per NHBC 
inspection at 0.13. 
 See page 35 
We monitor and publicly report on our 
quality performance, and our Remuneration 
Committee uses this information to feed 
into appropriate quality-related metrics for 
our Executive Annual Bonus Plan.
 See page 137
Interest: Competition in 
the housebuilding market 
We are pleased that the Competition and 
Markets Authority (CMA) study into the 
housebuilding market recognised that the 
majority of dysfunction in the sector arises 
from the planning system and funding 
difficulties facing local authorities. We are 
co-operating with the CMA on the Barratt–
Redrow combination, and its investigation 
into the sharing of information within the 
housebuilding industry. 
 See page 4
Interest: Supply and planning.
The delivery of new homes is inextricably 
linked to the planning system. 
 Our solutions to address the dysfunctional planning 
system can be found on page 17
7
Government consultations 
responded to
54
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Banks
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• The Chief Financial Officer and 
Group Treasurer regularly engage 
with each bank in our RCF and USPP 
investors, including calls after each 
trading update, financial results 
announcements, and at least one site 
visit each year 
	• Our Head of Mortgage Lender Relations 
holds regular meetings with the top 
ten mortgage lenders, supported by the 
Executive Directors
Board engagement:
	• The Chief Financial Officer and the 
Chief Executive provide regular updates 
on engagement activities with RCF 
banks and mortgage lenders, and 
on resulting actions
Our facilities
£700m 
committed RCF 
£200m
fixed rate Sterling USPP notes
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Energy-efficient homes 
We work with mortgage lenders to promote 
the benefits of new, energy-efficient homes 
by engaging with them and their appointed 
surveyors through meetings and visits, 
including visits to Energy House and Oregon 
Timber Frame factory. 
Interest: Viability of green mortgages 
As the leading national sustainable 
housebuilder, we have a dual approach to 
green mortgage development.
We work with mortgage lenders to 
develop enhanced mortgage products that 
recognise the advantages of our new build, 
energy-efficient homes. Also, through 
Government engagement and the Future 
Homes Hub, we are working to understand 
how the sustainable benefits of new 
homes can be recognised in the mortgage 
valuation process. 
 See page 29 for further details 
Currently, approximately 57% of lenders 
provide green mortgages: two of these 
lenders take the savings from lower energy 
bills and energy efficiency into account 
when assessing mortgage affordability. 
Interest: New high loan to 
value lending products for 
our customers 
Together with lenders we are developing 
products to expand the options available 
for customers with a 5% deposit, through 
expanding unsupported 95% lending and via 
the Deposit Unlock scheme.
Volunteers at City of Trees
Engaging with our banking partners is key to ensure that we 
have sufficient finance and working capital to support the 
business. It also helps identify ways we can collaborate to 
support mutual customers.
Building stronger 
relationships with our 
banking partners 
On 19 June 2024, the Barratt Treasury 
team, supported by our Chief Financial 
Officer, Group Investor Relations 
Director and five banking partners 
(lending participants in the Group RCF 
and USPP) took part in a community 
day maintaining approximately 200 
trees. Working in partnership with 
City of Trees – Manchester, this event 
helped contribute to the organisation’s 
overall tree-planting goals. The trees 
will benefit from the valuable care 
and effort made on the day. Our 
contribution made a huge difference by 
increasing biodiversity, making urban 
environments more resilient to climate 
change and helping create green 
spaces to boost community wellbeing.
We do it together
Stakeholder engagement continued
55
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Stakeholder engagement continued
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Health and safety on our sites
Safety is a key Group priority. The Board 
receives regular updates on safety 
performance and during FY24 requested an 
external effectiveness review of the Group’s 
SHE policies, procedures and processes. 
The outcome was reported back to the 
Board, with the reassurance that our SHE 
processes and practices are appropriate 
and remain fit for purpose. 
Interest: Sustainability and carbon 
reduction strategies
During FY24, we continued our engagement 
with suppliers on our sustainability 
priorities and improved our supply chain 
carbon emissions data. Twenty suppliers, 
covering approximately 50% of our 
emissions from materials (according to a 
spend-based model) shared their carbon 
emissions data and reduction strategies so 
we can better understand how these align 
with our net zero plans.
 See pages 81 to 84 for our net zero transition plan
Our engagement enables the Board to 
understand the challenges faced in collating 
data to measure scope 3 emissions and 
progress against our targets. 
Interest: Being paid in a timely manner
We are mindful of the pressures uncertain 
market conditions place on our suppliers 
and sub-contractors, and are committed 
to adhering to the Prompt Payment Code 
to ease their concerns. From 1 July 2023 
to 31 December 2023, the average time 
taken to pay invoices was 26 days and the 
average time for the period 1 January 2024 
to 30 June 2024 was 27 days.
Supporting our 
sub-contractors
In September 2023, our North East 
division hosted a seminar attended 
by 22 sub‑contractors. During the 
seminar, they discussed our Service 
Level Agreement (SLA) and Code of 
Conduct for all sub‑contractors and 
held an open forum to encourage 
feedback. Conversation also focused 
on addressing customer complaints, 
doing things right the first time, 
resolving issues in a timely manner 
and how the division and our 
sub‑contractors can support each 
other. Following the seminar, we 
implemented changes including:
	• contractors issuing tool box talks to 
all operatives to review the SLA and 
Code of Conduct; 
	• sending out monthly reports 
regarding outstanding defects to 
ensure all contractors are aware of 
defects; and
	• tool box talks with site management 
teams to stress the importance of 
weekly sub‑contractor meetings to 
discuss ongoing customer care. 
Suppliers and 
sub-contractors
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• Annual Supply Chain Conference with 
key Group suppliers 
	• Divisional sub-contractor and supplier 
days to discuss Local Plans 
	• Supplier and sub-contractor 
workshops, meetings and seminars
Board engagement:
	• The Chair spoke at and other Board 
members attended the Annual Supply 
Chain Conference
	• The Chief Operating Officer provides 
a supply chain update, including 
availability of materials and services to 
support our build delivery programme 
and sub-contractor performance at 
each Board meeting
	• The Group Procurement Director 
attends the Board meetings to update 
on suppliers and supply chain risk
	• Reviewed and approved our Modern 
Slavery Statement, which sets out 
actions taken to mitigate the risk of 
modern slavery in our sub-contractors’ 
operations and our supply chain 
Our performance
161
attendees at our Annual Supply 
Chain Conference
147
suppliers with membership of the Supply 
Chain Sustainability School
Over 53 
supplier and sub-contractor 
divisional events
68%
of invoices paid within 30 days*
*	 For the period 1 January 2024 to 30 June 2024.
Engaging with our sub-contractors and suppliers helps support 
our productivity levels, secure continuity of supply materials at 
appropriate prices and develop shared solutions to key challenges 
such as carbon reduction, waste management and modern slavery.
We do it right
56
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Listening to local 
communities
Chiltern Grange is a site in Oxfordshire 
where we obtained a Neighbourhood 
Plan site allocation by engaging with the 
local parish and understanding what 
local residents wanted for the village.
A Neighbourhood Plan is a community-
led framework for guiding the future 
development and growth of an area. 
Local engagement is essential to gain 
valuable input, understand pertinent 
issues and identify suitable sites.
The local parish and Neighbourhood 
Plan group wanted a relief road to 
the village centre, so together we 
planned landscaping and a new road. 
The site is now being delivered and 
our proportion of the road is near 
completion with the installation of a new 
roundabout complete and another due 
for completion by the end of 2024. Over 
110 new residents have now moved in.
Communities 
and environment
How we engage
Company engagement:
	• Meetings and site-specific 
consultations to consult and 
incorporate feedback
	• Working closely with local 
community members including 
schools and parish councils
	• Dedicated websites with information 
and updates, and site signage 
around our sites
	• Charitable giving through Barratt 
Foundation, volunteering and 
fundraising 
Board engagement:
	• The Chief Executive and the Chief 
Operating Officer inform the Board of 
any local issues that could escalate 
into Group-wide issues 
	• The Board receives updates from 
the Group Construction and 
SHE Director, the Sustainability 
Committee and the Barratt 
Foundation 
	• The Board receives feedback 
from charities on the impact of 
our support
Our performance
9,026 
planning consents secured (plots)
£6.4m
donated to local charities
14,515 
hours volunteered
Output from engagement
Examples of key interests:
Interest: Impact on the environment 
We monitor and publicly report on our 
environmental performance, and our 
Remuneration Committee uses this 
information to feed into appropriate 
environmental-related metrics for our 
Executive Annual Bonus Plan and Long Term 
Performance Plan.
 See pages 137 and 138
During FY24, the Board approved our revised 
science-based emission reduction targets 
for all three scopes of greenhouse gas 
emissions. These are awaiting validation 
by the SBTi. 
 See pages 79 to 84 for details on how we are 
minimising our environmental impact 
Interest: Impact on local area 
during construction 
During FY24, each of our divisions donated 
£1,500 per month to a different charity 
that supports the local community within 
the areas in which we build. In addition, 
divisions are encouraged to raise funding for 
local charities and utilise the match funding 
available from the Barratt Foundation. 
During FY24, our colleagues raised over 
£2.25m for local causes.
Interest: Impact on local area 
post completion 
During FY24, we spent £536m on physical 
improvement works benefiting local 
communities and provided 4,632 school places.
Our Environmental Policy sets out our overarching 
commitment to mitigate the adverse impact 
of our operations on the environment and the 
communities in which we operate, and includes 
specific commitments on minimising noise levels 
and traffic movements during construction, 
pollutant emissions and disturbance to wildlife 
habitats and local ecosystems. Our Board reviews 
and approves our Environmental Policy every year 
to ensure it remains appropriate. 
It is important to engage with the local communities in 
which we build to ensure that we are responding to local needs.
Over 110 new residents have now moved in at Chiltern Grange
We do it right
Stakeholder engagement continued
57
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Financial Officer’s Review
Solid performance
Despite the UK housing market stabilising at significantly 
lower activity levels, following the sharp rise in mortgage 
interest rates in the Autumn of 2022 and the ongoing 
pressures created by the cost of living, we have delivered 
a solid financial performance.
Our financial results reflect the Group’s clear operational 
priorities set at the start of the year centred around 
driving revenue, controlling costs, maintaining land buying 
discipline and continuing to lead the industry around 
customer service, build quality and sustainability.
Our disciplined operating framework has ensured that, 
despite the challenging trading conditions, the Group 
remains in a strong financial position, well placed to take 
operational and financial advantage of any market recovery.
Results to 30 June 2024
Income statement
Group revenue was £4,168.2m in FY24 (FY23: £5,321.4m), 
with Group wholly owned completions 17.8% lower at 13,468 
(FY23: 16,378), reflecting our lower order book at the start of 
the year and ongoing slower rate of reservations throughout 
the financial year.
The average selling price of our wholly owned completions 
reduced by 4.0% to £306.8k (FY23: £319.6k), with a reduced 
proportion of affordable homes, accounting for 20.8% 
(FY23: 23.9%) of wholly owned completions, diluting the 
degree of reported ASP decline. Our private average selling 
price reduced by 6.4% to £343.9k (FY23: £367.6k), due 
to underlying house price decline, a reduced proportion 
of completions in London and the dilutive impact of 
PRS growth, offset by minor changes in product and 
geographic mix.
Adjusted gross profit reduced by 39.0% to £689.0m (FY23: 
£1,130.4m) and adjusted gross margin reduced by 470 bps 
to 16.5% (FY23: 21.2%). This was a result of the combined 
impact of increased sales incentives, build cost inflation 
and a decline in completion volumes, which reduced fixed 
cost efficiencies. In FY24, our contribution margin was 
c. 29% (FY23: c. 32%) after land and direct build costs.
After adjusted items charged through cost of sales, totalling 
£179.5m (FY23: £155.5m) and relating to legacy property 
costs, reported gross profit was £509.5m (FY23: £974.9m) 
and reported gross margin was 12.2% (FY23: 18.3%).
Administrative expenses before adjusting items were 
£314.5m (FY23: £270.8m) and included:
	• Group-wide inflationary salary increases at an average 
of c. 5%, effective in FY24;
	• A reduction in Building Safety Unit running costs as we 
insourced support;
	• An increase in group-wide performance-related pay 
compared to FY23;
	• Project-related IT and digital investment; and 
	• Reduced sundry income of £14.8m, when compared 
with £16.7m in FY23.
After deducting administrative expenses before adjusting 
items and a modest net gain of £2.1m on part-exchange 
activities (FY23: £3.3m), the Group delivered an adjusted 
profit from operations of £376.6m (FY23: £862.9m), with 
an adjusted operating margin of 9.0% (FY23: 16.2%). The 
720 bps decline in the adjusted operating margin reflected:
	• Completion volumes: a decline in our wholly owned 
completion volumes of 17.8% or 2,910 homes created a 
300 bps negative impact (FY23: 30 bps negative impact).
	• Net inflation: adverse sales price movements compounded 
by higher underlying build cost inflation produced a 430 bps 
negative impact (FY23: 170 bps negative impact).
	• London: a significant decrease in completions from our 
London operations to 2% in FY24 (FY23: 8%), where margins 
are lower than our regional business, resulted in a 60 bps 
positive margin impact (FY23: 20 bps negative impact).
Mike Scott
Chief Financial Officer
Find out more
 Read more about our strategy on page 23
 Read more about our sustainability on pages 40 to 44
 Read more about our values on page 2
58
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

	• a corporation tax charge on adjusted profit before tax 
of £104.7m (FY23: £188.1m);
	• a residential property developer tax charge of £6.1m 
(FY23: £26.0m); and 
	• a tax credit for adjusted items totalling £54.4m 
(FY23: £39.3m credit).
Adjusted basic earnings per share decreased by 57.9% 
to 28.3 pence per share (FY23: 67.3 pence) due to a 
56.5% decline in adjusted pre-tax profitability and a 6.0% 
impact from the increased corporate tax rate and was 
partially offset by a 2.8% benefit from the reduced average 
share count, reflecting the impact of our share buyback 
completed in June 2023.
Basic earnings per share reduced by 77.8% to 11.8 pence 
per share (FY23: 53.2 pence).
Reflecting the decline in adjusted profitability as well as 
the slowing in asset turn – notwithstanding the disciplined 
management of capital employed throughout the year – 
our ROCE declined to 9.5% (FY23: 22.2%).
Adjusted items 
Adjusted items recognised in the year related to costs 
associated with legacy properties of £192.1m (FY23: £179.2m), 
as well as initial costs in relation to the Redrow transaction 
of £22.4m, where the balance of transaction costs will 
be recorded in FY25. Of the total charge related to legacy 
properties, £125.3m (FY23: £117.7m) related to future fire 
safety and external wall systems commitments, with a 
further £66.8m (FY23: £51.5m) relating to remedial works 
arising from the review of reinforced concrete frames.
Our commitment to addressing fire safety and concrete 
frame design and construction is clear, and evidenced by 
further investment in our dedicated Building Safety Unit, 
which manages our ongoing building safety remediation 
programme across the country. Whilst the regulatory 
backdrop and assessment regime remain subject to 
variability and subjective interpretation, we are focused 
on the efficient delivery of both suitable and sustainable 
remediation solutions, which we anticipate will be delivered 
over the next five years, with building safety considerations 
paramount in prioritising and scheduling remediation works.
Fire safety and external wall systems
Reflecting our commitment to dealing with these buildings 
as quickly and efficiently as possible, of the 262 buildings 
under review at 30 June 2024, 137 were in progress at 
tender, site mobilisation or remediation stage.
In the first half of the year, we recognised a charge of 
£56.4m to reflect higher than expected tender returns 
and cost increases on buildings being remediated by the 
Building Safety Fund. These generally related to buildings 
with atypical features and costs in relation to the remaining 
buildings are broadly in line with our initial estimates.
During the second half of the year we recognised a charge 
of £64.5m, following an initial £5.0m for fire testing recognised in 
the first half, in relation to a development of three buildings 
which we had previously disclosed as a contingent liability. 
We have been unable to develop a testing methodology 
under the FRAEW for these buildings due to the unique 
unitised wall system in place, which we now assess will 
need to be replaced. The provision is based on the current 
expected method of remediation, designed to minimise 
disruption to residents, though due to the unique nature 
of the building, this estimate may vary as the process is 
further developed.
After incorporating the additional adjusted item charges 
for fire safety and external wall systems of £125.9m, as 
well as with remediation costs incurred during FY24 and 
time discounting adjustments, the provision in relation to 
fire safety and external wall systems totalled £628.1m at 
30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: £535.9m). We believe this 
reflects our current best estimate of the extent and future 
costs of remediation work required and we will continue to 
review these estimates as we gather data and complete the 
remediation of buildings within our portfolio.
We signed the Scottish Government’s Safer Building Accord 
on 31 May 2023. The process to agree a legally binding, 
long-form contract to give effect to the Principles of the 
Accord remains in progress with Homes for Scotland and 
the Scottish Government. As a result of this uncertainty, 
our existing provisions for Scottish buildings have been 
made on a consistent basis with England and Wales but 
are subject to change depending on the outcome of the 
contract negotiations. 
Results to 30 June 2024 continued
Income statement continued 
	• Completed developments provision: after incurring 
significantly higher charges in FY23 due to lengthening 
timescales for local authority adoption of roads 
and public spaces on completed developments, a 
more normal movement in this provision created a 
20 bps positive margin impact (FY23: 60 bps negative 
margin impact).
	• Mix and other items: changes in sales mix, increased 
selling costs, reduced abortive costs in relation to land 
transactions no longer proceeding and other smaller 
items created a 30 bps positive impact (FY23: 70 bps 
negative impact).
	• Net administrative expenses: the small decrease in 
part-exchange income and the increase in administrative 
expenses deducted 100 bps (FY23: deducted 30 bps) from 
the adjusted operating margin. 
After deducting adjusted items, on a reported basis, 
profit from operations reduced to £174.7m (FY23: £707.4m), 
with a reported operating margin of 4.2% (FY23: 13.3%).
Net finance charges were £6.5m (FY23: £11.1m), reflecting 
increased interest received on cash balances throughout 
FY24. The cash component of the finance charge was 
an increased credit of £37.1m (FY23: £13.4m credit) with 
non-cash charges of £43.6m (FY23: £24.5m). The increase 
in non-cash finance charges reflected the impact of the 
increase in legacy property provisions and the higher discount 
rate applied to these provisions, arising from the movement 
in the gilt rate. In FY25, we expect finance costs will be c. £25m, 
reflecting a cash component credit of c. £15m and non-cash 
charges of c. £40m. 
Our JVs delivered lower adjusted profit for the year of £14.9m 
(FY23: £32.5m). Including adjusted charges for JV legacy 
properties of £12.6m (FY23: £23.7m), JV reported profits 
reduced to £2.3m (FY23: £8.8m). Consequently, reported profit 
before tax for the year declined to £170.5m (FY23: £705.1m).
The Group’s tax charge for the year reduced to £56.4m 
(FY23: £174.8m). This included the full year impact of the 
increase in the rate of corporation tax from 19% to 25%, 
effective from 1 April 2023. The tax charge comprised: 
Chief Financial Officer’s Review continued
59
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Results to 30 June 2024 continued
Adjusted items continued
Reinforced concrete frames 
Our remediation activities for concrete frame design and 
construction continued during FY24 with developments 
proceeding in line with our plans.
As highlighted earlier, in the Chief Executive’s report, 
during FY23 and separate from the original concrete frame 
review, structural issues were found at two developments 
where reinforced concrete frames were designed for us by 
a different engineering firm to that employed at Citiscape. 
Following preliminary work on these developments and 
further analysis, undertaken during the second half of FY24, 
it is now considered probable that extensive concrete frame 
remediation will be required. Based on a high-level risk 
review, an additional £56.6m has been provided for by the 
Group and £7.6m recognised as a share of loss from joint 
ventures in respect of the two developments. 
 Further details on how we build safety are on our website at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/about-us/our-approach-to-building-
safety
Whilst charges for legacy properties reflect our current best 
estimates of the extent and future costs of work required, 
we may have to update these figures as assessments and 
work progress.
Cash flow
Net cash decreased to £868.5m at 30 June 2024 
(30 June 2023: £1,069.4m). The main components of 
the change in net cash position were:
	• a £96.2m net cash inflow from operating activities 
(FY23: £465.5m cash inflow); 
	• a £12.0m net cash inflow from investing activities 
(FY23: inflow of £55.4m), with the reduction reflecting 
reduced cash received from joint ventures; and 
	• a £308.6m net cash outflow from financing activities 
(FY23: outflow of £590.6m), principally reflecting dividends 
paid of £270.6m (FY23: £360.0m) and the absence of any 
share buyback activities in FY24 (FY23: £201.3m share 
buyback including stamp duty charges of £1.3m).
The major driver of the decline to £96.2m net cash inflow 
from operating activities in the year was the reduction 
in our profit from operations, which reduced to £174.7m 
(FY23: £707.4m). This was partially offset by a reduced net 
cash outflow from working capital and provisions of £12.0m 
(FY23: £64.9m outflow) and net interest and tax payments, 
which reduced to £73.7m (FY23: £196.3m outflow). 
The net £12.0m outflow (FY23: £64.9m outflow) with 
respect to working capital and provisions included:
	• A £38.0m outflow (FY23: £48.9m inflow) with respect 
to inventories where a reduction in construction work 
in progress of £77.7m was offset by additional net land 
investment of £93.7m and investment at Gladman and 
additional part-exchange property costs.
	• A £87.2m decrease (FY23: £337.6m decrease) in 
payables, with land creditor balances reducing by a 
more modest £33.9m (FY23: £226.9m reduction) and a 
more modest reduction in trade and other payables of 
£53.3m (FY23: £110.7m). 
	• A £132.8m increase in provisions (FY23: £163.4m increase) 
created in large part by the additional legacy building 
safety charges incurred in FY24. During FY24, we spent 
£91.5m (FY23: £32.9m) on the remediation of legacy properties.
Balance sheet
The Group’s net assets at 30 June 2024 were £5,439.1m 
(30 June 2023: £5,596.4m) after the payment of dividends 
totalling £270.6m (30 June 2023: £360.0m).
Goodwill and intangible assets reduced to £1,037.4m 
(30 June 2023: £1,047.8m), reflecting amortisation charges 
in the year.
Our balance sheet assets showed limited movement over 
the year with:
	• The investment in our land bank increasing by £93.7m 
to £3,233.6m (30 June 2023: £3,139.9m);
	• Construction work in progress tightly controlled and 
reducing by £77.7m to £1,829.4m (30 June 2023: £1,907.1m);
	• Increased investment in land promotion activity at 
Gladman resulting in a £13.8m increase in promotional 
agreement work in progress to £111.5m (30 June 2023: 
£97.7m); and
Chief Financial Officer’s Review continued
	• Part-exchange properties and other inventories tightly 
controlled at £103.7m (30 June 2023: £93.3m).
Adjusted item charges in relation to legacy properties 
were the most significant factor impacting our balance 
sheet liabilities.
Our provisions on the balance sheet increased to £921.2m 
at 30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: £788.4m) and included 
£730.3m (30 June 2023: £612.3m) of provisions to cover 
future costs in connection with the remediation of external 
wall systems and reinforced concrete frames.
Net tangible assets were £4,401.7m (452 pence per share) 
at 30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: £4,548.6m; 467 pence per 
share). Land, net of land creditors, and work in progress 
totalled £4,590.2m (471 pence per share) at 30 June 2024 
(30 June 2023: £4,540.3m; 466 pence per share).
At 30 June 2024, the Group held net cash balances of £868.5m 
(30 June 2023: £1,069.4m). Whilst we continue to defer 
payment for some land purchases to optimise ROCE, the 
pause in land buying has led to a reduction in land creditors. 
At 30 June 2024, land creditors were £472.8m (30 June 2023: 
£506.7m) and equated to 14.6% (30 June 2023: 16.1%) of the 
owned land bank.
Our minimal year-end total net indebtedness target was 
achieved with a net surplus of £395.7m at 30 June 2024 
(30 June 2023: £562.7m net surplus).
During FY25, £307.8m of land creditors will fall due for 
payment (30 June 2023, during FY24: £321.5m). Land 
creditors due beyond 30 June 2025 totalled £165.0m 
at 30 June 2024 (30 June 2023: £185.2m due beyond 
30 June 2024).
Capital returns
The Board has reviewed capital allocation as is customary 
as part of its annual cycle. Having recently completed the 
Redrow acquisition, we will assess the capital requirements 
for the enlarged group taking into account current market 
conditions including the positive supply-side developments, 
our obligations with respect to building safety and our 
desire to be proactive in the land market. In principle we 
continue to believe that when appropriate, that excess 
capital will be returned to shareholders and the timing 
of any such returns remains under review.
60
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Results to 30 June 2024 continued
Operating framework and capital structure
Our operating framework and appropriate capital structure 
continue to deliver a stable and solid foundation for the 
Group. We target an appropriate capital structure as part 
of our disciplined operating framework, with shareholders’ 
funds and land creditors funding the longer‑term land 
requirements of our business, and term loans and 
bank debt funding the shorter-term requirements for 
working capital.
Our highly selective approach to land buying since the 
summer of 2022 has limited investment in land and the 
creation of additional land creditor obligations. Reflecting 
Treasury
The Board sets and approves the Treasury Policy and senior 
management controls day-to-day operations. The Group’s 
Treasury Policy seeks to maintain an appropriate capital 
structure and provide the right platform for the business 
to manage both operating risks and opportunities.
Cash management and relationships with our banking 
partners are co-ordinated centrally by the Group Head of 
Treasury. During the year, we extended our £700m Revolving 
Credit Facility to November 2028 with one further one‑year 
extension period through to November 2029 available, 
if agreed between the Group and its lenders. 
Tax
The Group does not enter into business transactions for 
the sole purpose of reducing potential tax liabilities. The 
Group’s tax strategy is to only use any available reliefs and 
exemptions, which have been set out in any current tax 
legislation, to minimise the Group’s tax liabilities.
The rate of corporation tax, including RPDT, for the year 
ended 30 June 2024 was 33.1% (FY23: 24.8%), which, 
reflecting the impact of the non-deductible Redrow 
transaction expenses, was above the standard effective 
rate of tax of 29% (inclusive of RPDT at 4%) (FY23: 24.5% 
inclusive of RPDT at 4%).
Looking ahead, the Group’s tax charge and underlying 
effective rate of tax is expected to be approximately 
29.0% in FY25.
Operating framework
Position at 30 June 2024 
Position at 30 June 2023
Land bank
c. 3.5 years owned and 
c. 1.0 year controlled
4.3 years owned and 
0.6 years controlled
3.6 years owned and 
0.7 years controlled
Land creditors
Maintain at 15–25% of the land 
bank over medium term
14.6%
16.1%
Net cash
Modest average net cash over 
the financial year
FY24: average net cash 
of £732.3m
FY23: average net cash of £759.1m
Year-end net cash
£868.5m
£1,069.4m
Total 
indebtedness 
Minimal year-end total 
indebtedness in the 
medium term
Total net surplus of £395.7m
Total net surplus of £562.7m
Treasury
Appropriate financing facilities
£700m Revolving Credit Facility 
extended to November 2028 and
£200m US Private Placing Notes 
maturing August 2027
£700m Revolving Credit Facility 
extended to November 2027 and 
£200m US Private Placing Notes 
maturing August 2027
Dividend 
Policy
Dividend cover of 1.75x adjusted 
earnings per share 
FY24: total ordinary dividend 
of 16.2 pence per share
FY23: total ordinary dividend 
of 33.7 pence per share
Chief Financial Officer’s Review continued
the calendar-based settlement of previously agreed land 
creditor obligations, but the limited investment in new 
land up until the final quarter of FY24, land creditors 
have reduced to 14.6% of our land bank. This situation is 
expected to reverse as land buying activity increases over 
the medium term.
Our operating framework remains unchanged, and our 
performance against targets at 30 June 2024 and 2023 
is summarised below.
In pursuing this clear framework we have ensured that, 
even through challenging trading conditions, the Group has 
remained in a strong financial position, ready to take both 
operational and financial advantage of both market recovery 
and organic investment opportunities looking forward.
61
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Results to 30 June 2024 continued
Pensions
Defined contribution pension arrangements are in place for current employees. Defined contribution scheme charges for 
qualifying employees totalled £21.2m (FY23: £19.2m). Pension contributions are based upon a fixed percentage of each 
qualifying employee’s pay and, once paid, the Group has no further obligations under these schemes.
Guidance for FY25
Looking to FY25, for regulatory reasons we are unable to provide guidance for the combined group at the date of our 
Annual Report and Accounts. We provide below guidance with respect to Barratt Developments PLC as it would have 
applied on a standalone basis, before considering the potential impact of the acquisition of Redrow plc:
Completions
c. 13,000 – 13,500 total home completions including c. 600 JV completions
Affordable mix expected to be in the high teens
Average sales outlet movement 
(inc. JVs)
c. 9% decline
Build cost inflation
c. Broadly flat
Adjusted administrative expenses
c. £310m, excluding integration costs (including amortisation of intangible asset 
charges of c. £10m)
Interest cost
c. £25m charge
(c. £15m cash credit, c. £40m non-cash charge)
Land approvals
Return to normal approval activity during the year. 
Land cash spend
c. £0.8bn
Year-end net cash
c. £0.5bn 
Taxation
Effective underlying tax rate of 29%, reflecting current corporation tax rate
at 25% and 4% RPDT
Ordinary dividend cover
1.75x ordinary dividend cover based on adjusted earnings per share
Well placed for FY25, despite continuing 
economic and political uncertainties
Despite limited economic growth and the ongoing 
affordability challenges for our customers, the Group is 
in a strong position. We entered FY25 with an excellent 
net cash position, our forward sales position is solid 
albeit reduced and we have maintained a strong land 
bank. Our operating framework and our strong financial 
position are the foundations for our divisions to focus on 
delivering high-quality, sustainable homes and developments 
throughout the country, as well as giving us the flexibility to 
react to changing market conditions and opportunities as 
they evolve.
Mike Scott
Chief Financial Officer
3 September 2024
Chief Financial Officer’s Review continued
62
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Risk management
Our approach 
to managing 
our risks
In pursuing our strategic priorities to create 
value for stakeholders, we are exposed 
to risk. The Board is responsible for risk 
management and ensuring the Group 
maintains the appropriate level of risk 
exposure to achieve its strategic objectives. 
The risks which the Group faces could have a material 
adverse effect on the implementation of the its strategy, its 
business operations, its financial performance, shareholder 
value and returns, and its reputation. Changes in the 
economic or trading environment including geopolitical 
events can affect the likelihood and potential impact of 
risks, and may create new and emerging risks meaning we 
must continually manage our risk exposure.
Risk management controls are integrated into all levels of 
our business and across all operations, including at site, 
divisional, regional and Group level, and are monitored 
continually to ensure controls are in line with risks as 
they evolve. 
Roles and responsibilities
Board and Audit and Risk Committee 
	• Corporate strategy, governance, performance, risk 
management and internal controls.
	• Monitoring the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal controls systems.
	• Ensuring there is an appropriate culture in place to 
support effective and embedded risk management 
throughout the Group.
*	 Management regional reviews.
**	 Divisional Board meetings.
Board
Audit and Risk Committee
Executive Risk Committee
Enterprise risk management (ERM) framework
Fraud risk framework
Internal control over material risks
Internal control over material risks
Risk type
How are risks 
assessed?
Where are risks 
and controls
captured?
Key sources 
of assurance
Regional and 
functional
risks
Bottom‑up risk 
assessments
Region and 
function 
risk register
2nd line 
monitoring 
MRR*/DBM**
Group-level 
risks
Top‑down risk 
assessment
Group risk 
register/
risk cards
Risk 
assurance 
mapping
Fraud risk
Fraud risk 
assessment
Fraud 
risk register
3rd line 
internal audit
programme
Financial 
reporting risk
Financial
reporting risk
assessment
Policies and
procedures,
documentation
and internal
control
matrices
2nd line
monitoring,
3rd line
internal audit, 
external audit
Material risks
Policies and 
procedures, and 
internal control
Control self- 
assessment
2nd line 
monitoring, 
3rd line 
internal audit 
	• Setting risk appetite, considering the expectations 
of stakeholders, and the macroeconomic context.
	• Monitoring principal and emerging risks and challenging 
the executive management team on how these risks are 
assessed and managed.
	• Assessing risks against the Group’s strategy and the 
interests of stakeholders, and gaining assurance on 
their management.
Executive Risk Committee 
A Committee consisting of all members of the executive 
management team, reporting to the Audit and Risk 
Committee, is responsible for:
	• Monitoring business and operational performance 
and changes to the key risks.
	• Assessing and monitoring identified risks using a scoring 
system based on the likelihood of the risk materialising, 
potential impact on the business and the velocity at 
which the risk may materialise.
	• Identifying, reviewing and monitoring emerging risks 
to assess the potential impact on the Company.
	• Implementing mitigation strategies to effectively manage 
key risks within the Group’s risk appetite.
	• Ensuring that risk management is embedded within the 
business and appropriate actions are taken to manage risk.
Group, regional and divisional management
	• Applying specialist knowledge to identify new risks and 
monitor changes to existing operational and strategic 
risks at a divisional, regional and functional level.
	• Risk management and control activities within the 
relevant divisions, regions or Group disciplines.
Site management, assessments and valuations
	• Identifying and assessing operational risks affecting 
housebuilding activity at site level, including construction, 
sub-contractor and SHE risk.
	• Maintaining an effective system of site-level risk 
management and internal control.
63
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Risk activities conducted during 
the year
Under the Group’s enterprise risk management framework, 
risk workshops are held between regional management and 
Group functional experts to provide a robust “bottom-up” 
assessment of the risks being experienced by the business. 
The outputs inform the determination of the Group level 
key risks by the Executive Risk Committee, which are then 
reviewed and challenged by the Board, with support from 
third-party experts, to arrive at the final principal risks. 
The Board has also refreshed its risk appetite approach 
during FY24 to ensure that the Board’s appetite for each 
of the principal risks is clear and can be used to determine 
appropriate mitigating actions across the Group. The Board 
now categorises risk appetite for each principal risk using 
the following methodology:
	• Averse — Minimise risk as much as possible, limited 
tolerance of potential exposure to risk consequence 
in pursuit of related benefits.
	• Cautious — A balanced and informed approach to risk 
taking, moderate tolerance of potential exposure to risk 
consequence in the pursuit of related benefits.
	• Opportunistic — A more receptive approach to adaptability; 
taking risk for increased benefits/returns or to achieve 
strategic goals.
As we continue our continuous improvement over risk 
management activities in FY25, we will refresh our approach 
to key risk indicators. 
As part of our risk identification processes, emerging risks 
were identified through external and internal risk processes 
including the regional and functional risk workshops, 
discussions with the Executive and external benchmarking. 
The emerging risks are formally reviewed by the Board and 
Executive as part of their ongoing activities.
During FY24, executive management has reviewed the policies 
and methodologies behind our risk management framework 
to ensure that our procedures suitably allow key risks and 
the specific events that may cause them to be identified.
The Group continues to assess the potential physical impact 
of climate change as well as the regulatory and social 
measures that may be adopted to mitigate it. The Board 
recognises that sustainability is integral to the delivery 
of the business strategy and has taken substantial steps 
to embed sustainability across all our processes and 
business activities. Therefore, the Board has removed 
sustainability as a standalone principal risk and will 
manage sustainability activities as an embedded part of 
its risk management processes, for example considering 
sustainability in its supply chain or Government regulation 
risks. See our assessment of sustainability-related risks 
and opportunities on pages 71 to 84.
Business continuity has been removed as a principal risk. 
Due to the nature of our operations covering a large number 
of sites and our continued operational resilience embedded 
throughout the Group, for example throughout the pandemic, 
we do not feel business continuity is high risk. We will 
continue to monitor operational resilience as part of our 
management of individual key risks.
The existing legacy properties principal risk has been 
expanded to reflect both the ongoing risk with quality of 
build for high-rise and complex structures, as well as 
the effective remediation of issues already identified in 
legacy properties. This has also reduced our construction 
quality and innovation risk on a net basis due to it no 
longer incorporating build quality over high-rise and 
complex projects. 
A new risk has been added to cover the Redrow integration. 
The integration offers significant synergies which we are 
confident in achieving but by recognising the risks associated 
with the integration early, we will ensure that we implement 
appropriate activities to safeguard these synergies over the 
medium to long term. 
In July, the new Government published a revised draft 
of the National Planning Policy Framework (NPPF) which 
guides local councils on the location, type and amount 
of new homes required. The policies within the new NPPF 
reduce Barratt’s level of land and planning risk by reason of, 
(a) increased Government targets for new homes, (b) new 
requirement to release sites currently within Green Belt, and 
(c) enforcement of the presumption in favour of approving 
planning applications in areas without a five-year supply 
of housing. The new policies should lead to a greater supply 
Risk management continued
of consented land. As these actions materialise, they should 
help to support a reduction in our risk exposure in the 
near future. 
On 26 February, the CMA launched an investigation into 
suspected breaches of competition law, relating to the 
exchange of competitively sensitive information, by eight 
housebuilders, including Barratt and Redrow. We continue 
to co-operate with the CMA in its investigation. This is 
considered within our government regulation and political 
risk principal risk. 
The health, safety and environment risk has also been 
decreased on a residual basis due to the Board being 
comfortable with our existing mitigation and the priority 
that it is given across the Group.
As well as quantitative measures, there are also 
qualitative measures considered within the risk methodology. 
Reputational risk could potentially arise from a number of 
sources including external and internal influences relating 
to the housebuilding sector that, when combined or over a 
period of time, could create a new principal risk. The Group 
actively manages the impact of reputational risk by carefully 
assessing the potential impact of all the principal risks and 
implementing mitigation actions to minimise those risks. 
Reputational risk is therefore covered by the management 
of each of our individual risks and is not presented as a 
principal risk in its own right.
Overall assessment
The Board has completed its assessment of the Group’s 
principal and emerging risks, including those that could 
threaten its business model, future performance, solvency 
or liquidity.
The current risk profile is within our tolerance range as the 
Group is willing to accept a moderate level of operational 
risk to deliver financial returns.
There may be instances where these risks could have a 
moderate adverse impact on the Group – either financially 
or operationally. To ensure the Group’s business model 
remains resilient over the medium and long term, the 
Group has modelled these scenarios alongside achievable 
mitigating actions. The results are presented in the Viability 
Statement on pages 85 to 87.
64
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

The Group has identified ten principal risks that it 
considers to be of material impact and likelihood:
A 	 Economic environment 
B 	 Land and planning
C  Government regulation and political risk
D 	 Construction quality and innovation
E 	 High-rise and complex structures
F 	 Supply chain resilience
G 	 Safety, health and environment
H 	 Attracting and retaining high-calibre employees
I 	 Information technology
J 	 Redrow integration 
The principal risks are detailed on pages 66 to 70, 
categorised by the strategic priorities to which they 
relate. Risk levels are presented net of any mitigation 
that is in place and the risk appetite defines the level 
of risk that the Board is comfortable with. 
Heat map of principal risks net of mitigation
Velocity based on estimates 
and past experience
Impact
>£50m
£25m–
£50m
£10m–
£25m
£5m–
£10m
<£5m
Very unlikely
Unlikely
Likely
Highly likely
Very highly 
likely
Probability
B
E
A
J
F
D
G
H
C
I
Rapid 
Risk can materialise immediately 
or impact felt within 1 month 
of occurring.
Moderate 
Risk can materialise quickly, 
or impact felt between 1 and 
12 months of occurring.
Slow 
Risk can materialise slowly, 
or impact felt after 12 months 
of occurring.
Scores are net, after mitigation.
Risk management continued
Principal risks
65
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

A  Economic environment
Risk level: H  
Velocity: Rapid
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Executive Committee
Risk description
Significant changes in the UK macroeconomic environment 
or continuing major geopolitical events and uncertainty 
may lead to falling demand, tightened mortgage availability, 
lack of funding for housing associations, or reduced 
purchaser liquidity, especially in the first-time buyer 
market. This could reduce the affordability of our homes 
for private and rental customers, resulting in reduced 
sales volumes and our ability to provide profitable growth.
Response/mitigation
	• Continual monitoring of the market at Board, Executive Committee, regional and divisional 
levels, leading to amendments in the Group’s forecasts and planning as necessary.
	• Comprehensive sales policies, regular reviews of pricing in local markets and development 
of good relationships with mortgage lenders.
	• Disciplined operating framework with an appropriate capital structure and strong 
Balance Sheet.
Key risk indicators
Internal: Gross and 
operating margins, PBT, 
ROCE, EPS, TSR, total home 
completions.
External: GDP growth, 
CPI inflation, mortgage 
approvals, mortgage 
affordability, new 
housebuilding site starts.
B  Land and planning
Risk level: H  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Land Committee
Risk description
Lack of developable land due to delays in planning 
approval, failure of a clear and consistent Government 
policy or insufficient consented land and strategic land 
options at appropriate cost and quality could affect our 
ability to grow sales volumes and/or meet our margin and 
site ROCE hurdle rates.
Response/mitigation
	• All land acquisitions are subject to formal appraisal and approval by the Land and 
Development Leadership Group.
	• Group, regional and divisional review of land currently owned, committed and identified 
against strategic requirements.
	• Regular meetings with external stakeholders including land agents, promoters and 
land owners.
	• Review by Land and Development Leadership Group and management on strategic 
land and sites.
	• Robust review of land appeals before resubmission.
Key risk indicators
Land approvals (plots), 
UK quantum of consented 
housing units per 
year, UK quantum of 
applications decided within 
statutory periods.
Risk management continued
Risk level: 
H  High risk 
M  Medium risk 
L  Low risk
Change from previous year: 
 Increase 
 Decrease 
 No change
Principal risks continued
66
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

C  Government regulation and political risk
Risk level: H  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Averse
Responsibility: 
Operations Committee
Risk description
The housebuilding industry is subject to increasingly 
complex legislation and regulation, Government 
intervention and policy changes, for example climate 
change, building regulation, legal, NHQC, competition 
law and sustainability regulation. Deviation from current 
regulations or failure to implement the changes effectively 
within our processes could lead to financial penalties, 
damage to the Group’s reputation or increased costs due 
to inefficient processes.
Response/mitigation
	• Robust and rigorous design standards for the homes and places we develop that exceed 
current and expected statutory requirements.
	• Policies and technical guidance for employees on regulatory and legal compliance and 
the standards of business conduct expected.
	• Dedicated compliance team.
	• Consultation with Government agencies and membership of industry groups to help 
monitor, understand and plan for proposed regulation change. 
Key risk indicators
Regulatory violations, 
audit findings, data 
breach incidents.
D  Construction quality and innovation
Risk level: L  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Operations Committee
Risk description
Failure to achieve excellence in housebuilding construction 
and product quality, through insufficient quality assurance 
programmes, or inability to develop, evaluate and implement 
new and innovative construction methods, or to be a 
market leader with changes in technology advancement, 
could increase costs, expose the Group to future remediation 
liabilities, and result in poor product quality and 
reputational damage.
Response/mitigation
	• Continuous review of design and materials, which are evaluated by technical experts 
including the NHBC, to ensure compliance with all regulations.
	• Monitoring and improving the environmental and sustainability impact of construction 
methods and materials.
	• Implementation of modern methods of construction by design and technical teams.
	• Detailed build programmes supported by robust quality assurance. 
Key risk indicators
Customer service, total 
home completions, 
gross margin, operating 
margin, PBT, ROCE, EPS, 
construction waste intensity 
and carbon intensity, NHBC 
Reportable Items and 
Builder Responsible Items.
Risk level: 
H  High risk 
M  Medium risk 
L  Low risk
Change from previous year: 
 Increase 
 Decrease 
 No change
Risk management continued
Principal risks continued
67
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

E  High-rise and complex structures
Risk level: H  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Averse
Responsibility: 
Operations Committee
Risk description
Failure to build high-rise and complex structures in line 
with building regulations or remediate existing legacy 
quality issues effectively could result in remediation 
delays, reputational damage, increased provisions or 
further future remediation liabilities.
Response/mitigation
	• Hired senior technical expertise into the business. 
	• Use of qualified engineers through an approved panel including structural engineer peer 
review process.
	• Third-party liability insurance.
	• Detailed build programmes supported by robust quality assurance. 
	• A dedicated Building Safety Unit (BSU) which undertakes independent reviews and 
investigations of legacy buildings and, where necessary, conducts remediation work.
	• Assumptions on the estimated financial costs for remediation have been tested and 
challenged robustly. 
Key risk indicators
Independent third-party 
assessor results, NHBC 
Reportable Items and 
Builder Responsible 
Items, EPS, customer 
satisfaction surveys.
F  Supply chain resilience
Risk level: M  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Operations Committee
Risk description
Not adequately responding to shortages or increased costs 
of materials and skilled labour including those events 
caused by geopolitical uncertainty, or the failure of a key 
supplier in the current economic environment, may lead 
to increased costs and delays in construction.
Response/mitigation
	• Centralised team procures most materials from UK suppliers, ensuring consistent quality 
and cost. 
	• Development of multiple supplier relationships for labour and material supplies, with 
contingency plans should any key supplier fail. 
	• Clear tendering policies and procedures.
	• Robust due diligence procedures to ensure quality of products and ethical suppliers.
	• Build and material cost controls throughout build programmes to allow supply chain planning. 
	• Monitoring of supplier performance.
Key risk indicators
Customer service, gross 
and operating margin, 
PBT, ROCE, EPS, TSR, 
total home completions.
Risk management continued
Risk level: 
H  High risk 
M  Medium risk 
L  Low risk
Change from previous year: 
 Increase 
 Decrease 
 No change
Principal risks continued
68
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

G  Safety, health and environment
Risk level: L  
Velocity: Moderate
Risk appetite: Averse
Responsibility: 
Safety, Health 
and Environment 
Operations Committee
Risk description
Health and safety or environmental incidents or compliance 
breaches can impact employees, sub‑contractors, 
customers and site visitors, and undermine the creation 
of a great place to work and visit.
Response/mitigation
	• Clear roles and responsibilities for SHE across the Company.
	• SHE management system supports and reinforces documented SHE policies 
and procedures.
	• Employee and sub-contractor relevant and appropriate SHE training.
	• Monthly operational Divisional Board reporting on SHE performance. 
	• Second line team of SHE compliance managers provide support and guidance.
	• Board-level SHE Committee and SHE Operations Committee review and monitor.
Key risk indicators
Health and safety (SHE) 
audit compliance.
H  Attracting and retaining high-calibre employees
Risk level: M  
Velocity: Slow
Risk appetite: Opportunistic
Responsibility: 
Executive Committee
Risk description
Increasing competition for skills may mean we are unable 
to recruit and/or retain the best people. Having sufficient 
skilled employees is critical to delivery of the Group’s 
strategy of volume growth whilst maintaining excellence 
in all of our other strategic priorities.
Response/mitigation
	• Company values relaunched and embedded across all areas of the business.
	• Comprehensive HR programmes covering apprenticeships, graduate development, 
succession planning and training academies.
	• Personal development plans for all employees.
	• Monitoring of employee turnover, absence statistics and independent feedback 
from exit interviews.
	• Annual employee engagement survey to measure employee satisfaction.
	• Remuneration benchmarking.
Key risk indicators
Employee 
engagement score.
Risk level: 
H  High risk 
M  Medium risk 
L  Low risk
Change from previous year: 
 Increase 
 Decrease 
 No change
Risk management continued
Principal risks continued
69
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

I  Information technology
Risk level: M  
Velocity: Rapid
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Executive Risk Committee
Risk description
Failure of any of the Group’s key systems, particularly 
those for financial and customer information, surveying 
and valuation, through a successful cyber attack or 
lack of investment leading to outdated systems, could 
restrict operations and disrupt progress in delivering 
strategic priorities.
Response/mitigation
	• Regular external reviews to reduce the risk of successful cyber attacks, including 
vulnerability and penetration tests by third parties.
	• Adoption of the recognised NIST control framework. 
	• Group-wide compliance and policies on passwords and transferring data to third parties.
	• Mandatory information security training programme for all employees.
	• IT disaster recovery plan.
	• Continued investment in IT infrastructure. 
	• Cyber Security Insurance Policy.
Key risk indicators
Customer service, gross 
and operating margin, PBT, 
ROCE, EPS.
J  *New* Redrow integration
Risk level: M  
Velocity: Slow
Risk appetite: Cautious
Responsibility: 
Executive Committee
Risk description
Without careful management, there is a risk that synergies 
that are initially achieved as part of the merger may not 
be maintained over the medium to long term, leading 
to higher costs than forecast. There is further risk that 
revenue opportunities arising from the multi-branded 
portfolio are not realised.
Response/mitigation
	• Tracking, monitoring and reporting of expected and achieved synergies.
	• Dedicated Integration Management Office.
	• Executive and Board oversight of integration through Integration Steering Committee.
Key risk indicators
EPS and PBT.
Risk management continued
Risk level: 
H  High risk 
M  Medium risk 
L  Low risk
Change from previous year: 
 Increase 
 Decrease 
 No change
Principal risks continued
70
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Task Force on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures (TCFD)
In accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6 R and the 
Climate-related Financial Disclosure Regulations 
(CFD) 2022, this Annual Report and Accounts includes 
climate-related financial disclosures consistent 
with all eleven TCFD recommendations and all eight 
CFD requirements. 
Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance 
in accordance with the International Standard for 
Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and 
Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas 
Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the International 
Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over 
the TCFD disclosures on pages 71 to 84 and selected 
metrics on page 80. 
Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which 
includes details of the selected assured metrics, 
is available on our website.
Find out more
 Read more about our governance on page 72
 Read more about our strategy on pages 74 to 78
 Read more about our risk management on page 73
 Read more about our metrics and targets, including our 
transition plan, on pages 79 to 84
 www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/
our-publications-and-policies/publications
Anson Gardens, Fradley.
Upcoming reporting frameworks
We recognise the importance of major global frameworks 
in guiding our sustainability strategy and reporting.
Aligned with our commitments to sustainability and 
transparency, we have initiated a review of the Taskforce 
on Nature-related Financial Disclosures (TNFD) framework 
alongside our ongoing TCFD compliance efforts. 
FY24 marks the beginning of our journey with TNFD, and 
we are also considering the implications of the International 
Sustainability Standards Board (ISSB) standards. 
Work is underway to derive comprehensive insights 
from our TNFD review, but our overarching objective 
is to transition to a comprehensive sustainability 
risk assessment, addressing all sustainability-related 
risks holistically.
As our understanding and implementation of these 
frameworks evolve, we look forward to sharing more 
detailed findings in our future reporting.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities
Our Sustainability Framework is fundamental to our strategy and is embedded across 
all aspects of our operations. Issues that may affect the sustainability of our business 
model or the environments in which we operate are assessed as part of our risk 
management process and captured within our broader principal risks. 
By engaging and collaborating with our stakeholders, we aim to mitigate sustainability-related risks and capitalise 
on opportunities that create lasting value for nature, places and people. This integrated approach ensures that our 
commitment to sustainability is reflected throughout our risk management framework, driving long-term value and 
resilience across the organisation. 
71
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Governance
The Board is responsible for the oversight of the Group’s 
sustainability strategy, delivery approach and related 
risks. The Chief Executive is the Board member who holds 
accountability for the sustainability strategy.
Sustainability Committee
The Sustainability Committee, chaired by the Chief 
Executive, is the Board sub-committee responsible for 
debating, reviewing and scrutinising our sustainability 
strategy; this includes monitoring its implementation and 
approving plans to mitigate risks and leverage opportunities 
related to climate change and nature. 
The Sustainability Committee also plays a critical role 
in approving and overseeing initiatives that address 
sustainability-related risks and opportunities. It assists the 
wider Board in integrating climate and other sustainability 
issues into our overall business strategy. 
Staying informed
Climate understanding – and the world’s response 
to it – continues to evolve. To ensure our 
business strategy addresses existing and potential 
sustainability risks, the Sustainability Committee 
stays up to date with evolving sustainability 
developments, including those related to climate 
change and nature. 
In FY24, our Sustainability Committee had the 
following updates on climate change and nature: 
	• The Chair of the London Climate Resilience 
Review presented on nature-based solutions and 
climate resilience considerations in developments 
and homes.
	• The Ex-Chair of the Carbon Trust presented 
the key ingredients for a best practice 
transition programme to ensure we deliver 
our science‑based targets.
	• The Group Sustainability team ran through several 
working sessions, including a detailed net zero 
transition plan update, revised science-based 
targets, an annual update on our climate risks and 
opportunities and our energy savings opportunities 
compliance update. 
	• During the climate risk assessment process, 
and on an ongoing basis through the Sustainable 
Operations Group, senior management received 
updates on emerging climate understanding 
to support us in developing our responses to 
climate challenges.
Executive Risk Committee
Evaluates our internal control policies and procedures for identifying, assessing and reporting climate and nature-related risks.
Reviews our overall risk profile, examining climate-related risks in the context of our other principal risks and significance to our 
business strategy.
Actions in FY24 included: 
	• approval of our revised science-based targets, which are 
awaiting validation from the SBTi (page 81);
	• approval of the net zero transition plan (page 81); 
	• oversight of the climate-related risks and opportunities, 
and the implications on future strategy (pages 76 to 78);
	• oversight of improvements to climate data collection and 
monitoring (page 83); 
	• spotlighting on alternatives to reduce reliance on fossil 
fuels across our operation (page 82);
	• approval of the Energy Savings Opportunities Scheme (ESOS) 
recommendations and compliance timeline, proposed action 
plan and governance process; and
	• overview of the approach and intended content of 
Sustainability Disclosures in the Annual Report 2024, 
encompassing the Building Sustainably Framework, 
climate risk and our transition plan.
 For our detailed governance structure see page 100
Remuneration Committee
Designs our Remuneration Policy 
to incentivise performance against 
sustainability-related targets (see page 128).
Monitors performance against targets and 
approves remuneration accordingly.
SHE Committee
Monitors the effect of climate-related 
SHE risks (such as the impact of weather 
patterns on our workforce) and compliance 
with site‑based environmental initiatives 
(such as waste reduction).
Audit and Risk Committee
Monitors the integrity of sustainability-related 
disclosures (such as climate change and 
nature) and data reporting through internal 
and external assurance of the reporting 
of sustainability-related metrics. 
Ensures compliance with external 
sustainability-related reporting 
requirements and frameworks, including 
TCFD and TNFD.
 Read more from page 123
 Read more from page 121
 Read more from page 112
Other sustainability-related responsibilities delegated to Board sub-committees are summarised below:
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
72
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Climate risk assessment criteria
Each risk undergoes assessment using our risk 
assessment process outlined in the risk assessment 
criteria table (see page 65). 
We evaluate the estimated profit impact of a risk or 
opportunity within the relevant financial year and climate 
scenario, with long-term obligations recognised over their 
respective periods. We define a “substantial” financial 
impact as one that exceeds £50m, which aligns with our 
criteria for assessing broader business risks on page 65. 
Our risk assessment spans short, medium and long-term 
timeframes, aligns with our emissions reduction targets 
and captures both transitional and physical risks. The 
short-term focus pertains to our owned land bank, while 
the medium to long-term addresses strategic land options 
and promotion agreements.
Climate-related risk management
The effects of climate change encompass physical risks 
from new weather patterns, and transition risks associated 
with moving towards a low-carbon economy. The uncertain 
outcome of climate change and impact on our Company 
hinges on global temperature limitations and specific 
regulatory responses in regions where we operate, and for 
our supply chain. Opportunities arise as industry leaders 
drive sustainable development.
We assess region-specific climate risks from the bottom 
up, including relevant legislation such as the Future Homes 
Standard. Additionally, we evaluate all climate risks and 
opportunities at Group level, with annual assessments 
to ensure alignment with our risk management process.
Climate changes present both opportunities and risks, 
so we need to adapt what we do, and how we do it, to 
continue delivering the homes our customers need. Whilst 
climate change risk is integrated into our detailed risk 
management process (see page 63), we separately assess 
the impact of climate change as a whole.
Identify
We assess potential climate 
change outcomes based on 
different global response 
scenarios and resulting weather 
pattern changes. See page 74 
for the different scenarios we 
have considered. 
With assistance from external 
experts, we uncover emerging 
risks, potential regulations and 
new developments that require 
further investigation.
Assess
We share identified climate 
outcomes with business and 
local management, which then 
evaluate their potential impact 
on our operations. All risks 
are documented in a climate 
risk register.
Using public climate models and 
internal data, we estimate the 
short, medium and long-term 
financial impacts of each risk and 
opportunity under each scenario.
Review and respond
Internal subject matter experts, local 
and Group senior management, and 
external climate specialists discuss 
identified risks and opportunities. 
We prioritise risks and opportunities 
with the highest potential impact 
and report these to the Executive 
Risk Committee, which manages our 
response (see pages 63 to 64).
Climate risks and opportunities assessment process
	• Short-term scope 1 and 2 
science-based targets (SBT).
	• Implementation of the 
Future Homes Standard.
	• Medium-term scope 3 
science‑based targets (SBT).
	• Zero carbon homes in use for 
regulated energy.
	• Our target is to achieve net 
zero emissions across our value 
chain by 2040.
	• Paris Agreement and UK target 
for net zero by 2050.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
2025
2030
2050 
2024
Short term
Medium term
Long term
We have four science-based targets which are awaiting validation by the 
Science Based Targets initiative – see page 81 for detail.
73
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Climate scenario analysis
Climate change could have a profound 
impact on our operations, as well as 
on our external stakeholders such as 
suppliers and customers. We have tested 
our business resilience against various 
climate scenarios:
1.5°C sustainable transition
Orderly transition to a low-carbon economy, aligning 
with regulatory efforts to limit the global temperature 
rise to the Paris Agreement goal of 1.5°C by 2100.
Modelling methodology
In FY23, we presented the results of our detailed climate 
scenario analysis. We evaluated a sample of sites from 
our land bank to identify vulnerabilities and risks inherent 
in our business model, including our capacity to transfer 
industry-wide development costs to land vendors. 
In FY24, we refined our financial assessment of carbon 
pricing to reflect decarbonisation pathways planned by 
our supply chain, summarised on page 81. The unmitigated 
financial impacts under our “sustainable transition” 
(transition risks and opportunities) and “adaptation” 
(physical risks) scenarios are summarised in the risk 
table on pages 76 to 78. 
 Please see our full Climate-related Risks and Opportunities 
Analysis on our website further information on these 
scenarios and the impact on our business model: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/
our-publications-and-policies/publications
 For more detail on our methodology and findings, see 
our full Climate-related Risks and Opportunities Analysis: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/
our-publications-and-policies/publications
4.0°C adaptation
Global policy shifts away from prevention towards 
adapting to a new climate, leading to a global 
temperature rise of 4°C by 2100.
2.0°C disorderly transition
Minimal additional regulation until 2030, after which 
stringent policies are hastily implemented to limit 
warming to 2°C by 2100.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Focus areas for FY24
In line with requirements, we will update our detailed 
climate-related scenario modelling every three years. As 
we expand our sustainability risk assessments to cover 
emerging and priority areas, these will be updated in the 
intervening years. For FY24, we focused on the potential 
impact of standing water on our developments.
Standing water flooding
During FY24, we engaged external consultants to assess 
surface water flooding risk across our developments 
and supplement our previous analyses of coastal and 
fluvial flooding. 
We examined current surface water flood risk across 
a sample of our developments and reviewed climate 
scenario-specific precipitation projections to consider 
how surface water flooding risk could develop.
Focus for FY25
While we already consider the impact of climate change 
on our timber supply chain, we will research the impact of 
physical risks across our broader supply chain beyond our 
tier 1 suppliers, so we can better understand the potential 
indirect impacts of climate change on our business.
Water and flood security is a key consideration in our site designs
74
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Strategic impact
Our analysis affirms that our business model remains 
profitable under the current climate scenarios and timeframes, 
even without additional mitigating actions and despite 
associated costs. We will continue to monitor this in 
ongoing assessments.
A sustainable transition, despite its costs, offers 
opportunities. A disorderly transition, though disruptive, 
would still see us maintain profitability. The adaptation 
scenario has the least financial impact, which is manageable 
thanks to proactive measures we’ve already implemented, 
such as design changes and flood risk assessments.
To thrive in all three climate scenarios, we have highlighted 
key areas to progress:
	• reducing embodied carbon in our supply chain (see pages 
81 to 84 for our transition pathway and how we are working 
with our supply chain partners to achieve net zero);
	• updating designs to meet stringent regulations 
(see page 37 for findings from our research on our 
concept eHome2); and
	• leveraging our sustainability expertise to provide 
energy‑efficient, affordable homes and promote 
green mortgages. 
 For more on our metrics and targets to minimise our exposure to 
climate-related risks and maximise the opportunities this offers, 
see page 79
Impact on the Financial Statements
Climate change impacts are not solely future oriented: they already shape the financial information we report today 
and influence our financial planning and forecasts. 
We integrate material climate-related impacts into our three-year forecasting cycle, with site-specific climate 
considerations that influence our site profitability assessments. In our FY24 Financial Statements, we considered 
the financial impact of climate change on the following areas:
Going concern 
and long-term 
viability
We assessed whether there are any material uncertainties regarding our ability to continue 
operating as a going concern (see note 1 to the Financial Statements on page 165). Additionally, 
we assessed our long-term prospects for disclosure in our Viability Statement (see page 85). 
To ensure comprehensive assessment, we stress tested our financial forecasts, considering the 
impact of principal risks at severe but plausible levels over three years to 30 June 2027. We 
included climate‑related transition risks aligned with the sustainable transition scenario and 
incorporated the impacts of the Future Homes Standard and carbon pricing. 
Despite the presence of climate risk alongside other principal risks, our evaluation confirms 
our capability to meet our obligations and sustain operations throughout the review period.
Land 
acquisitions
We have integrated fluvial and coastal flood risk assessments into our evaluation of potential land 
acquisitions and strategic site options. If any of our sites need additional flood mitigation measures, 
we consider these in our viability assessments, tender offers and forecast margins. Our assessment 
of flood risk under various climate scenarios indicates there are no sites in our existing portfolio 
where the expense of enhanced flood defences would lead to an impairment. At year end, we 
evaluate the carrying value of land and work in progress (see note 15 to the Financial Statements 
on page 182). 
Site profitability
In our estimated costs to complete developments, we have included complying with Parts F and 
L of the Building Regulations (applicable from 15 June 2022), and design adjustments to address 
overheating concerns in homes. This aligns with our accounting policy in note 3 to the Financial 
Statements on page 167. 
These costs are reflected in the carrying values of inventories and the margins recognised for 
developments in which we anticipate impacts to future completions.
Goodwill and 
intangible assets
Annually, we reassess the carrying value of goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful 
lives listed on the balance sheet. We calculate the present value of projected future cash flows 
(outlined in note 10 to the Financial Statements on page 174). 
Cash flow projections for years three to five incorporate the anticipated impact of announced 
policies, as modelled in our climate scenario analysis for FY25. We have extended these projections to 
perpetuity, reflecting the short to medium-term implications of climate change in our valuation process.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
75
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Transition risks
Key assumptions in impact calculations
Gross risk score 
(sustainable 
transition)
Estimated 
maximum 
unmitigated 
financial impact 
Our response
2025
2030 2050
Housing regulations
Changes to house specifications 
due to Government legislation to 
reduce home carbon emissions, 
for example the Future Homes 
Standard, including varying 
standards across the UK
	• Average cost uplifts to meet the Future Homes Standard 
and zero carbon homes (based on our internal calculations, 
including current cost of technologies such as air source 
heat pumps (ASHP) and mechanical ventilation systems).
	• Costs of ASHP fall by 20% by 2030 and 40% by 2040, 
due to economies of scale and increased competition.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £155m 
per annum 
We support the Government’s climate ambitions, engaging with MPs 
and industry partners in policy development. 
We are committed to zero carbon homes, using innovative technologies 
tested through projects like eHome2. 
Our CEO chairs the Future Homes Hub and is a member of the 
DESNZ‑led Net Zero Council. 
Carbon pricing
Increasing materials and 
sub‑contractor costs due to 
Government legislation to reduce 
emissions, and subsequent increased 
demand for low-carbon materials, for 
example carbon taxation on suppliers 
	• Carbon prices rise to $250/tCO2 by 2050, in line with the 
IEA Net Zero Emissions scenario.
	• Average supply chain emission reductions of 90% by 2050.
	• 100% of diesel usage by groundworkers substituted with 
low-carbon alternatives by 2040.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £70m 
per annum
We manage carbon price exposure by focusing on upstream supply 
chain emissions and refining scope 3 emissions understanding. 
In FY24, we collected emissions data from 20 key suppliers, guiding 
them on carbon reduction. 
We aim to standardise reporting for a more accurate scope 3 footprint 
and integrate supplier performance. 
New technologies
Implementation of new 
technologies in homes and 
construction, requiring high capital 
investment and upskilling of labour
	• Additional costs associated with technologies, such as 
underfloor heating and infrared heating panels, which are 
demanded by more sustainability-informed customers. 
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £25m 
per annum
In FY24, we completed sales on our first gas-free development at 
Delamare Park, Somerset, with all 82 homes featuring ASHPs. 
We research low-carbon products through market studies, university 
partnerships, prototype houses, and grant-supported trials, with 
projects like eHome2 enhancing energy efficiency. 
Planning requirements
Increasing planning or site 
infrastructure requirements from 
Government and local authorities 
result in reduced viability of land 
in certain regions
	• The percentage of total Barratt developments subject to 
increased sustainability requirements increases from 0% 
in 2020 to up to 30% by 2050.
	• Estimated cost per site to meet increased sustainability 
requirements based on design and installation of a 
previous Community Heat Hub and mains.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £60m 
per annum
We strategically address planning requirements through collaboration 
with landowners and expert research.
Our Land and Development Leadership Group evaluates land 
acquisitions for compliance and sustainability, integrating green spaces 
and renewable energy opportunities. 
A sustainability toolkit supports our Land and Planning teams with 
detailed information on standards, zero carbon homes, biodiversity, 
and socio-economic outcomes. 
Water scarcity
Increased water scarcity in areas 
of proposed developments, leading 
to additional planning requirements 
to ensure a consistent water supply 
for new homes
	• Local authorities take a greater focus on water neutrality, 
affecting the ability to gain planning permission.
	• Installation of rainwater harvesting systems on 
new developments.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £5m
per annum
We design homes to use 105 litres per person per day, 16% lower than 
regulatory requirements, reducing water withdrawals. 
Our Group Head of Infrastructure and Utilities chairs the HBF 
Water Matters Group, collaborating to solve water issues affecting 
housing schemes. 
Climate-related risks and opportunities
The maximum unmitigated financial impacts per annum of the material climate-related risks and opportunities and how we 
are responding to them are presented in the tables below. For transition risks and opportunities, the financial impacts relate 
to our Paris Agreement-aligned sustainable transition scenario. Physical risk impacts are based on our adaptation scenario. 
The estimated financial impacts do not factor in the acquisition of Redrow plc.
 Gross risk score


Low
High
 Please see our full Climate-related Risks 
and Opportunities Analysis for the risk and 
opportunities assessment under each scenario: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/
our-publications-and-policies/publications
76
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

 Gross risk score

Low
High
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Climate-related risks and opportunities continued
Physical risks
Key assumptions in impact calculations
Gross risk score 
(adaptation)
Estimated 
maximum 
unmitigated 
financial impact 
Our response
2025
2030 2050
Overheating in homes
Changes to house specifications 
required to mitigate long‑term 
shift in climate patterns, 
such as prolonged increased 
temperatures in summer
	• London and East regions particularly susceptible to 
overheating in the medium to long term.
	• Additional mitigation measures, such as extractor fans or 
air conditioning units, may be required in worst-affected 
areas to address safety concerns about overheating.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £10m
per annum
We hold forums with consultants, industry experts, academics, and key 
suppliers to develop innovative overheating solutions for volume housing. 
We also conduct research on overheating and indoor air quality with 
Birmingham City University and other housebuilders, and sponsor two 
PhD students to study overheating mitigation to inform future designs. 
Flood mitigation
New site infrastructure required to 
mitigate extreme weather events, 
for example flood barriers and 
balancing ponds
	• Based on localised climate projections, estimated 
additional sites in our existing land bank that might 
require additional flood defence infrastructure.
	• Identified two sites and estimated cost based on flood 
defence infrastructure spend at a similar site.
	• Assessment covered fluvial and coastal flooding, but 
excluded impacts from standing water flooding, due 
to a lack of available data.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £5m
per annum
We proactively mitigate flood risk through horizon scanning, stakeholder 
engagement and expert research. 
Our Land and Development Leadership Group reviews all land purchases 
for flood risk, and our developments typically exceed the requirement to 
withstand a 1 in 100-year storm plus 30%. 
We are conducting a value chain water risk assessment so we can 
improve our understanding of water risk hotspots, including flooding, 
across our materials suppliers and across our developments, with findings 
informing our future water strategy. 
Weather disruption
Disruption to build activity due 
to increased frequency of severe 
weather (heat, cold or precipitation) 
or damage to construction sites 
from extreme weather events
	• Based on localised climate projections, estimated 
potential disruption to construction activity due to 
severe weather.
	• Consecutive days lost could lead to disruption, increased 
overhead costs and delays to sales.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
and decreased 
revenue 
by up to £5m
per annum
Our robust construction processes and crisis management protocols 
help mitigate delays caused by extreme weather. 
We design schemes with flood protection and sustainable urban drainage 
systems. Divisional SHE Managers ensure health and safety in adverse 
weather, with energy-efficient site cabins and adjustable build schedules. 
Timber frame construction methods minimise on-site build time, 
enhancing resilience to weather-related delays.
Supply availability
Reduced supply availability (such 
as timber) due to long-term shift 
in climate patterns and extreme 
weather events (such as wildfires 
or flooding) where we source supply
	• Supply availability assessment based on timber suppliers 
primarily in Sweden, Finland and Germany. 
	• Using localised climate projections, considered supply 
chain shocks as a result of increased likelihood of 
forest wildfire. 
	• Analysed short-term price impacts of sourcing elsewhere 
due to disrupted supply, and sustained price rises in the 
medium to long term.
Increased build 
cost of sales 
by up to £5m
per annum
Our Timber Sourcing Policy ensures all timber products that we purchase 
are FSC/PEFC certified, with annual surveys confirming compliance. 
Group agreements enforce adherence to our Sustainable Procurement 
and Timber Sourcing Policies. We engage suppliers via our Timber 
Sourcing Policy and the Supply Chain Sustainability School, providing 
resources on sustainable timber sourcing. 
Our supplier maturity matrix assesses performance and identifies 
collaboration opportunities, with many suppliers meeting targets 
by July 2024. 
77
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

 Gross opportunity score

Low
High
Opportunities
Key assumptions in impact calculations
Gross risk score 
(sustainable 
transition)
Estimated
maximum
unmitigated
financial impact
Our response
2025
2030 2050
Demand for and affordability 
of green homes
Eligibility for green mortgages and 
cost savings from energy efficiency 
allow for a premium charge 
on new homes
	• House buyers will be able to borrow more and buy a larger 
home on a green mortgage, due to increased affordability 
of energy-efficient homes.
	• Based on existing green mortgage offers, an average 
private buyer could borrow between 5% and 10% more on 
a new build Barratt home, compared to an older property 
(built before 2020).
Increased 
revenue by 
up to £320m
per annum
Our customer research shows rising interest in sustainable, 
energy‑efficient homes, with more lenders offering green mortgages. 
We’ve collaborated with lenders to launch green mortgage 
products, potentially increasing lending by up to 10% for our energy-
efficient homes. 
Through the Future Homes Hub, we educate valuers on assessing 
sustainable features, enhancing home affordability and accessibility in 
line with consumer demand for eco-friendly living. 
Green developments
Increased land buying and local 
partnership opportunities through 
strong low-carbon credentials and 
offer of low-carbon developments, 
for instance partnering with councils 
to deliver low-carbon homes
	• Based on the UK Government’s Ten Point Plan for a Green 
Industrial Revolution (November 2020)1, up to 25% of land 
will need to be available for low-carbon and climate-
resilient homes by 2050.
	• Access to some land may be restricted to developers 
offering low-carbon credentials like our own, resulting 
in lower competition and discounted rates on these 
developments.
Decreased land 
cost of sales 
by up to £65m
per annum
Our divisional land teams ensure compliance with planning regulations 
and achieve local consents through technical and planning expertise. 
We use tools like the Land Bidding Toolkit to highlight our sustainability 
credentials in land bids. 
As a leading sustainable housebuilder, we build strong relationships 
with landowners, showcasing our innovation and performance through 
benchmarks such as NextGeneration, and dedicated publications such 
as land planning brochures. 
Cost of capital
Our sustainability performance 
opens green financing 
opportunities, providing access 
to lower interest rates
	• The potential to reduce finance costs if we switch 
borrowings to a green finance equivalent.
Decreased 
finance 
costs by 
less than £1m
per annum
Within our Building Sustainably Framework, we commit to exploring 
new green finance products.
In FY23, we linked our Revolving Credit Facility (RCF) to sustainability 
performance via a sustainability-linked loan mechanism (see page 79).
Sustainable practices
Adopting low-emissions materials 
and processes, ahead of regulation, 
provides a cost advantage and 
improves reputation
	• Using low-carbon materials in the build process may 
provide cost savings through avoided carbon taxations 
within the supply chain.
	• Average embodied carbon savings multiplied by the 
projected carbon prices (as per IEA’s dataset) to 
determine cost savings associated with switching 
to a lower-carbon material.
Decreased 
build cost 
of sales 
by up to £5m
per annum
Our strategy emphasises investing in innovative products, techniques, 
and customer insights, aiming for zero carbon homes by 2030. 
We conduct market research, product testing, and collaborate with 
universities, using prototype test houses like eHome2. 
Our Group Design and Technical teams drive incremental carbon 
reductions with milestones and transitional plans for existing sites. 
1	
Our Sustainable Procurement and Timber Sourcing Policies are available at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/our-publications-and-policies/policies.
2	 www.gov.uk/government/publications/the-ten-point-plan-for-a-green-industrial-revolution.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Climate-related risks and opportunities continued
78
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Climate-related metrics and targets
Our primary focus areas are reducing emissions from our homes, 
enhancing energy efficiency and bolstering resilience to climate 
change for our customers. Our Sustainable Operations Group 
monitors key performance metrics in our focus areas.
Metric and target status
Risk/opportunity
Description
Performance against target1
Progress narrative
Scope 1 and 2 (market-
based) emissions (tCO2e) 
Carbon
pricing
Scope 1 and 2 emissions are 1% of our total 
value chain, but we aim for net zero in direct 
operations by 2040. 
 Read more about our scope 1 and 2 science-based 
targets on page 81.
Scope 1 and 2 emissions fell 34% this 
year, 50% below our 2018 baseline, due 
to lower output drop, reduced fuel use, 
and 40% diesel substitution with HVO. 
 See pages 82 to 84 for our 
decarbonisation levers
Scope 3 greenhouse gas 
intensity (tCO2e/100m2)
Carbon 
pricing
We monitor carbon pricing exposure via indirect 
emissions, using them as indicators of potential 
future regulatory cost increases.
 Read more about our scope 3 science-based targets 
on page 81.
Scope 3 emissions intensity dropped 
10% this year, mainly from reduced 
overheads and grid decarbonisation. 
In FY25, we’ll adopt a quantity-based 
method to better capture supplier and 
material impacts. 
 See page 81 for our transition plan
Average dwelling emissions 
rate (DER) for completed 
properties (kgCO2/m2/yr)
 
Housing 
regulations; 
demand for and 
affordability of 
green homes
The Future Homes Standard is expected to 
mandate a 75%-80% reduction in Dwelling 
Emissions Rate (DER) compared to 2013 
building standards for new builds.
Average DER improved by 1.5%, though 
less than anticipated due to slower 
2021 regulation transition and product 
mix changes. Home emissions will 
decrease as more energy-efficient 
house types advance through planning, 
construction and sales.
Home completions in year 
achieving an A or B EPC 
rating (%)
Demand for and 
affordability of 
green homes
New Barratt homes can unlock annual energy 
savings of up to £2,200 compared to older 
homes. Maintaining top energy ratings ensures 
we capitalise on opportunities for energy-
efficient new homes.
Over 99% of our homes maintained 
an A or B rating, providing significant 
energy savings for customers. 
 See page 29 for our work with lenders on 
mortgage products reflecting our energy-
efficient homes
Use of offsite-based 
products and systems in 
homes constructed (%)
New technologies; 
weather 
disruption; 
sustainable 
practices
Offsite production reduces build time and 
increases resilience to severe weather. In FY22, 
we accelerated our 2025 target to apply offsite-
based products and systems to 30% of homes.
We delivered 4,668 plots using MMC, 
which represented 33% of gross 
completions, surpassing our FY25 target 
of 30%.
 See page 39 for details on accelerating timber 
frame home delivery with our new Oregon 
facility at Infinity Park, Derby
1	
Performance data for the last five years is included in the five-year record on pages 212 and 213.
On track
Target not met
Metric linked to the 
Revolving Credit Facility
Metric linked to the 
Long Term Performance Plan
Below target
Monitor
Achieved
RCF
LTPP
RCF
Target
Baseline
FY30
FY23
14,794
24,909
16,458
32,657
FY24
FY18
Target
Baseline
FY34
FY23
70.10
242.13
218.68
222.83
FY24
FY18
Target
Baseline
FY25
FY23
12.91
16.02
15.78
15.89
FY24
FY22
Target Ongoing
Baseline
FY23
99.0%
99.2%
99.8%
96.8%
FY24
FY18
RCF
LTPP
Target
Baseline
FY25
FY23
30%
32%
33%
19%
FY24
FY18
Our primary exposures to climate change stem from transition 
risks, building regulations and carbon pricing. Physical risks pose 
minimal threats, as our land appraisal process already integrates 
considerations for hazards such as flooding. 
Instead of applying a generalised percentage to overall business 
activities facing physical risks, we monitor our risk exposure through 
risk-specific metrics, as detailed in the table below.
 Industry-specific metrics are in our SASB disclosure on 
our website
 Cross-industry metrics are in our five-year record on 
pages 212 and 213
 For our climate risk exposures, see our climate risk register 
on pages 76 to 78
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
79
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Climate-related metrics and targets continued
Greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions
Our greenhouse gas emissions are presented below. 
For a breakdown of our value chain emissions and our plans to decarbonise in line with our 2040 net zero ambition, see page 81. 
More detail on FY24 performance and progress against targets is on page 79.
Greenhouse gas emissions
 
 
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
Baseline
2018
 
 
Scope 1
tCO2e
 15,523* 
 23,580 
 23,234 
 26,769 
 20,323 
 27,577 
Scope 2
Market based
tCO2e
 935* 
 1,329 
 1,840 
 2,496 
 1,640 
 5,080 
Location based
tCO2e
 6,332* 
 5,515 
 4,802 
 5,973 
 4,260 
 6,716 
Total gross scope 1 and 2 emissions
Market based
tCO2e
 16,458 
 24,909 
 25,074 
 29,265 
 21,963 
 32,657 
Location based
tCO2e
 21,855 
 29,095 
 28,036 
 32,742 
 24,583 
 34,293 
Scope 1 and 2 energy consumption
 
MWh
 117,687*
 139,718 
 128,189 
 141,945 
 102,966 
 127,496 
Carbon intensity (scope 1 and 2 emissions per 100m2 of legally 
completed build area)
Market based
tCO2e/100m2
 1.26* 
 1.60 
 1.53 
 1.78 
 1.80 
 1.90 
Location based
tCO2e/100m2
 1.67* 
 1.86 
 1.71 
 1.99 
 2.02 
 1.99 
Scope 3 category 1: purchased goods and services
 
tCO2e
 1,701,176 
 2,332,213 
 2,395,642 
 1,923,397 
 2,019,509 
 2,421,559 
Scope 3 category 11: use of sold products
 
tCO2e
 992,879* 
 1,217,738 
 1,244,317 
 1,352,982 
 930,797 
 1,273,346 
Other scope 3 emissions
tCO2e
170,126
 229,378 
 241,921 
 144,890 
 178,479 
 160,785 
Total gross scope 3 emissions
 
tCO2e
2,864,181
 3,779,329 
 3,881,879 
 3,421,269 
 3,128,785 
 3,855,690 
Scope 3 carbon intensity (scope 3 emissions per 100m2 of legally 
completed build area)
 
tCO2e/100m2
 218.68 
 242.13 
 236.67 
 208.12 
 256.52 
 222.83 
Total gross scope 1, 2 and 3 emissions
Market based
tCO2e
2,880,639
 3,804,238 
 3,906,953 
 3,450,534 
 3,150,748 
 3,888,347 
Location based
tCO2e
2,886,036
 3,808,424 
 3,909,915 
 3,454,011 
 3,153,368 
 3,889,983 
Outside of scopes emissions
tCO2e
4,779
3,698
1,499
909
718
128
Scope 1, 2 and 3 GHG emissions have been measured in accordance with the operational control 
method of the GHG Protocol. All scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions arise in the UK. Emission factors 
come from BEIS ‘UK Government Conversion Factors for Company Reporting 2023’.
Scope 1 and scope 2 energy consumption comprises scope 1 energy consumption of 87,070 
MWh* and scope 2 energy consumption of 30,617 MWh*.
Other scope 3 emissions is comprised of category 2: capital goods; category 3: fuel and energy 
related activities (4,533 tCO2e)*; category 4: upstream transportation and distribution; category 
6: business travel (5,170 tCO2e)*; category 7: employee commuting; and category 12: end of life 
treatment of sold products.	
Deloitte LLP (‘Deloitte’) have provided independent third-party limited assurance in accordance 
with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and Assurance 
Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the International Auditing 
and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over selected metrics in the table and footnotes above 
identified with an *. For Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details 
of the selected metrics assured, our full Carbon Reporting Methodology Statement, our ESG 
Basis of Reporting and a full breakdown of scope 3 GHG emissions, see our website at www.
barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/our-publications-and-policies/publications.
 Read more on our sustainability performance on our 
website: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
building-sustainably/performance-data/data
 See our website for our data reporting policies and 
insurance statements: www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/
building-sustainably/our-publications-and-policies/
publications
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
80
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

The Group is committed to 
achieving net zero emissions 
across our entire value chain 
by 2040 and we recognise that 
while we have control of how we 
reduce emissions from our direct 
operations, scope 1 and 2, we 
know we will have to continue 
to influence areas outside our 
direct control to reduce our 
emissions in scope 3. We have 
been further developing our 
transition plan and model to 
allow us to understand where 
we can drive reductions and 
the total impact that will have 
on our value chain emissions.
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
 Scope 1 and 2 
 Grid decarbonisation 
 Building standards 
 Diesel substitution
 Building techniques 
 Main contractors 
 Bricks and blocks
 Timber 
 Concrete and cement 
 Lime and gypsum (plasterboard) 
 Additional materials 
 Material choices
2024 
100%
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
2040 
99% scope 3
2025
2030 
2035
% of value chain emissions (scopes 1,2 and 3)
Absolute reduction
29.0% 
reduction by 2025 
54.7% 
reduction by 2030 (4.6% p.a.)
Net zero by
2040 
(4.5% p.a.)
We have four science-based 
targets, which are awaiting 
validation by the Science Based 
Targets initiative. 
Near term
Intensity reduction
68.7% 
reduction by 2034 (4.3% p.a.)
Near term
Long term
Net zero by
2040 
(4.5% p.a.)
Long term
Scope 1 and 2
Scope 3
Our greenhouse gas emission reduction targets
In FY24, our total carbon footprint across all scopes was estimated to be over 2.8m tCO2e. Of this, less than 1% was 
from our direct operational activities. The remainder (99%) came from the transformation of raw materials into products, 
transport to sites, site preparation and groundworks, and the impact of the homes that we build over their lifetime.
Transition plan 
81
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

How could the Group achieve net zero by 2040?
Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Our decarbonisation levers
We have identified six principal “decarbonisation levers” 
that we consider have the most material impact on 
achieving our transition towards net zero operations and 
Levers
1 	Reduce embodied
	
carbon
Future Homes Standard*
Move to quantity-based reporting to enable more direct carbon emissions 
data on products.
Diesel substituted by 
HVO circa 40%
Minimise diesel generator hire
60% reduction in diesel.
Continued investigations and trials e.g. carbon removal
No diesel cars offered 
since June 2022
No petrol cars offered 
since June 2024
Hydrogen investigations 
(where technology feasible)
100% zero carbon homes*
80% reduction
2 	Reduce emissions
	
from completed homes
3 	Diesel reduction/
	
replacement
4 	Renewable tariffs
	
and plot heating
5 	Low-emissions
	
business travel
6 	Low-emissions
	
business premises
	
and facilities
2040 
2025
2030
2035
Ambition and action – underway and under investigation
100% of company car fleet to be electric or hybrid
100% renewable electricity
supply chain. Within each of these levers we have identified 
a number of actions we can take – some of these are 
currently underway, while others require further work with 
value chain partners to understand when and how they 
can be deployed. See page 84 for how we are seeking to 
overcome challenges and barriers to achieve this.
The figure below sets out the broad areas we are prioritising 
to deliver our carbon reduction ambitions.
Our plans to reduce emissions from completed homes rely heavily on the Future Homes 
Standard. This is currently delayed, and we await the introduction of this, after which we will 
review our detailed plans.
 More on the challenges we face to deliver the transition plan on 
page 84
Hybrid generators
Zero carbon pilots*
40% reduction
100% of company vans 
diesel/petrol free
No diesel on sites
100% carbon-free grid – 
Government commitment
Electric plant 
(where technology feasible)
Continued energy reduction programme
*	 Subject to Future Homes Standard being introduced.
82
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
1
Reducing embodied carbon of materials 
For scope 3, reducing the embodied carbon of construction 
materials is our priority, which we influence by specifying 
low-carbon materials in design and construction of homes.
Approximately 50% of the emissions relating to materials 
arises from our interaction with 20 of our suppliers. 
This year, we directly engaged with these suppliers to 
examine their emission reduction plans and how they 
would be achieved. We sought to understand how they 
tracked reductions in embodied carbon, and the extent 
to which materials are backed by Environmental Product 
Declarations (EPDs). Emissions data from EPDs is critical 
in selecting suppliers and lower embodied carbon materials 
over time.
To track the impact of supplier and material selection on 
our transition pathway over the next three years, we aim 
to start the move from a spend-based Environmentally 
Extended Input Output (EEIO) approach to using quantity‑based 
data. This will inform the actions needed over time and 
investments required to lower embodied carbon products. 
2
Reduce emissions in-use 
from completed homes
The Group is committed to zero carbon ready homes 
by 2030 (regulated energy). The Future Homes Standard 
will phase out gas boilers, reducing the lifetime in-use 
emissions of our sold homes. Our plans rely heavily on 
the delayed standard. Once introduced, we will review our 
detailed plans. Should the grid become zero carbon by 
2030, then this further reduces potential emissions in use. 
3  4
Reduce emissions from construction sites 
For scopes 1 and 2, our priority is reducing diesel 
consumption from telehandlers and generators. 
In the short term, diesel is being substituted for alternative 
fuels such as hydrotreated vegetable oil (HVO). In order 
to enable us to trial hydrogen plant and understand how 
quickly this can be adopted, we will monitor the regulations 
governing hydrogen plant use on public highways. We are 
also exploring opportunities to pilot innovative electric plant. 
Another priority is reducing plot heating from natural 
gas. Regulatory requirements, such as the Future Homes 
Standard, will move plot heating to electricity (using air 
source heat pumps).
From FY24, our new Plant and Machinery Dashboard 
supplements our Carbon Emissions Dashboard, providing 
deeper insights into fuel consumption and efficiency 
opportunities in line with relevant remuneration targets.
Our ESG Data and Controls Working Group has devised a 
roadmap to automate ESG data collection, fortify internal 
controls and facilitate prompt decision making across our 
sites and offices.
In FY25, we will explore automated data capture for 
scopes 1 and 2 emissions from our operations, and scope 
3 emissions from our supply chain, to strengthen timely 
decision-making processes.
5  6
Low-emissions business travel 
Emissions from business travel, premises and facilities 
make a smaller contribution. We are managing this through 
the electrification of our company vehicle fleet, and 
switching supplies for premises to renewable energy. 
78% of our company car fleet were either electric or 
hybrids as of 30 June 2024. As the availability of electric 
vans increases we will roll these out across our fleet and 
we are trialling smaller, electric customer service vans to 
determine the pace of wider adoption. Larger commercial 
vans are not currently widely available.
6
Reduce emissions from business premises 
and facilities
In FY24, 87% of electricity consumed within our business 
premises and facilities was renewable-backed. The remaining 
13% supplies offices that are third-party owned or leased, and 
when leases renew or expire, embedding energy efficiency 
into new leases will be promoted. 
Electric vehicle charging point at Kingsbrook
Our decarbonisation levers continued
83
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Sustainability-related risks and opportunities continued
Overcoming challenges and barriers
In order to successfully deliver our transition to net zero, there are critical challenges and barriers to overcome. There are multiple 
interdependencies, which rely on us actively engaging with other businesses, government and wider society, to drive the transition 
collaboratively. Our ambition rests on the challenges outlined below being overcome at a national level.
Effective regulation
A lack of effective regulation, its practical application and clarity 
over transition timelines has created uncertainty and delayed 
implementation of stronger building standards.
The Future Homes Standard implementation and associated 
calculation tools are key to the delivery of our plans but at the 
time of writing this has been delayed.
Clear targets with time to deliver
Without a defined and clear roadmap to zero carbon homes 
the industry is unable to build confidence and unlock 
investment at scale.
Government should set the direction, with a cross‑sector, long-term 
plan to net zero that sets clear targets and a consistent approach 
to measurement and reporting.
Confident consumers
Consumers are increasingly demanding energy efficient homes. 
However, public awareness of options, costs and benefits remains 
low within both retrofit and new build homes. Consumer awareness 
and acceptance will stimulate investment and demand for all 
energy efficient homes. 
Simple solutions need to be endorsed, and backed, by clear, 
independent advice via trusted consumer sources. Accredited 
products, training and installation standards are needed. 
Government should support this, for example, by raising public 
awareness at scale.
Impactful green finance
Who pays for the transition is critical. It requires a collection of 
measures that appropriately address different tenures of homes. 
For home purchasers, green finance will drive and unlock consumer 
demand with energy efficiency built into affordability statements at 
the point of consideration.
Net zero ready skills and supply chains
The construction sector already has a skills shortage, and this will 
be exacerbated by the drive to net zero.
As part of a long-term, interconnected roadmap to net zero, we 
need a detailed plan of the skills gap and create the necessary 
pathways and mechanisms to allow time for training, alongside the 
development of the materials and equipment that reduce embodied 
carbon and energy use.
Clear standards, consistently measured
There are a number of standards that are currently inconsistent, 
without a shared baseline, or common approach, which prevent 
the sector from driving better outcomes. For example, Energy 
Performance Certificates are recognisable and easy to understand, 
however, they need to be reformed with the customer in mind. 
A greater emphasis on carbon emissions would avoid a heat 
pump negatively impacting a home’s rating. Similarly, consistency 
in methodology of specific environmental data for products 
would encourage confidence in the move to materials with lower 
embodied carbon.
A decarbonised grid
Any delay to UK grid decarbonisation plans will impact the Group’s 
transition to Net Zero. Our key materials sectors and our own 
transition plan are dependent upon the UK decarbonising the grid 
by 2030 as per the Government’s stated ambition.
Technology and policy dependence
For our own direct emissions, we are reliant upon advancements 
in low-carbon plant and equipment that have the lifting capacity 
of the current fossil-fuel equipment. For example, we need 
advancements in electric and hydrogen site plant, supported by 
the establishment of appropriate policy and infrastructure and 
safety requirements so that these can be trialled, tested and 
deployed at scale.
Challenges in the value chain
Approximately 35% of our footprint is dependent upon activities 
driven by our value chain partners. 
Alignment of sectoral commitments
Misalignment of sectoral commitments for our key materials at 
a national level will undermine delivery of our transition plan. 
We have examined sectoral commitments for materials we 
recognise as key to driving our emissions reduction plans. Not all 
of these sectors are aligned, however, they set out the ways in 
which emissions reductions are expected to be delivered and this 
provides a useful starting point for more direct engagement with 
our partners.
Reliance on technology 
Many key material sectors, particularly those in high-energy 
manufacturing, are reliant on the deployment of unproven 
technology such as carbon capture usage and storage (CCUS) 
from 2030. 
There is still no certainty on the timeline for upscaling CCUS, and 
this therefore puts many of the sectoral transition plans at risk, 
which could impact our plans. 
Supply chain readiness 
Our key suppliers require confidence to invest in technology and skills.
Suppliers in our key material sectors often have less ambitious 
net zero targets than the Group, with most suppliers looking to 
2050, capitalising on future technology improvements and emission 
reduction opportunities in their supply chains. 
Our decarbonisation levers continued
84
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Going concern
In determining the appropriate basis of preparation of the 
Financial Statements, the Directors are required to consider 
whether the Group can continue in operational existence for 
the foreseeable future. 
Accordingly, after making enquiries and having considered 
forecasts and appropriate sensitivities, the Directors have 
formed a judgement, at the time of approving the Financial 
Statements, that there is reasonable expectation that the 
Group has adequate resources to continue to operate for 
the foreseeable future, being at least 12 months from the 
date of these Financial Statements. (More information on 
the going concern judgement can be found in note 1 to the 
Financial Statements.) Therefore the Directors continue to 
adopt the going concern basis in the preparation of these 
Financial Statements.
Viability statement 
In accordance with the Code, the Directors have assessed 
the prospects and financial viability of the Group over 
the longer term, considering both its current position 
and circumstances, and the potential impact of its 
principal risks. The Group’s business model is presented 
on pages 10 and 11 and its future prospects are primarily 
monitored through the risk management processes detailed 
on page 63.
On 21 August 2024 the Group acquired the full share capital 
of Redrow plc in an all share transaction. In accordance 
with standard practice, the Competition and Markets 
Authority (the CMA) has issued an Initial Enforcement Order 
requiring the Barratt and Redrow businesses to continue to 
operate independently until the CMA has formally accepted 
the undertakings proposed by the parties in response to 
the findings of its phase 1 investigation, or otherwise agrees 
to integration taking place. The sharing of competitively 
sensitive information between the businesses is prohibited 
while the Enforcement Order is in place. In recognition of 
the need for the pre-acquisition business to be able to 
support itself independently, the Directors have considered 
the ability to continue trading of both the group of companies 
that existed prior to the acquisition (the ‘Barratt group’) and 
the new group including Redrow plc and its subsidiaries 
(the ‘combined group’).
Assessment period
For the long-term viability statement, the Directors consider 
that a three-year review period is appropriate. This period 
is aligned to our operating framework of a 3.5 year owned 
land bank, and the time frame over which the majority of 
our risks have the potential to manifest. Additionally, the 
Barratt group’s bottom-up planning and forecasting cycle, 
which considers a wide range of information relating to 
present and future business conditions, including those 
impacting on expected profitability, cash flows, and funding 
requirements, covers three years. As the Redrow business 
also operates with a strategic three year planning horizon 
and similar land cycle, this review period is also appropriate 
for an assessment of the combined group.
As environmental and climate change risks become more 
significant, the potential for moving towards a five-year review 
period will be considered for future viability assessments.
The Barratt group’s and combined group’s business plans 
reflect the anticipated effects of the current economic 
environment. The Barratt group and combined group are 
forecast to remain profitable and in compliance with 
financial covenants throughout the forecast period.
Principal risks
The Barratt group continues to be subject to its principal 
risks, which are detailed on pages 65 to 70. The Directors 
consider the principal risks of the Barratt group to be 
applicable to the combined group. In addition, the risk that 
synergies are not achieved from the Redrow combination 
has been identified as a new principal risk. This Viability 
Statement considers the impact that these risks might have 
on the ability of the Barratt group and the combined group 
to meet their targets in current market conditions over the 
review period.
Viability Statement
85
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Viability Statement continued
Principal risks continued
The current economic environment presents significant macroeconomic uncertainties, most notably around interest rates and their consequent impacts on UK economic growth, housing 
affordability, as well as consumer confidence and spending. The risks that were considered relevant, for which the impacts were applied in aggregate, were as follows:
Principal risk
Impact modelled
Group resilience to risk impact modelled
Mitigating actions to risk impact modelled
A, 
B
Economic 
environment, 
Land and planning 
A decline in demand, leading to a 5% reduction 
in private average selling prices compared to 
FY24 levels throughout FY25 and FY26 followed 
by a 2% recovery in FY27, and a fall in sales 
volumes of 15% in FY25 followed by a 5% 
recovery in FY26 and FY27.
Geographic and product diversity allows for flexibility in 
response to market conditions whilst the diverse land bank 
allows for selective development of future sites.
In response to lower volumes, a reduction 
in uncommitted land investment, lower 
production and reduction in overhead base. 
Increased focus on affordable housing 
contracts and bulk sales to reduce reliance 
on private sales.
Increased levels of sales incentives to maintain 
volumes in challenging economic environment.
C
Government 
regulation and 
political risk
Increased regulations on housebuilding, 
including early implementation of the Future 
Homes Standard and increased carbon 
pricing as part of commitments to limit global 
temperature rise to 1.50C.
An additional cost per private plot of £4,500 
for compliance with additional regulations has 
been included, applied to 10% of plots in FY26 
and 40% of plots in FY27.
Continuous review of the operational and financial impact of 
building regulations, including the Future Homes Standard, to 
adapt and plan for compliance.
For details regarding the Group’s engagement 
with Government, opposition parties and 
regulators, see page 54.
For the transition plan to achieve net zero by 
2040 and mitigating exposure to carbon pricing, 
see page 81.
E
High rise 
and complex 
structures
A Building Safety Levy of £1,500 per private plot 
for potential additional safety costs that could 
be imposed by the UK Government, applied to 
10% of plots in FY26 and 40% of plots in FY27.
A £50m increase in the building safety 
provision in FY25.
Strong balance sheet and net cash position along with good 
cost control through well monitored build programmes.
As an industry-wide cost, any such levy will 
likely be factored in to future land bids over 
the medium term.
For further details regarding the building safety 
provision, see note 19 on pages 186 to 188.
F
Supply chain 
resilience
A further increase in material and labour costs 
of 2% arising from shortfalls in supply and 
inflationary pressures.
Key supplier audit programme, centralised procurement 
and long-standing relationships ensure continuity of 
supply. Robust cost control through well monitored 
build programmes.
Redesign of developments to emphasise cost 
savings. Development of multiple supplier 
relationships for labour and material supplies, 
with contingency plans should any key 
supplier fail.
J
Redrow integration No synergies are assumed in the 
combined forecast.
A dedicated Integration Management Office has been 
established to oversee the combination. 
Expected synergies will be tracked, monitored 
and reported to the Integration Steering Committee.
86
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Viability Statement continued
Outcome of assessment 
To assess the resilience of the Barratt group and combined 
group to adverse outcomes, their forecast performance 
over the three-year period was sensitised to reflect a series 
of scenarios based on the identified principal risks and 
the downside prospects for the UK economy and housing 
market presented in the latest external economic forecasts. 
This assessment included a reasonable worst-case scenario 
in which the principal risks manifest to a severe but plausible 
level. For the purposes of this assessment, it was assumed 
that the financing facilities available to the combined group 
were those currently available to the Barratt group, and that 
all associated financial covenants would apply.
The Barratt group and combined group would undertake 
mitigating actions in response to the challenging circumstances 
modelled. This would primarily involve a reduction in 
investment in land and work in progress in line with the 
fall in expected sales, and would not prevent the ability of 
the Barratt group or the combined group to grow over the 
long term.
Under the described scenario, the Barratt group and the 
combined group are able to operate within current facilities, 
meet liabilities as they fall due, and remain in compliance 
with financial covenants in the assessed period. The 
Group has a policy of maintaining a £150m headroom on 
its available facilities and both the Barratt group and the 
combined group would remain in compliance with this 
policy throughout the viability review period.
Mitigations
In such challenging economic circumstances, additional 
options would be available to ensure that the Group 
would retain the flexibility to react to further risks or 
opportunities, including:
i.	
Further reductions in uncommitted land spend;
ii.	 Redesign of developments to emphasise cost savings;
iii.	 Disposal of interests in joint ventures to partners; and
iv.	 Sale of land or unsold stock at discounted value.
As these actions could affect the long-term solvency 
and growth prospects of the Group, they would only be 
used to meet immediate requirements. Nonetheless, 
their availability in addition to the actions modelled 
demonstrates that the Barratt group has further flexibility 
to respond to challenges as they arise.
Conclusion
Based on this review, the Directors confirm that they have 
a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to 
continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall 
due over the three-year period of their assessment.
Over the longer term, climate change will present an 
increasing risk to the Group. In response to this, and 
in line with the recommendations of the Task Force for 
Climate‑related Financial Disclosures, the Board has 
undertaken a review of the climate-related risks and 
opportunities that may affect the business out to 2050, 
including the modelling of the Barratt group’s resilience 
under several climate-related scenarios. The results of 
this review, as well as the action being undertaken to 
ensure the business is well positioned to thrive in the 
new physical, socio-economic and regulatory environment, 
are set out on pages 71 to 84. 
Looking forward, significant macroeconomic challenges, 
most a prolonged higher interest rate environment, will 
impact the housebuilding sector going in the medium term. 
The Directors consider that the Group can demonstrate 
its resilience to these challenges with its well-capitalised 
balance sheet, strong net cash balance and a solid forward 
sales position going into FY25.
Approval of the Strategic Report
The Strategic Report on pages 1 to 87 was approved 
by the Board and signed on its behalf by
David Thomas
Chief Executive
3 September 2024
87
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Governance
89 Board of Directors and Company Secretary
93	 Executive Committee
94	 Corporate Governance Report 
102	 Nomination Committee Report 
112	 Audit and Risk Committee Report 
121	 Safety, Health and Environment Committee Report
123	 Remuneration Report 
146	 Other statutory disclosures 
148	 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
Anson Gardens, Fradley
88
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance

A collaborative Board
Read more about 
Chris on page 92
Read more about 
Katie on page 91
Read more about 
Steven on page 90
Read more about 
Jasi on page 91
Read more about 
Jock on page 91
Read more about 
David on page 90
Read more about 
Mike on page 91
Read more about 
Caroline on page 90
Read more about 
Tina on page 92
Read more about 
Nigel on page 92
Read more about our Board on pages 90 to 92
Board of Directors and Company Secretary
89
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board of Directors and Company Secretary continued
Caroline Silver
Chair
Appointed:
Caroline joined the Board on 1 June 2023, and was 
appointed Non-Executive Chair on 30 June 2023. 
She became Designated Non-Executive Director 
for Workforce Engagement in July 2023.
Skills and qualifications:
Caroline brings a wealth of knowledge and 
experience to the Board across a number of 
commercial, financial, investment banking, 
governance and board leadership roles. Caroline 
was Chair of PZ Cussons PLC until 31 March 2023 
and was Non-Executive Director of Meggitt PLC 
and M&G PLC. She served on the boards of BUPA 
and the London Ambulance Service NHS Trust and 
as a trustee of the Victoria and Albert Museum. 
She spent over 30 years in the investment banking 
sector, holding senior corporate finance and M&A 
positions at Morgan Stanley and Merrill Lynch, and 
until 2020, was a partner and Managing Director at 
Moelis & Company. Caroline started her career as 
a Chartered Accountant at PwC.
External appointments:
Caroline is currently a Non-Executive Director 
at Tesco PLC and Intercontinental Exchange, 
Inc. She is also a member of the International 
Advisory Board of Adobe Inc, a member of the V&A 
Foundation, a Senior Adviser to Moelis & Company 
and Chair of the Audit Committee of the National 
Film and Television School.
David Thomas
Chief Executive
Appointed:
David joined the Board as an Executive Director 
and Group Finance Director in July 2009, and 
was appointed Chief Executive in July 2015. 
Skills and qualifications:
David brings significant leadership and finance 
experience acquired over several years in senior 
positions, and is an Associate of the Institute of 
Chartered Accountants in England and Wales. He 
was previously Group Finance Director and Deputy 
Chief Executive of The GAME Group plc, and Group 
Finance Director at Millennium and Copthorne 
Hotels plc. He has also held senior financial roles 
with House of Fraser plc and Forte plc. David is 
also a former trustee of the Barratt Developments 
PLC Charitable Foundation.
External appointments:
David is a Non-Executive Director of the HBF, 
Chair of the Future Homes Hub, a member of 
the Net Zero Council and a Trustee at CentrePoint, 
the UK’s leading youth homelessness charity.
Steven Boyes
Chief Operating Officer and Deputy 
Chief Executive
Appointed:
Steven joined the Board as an Executive Director in 
July 2001, became Chief Operating Officer in July 
2012 and Deputy Chief Executive in February 2016. 
He is responsible for the Group’s housebuilding 
operations and the land promotion business, 
Gladman Developments Limited.
Skills and qualifications:
Steven has over 40 years’ experience in the 
housebuilding industry, having joined as a junior 
quantity surveyor in 1978. He progressed through 
the business to assume the roles of Technical 
Director and Managing Director of Barratt York, 
before being appointed Regional Director for 
Barratt Northern in 1999. Steven was previously 
a Trustee of the UK Green Building Council.
External appointments:
Steven holds no external appointments.
Committee membership key
 Audit and Risk Committee
 Nomination Committee 
 Remuneration Committee 
 Disclosure Committee
 Safety, Health and Environment Committee
 Sustainability Committee 
 Workforce Forum 
 Chair of Committee
90
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Mike Scott
Chief Financial Officer
Appointed:
Mike joined the Board as an Executive Director 
and Chief Financial Officer in December 2021.
Skills and qualifications:
Mike has extensive experience in the housebuilding 
sector and is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered 
Accountants in England and Wales. He was previously 
Chief Financial Officer of Countryside Properties PLC, 
having joined as Group Financial Controller in 2014. 
Prior to this, Mike held a number of senior finance 
roles at J. Sainsbury plc, including latterly as Head 
of Investor Relations, and spent 11 years at PwC.
External appointments:
Mike holds no external appointments. 
Katie Bickerstaffe
Non-Executive Director
Appointed:
Katie joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director 
on 1 March 2021 and took over as Chair of the 
Remuneration Committee on 4 May 2021.
Skills and qualifications:
Katie brings extensive business transformation 
experience together with considerable digital 
expertise. She was Co-Chief Executive of Marks 
and Spencer Group PLC from May 2022 to July 
2024. She was also a former Non-Executive 
Director of Marks and Spencer Group PLC, and was 
previously Executive Chair of SSE Energy Services, 
where she led its separation from SSE plc and 
subsequent sale to OVO Group Ltd. She was also 
a Non‑Executive Director of SSE plc and Chair of its 
Remuneration Committee until 2018. Prior to this, 
she worked in a variety of general management 
roles in retail and manufacturing businesses.
External appointments:
Katie is a Non-Executive Director of the England 
and Wales Cricket Board, where she was appointed 
the Senior Independent Director in May 2023.
Jasi Halai
Non-Executive Director
Appointed:
Jasi joined the Board on 1 January 2023.
Skills and qualifications:
Jasi brings considerable financial and business 
skills and experience which complement those 
of other Board members. She is a Chartered 
Management Accountant and holds an MSc in 
investment management from the CASS Business 
School. Before being appointed to the Board of 
3i Group plc, she held a variety of posts there, 
most recently as Group Financial Controller. She 
was also a Non-Executive Director and Chair of the 
Audit Committee at Porvair Plc until January 2023.
External appointments:
Jasi is currently Chief Operating Officer and an 
Executive Director of 3i Group plc, and is also a 
member of the 3i Executive, Investment, Group 
Risk and ESG Committees.
Jock Lennox
Senior Independent Director
Appointed:
Jock joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director 
in July 2016 and became Senior Independent 
Director on 4 May 2021.
Skills and qualifications:
Jock, a Chartered Accountant, brings significant 
business and finance experience to the Board. 
He was Chair of Hill and Smith Holdings plc 
and Enquest plc. Jock was previously Senior 
Independent Director of Oxford Instruments plc 
and Non-Executive Director and Chairman of the 
Audit Committees of Dixons Carphone plc and A&J 
Mucklow Group plc. He was also the Chair of the 
Audit Committee Chairs’ Independent Forum. Jock 
spent 30 years with Ernst & Young LLP, holding 
several leadership positions in the UK and globally, 
including 20 years as a partner.
External appointments:
Jock is Chair of Johnson Service Group plc and 
of Clarion Housing Group (appointed August 2024).
Board of Directors and Company Secretary continued
91
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board of Directors and Company Secretary continued
Chris Weston
Non-Executive Director
Appointed:
Chris joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director 
on 1 March 2021 and took over as Chair of the 
Safety, Health and Environment Committee on 
4 May 2021.
Skills and qualifications:
Chris brings to the Board considerable commercial 
experience, driving performance and growth, 
including as former Chief Executive Officer at Aggreko 
Limited and as Managing Director, International 
Downstream at Centrica plc. Chris joined Centrica 
after a successful career in the telecoms industry 
working for Cable & Wireless Plc and One.Tel. 
Until June 2023, Chris was also a Non-Executive 
Director on the board of the Royal Navy.
External appointments:
Chris was appointed as Chief Executive Officer of 
Thames Water Utilities in January 2024 and as a 
Non-Executive Director of Sportquest Holidays Ltd 
in August 2023.
Tina Bains
Company Secretary
Appointed:
Tina was appointed to the role of Company 
Secretary in January 2016.
Skills and qualifications:
Tina joined the Group in 2008 as Assistant 
Company Secretary, and was promoted to the role 
of Deputy Company Secretary in 2011. Prior to this, 
Tina held various Company Secretarial positions 
within the private and professional services sectors 
including TMF Corporate Secretarial Services 
Limited and Ernst & Young LLP. Tina is a Fellow 
of the Corporate Governance Institute.
External appointments:
Tina is a Trustee of the Barratt Developments PLC 
Charitable Foundation.
Nigel Webb
Non-Executive Director
Appointed:
Nigel joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director 
on 1 October 2023.
Skills and qualifications:
Nigel Webb brings over 38 years of experience 
in property investment and development to 
the Barratt Board. Up until June 2023, Nigel 
was the Head of Development and a member 
of the Executive Committee at British Land 
Company plc, where he had worked since 1992. 
His responsibilities included leadership of British 
Land’s property development activities throughout 
the UK and across all sectors, primarily office, 
retail, residential and urban logistics. He was 
also responsible for delivery of the group’s 
industry‑leading Environment, Social and 
Governance (ESG) strategy, including developing 
all new buildings to net zero embodied carbon.
External appointments:
Nigel is currently a Non-Executive Director of 
Precede Capital Partners, non-executive Board 
Adviser to Sir Robert McAlpine and Interim Chair 
& Trustee of the Victoria and Albert Museum.
Board skills and experience
All Directors are expected to devote the 
necessary time to fulfil their responsibilities 
and duties to the Company, with the highest 
standards of integrity. Each Director 
has demonstrable experience, skills and 
knowledge which complement those of 
other Board members and enhance Board 
effectiveness.
The skills held by the Directors are 
summarised below.
Skill
Total
Housebuilding
Property
Retail
Public policy
Marketing
Governance
Finance/accounting
Legal
Employment/HR
Sustainability
Digital
Financial services
Land/construction
People/talent/  
succession/  
diversity, etc
92
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Sally Austin
Group HR Director
Sally joined Barratt in November 2023 
as Group HR Director.
Career and experience: 
She was previously the Chief People 
Officer at Wincanton PLC from 
August 2019 to October 2023. Prior 
to Wincanton, Sally was the Group HR 
Director with Costain Group PLC, a 
British technology-based construction 
and engineering company where she 
held a variety of HR roles and became 
Group HR Director in 2014. Sally began 
her career in HR at BAE Systems and 
Eaton Corporation where she held 
HR roles across Europe, Middle East 
and Africa. Externally, Sally is Chair 
of Warwick Schools Foundation.
Louise Ruppel
General Counsel
Louise joined Barratt in February 2024 
as General Counsel and a member of the 
Executive Committee.
Career and experience: 
Louise trained as a lawyer with 
Slaughter & May and has over 20 years 
of Executive Committee experience in 
industries spanning defence, security, 
and transport, including at FirstGroup 
plc and Manchester Airport Group. 
She most recently held the position of 
General Counsel and Company Secretary 
at defence and security company Ultra 
Electronics for four years.
Members
The Executive Committee 
currently comprises of:
1 	David Thomas
	
Chief Executive
2 	Steven Boyes
 
Chief Operating Officer and  
	
Deputy Chief Executive
3 	Mike Scott
 
Chief Financial Officer
4 	Tina Bains
	
Company Secretary
5 	Bukky Bird
	
Group Sustainability Director
6 	Tim Collins
	
Group Corporate
 
Affairs Director
7 	Sally Austin
	
Group HR Director
8 	Louise Ruppel
	
General Counsel
 Biographies can be found 
on pages 90 to 93
Tim Collins
Group Corporate Affairs Director
Tim is responsible for the Group’s 
internal and external communications 
and public affairs. He is also a Trustee 
of the Barratt Developments PLC 
Charitable Foundation.
Career and experience: 
Tim joined the Group in 2014 as the 
regional Head of Communications, 
before becoming Group Head of 
Corporate Communications in 2016. 
He was appointed to his current role 
and joined the Executive Committee in 
September 2022. Tim brings significant 
political and industry experience, having 
held the roles of Deputy Director of 
Communications at the Conservative 
Party, Chief of Staff to the Shadow 
Housing Minister and Deputy Director 
External Affairs at the HBF. Tim has a Law 
degree from University College London.
6
Bukky Bird 
Group Sustainability Director
Bukky is responsible for the Group’s 
sustainability strategy and its delivery. She is 
a member of the Sustainability Committee.
Career and experience: 
Bukky joined the Group in 2020 and was 
appointed to the Executive Committee 
in September 2022. She brings a breadth 
of experience acquired from leadership 
roles in strategy, sustainability, business 
transformation, engineering, construction 
and retail operations. She was previously 
at Tesco PLC, and before that at WSP Group 
PLC. Bukky is a qualified Mechanical 
Engineer and also holds a Master’s 
degree in Environmental Design and 
Engineering, both from UCL.
5
7
8
6
5
8
7
2
4
1
3
Executive Committee
93
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Dear Shareholder
As a Board, we are responsible for the stewardship of the 
Company and remain accountable to you for the decisions 
that we make. 
Despite the ongoing challenges in our operating environment, 
we have made good progress during the year towards 
our purpose of making sustainable living a reality and 
building strong communities. This report explains how 
our governance framework contributes to the long‑term 
sustainable success of the Company by ensuring 
that decisions are made by the right people following 
appropriate challenge and debate. 
Having the right culture is key for ensuring that decisions 
are made in the right way. As a Board we set and review, at 
least annually, the Group’s core policies and ensure that we 
have effective systems and processes in place to monitor 
how we do business. Details on how we monitor culture can 
be found on page 98. 
Caroline Silver
Chair
Corporate Governance Report
Governance 
at a glance
FY24 highlights
During the year, the Board:
	• agreed the combination with Redrow;
	• approved the appointment of Nigel Webb as a 
Non-Executive Director;
	• approved the appointment of Matthew Pratt as an 
Executive Director and Group CEO, Redrow and Nicky 
Dulieu and Geeta Nanda as Non-Executive Directors 
subject to CMA clearance and the completion of the 
Combination;
	• agreed updated science-based targets for carbon 
emissions; and 
	• joined the Responsible Actors Scheme to improve building 
standards and remedy defects relating to fire safety. 
Fully compliant with the 2018 
UK Corporate Governance 
Code (the Code).
The Company is subject to the Code which can be found 
on the FRC’s website, www.frc.org.uk. The Board confirms 
that, throughout the year ended 30 June 2024, and as at 
the date of this report, the Company has complied with 
all relevant provisions set out in the Code.
This report, together with the reports from the Nomination, 
Audit and Risk, SHE and Remuneration Committees 
and the other statutory disclosures, provides details 
of how the Company has applied the principles of the 
Code. The Company has also complied with the relevant 
requirements of the FCA’s Disclosure and Transparency 
Rules and the UK Listing Rules, BEIS’s Directors’ 
Remuneration Reporting Regulations and Narrative 
Reporting Regulations and the FRC’s Guidance on Risk 
Management, Internal Control and Related Financial 
and Business Reporting. The Company’s Board diversity 
statement and associated data is included in the 
Nomination Committee Report on pages 106 to 108. 
We welcome the FRC’s publication of the 2024 Code 
which will apply to us from 1 July 2025. We are in the 
process of reviewing our governance framework and 
arrangements in light of the 2024 Code to ensure 
that any necessary changes can be implemented 
in a timely manner. 
94
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board and Committee attendance 
Attendance at Board and Board Committee meetings during the year is set out in the table below. During the year, the Board also held two 
additional meetings through a dedicated sub-Committee convened specifically to consider and agree matters relating to the Combination. 
Board
Nomination
 Committee 
Audit 
and Risk 
Committee
Safety, 
Health and
 Environment
 Committee
Sustainability
 Committee
Remuneration
 Committee
Caroline Silver – Chair
13/13
2/2
N/A
N/A
N/A
4/4
David Thomas – Chief Executive
13/13
N/A
N/A
N/A
4/4
N/A
Steven Boyes – Chief Operating Officer 
and Deputy Chief Executive
13/13
N/A
N/A
1/1
3/4
N/A
Mike Scott – Chief Financial Officer
13/13
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Jock Lennox – Senior Independent 
Non-Executive Director 
13/13
2/2
4/4
N/A
4/4
4/4
Katie Bickerstaffe – Non-Executive Director
13/13
2/2
4/4
N/A
4/4
4/4
Jasi Halai – Non-Executive Director
13/13
2/2
4/4
N/A
4/4
4/4
Nigel Webb1 – Non-Executive Director 
12/12
2/2
3/3
N/A
N/A
4/4
Chris Weston2 – Non-Executive Director
12/13
2/2
4/4
1/1
N/A
4/4
Bukky Bird – Group Sustainability Director
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
4/4
N/A
Jeremy Hipkiss3 
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1/1
N/A
Tina Bains – Company Secretary
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
4/4
N/A
1 	 Nigel was appointed to the Board on 1 October 2023. His attendance above reflects the meetings he was eligible to attend during FY24.
2 	 Chris Weston was unable to attend the October Board meeting due to a prior commitment. Prior to the meeting, he provided his views on the items on the agenda which were shared with the 
other Board members during the meeting. Following the meeting Chris was briefed on the business of the meeting and any decisions taken.
3	 Former Group Customer and Change Director.
 Read more about our board on pages 90 to 92
Non-Executive Director tenure
 0–3 years50.00%
 3–6 years33.33%
 6+ years
16.67%
Gender diversity
Independence (excluding the Chair)
 Male
66.67%
 Female
33.33%
 Executive 
	
Directors 37.50%
 Independent 
Non-Executive 
Directors 62.50%
Corporate Governance Report continued
95
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board leadership and 
Company purpose
How we have applied 
the Code
1. Board of 
Directors
2. Purpose, values, 
strategy and 
culture
3. Resource 
and control 
framework
4. Stakeholder 
engagement
5. Workforce 
policies and 
practices
Division of 
responsibilities
How we have applied 
the Code
1. Role of the Chair
2. Division of 
responsibilities
3. Role of the 
NEDs
4. Policies, 
processes, 
information, 
time and 
resources
Composition, 
succession 
and evaluation
How we have applied 
the Code
1. Appointments 
to the Board
2. Skills, 
experience 
and knowledge
3. Board 
evaluation
Audit, risk and 
internal control
How we have applied 
the Code
1. Independence 
and 
effectiveness 
of internal and 
external audit
2. Fair, 
balanced and 
understandable 
assessment
3. Risk 
management and 
internal control 
Remuneration
How we have applied 
the Code
1. Alignment to 
purpose, values 
and long-term 
success
2. Remuneration 
Policy
3. Independent 
judgement and 
discretion
Implementation of the Code 
See pages 
90 to 92, 
95 and 96
See page 98
See pages 
96, 97 and 
101
See pages 
50 to 57
See page 45
Role of the Board 
We are responsible for the stewardship and long-term 
sustainable success of the Company. Our overarching 
aim is to create sustainable value for the benefit of our 
shareholders through:
	• setting the strategic objectives and ensuring the right 
leadership and resources are in place to meet them; 
	• setting the purpose and values to provide direction as 
to how the strategic objectives should be met; and
	• ensuring that the Company has an effective risk 
management framework.
Board meetings
We meet formally at least seven times a year. To increase 
our visibility of the Group’s operations and provide further 
opportunities to meet senior management, at least two 
Board meetings are combined with visits to the Group’s 
sites. In March 2024 we visited our West Craigs and Cammo 
sites in Edinburgh, Scotland, and in May 2024 we visited 
Darwin Green and Franklin Gardens in Cambridgeshire. 
On both visits we toured the development and met with 
senior management and site and sales office employees 
who provided an overview of the regional, divisional and 
site operations respectively, enabling us to gain a better 
understanding of how culture is embedded in the business, 
and the challenges faced on a day-to-day basis.
In addition to our regular Board meetings, we held a 
strategy day which was devoted to reviewing progress 
against the Group’s strategy and discussing longer-term 
strategic options. During this meeting we received updates 
on analyst and investor feedback, the political landscape 
and the housing market and discussed our construction 
strategy and roadmap to meet the requirements of 
the Future Homes Standard. We also held a number of 
informal meetings during the year to build and maintain 
strong relations between the Directors, and I met with the 
Non‑Executive Directors without the Executive Directors 
present prior to each Audit and Risk Committee and 
Remuneration Committee meeting to discuss their priorities 
and concerns; eight of these meetings have been held 
during the financial year.
Corporate Governance Report continued
See page 99
See page 106
See pages 
118 to 120
See page 127
See pages 
128 to 131
See page 129
See pages 
116 to 117
See pages 
117 and 118
See pages 
90 to 92 
and 103
See pages 
109 to 111
See page 99
See page 99
See pages 
96 and 100
96
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Strategy
Approved updated science-based 
targets to reduce carbon emissions 
which will help the delivery of our 
purpose to make sustainable living 
a reality 
Link to risks	
 C  G
 See page 81
Stakeholders considered 
Government, shareholders, 
sub‑contractors and suppliers,
customers, local communities 
and the environment 
Approved the combination with Redrow 
to create an exceptional homebuilder 
to drive innovation for customers, 
employees, sub-contractors and the 
supply chain and meet the demand 
for more houses
Link to risks	
 C  H  J
 See pages 48 to 49
Stakeholders considered 
Government, opposition and 
regulators, banks, shareholders, 
employees, sub-contractors 
and suppliers, customers, local 
communities and the environment 
Operations
Approved multiple investments in land
Link to risks	
 B
Stakeholders considered 
Customers, local communities 
and the environment
Considered the results of the 
investigation into the fatality at one of our 
sites in November 2023 and was satisfied 
that the report from the Health and 
Safety Executive concluded that suitable 
safety arrangements were in place 
Link to risks	
 C  G
Stakeholders considered 
Employees, sub-contractors 
and local communities
Considered updates on engagement 
with the CMA in respect of the 
housebuilding market study and its 
investigation into information sharing
Link to risks	
 C
Stakeholders considered 
Government, opposition and 
regulators, and customers
Considered updates on customer 
service performance
Link to risks	
 D
Stakeholders considered 
Customers
Considered updates on employee 
survey results
Link to risks	
 H
Stakeholders considered 
Employees
Finance
Approved results announcements and 
trading statements
Link to risks	
 A
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders 
Approved the 2024 interim dividend 
payment and recommended the 2024 
final dividend payment
Link to risks	
 A
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders, banks
Approved the annual budget whereby 
the resources to achieve the agreed 
strategy are made available 
Link to risks	
 A  B  D  G  H  I
Stakeholders considered 
Employees, suppliers and 
sub-contractors, shareholders, 
local communities and the environment
Risk management
Reviewed the Company’s principal and 
emerging risks and agreed a process 
by which to re-assess the Board’s 
risk appetite
Link to risks	
 A  B  C  D  E
	
 F  G  H  I  J
 See pages 65 to 70
Stakeholders considered 
Employees, suppliers and 
sub-contractors, shareholders, 
banks, local communities and the 
environment and customers 
Reviewed the effectiveness of 
the risk management and internal 
control framework
Link to risks	
 A  B  C  D  E
 F  G  H  I  J
 See pages 117 and 118
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders, employees, 
suppliers and sub-contractors
Governance
Approved the appointment of Nigel 
Webb to ensure Board composition 
remains appropriate 
Link to risks	
 B  H
 See page 106
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders
Received diversity and inclusion updates
Link to risks	
 C  H
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders, employees 
and government
Approved Board evaluation action plans 
Link to risks	
 C  H
 See pages 109 to 111
Stakeholders considered 
Shareholders
Key activities and discussions in FY24 and outcomes
Our values
 We do it for our customers
 We do it right
 We do it together
 We make it happen
Principal risks
A  Economic environment 
B  Land and planning
C  Government regulation and political risk
D  Construction quality and innovation
E  High rise and complex structures
F  Supply chain resilience
G  Safety, health and environment
H  Attracting and retaining high-calibre employees
I  Information technology
J  Redrow integration
Corporate Governance Report continued
97
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Purpose
Making sustainable living a reality, building strong communities.
We do it for 
our customers
We do it right
We do it 
together
We make 
it happen
Culture in the workplace
As a Board we set the culture and tone from the top. We determine the Company’s 
purpose and values and remain responsible for ensuring that the right culture is 
embedded throughout the business.
We refreshed our purpose and values in 
FY23 and embedded them throughout 
the Group during FY24 via a Group-wide 
training programme comprising interactive 
face‑to‑face seminars and training material 
with clear examples of what living each 
value means in practice. Our values show 
our employees how to behave and clarify 
the standards they can expect from each 
other and the Company. They help us build 
better, work better, be better and create 
places where people, communities and 
nature can thrive. We all have a part to play 
and as a Board we lead by example by living 
and promoting our values every day.
Further details on our purpose and values can 
be found on pages 1 and 2 and in numerous 
case studies throughout this report.
How we drive and monitor 
culture across the business 
We undertake a number of actions to support 
and monitor the Company’s culture, including:
	• Conducting site visits at which we 
engage with employees at all levels of 
the business, seeking their views on the 
Company and its performance. In addition 
to the two Board visits, the Executive 
Directors and many of the Non-Executive 
Directors made independent visits to 
some of our sites during the year. 
	• Reviewing feedback from the employee 
engagement survey and pulse survey 
and overseeing action plans to address 
matters raised. See page 30 for 
further details.
	• Reviewing customer satisfaction scores. 
Our customer satisfaction KPI is used by 
the Remuneration Committee as part of 
the annual bonus performance measure 
to drive behaviour consistent with our 
purpose, values and strategy. 
	• Receiving SHE performance updates 
together with information on new 
or ongoing investigations and their 
outcomes. The SHE audit compliance KPI 
underpins the quality and service annual 
bonus performance measure set by the 
Remuneration Committee to promote the 
desired culture. 
	• Monitoring employee leaver numbers and 
reasons, and the steps being taken to 
attract, recruit and retain employees.
	• Reviewing core governance policies on 
an annual basis to ensure that they 
remain appropriate. 
	• Receiving, via the Audit and Risk Committee, 
updates on matters raised via the Group’s 
whistleblowing procedure. See page 118.
Corporate Governance Report continued
To ensure our culture aligns with our purpose and values we review a number of 
cultural indicators including:
302
per 100,000 
workers IIR 
5 star
HBF customer 
satisfaction score
 
77%
of employees 
completed the 
engagement survey 
74.9%
employee 
engagement index
97%
SHE audit 
compliance
68%
invoices paid 
within 30 days 
32%
of employees 
are female 
8%
employees are 
from an ethnic 
minority 
background
14,515
hours volunteered
12%
voluntary 
employee turnover
27
whistleblowing 
reports
97%
completion rate 
for the 6 key 
mandatory 
e-learning modules
98
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board roles and their responsibilities
Read more about the Board on pages 90 to 92
Chair
Chief Executive
Chief Operating Officer 
and Deputy Chief 
Executive 
Chief Financial Officer
Senior Independent 
Director
Independent 
Non-Executive Directors
Caroline Silver
David Thomas
Steven Boyes
Mike Scott
Jock Lennox
Katie Bickerstaffe, Jasi 
Halai, Jock Lennox, Chris 
Weston and Nigel Webb
	• Leads the Board in the 
achievement of its objectives, 
sets its agenda and chairs 
its meetings.
	• Shapes the culture in 
the Boardroom.
	• Responsible for the 
effectiveness of the Board 
and its governance.
	• Facilitates the effective 
contribution of Non-Executive 
Directors and constructive 
relations between Executive 
and Non-Executive Directors.
	• Ensures the Board 
receives accurate, timely 
and clear information.
	• Responsible for arranging 
inductions and continued 
development for the Directors.
	• Ensures effective 
communication with 
shareholders and other 
stakeholders, and participates 
in corporate relations activities.
	• Develops the Group’s strategy 
for the enhancement of long-
term shareholder return taking 
into account the needs of the 
Group’s stakeholders.
	• Leads the implementation of 
the Group’s strategy approved 
by the Board.
	• Responsible for the day-to-day 
leadership and management 
of the operational activities of 
the Group in accordance with 
overall strategy and policy as 
determined by the Board.
	• Chairs the Executive 
Committee through which 
he carries out his duties.
	• Oversees corporate 
relations with shareholders 
and other stakeholders.
	• Responsible to the Board for 
sustainability policies and 
practices of the Group.
	• Chairs the Sustainability 
Committee and co-chairs 
the Workforce Forum.
	• Responsible for the 
Group’s operations.
	• Day-to-day responsibility 
for safety, health and 
environment issues, promoting 
the wellbeing of employees.
	• Responsible for our 
procurement function and 
our land promoter business.
	• Responsible for ensuring 
stakeholder requirements 
are appropriately addressed.
	• Chairs the Operations 
Committee meetings, the 
other members of which 
include the Regional 
Managing Directors.
	• Co-chairs the Workforce Forum.
	• Develops and implements 
the Group’s financial strategy 
and policies.
	• Responsible for the 
management of the finance, 
tax, internal audit, treasury 
and investor relations functions.
	• Supports the Chief 
Executive with his corporate 
relations responsibilities 
with shareholders and 
other stakeholders.
	• Manages the Group’s 
relationship with the 
external auditor.
	• Manages the Group’s 
relationships with its 
lending banks.
	• Chairs the Executive 
Risk Committee.
The following are in addition 
to his role and responsibilities 
as an Independent Non-
Executive Director:
	• Available to shareholders, 
when required, to address any 
material issues or concerns 
which the Chair and/or 
Chief Executive have failed 
to resolve.
	• Available to shareholders, 
when required, to listen to 
their views to gain a balanced 
understanding of their issues 
and concerns.
	• Evaluates the performance 
of the Chair, at least annually, 
with the Non-Executive 
Directors, and leads the process 
for the Chair’s succession.
	• Acts as a sounding board for 
the Chair and, if necessary, 
an intermediary for the 
other Directors.
	• Provide an appropriate 
level of scrutiny, and 
constructively challenge 
the Executive Directors, 
holding management to 
account and ensuring the 
needs of stakeholders are 
appropriately considered.
	• Using the broad range 
of their experience and 
external perspective, provide 
specialist advice and an 
independent perspective 
in developing strategy.
	• Monitor the implementation 
of the Group’s strategy within 
its risk and control framework 
and ensure the integrity of 
financial reporting.
	• Ensure that recruitment 
and succession planning is 
appropriate and mindful of 
diversity and balance.
	• Review and refresh the 
Remuneration Policy in 
the context of stakeholder 
interests, and ensure it is 
implemented appropriately.
Company Secretary 
Tina Bains
	•
Supports the Chair and Chief Executive in fulfilling their duties especially in respect of induction, training and Board 
and Committee effectiveness evaluations.
	•
Available to all Directors for advice and support.
	•
Keeps the Board regularly updated on governance matters and best practice.
	•
Ensures Group policies and procedures are maintained and updated on a regular basis.
	•
Attends and maintains a record of the matters discussed and approved at Board and Committee meetings, including 
where Directors have concerns that cannot be resolved.
	•
Maintains an annual agenda to ensure that all key matters are allocated adequate time for discussion.
Corporate Governance Report continued
99
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Governance framework 
Board
Chief 
Executive
Chief 
Operating 
Officer
Executive 
Committee
Group Management Committee 
Board Committee 
Corporate Governance Report continued
The Board makes decisions on strategy and on items set out in the matters reserved for it. It also delegates various operational decisions to several Board and management 
Committees (see below). The schedule of matters reserved to the Board and the Terms of Reference of the Board Committees are available on the Company’s website at 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors/corporate-governance. 
Sustainability Committee 
	•
Reviews and scrutinises sustainability strategy and its implementation 
by the business.
	•
Reviews and approves plans by the business to mitigate risks and 
leverage opportunities relating to sustainability and climate changes.
	•
Develops and implements ESG policies and monitors compliance 
against these.
	•
Scrutinises sustainability performance incentives for consideration 
by the Remuneration Committee.
	•
Advises the Board on the appetite and tolerance with respect to ESG risks.
	•
Oversees carbon emission science-based targets and recommends 
changes where necessary.
	•
Oversees the development of our sustainability reporting.
Remuneration Committee
	•
Designs and implements the Group’s overall remuneration strategy 
and policy, ensuring alignment with purpose and strategy.
	•
Sets the remuneration and determines the outcomes for the Executive 
Directors and senior management.
	•
Monitors performance of long and short-term incentive schemes against 
both financial and non-financial targets. 
	•
Considers the remuneration and related policies of the wider workforce 
when determining Executive Directors and senior management’s 
remuneration and incentives.
Nomination Committee
	•
Monitors the composition of the Board and its Committees to 
ensure a balance of skills, experience and knowledge, and their 
progressive refreshment.
	•
Reviews succession plans for Board and senior management to ensure 
there is a diverse pipeline.
	•
Promotes diversity of Board Directors and senior management.
	•
Undertakes annual effectiveness evaluations of the Board, 
its Committees and individual Directors. 
Disclosure Committee
	•
Comprising any two of the Chief Executive, Chief Financial Officer and the Company Secretary, meets as required to ensure that the Company 
remains compliant with the requirements of the UK Market Abuse Regime.
Safety, Health and Environment Committee 
	•
Focuses on the prevention and mitigation of key operational risks 
relating to SHE.
	•
Monitors compliance with the SHE management system.
	•
Oversees direction and implementation of SHE policies and procedures.
Audit and Risk Committee
	•
Monitors the integrity of the Group’s Financial Statements and formal 
announcements on its financial performance, including reviewing 
financial reporting judgements contained within them. 
	•
Advises the Board on whether the Group’s Annual Report and Accounts 
are fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the information 
necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and 
performance, business model and strategy.
	•
Provides oversight of non-financial information, including sustainability 
and considers the need for external assurance.
	•
Reviews the Group’s internal financial, operational and compliance 
controls and its systems for risk management and internal controls.
	•
Monitors and reviews the independence, objectivity and effectiveness 
of the external auditor and the internal audit function, and reviews and 
recommends to the Board the reappointment, remuneration and terms 
of engagement of the external auditor.
	•
Develops and implements the Group’s policy on the engagement 
of the external auditor to supply non-audit services.
Executive Risk Committee
	•
Reviews the effectiveness of the Group’s internal control 
policies and procedures for the identification, assessment 
and reporting of risks.
	•
Assesses individual key risks on a rolling basis (including the 
identification of the Group’s principal and emerging risks) 
together with the appropriateness of any mitigations.
Land Committee
	•
Reviews and approves all land acquisition and disposal 
proposals across the Group.
	•
Refers proposals to the Board for approval depending on 
the value of the land transaction or its complexity, e.g. joint 
venture arrangements.
Allotment Committee
	•
Approves the allotment of shares within dilution limits 
and within the authorities obtained from shareholders.
Operations Committee
	•
Manages operational performance.
Treasury Operating Committee
	•
Reviews the Group’s treasury arrangements and approval 
of changes to debt facilities.
	•
Obtains Board approval for certain types of facility and 
where the facility is above the levels delegated to the 
Treasury Operating Committee.
Safety, Health and Environment 
Operations Committee 
	•
Develops the SHE strategy for the Group. 
	•
Ensures that SHE policies and procedures are adequately 
implemented and adhered to.
	•
Monitors the effectiveness of the Group’s SHE systems.
	•
Keeps up to date with changes in legislation surrounding 
SHE matters.
100
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

We recognise the importance of maintaining a sound system 
of internal controls to safeguard shareholders’ investment 
and the Company’s assets. As a Board we are responsible 
for establishing procedures to manage risk and oversee the 
work of management to ensure that the internal control 
framework is appropriate to support the Group in achieving 
its long-term strategic objectives. Our control framework 
is designed to mitigate business, operational, financial and 
reporting risks. Management own the risk management 
process, submit appropriate policies for our approval, 
implement appropriate procedures and provide relevant 
information to enable us to fulfil our duties. 
As a Board we set the risk appetite and tolerance levels 
for the Group and in doing so, consider the expectations 
of our shareholders and other stakeholders. As part of our 
risk management process, we review and approve our risk 
appetite and tolerance levels to ensure that they remain 
appropriate. Approved risk appetite levels for each of our 
Principal Risks are detailed in the Principal Risk tables on 
pages 65 to 70. 
Details of how we manage risk can be found on pages 63 
to 65 and information about how we monitor and review the 
effectiveness of our risk management and internal control 
systems can be found in the Audit and Risk Committee report 
on pages 117 to 118. Our risk management and internal 
control frameworks define the procedures to manage and 
mitigate risks facing the business, rather than eliminate 
risk altogether, and can only provide reasonable and not 
absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss.
On behalf of the Board
Caroline Silver
Chair
3 September 2024
Helping to create energy efficient homes at Kingsbrook.
Corporate Governance Report continued
Risk management and internal controls
101
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Nomination Committee Report
Committee members
Katie 
Bickerstaffe
Jasi Halai
Chris Weston
Jock Lennox
Caroline Silver
Chair of the Nomination Committee
Statement from the Chair of 
the Nomination Committee
I am pleased to present the Nomination 
Committee Report for FY24. It has been 
another busy year for the Committee in 
terms of appointments to the current Board 
and considering potential appointments 
to the combined Board once the two 
businesses are able to fully integrate.  
Board changes and succession planning
Following a thorough recruitment process the Committee 
recommended that the Board appoint Nigel Webb as a 
Non-Executive Director and member of the Audit & Risk, 
Nomination and Remuneration Committees with effect 
from 1 October 2023. Nigel brings a wealth of property 
investment and development experience and ESG strategy 
expertise to the Board which complements the skills of the 
other Directors. Nigel’s skills, knowledge and experience will 
be of great value to the Company over the coming years. 
 Members biographies and qualifications are shown on pages 90 to 92
 See page 95 for Committee meeting attendance
Nigel Webb
Caroline 
Silver
 
Quick facts1
	• The majority of Committee members are independent
	• 3 females on the Board
	• 1 female in a senior Board position
	• 1 Director from an ethnic minority background 
1	
As at date of this report.
Our approach to appointments, 
succession and evaluation
Focus in the reporting year 
	• Undertook an extensive review of the size and 
composition of the Board 
	• Conducted a robust recruitment process for the 
appointment of Nigel Webb as a Non-Executive Director
	• Assessed the skills, experience and knowledge necessary 
to drive the future strategy of the Company and strengthened 
the Committee’s oversight of the Board’s skills, knowledge 
and experience
	• Reviewed the succession plans for the Executive 
Directors and senior management
Priorities for FY25 
	• To assess the composition (including size and diversity) 
of the Board and its Committees following completion 
of the Redrow combination
	• Conduct induction processes for Matthew Pratt, Nicky 
Dulieu and Geeta Nanda on Barratt’s business and 
induction processes for the current Barratt Directors 
on Redrow’s business 
	• Map the key skills to drive the future strategy of the business 
against the skill set of the Directors to identify gaps and 
inform the role specification of future appointments
	• Oversee an effective handover of the Audit and Risk 
Committee Chair and Senior Independent Director 
roles should Jock Lennox step down from the Board 
on completion of his third three year term.
102
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement from the Chair of the 
Nomination Committee continued
Board changes and succession planning 
continued
As previously announced, we expect Matthew Pratt, Nicky 
Dulieu and Geeta Nanda to join the Board once either: (i) 
undertakings have been agreed with the Competition and 
Markets Authority (CMA) that address the CMA’s limited 
concerns in connection with the combination of Barratt and 
Redrow; or (ii) the CMA otherwise agrees to their appointment. 
Provided that they are appointed as Directors by the Board 
prior to the date of the AGM, Matthew, Nicky and Geeta will 
seek election by shareholders at the 2024 AGM. If they are 
not appointed prior to the date of the AGM, they will seek 
election by shareholders at the 2025 AGM.
Matthew, Nicky and Geeta bring a variety of skills, knowledge 
and experience to the Combined Board and I am pleased 
that their appointments will strengthen the overall diversity 
at Board level. 
During the year we held a detailed succession session with 
David Thomas where we considered the talent pipeline for 
key executive roles at Board and senior management level. 
Given that integration planning is underway, Committee 
members now meet with David immediately prior to each 
Board meeting to understand the discussions taking place 
about, and the impact on, our employees. We will continue 
to undertake detailed work on succession planning at 
Board and senior management levels to ensure we have 
a sufficiently diverse pipeline and the right skills and 
experience to drive our strategy forward.
Skills and experience of the Board
During the year, as part of our annual evaluation process, 
we reviewed the composition, skills, experience and diversity of 
the Board and its Committees. This identified opportunities 
to strengthen the skills matrix and the process by which 
we carry out our skills gap analysis. Board members were 
asked to identify the key skills needed on the Board to drive 
the future strategy of the business. The outcomes of this 
review will be mapped against the current Board’s skill set 
to identify any skill gaps which will help determine the role 
specification for any future non-executive appointments. 
When Matthew, Nicky and Geeta, join the Combined Board, 
we will update our skills matrix and map this against the 
skills gap analysis to ascertain if any gaps are satisfied.
Diversity and inclusion
We fully understand the importance of having diversity on 
the Board, not only in terms of skills and experience but also 
female and ethnic representation. Following my appointment 
as Chair in June 2023 and Jasi Halai’s appointment in 
January 2023, we meet the recommendations to have a 
woman in a senior Board position (Chair, CEO, CFO or SID) 
and to have at least one member on the Board from a 
minority ethnic background (as defined by the FTSE Women 
Leaders Review and the Parker Review). 
Whilst we were conscious that female representation on 
the Board fell to 33.33% following Nigel’s appointment 
in October 2023, we were confident that he was the 
best candidate for the role given his skills, knowledge 
and experience in property, construction and land. 
Strengthening diversity on the Board is and remains a key 
priority for the Committee and the Board. Subject to CMA 
clearance, the appointments of Matthew, Nicky and Geeta 
will strengthen the overall diversity of the Board, including 
diversity of industry skills, knowledge and experience in 
addition to gender and ethnicity. Female representation 
on the Combined Board will be 41.67%.
Information on the Board’s diversity targets as required by 
the UK Listing Rules, together with accompanying numerical 
data, is set out on pages 106 and 107. Further information 
on the Company’s progress on diversity and inclusion 
initiatives can be found on page 108 and in the Strategic 
Report on pages 31 and 32.
FY25 priorities
Following completion of the Redrow combination, the 
composition (including size and diversity) of the Board and 
its Committees will be a key focus area in FY25 to ensure 
that we continue to have the right combination of skills and 
industry experience to provide effective challenge, guidance 
and support to management and drive the business 
strategy forward.
The induction of Matthew Pratt, Nicky Dulieu and Geeta 
Nanda will also be a key focus in the year ahead to ensure 
that they quickly build key stakeholder relationships. It will 
also be important for the Combined Board to gain a sound 
understanding of the enlarged Group so that it can apply its 
extensive and wide-ranging experience to drive the strategy 
and achieve synergies.
In July 2025 Jock Lennox will have completed nine years 
as a Non-Executive Director on the Board. Discussions are 
underway with Jock to determine if he will be stepping 
down from the Board and, if required, who will succeed 
him as Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee and the 
Senior Independent Director.  
Further details of the work undertaken by the Nomination 
Committee during the year are set out on the following pages.
Caroline Silver
Chair of the Nomination Committee 
3 September 2024
Nomination Committee Report continued
103
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Q&A
with Nigel Webb 
Caroline Silver asked Nigel about his 
experience of joining Barratt.
What were your first impressions 
on joining the business?
Prior to joining the Board I had some previous 
experience of Barratt on two joint ventures I had 
negotiated with my previous employer, British Land. 
Those relationships gave me a very positive view of 
the Company and its professionalism, strength of 
leadership and purpose. Joining the Board has only 
reinforced those positive opinions. Going around the 
business I have seen how dedicated and motivated 
our teams are in delivering first class homes for 
our customers and striving to maintain our industry 
leading customer experience. It really is an honour 
to join the Board.
How effective have you found your 
induction programme in preparing you 
for the Barratt Board discussions?
The induction process has been first class, thorough 
and enjoyable and has really helped me get a good 
understanding of the business. It involved over 20 
one-to-one meetings with members of the Board 
and senior management team, key external advisers 
including legal advisers, corporate brokers, bankers 
and auditors. It really did help me to hit the ground 
running and reinforced my positive views on the quality 
of the people and how well the Company is run.
Out of our values, which one do you 
resonate with the most?
Each of our four values are very powerful and what 
makes us the Company and team we are. However, 
if I had to single out one that most resonates with 
me it would be “We do it right”. Doing things the right 
way, treating our customers, our suppliers and our 
people in the right way is essential. It helps to define 
us and maintain our market leading position. Doing 
what is right is important to me personally and aligns 
very much with my own personal values.
In what ways do you think your 
role will contribute to the Board’s 
overall effectiveness?
As someone who has spent a career in property 
development, acquiring sites, securing planning 
and delivering complex projects, I believe I bring 
additional skills to complement the wealth of skills 
that already exist on the Board to help the Company 
achieve its strategic goals. 
How important is a company’s culture 
to you and what are your views on 
Barratt’s culture?
Having the right culture within the Company is 
essential. It is what binds the Company together and 
provides a sense of belonging and team spirit and 
a shared sense of purpose. From my limited time 
on the Board, that positive culture, together with 
strong values and the sense of pride in what we do, 
is clearly evident throughout the business. 
Do you have any other thoughts or 
ideas you would like to share with 
colleagues based on your first few 
months on the Board?
As we all know, it has been a very challenging few 
years battling some severe economic headwinds. 
Whilst we are not entirely “out of the woods” it feels 
that we are starting to turn the corner and that better 
times are ahead. This improving backdrop, coupled 
with the Combination makes for a really exciting 
future for the business as THE leading house builder 
in the country. I very much look forward to getting 
to know more people in the business and helping in 
whatever way I can to deliver a successful future for 
the business.
Nomination Committee Report continued
NW
NW
NW
NW
NW
NW
CS
CS
CS
CS
CS
CS
104
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Priorities
Work carried out and outcomes
Governance
Reviewed training and development needs 
for the Board and identified innovation 
in construction and housebuilding as a 
key area for development to facilitate the 
consideration of alternative areas for the 
business to explore. 
Composition 
and succession
Considered candidates and proposed 
the appointment of Nigel Webb as an 
additional Non-Executive Director.
Conducted an extensive review of the 
size and composition of the Board and 
its Committees, assessed the skills, 
experience and knowledge necessary to 
drive the future strategy of the Company, 
and strengthened oversight of Directors’ 
skills, knowledge and experience.
Considered succession plans for 
Non‑Executive Directors, Executive 
Directors, Executive Committee and 
Regional Managing Directors, taking into 
account the need for diversity and the 
future strategic direction of the Company. 
Directors’ conflicts of interest
The Board has authorised the Committee to oversee the 
process for reviewing and making recommendations to 
the Board concerning any actual or potential conflicts of 
interest that may arise for any Board member, including 
details of any terms and conditions that it deems necessary 
to impose on any authorisation given. Throughout FY24, 
the Company Secretary maintained a register of Directors’ 
conflicts of interest, a summary of which was reviewed at 
each Board meeting to ensure it remained accurate and 
current throughout the year. As a Committee, we review 
the full register on an annual basis, and recommend any 
changes to the authorisations that may be required to the 
Board. The Board, when authorising any conflict or possible 
conflict of interest, does not count in the quorum the Director 
whose conflict or possible conflict is being discussed and 
reserves the right to exclude a Director from a meeting whilst 
a conflict or possible conflict is being considered. The 
Board may revoke or vary any authorisation at any time.
During the year we updated the Committee’s Terms of 
Reference to strengthen oversight of the time involved 
in candidates’ other significant commitments prior to 
recommending their appointment to the Board. The Committee 
monitored the time commitments and conflicts of interest 
relating to the external appointments of existing Directors 
throughout the year. 
I am pleased to confirm that these procedures have 
operated effectively during the year.
Nomination Committee role and 
activity FY24
Role and main activities undertaken by the 
Committee during the financial year 
In addition to its annual tasks, such as the review of its 
Terms of Reference, effectiveness and approval of this 
report, the Committee carried out the following work 
during the year:
Board changes and succession planning
Succession planning is a live topic at Committee meetings. 
All appointments and succession plans are objective, based 
on merit and the need to promote diversity.
We annually review the length of service for each Non‑Executive 
Director, to determine if a new appointment needs to be 
made to replace anyone that may need to retire, taking into 
account the cyclicality of the business, as lessons gained 
through one property cycle can be useful during the next.
We discuss the succession plans for the other Executive 
Directors and senior management below Board level with 
the Chief Executive as well as his own succession. During 
the financial year we held four meetings with the Chief 
Executive to discuss succession plans and identify suitable 
individuals to fill senior managerial or Board positions in the 
future as well as determine and address their development 
needs. As part of their development, senior managers are 
invited to attend part of a Board meeting to present on 
their specialist area. This also enables the Board to assess 
the quality of internal talent, and for the individual to get 
a greater understanding of the workings of the Board.
During the year we discussed ways for certain Regional 
Managing Directors and individuals in other key roles to  
gain increased exposure to Group-wide matters to develop 
high-potential employees and strengthen the internal talent 
pipeline. 
Succession plans are in place across the business for the 
wider workforce and our work on developing our employees 
is set out in the Strategic Report on pages 30 to 31. When 
considering succession plans, the Board remains cognisant 
of the need to ensure that there is a diverse range of individuals 
included in the plan. The business continues to promote 
diversity and inclusion from within, and further details of 
the work that has been undertaken in this area can be 
found on pages 31 to 32 and page 108.
Nomination Committee Report continued
105
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board appointment process
Induction
Nigel has been through a detailed induction process 
designed to give him a good understanding of the business 
and how it operates to help him fulfil his role effectively. 
As part of this, he received a comprehensive induction 
pack, and had meetings with each of:
	• the other Board members;
	• the Company Secretary;
	• members of the Executive Committee;
	• the Regional Managing Directors and teams (at the 
regional offices);
	• heads of key Group functions;
	• key external corporate advisers; and
	• the external auditor.
His induction also included two individual site visits in 
addition to the Board visit to David Wilson and Barratt sites 
in Cambridge. During the year Nigel, together with one of 
our Regional Managing Directors, visited a plot of land the 
Company was looking to acquire and fed his thoughts back 
to the Board, which subsequently approved the acquisition. 
Caroline Silver met with Nigel to listen to his views and 
feedback on the induction process, which was seen to be 
comprehensive and well structured. 
 Nigel’s thoughts on his induction process can be found on page 104
Reappointment and re-election of Directors
Non-Executive Directors are appointed by the Board for up 
to three three-year terms subject to annual shareholder 
re-election and a particularly rigorous review prior to a 
third term being agreed. Non-Executive Directors will 
normally step down from their position on the Board and 
its Committees at the AGM following their ninth anniversary. 
The length of tenure of the Non-Executive Directors is 
shown on page 95. 
In July 2025 Jock Lennox will have completed nine years as 
a Non-Executive Director and the Committee is in discussion 
with Jock to determine whether he will step down from the 
Board at the 2025 AGM and not offer himself for re-election.  
Each of the Directors has been subject to a formal 
performance evaluation process during the year, as set 
out on page 111, and we are satisfied that each Director 
continues to be effective in, and demonstrates commitment 
to, their respective roles. All Directors will be standing 
for re-election at the forthcoming AGM. Subject to CMA 
clearance and being appointed to the Board prior to the 
AGM, Matthew Pratt, Nicky Dulieu and Geeta Nanda will 
stand for election.
Diversity and inclusion
Board diversity
During the year, the Board reviewed its policy on diversity 
and inclusion. The objective of the policy is to ensure 
that diversity is reflected within the composition of the 
Board, its committees and throughout the business in its 
broadest sense, including gender, ethnicity, age, disability, 
religious belief, sexuality, social class, education, experience 
and ways of thinking. The policy aims for continuous 
improvement at Board and senior management level on 
all these elements of diversity and to identify the most 
suitable candidate to join the Board and its Committees 
having regard to the individual’s skills, experience and 
knowledge. It also seeks to ensure that, in managing any 
senior appointment and in succession planning more 
broadly, the Committee has regard to the recommendations 
of the Parker and the McGregor-Smith Reviews on ethnicity 
and race and the benefits of diversity, including gender, 
ethnicity, social background and cognitive and personal 
strengths. Diversity is addressed as part of the annual 
evaluation of the Board and its Committees.
 Progress on diversity and inclusion can be found on pages 31 and 32. 
The main objectives of our policy, how they are implemented and 
progress towards them are set out on page 108
 
 A copy of our Board Diversity Policy can be found at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/sustainability/our-policies
Stage 1 
We review the length of tenure of each Non-Executive Director, 
determine the gaps in experience and consider the existing 
balance of gender, ethnicity and social backgrounds on the 
Board to help identify the need to recruit. Following the early 
departure of Sharon White in June 2023 we agreed to identify 
and appoint at least one Non-Executive Director. 
Stage 2 
We reviewed and approved an outline brief and role specification, 
and appointed Russell Reynolds1, to identify suitable candidates 
from a diverse pool of individuals and delegated authority to a 
sub-Committee led by Caroline Silver to select candidates for a 
short-list. 
Stage 3 
We met with the short-listed candidates and the preferred 
candidates went on to meet the remaining members of 
the Board. 
Stage 4 
We agreed Nigel Webb as the preferred candidate, based 
on his range of skills, experience and knowledge that 
complemented those of the existing Board members 
and recommended his appointment to the Board. 
Stage 5 
The Board considered the appointment of Nigel on its 
merits and approved his appointment with effect from 
1 October 2023. 
Nomination Committee Report continued
1	
Russell Reynolds Associates are occasionally requested to assist the Company with searches for senior management positions. They have no other connection with the individual Directors or the 
Company. Russell Reynolds Associates is accredited by the Enhanced Voluntary Code of Conduct for Executive Firms for its support to FTSE 350 Boards in increasing gender diversity. It is also a 
Co-Founder of The 30% Club, an advocate for improved gender balance on boards. Specific guidance was given to Russell Reynolds Associates to ensure diversity within the candidate long and 
short-lists whilst identifying candidates who had the relevant skills and experience required on the Board. 
Nomination Committee role and 
activity FY24 continued
106
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Diversity and inclusion continued
Board diversity continued
In accordance with the UK Listing Rules, the following tables detail the diversity profile of 
the Board and the Executive Committee as at 30 June 2024. This data was collated from 
our HR database which has been populated using information provided by each individual 
employee, including Non-Executive Directors. Diversity information for employees below 
the Executive Committee can be found on pages 30 to 32. Subject to Matthew Pratt, Nicky 
Dulieu and Geeta Nanda joining the Board, we will have five women on the Board (41.67%) 
and two Directors from an ethnic minority background.
Reporting table on gender representation as at 30 June 2024
Number
 of Board
 members
Percentage
 of the 
Board
Number 
of senior
positions
on the Board
 (CEO, CFO,
 SID and
 Chair)
Number
 in executive
management
Percentage
 of executive
 management
Men
6
66.7
3
4
50.0
Women
3
33.3
1
4
50.0
Reporting table on ethnicity representation as at 30 June 2024
Number
 of Board
 members
Percentage
 of the 
Board
Number 
of senior 
positions
on the Board
 (CEO, CFO,
 SID and Chair)
Number
 in executive
management
Percentage
 of executive
 management
White British or 
other White 
(including 
minority‑White 
groups)
8
88.89
4
6
75.00
Asian/Asian British
1
11.11
0
1
12.50
Black/African/
Caribbean/
Black British
0
0.00
0
1
12.50
1	
A full explanation regarding diversity is provided in the Chief Executive’s Statement on pages 31 and 32 of this report.
Ersham Park, Hailsham
Nomination Committee Report continued
107
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Diversity and inclusion continued
Diversity and inclusion throughout the business 
The Nomination Committee and the Board recognise the importance of a diverse workforce, at all levels of seniority. Promoting diversity at senior management level, and 
more generally across the workforce, remains an objective for David Thomas, our Chief Executive. David, together with the new Group HR Director, will continue to support 
the Group Head of Diversity and Inclusion, to drive the agenda forward in this area and undertake full review of the overall strategy for 2025. The Group’s aim is for its 
employee profile to mirror that of the communities in which it operates and provide an inclusive culture, where everyone can thrive. Further information on the Group’s 
progress on diversity and inclusion can be found on pages 31 and 32. The main objectives, how they are implemented and progress towards them are set out below.
Objectives
Implementation
Progress
Talent: HR processes that 
support a wide range of 
skills and backgrounds
Ensure we have a detailed 
understanding of our people 
and their needs
Review the HR lifecycle 
activity and ensure it 
is inclusive
Tailored support 
programmes and 
early careers
Alongside our continued quarterly scorecard that reports levels of representation by grade, function and team for gender and 
ethnicity, we asked key demographic questions in an employee engagement survey to help us understand our population in 
more detail. This included questions relating to caring responsibilities and social mobility markers as recommended by the Social 
Mobility Commission. 
Across the HR lifecycle we have made changes to ensure a more inclusive approach; this has included moving to diverse short-lists 
for all roles, inclusive recruitment training for all hiring managers, support for carers following the launch of our Carers Leave Policy 
and toolkits for employees and managers to support the menopause. Catalyst, a female support programme, has run for another 
successful year, with its largest intake so far, and following a successful pilot Spotlight, our support programme for ethnic minority 
colleagues, is in its second successful year. Employees are encouraged to self-nominate and the sessions are externally facilitated.
Leadership: role models 
and allies – leading 
the change
Leading 
inclusivity workshops
Support difference 
– employee network 
sponsorship
Reverse mentoring
Our dignity and respect training for leaders has been rolled out to all our Divisional Directors and Group Service Centre Heads 
of function. We have now also begun delivering this to full divisions across the country. 
Each of our employee networks has an Executive Committee member as their sponsor, who supports the activities 
and objectives of the respective group. 
Both our gender and ethnicity support programmes include reciprocal mentoring, which is an opportunity for both our 
leadership mentors and the programme mentees to share and learn. 
We have established Regional Diversity and Inclusion Committees across the country, to support open dialogue to the 
regional senior leadership teams on areas to address and successes. This is also creating collaboration across divisions 
and ensuring we share best practice.
Shift attitudes: support 
our people’s understanding 
to create the right 
experience for all
Hear the employee voice
National Inclusion Week 
Dignity and 
respect awareness
We have six employee network groups, offering a range of activities from webinars, leading discussions, marking of key events 
and signposting support – gender (now including a sub-group for Women on Site and Tools), Ethnicity, Culture and Religion, 
Disability, Families (including Carers) and LGBT+. A member of the Executive Committee sponsors each network.
National Inclusion Week in September 2023 saw each network celebrate its role models and offer insightful and educational 
pieces, from blog posts to podcasts. We have over 3,200 views and all our networks saw an increase in membership. 
Across a variety of delivery methods, we have continued to embed the importance of treating each other with dignity and 
respect, valuing difference in each other. Face-to-face training, poster campaigns, including on-site, and a section in our-site 
induction help support the message right through to sub-contractors. 
Please refer to page 51 for more information on the Workforce Forum.
Nomination Committee Report continued
108
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Board and Committee evaluation 
Each year, the Board undertakes a formal and rigorous annual evaluation of its own performance and that of its Committees and individual Directors. Every three years, the Board 
undertakes an externally facilitated evaluation. The last one was carried out in 2022. This year’s evaluation was carried out internally by the Company Secretary. The next external 
evaluation is scheduled to be carried out for FY25.
Board and Committee evaluation process for FY24
Stage 1 
Online questionnaires issued to Board 
and Committee members, and also to 
those who attend Committee meetings 
on a regular basis.
Stage 2 
The Company Secretary 
reviewed the responses 
received and prepared a 
consolidated report for 
each of the Board and its 
Committees to consider.
Stage 3 
The reports were 
shared with each of the 
respective Chairs.
Stage 4 
Results were 
presented and 
discussed at the June 
or August Board and 
Committee meetings.
Stage 5 
Actions for improvement 
were agreed for the next 
financial year, as set 
out below.
Progress on FY23 evaluation
Progress made against the outcomes of the internal Board evaluation undertaken in FY23 is set out below:
The Board
Board composition
Strategy
Diversity and inclusion
FY23 outcomes
To ensure that the Board continues to have the 
appropriate skills, experience and diversity to help 
drive the Group’s strategy forward.
To review the existing strategy, market evolution 
and future direction of the business.
Focus on further developing the Group’s diversity and 
inclusion agenda and increasing diversity on the Board 
and throughout the business.
Progress in FY24
The Nomination Committee identified that the Board 
required a Non-Executive Director with land and 
construction experience to complement the existing 
skills of the incumbent Directors and recommended 
the appointment of Nigel Webb, which was subsequently 
approved by the Board. 
The Board held a strategy day during the year with 
presentations from external experts to aid discussion 
on the appropriateness of the current strategy. 
Diversity and inclusion was added as a bonus metric 
for senior management. The metric will be cascaded 
to a further 300 employees for FY25. 
The Board looks forward to enhancing the diversity and 
skills on the Board post-completion of the combination. 
Nomination Committee Report continued
109
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Progress on FY23 evaluation continued
Key areas of improvement for the Committees
Nomination Committee
Audit and Risk Committee
Remuneration Committee
FY23 outcomes
Continue to focus on Board, 
Executive Directors and senior 
management succession.
To hold additional deep-dive and training sessions to support the Committee’s 
understanding of current and emerging topics, including the impact of potential 
changes to the various governance and audit landscape.
To continue to consider the structure of meetings to ensure that there is 
sufficient time allocated to address changes that may be required to the 
Committee’s remit in response to the implementation of any governance 
and audit proposals during FY24 or beyond.
Consider ways to streamline the 
metrics used for short and long-term 
incentive schemes.
Progress in FY24
During FY24 the Committee held two 
meetings with the Chief Executive to 
discuss succession plans for him, the 
other Executive Directors and senior 
management. In addition, the Chair held 
separate meetings with the Executive 
Directors to get their views on their own 
succession. Working with the Group 
HR Director, a clear plan to identify 
and develop internal candidates to 
succeed the Executive Directors, at the 
appropriate time, has been developed.
Having evolved the way in which risk is identified, assessed and monitored across 
the organisation including by the Committee and the Board, deep-dive sessions into 
each of the principal risks have started to be scheduled for each Committee meeting. 
In June 2024, the Committee undertook a deep dive into the risks around our supply 
chain and the mitigations, controls and assurance around these. 
Deloitte LLP provided regular updates on the new UK Corporate Governance Code 
which has enabled the Committee to determine the steps it needs to take to ensure 
that the Group can meet the new requirements. 
The annual agenda was reviewed during the year and updated to take into account 
changes to the Committee’s remit that are required as a result of the new UK Corporate 
Governance Code. 
With the appointment of the Group 
HR Director a full review of the metrics 
and structure of the annual bonus 
schemes was commenced during 
the year. In addition, the Committee 
considered the metrics for the 
LTPP award. Given the combination 
with Redrow, the Remuneration 
Committee and management will be 
reviewing the Remuneration Policy, 
structure and metrics as part of the 
integration process.
FY24 Board effectiveness evaluation outcomes
Overall, the results of the evaluation were positive and showed that the Board continues to be run effectively. It is seen as being cohesive and comprising the appropriate balance of 
experience, skills and knowledge to implement the Group’s strategy. Board meetings operate in a spirit of openness, fostered by the Chair, in which Directors are able to challenge and 
discuss openly ideas of importance to the Group, its strategy and risk.
Key areas of improvement for the Board
Succession
Integration
Interaction with stakeholders
FY24 outcomes
Have greater visibility over the talent pipeline.
Successfully integrate the Redrow business and start 
to deliver synergies.
Gain a better understanding of stakeholders’ interests 
and concerns during uncertain market conditions and 
the integration period.
Actions for FY25
Increase the level of interaction between the Board 
and individuals named in the succession plans. 
Monitor progress against the integration and 
synergies plan.
Identify a range of events and opportunities in which 
individual Board members can participate and feed 
back to the Board.
Nomination Committee Report continued
110
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

FY24 Board effectiveness evaluation outcomes continued
The Committees
Nomination Committee
Audit and Risk Committee
Remuneration Committee
FY24 outcomes
Continue to develop the Committee’s approach to 
succession for Executive and Non-Executive Directors 
and senior management.
Continue to seek and develop talent at 
executive level.
Ensure that members of the Board and senior 
management have the appropriate skills, knowledge 
and experience to guide the business through 
the integration with Redrow post CMA clearance 
and to deliver the synergies identified as part of 
the Combination.
Continue to evolve the risk management process 
including the internal control framework and 
assurance process.
Ensure adequate processes and reporting are in place 
to enable the Committee to monitor progress with the 
synergies in respect of the combination. 
To ensure that the Remuneration Policy, strategy and 
performance metrics are appropriate to support the 
Combination and deliver the synergies.
Actions for FY25
Continue with the succession planning meetings with 
the Chief Executive.
Working with the Group HR Director develop a process 
to identify talent and the support required for their 
development to create a diverse succession pipeline.
Continuously monitor progress with the integration 
and delivery of synergies and consider with the Chief 
Executive whether any other skills are required to 
drive this forward.
Continue to support the work being undertaken by 
the Director of Risk and Audit in enhancing the risk 
management process.
Work with management and the Director of Audit and 
Risk to identify and agree the process and reporting 
required to give full visibility of progress on synergies.
To review the Group’s Remuneration Policy to ensure 
it remains fit for purpose and adequately supports 
the Combination.
To consider how performance metrics for short and 
long-term incentives may be streamlined and support 
the Combination.
To review and, if required, adjust the metrics 
of any in-flight, long-term incentives to reflect 
the Combination. 
Evaluation of individual Directors
In May 2024, a questionnaire was issued to all Directors to assess the effectiveness of Caroline Silver, in her capacity as Chair of the Board. The Senior Independent Director discussed 
the comments and views expressed with the Non-Executive Directors and then provided the feedback to Caroline. Caroline was seen as being supportive but appropriately challenging, 
managing meetings with professionalism and ensuring each Director had the opportunity to express their views. Despite her other commitments, Caroline was seen to be available 
and flexible, maintaining a high level of engagement with the Company, management and members of the Board. During FY24, the Chair held one-to-one meetings with each Director 
to assess the effectiveness of their contributions, the appropriateness of their experience and the effectiveness with which they utilised that experience in furthering the Company’s 
strategy. Any areas of improvement or training and development were agreed. There were no issues of any substance arising from these meetings.
This report forms part of the Corporate Governance Report and is signed on behalf of the Nomination Committee by:
Caroline Silver 
3 September 2024
Chair of the Nomination Committee
Nomination Committee Report continued
111
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Audit and Risk Committee Report
Audit, risk and internal control
Statement from the Chair of 
the Audit and Risk Committee
I am pleased to present the Audit and Risk 
Committee’s Report for the year ended 
30 June 2024.
This report sets out our work and how our responsibilities 
in relation to audit, risk and internal control have been 
implemented. We work closely with our Finance and 
Internal Audit teams, and with Deloitte LLP to ensure that:
	• our risk and internal control processes remain robust 
and continue to adapt;
	• our financial reporting remains clear; and
	• our critical accounting judgements and key sources of 
estimation uncertainty are appropriate.
Areas of focus FY24
Risk Management and Internal Control
During the year we renamed the Committee to the Audit 
and Risk Committee and reviewed the annual cycle of 
work to extend its scope to monitor the Group’s risk 
management processes and activities. This was a natural 
step given the continued development of the role of risk 
management alongside internal controls and the oversight 
by the Committee.
The approach to risk management and internal control is 
based around the Group’s principal risks. In anticipation of 
the Audit Reform changes we have taken steps to enhance 
our risk management, internal controls and assurance 
processes. This has resulted in a more integrated process 
Committee members
Quick facts
	• All members of the Committee are independent 
Non-Executive Directors 
	• Jock Lennox and Jasi Halai have recent and relevant 
financial experience
	• The Committee as a whole has competence relevant 
to the sector in which the Group operates
 Details of Committee members’ skills and experience can be 
found on pages 90 to 92
Nigel Webb
Jasi Halai
Jock Lennox
Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee
Katie 
Bickerstaffe
Chris Weston
Our approach 
to managing risk
Jock Lennox
 Attendance at each meeting is set out on page 95
Focus in the reporting year 
	• Enhanced our risk management and internal 
control processes
	• Considered the impact of the acquisition of Redrow plc 
on risk management, internal controls and reporting
	• Continued to monitor and assess the accounting for, and 
control over, provisions for legacy buildings
	• Reviewed the Group’s reporting of and assurance obtained 
over sustainability performance
	• Continued our oversight of external audit
Priorities for FY25 
	• Continue to scrutinise control over and provisions for 
legacy buildings
	• Consider integration risk related to the 
Redrow combination
	• Consider the implications of any changes in government 
policy for the housing market
112
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

that is grounded in a debate of our risks (including a Board 
risk workshop), considers mitigating actions and controls 
and oversees the assurance, including from Internal Audit, 
that gives comfort as to their operation. The process 
includes regular consideration of emerging and changing 
risk and the related evolution of our principal risks.
The Committee collectively and individually has reviewed 
this model in the year and was satisfied that it is fit for 
our purpose and will satisfy our reporting requirements 
as the recently announced changes to the UK Corporate 
Governance Code (including the FRC’s minimum standard 
for Audit Committees) are introduced.
A deep dive into each of the Principal Risks is presented to 
the Committee on rotation. At our meetings in June and 
August 2024 Supply Chain Resilience (including consideration 
of modern slavery and human rights) and Government 
Regulation were debated. In each case presentations 
were made by members of the management team, actions 
considered and next steps agreed.
Acquisition of Redrow plc
The Committee has considered the impact of the 
acquisition on both risk management and internal 
controls and financial reporting requirements. Various 
discussions have taken place with management and the 
external auditor, and the Committee has been satisfied 
that appropriate resources are being applied to the 
consequences for risk management and internal controls 
and that the financial reporting disclosures are appropriate.
Legacy Properties
At each meeting we received updates from management 
on the Group’s exposure to the risks derived from both 
fire safety relating to external wall systems (EWS) 
and the remediation required to reinforced concrete 
frames. Presentations were received from both financial 
management and the leadership of the Building Safety Unit. 
As can be seen in the results, further provisions were 
required in respect of EWS and reinforced concrete frames. 
In the period, certain additional buildings were brought into 
scope and risks were determined to require remediation. 
These buildings and risks had been previously disclosed as 
contingent liabilities. The risk that further liabilities could 
arise is still disclosed within contingent liabilities, but 
the rate of emergence of new buildings has declined. The 
development of these issues and the assumptions for the 
remaining provisions have been subject to considerable 
debate with management and the Committee is satisfied 
that the conclusions reached and the timing of the 
provisions being recognised and utilised is appropriate.
Work is expected to continue for the next five years. The 
Committee has discussed the need to balance the pace of 
remediation with ensuring that the quality of the work being 
undertaken remains at satisfactory levels in line with our 
value of ‘We Do It Right’, given the demand on the supply 
chain. The Committee continues to seek comfort from 
management that the approach being pursued by them is 
consistent with the overarching objective that leaseholders 
should not be disadvantaged, and remediation is set at the 
appropriate level.
CMA investigation into information sharing
As has been commented on publicly and elsewhere in this 
report, the CMA launched an investigation into suspected 
breaches of competition law, relating to the exchange of 
competitively sensitive information, by eight housebuilders, 
including Barratt and Redrow in February 2024. 
This has been an important issue for the Committee to 
consider, involving discussions with both management 
and legal advisors. The Committee has received regular 
updates on the status of the investigation since its inception 
including the related risks. Regard has been given to the 
disclosure contained in this Annual Report, including those 
relating to contingent liabilities. Analysis and papers were 
received from management and our legal advisers, following 
review and discussion of which the Committee agreed that 
the conclusions reached on disclosure are appropriate.
Sustainability
During the year, the Committee reviewed the results of 
a benchmarking exercise which compared the Group’s 
disclosures and assurance of ESG metrics with those of 
peer companies. Following this review, we were satisfied 
that Barratt continues to obtain and disclose assurance on 
ESG related metrics in line with best practice across its 
peers. The extent of assurance and reporting is continuing to 
evolve, including in relation to scope 3, and the Committee 
continues to have oversight of this. 
The Committee debated the extent of the sustainability 
disclosure, and asked the Sustainability Committee, where 
I am a member, to do similarly. As a consequence, the 
structure and extent of sustainability reporting has evolved 
and can be found on pages 40 to 44 and pages 71 to 84.
Audit oversight
As a Committee, we continue to hold meetings with the 
external auditor and with the Director of Audit and Risk 
without the Executive Directors being present to discuss 
matters within our remit and provide them the opportunity 
to raise matters in private. I also meet separately with the 
external auditor and Director of Audit and Risk outside 
formal meetings. This included a meeting with the wider 
external audit team to understand their experience. 
Key areas of focus for FY25
We will continue to oversee the development of our 
approach to risk management and internal controls, 
including further deep dives into each of our principal risks. 
This will help us to ensure that we are well prepared for the 
adoption of the changes arising from the 2024 UK Corporate 
Governance Code and any that emanate from amendments 
to policy and legal requirements that are implemented by 
the new Government. 
In FY25 we will continue to oversee the provisioning for 
legacy properties; risk and control topics that emerge from 
the Redrow integration; the continuing development of our 
sustainability reporting; and any implications of the CMA 
investigation into information sharing.
Given that I will be coming up to my nine-year anniversary 
of joining the Board in July 2025, I will work closely with 
the Chair to ensure that everything is in place for me 
to handover the position of Chair of the Audit & Risk 
Committee to my successor, if I step down from the 
Board. I look forward to meeting shareholders at the 
forthcoming AGM.
Jock Lennox
Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee
3 September 2024
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Statement from the Chair of the 
Audit and Risk Committee continued
Areas of focus FY24 continued
Risk Management and Internal Control continued
113
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Role and activity of the 
Audit Committee
Membership and attendance at meetings 
Members of the Committee are set out on page 112. In addition 
to Committee members, the Company Secretary, Director 
of Audit and Risk, Group Director of Finance, Chair of 
the Board, Chief Executive, Chief Operating Officer, Chief 
Financial Officer and representatives from our external 
auditor attended each of the Committee meetings. Other 
executives and senior managers attended when appropriate 
for specific agenda items.
After each Committee meeting, it reports to the Board 
on the matters discussed and make recommendations 
as appropriate. 
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Priorities
Work carried out and outcomes
Integrity of 
Financial 
Statements and 
announcements
	• Reviewed the Annual Report and Accounts and assessed the processes which ensure it is fair, balanced and understandable.
	• Reviewed the full year and interim results announcements.
	• Reviewed the going concern statement.
	• Considered management’s analysis of significant accounting and audit issues, including the costs associated with legacy properties and their presentation in the 
Financial Statements, concluding that they remain appropriately provided and disclosed. 
	• Received regular updates on the status of the CMA’s investigation into suspected breaches of competition law by eight housebuilders, including Barratt and Redrow, 
and the potential risks and consequences of this. Considered the relevant disclosures in this Annual Report, including those relating to contingent liabilities.
Risk 
management 
and internal 
control systems
	• Oversaw improvements to the Group’s risk management framework, including the increase in scope of the Committee to cover risk management as the renamed 
Audit and Risk Committee and the introduction of a quarterly risk review by the Executive Committee.
	• Received a report from external advisers on the results of an assessment of the Group’s design risk controls and oversaw management’s plans and progress in 
implementing more effective design risk controls. 
	• Received regular risk updates from the Director of Audit and Risk.
	• Performed deep-dive reviews of supply chain resilience risk (including the availability of supply and modern slavery and human rights) and Government regulation risk.
	• Reviewed the effectiveness of the Group’s risk management and internal control processes, concluded that they continued to operate effectively and recommended 
to the Board that a disclosure to this effect be included in the Annual Report and Accounts. 
	• Reviewed the viability model.
	• Considered the implications of the 2024 Corporate Governance Code and the potential for more changes from the new Government. 
Committee effectiveness
The Committee has a carefully planned agenda of items 
of business to ensure that high standards of financial 
governance and risk management are maintained. 
There were four scheduled meetings during the year.
I have an open, constructive and collaborative relationship 
with management and meet with them and the external 
and internal auditors outside of meetings to share views 
and discuss key issues.
The Board evaluation for FY24, which is described more 
fully on page 109, included an appraisal of the performance 
of the Committee. The outcome of the appraisal was that 
the Committee is operating effectively and should continue 
to evolve the risk management and internal controls 
framework and ensure adequate processes are in place to 
monitor progress on the integration of Redrow, including the 
establishment of consistent financial and operating controls 
for the combined Group and the achievement of synergies.
 Further details can be found on page 109 
Role and main activities undertaken by the 
Committee during the financial year 
The main role of the Committee is to assist the Board in 
fulfilling its governance obligations relating to the Group’s 
financial and non-financial reporting practices and its risk 
management and internal controls framework.  
We review and agree an annual work programme to ensure 
that our role and responsibilities are completed throughout 
the year. In agreeing the annual programme, we consider 
the external environment, internal operation of the business 
and regulatory changes to ensure that all the main priorities 
are included. Following the increase to the Committee’s 
scope we conducted an interim review of our annual work 
programme to ensure additional responsibilities relating to 
the identification and management of risk would be duly 
covered during the year. 
During the year we carried out the following activities: 
114
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Priorities
Work carried out and outcomes
Internal audit
	• Confirmed that an internal quality self-assessment had been carried out by the internal audit function against IA standards for FY24 and concluded that the internal 
audit function continues to be effective.
	• Agreed internal audit’s programme of work for the year and reviewed progress against the plan. 
	• Approved the annual review and updates to the risk assurance map, setting out the assurance provided by each of the three lines of defence over the effective 
management of the Group’s principal risks. 
	• Reviewed and approved the Audit Charter ensuring that it is appropriate to the current needs of the organisation.
External audit
	• Reviewed the outcome of the Group’s external audit quality indicator assessment. 
	• Reviewed Deloitte’s audit plan for the Annual Report and Accounts, including key audit risks and divisional audit work performed around the business, and the 
progress of the audit.
	• Recommended to the Board the reappointment of Deloitte LLP as external auditor.
	• Reviewed and approved changes to the external auditor Non-Audit Services Policy.
Governance
	• Monitored progress of the finance strategy.
	• Updated the Terms of Reference to align with the FRC’s Minimum Audit Standards and enhanced the Committee’s oversight of risk management processes and 
the Company’s principal risks. 
	• Worked closely with the Remuneration Committee and the Sustainability Committee to ensure that target setting and performance measurement for the variable 
elements of the remuneration package were challenging, stretching yet achievable.
FY24 Financial Statements 
Significant issues considered during the financial year 
The issues considered by the Committee to be the 
most significant (due to their potential impact on the 
performance of the Group’s activities) in relation to the 
Financial Statements during the financial year are set 
out below.
1.	 Critical accounting judgements and key sources 
of estimation uncertainty
These are set out in the table on the following page.
2. Going concern
As a Committee, we:
	• concurred with management’s conclusion, and 
recommended to the Board, that the Company and the 
Group continue to be a going concern and that the Financial 
Statements should be prepared on a going concern basis;
	• using the Group’s business plan, assessed the Group’s 
available facilities, headroom and banking covenants;
	• reviewed management’s detailed analysis, which included 
forecasts, scenarios and sensitivities and the impact of 
the Combination;
	• considered the going concern requirements of the Code 
to ensure compliance; and
	• continued to monitor market conditions to ensure any 
appropriate adjustments are reflected.
We also reviewed management’s viability assessment of 
the Group and agreed that it was appropriate.
 Further details on the Group’s going concern assessments can be found 
in note 1 on pages 165 and 166, and the Group’s viability statement can 
be found on pages 85 to 87
3.	Financial reporting
We reviewed the integrity of the Financial Statements of 
the Group and the Company, and all formal announcements 
relating to the Group and Company’s financial performance.
This process included the assessment of the following 
primary areas of judgement and took into account the 
views of our external auditor.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Role and activity of the Audit Committee continued
Role and main activities undertaken by the Committee during the financial year continued
115
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Role and activity of the Audit Committee continued
FY24 Financial Statements continued
Significant issues considered during the financial year continued
3.	Financial reporting continued
Issue
The Committee’s response
External auditor challenge 
Outcome
Margin recognition
Development costs are allocated, on a site by 
site basis, between homes built in the current 
and future years. The Group’s site valuation 
process determines the profit margin for each 
site. Integral to this is the consideration of the 
completed development provision. This requires 
the estimation of future sales prices and costs 
to complete each site. Further detail is given in 
note 3 on page 168.
The Committee considered:
	• Assumptions and estimates as they related to build 
cost and sales prices in particular. The Committee also 
reviewed and validated the Group’s overall approach to 
margin recognition.
	• Internal audit feedback on adherence to the Group’s 
policies and procedures in the divisions.
	• The adequacy of the Group’s control structures around 
valuation and cost to complete, both from a systems 
and process standpoint.
Throughout the year, the external 
auditor has attended valuation 
meetings, reviewed land acquisition 
feasibility assessments and 
challenged cost-to-complete 
assumptions through analytic 
procedures and discussion with 
divisional management. A review 
of the key estimates in the margin 
calculation at a Group level was also 
undertaken to ensure the overall 
margin is appropriate.
As a result of its review, the Committee 
was comfortable with the approach 
taken by the Group on this key area 
of control, and also on the valuation 
of the Group’s WIP balance (including 
the assessment of the need for NRV 
provisions) and margin recognised.
Costs associated with legacy properties 
The Group has a liability for remedial work 
on its legacy property portfolio, in two areas: 
external wall systems (EWS) and reinforced 
concrete frames. Estimations of those 
cost provisions are to be sufficiently provided 
for and appropriately disclosed.
The Group has sought to respond appropriately 
to ongoing evolution in the regulatory environment, 
and to reflect sufficient provisions during 
a period of unit cost inflation and ongoing 
discovery in the known building portfolio.
Further detail is given in note 4 on page 169 
and note 19 on pages 187 and 188.
Regarding EWS, the Committee has reviewed and 
challenged the quantum of provisions held against 
specific buildings under review, considering the 
assumptions made regarding cost inflation and the 
number of buildings provided for. The adequacy of the 
assumed cost per unit has been a particular focus. 
On reinforced concrete frames, a review of the 
completeness of the provision held was undertaken 
during the year. In addition the Committee considered 
the nature of the Group’s liabilities between contingent 
liabilities and specific provisions, as well as the timing of 
recognition of those liabilities and potential liabilities.
The Committee also considered the adequacy of disclosures 
concerning the Housing (Cladding Remediation) (Scotland) 
Act 2024. 
The Group’s COO and Managing Director of the Building 
Safety Unit also attended the Committee to ensure 
members were appropriately and sufficiently informed 
of relevant matters.
The external auditor reviewed 
the controls implemented by the 
Group over the recognition and 
measurement of legacy property 
costs. For both the reinforced 
concrete frames and EWS provisions, 
they validated the balance recognised 
to supporting evidence and challenged 
the underlying management 
assumptions governing valuation 
and completeness.
The external auditor also challenged 
the appropriateness of the disclosures 
in the Financial Statements in relation 
to the provisions and associated 
contingent liabilities, including 
the adequacy of the disclosure of 
estimation uncertainty, and the 
presentation of legacy property 
costs as adjusted items.  
Based on this, the Committee was 
comfortable with the process and 
controls adopted by management 
around the disclosures, including 
contingent liabilities, and estimation 
of costs and provisions associated 
with legacy properties.
Fair, balanced and understandable considerations and conclusions
We received a draft of the Annual Report and Accounts prior to our August 2024 meeting, together with supporting material from management and the external auditor. At the meeting, 
we considered and assessed the process undertaken in drafting the 2024 Annual Report and Accounts to determine whether it was fair, balanced and understandable.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
116
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Role and activity of the Audit 
Committee continued
Considerations 
	• Feedback provided by shareholders on the FY23 Annual 
Report and Accounts.
	• Assurances provided in respect of the financial and 
non‑financial management information.
	• The balance between statutory and adjusted 
performance measures.
	• The internal processes underpinning the Group’s reporting 
governance framework and the reviews and findings of 
the Group’s external legal advisers and external auditor.
	• A report from the Company Secretary, which confirmed 
that: i) the process involved collaboration between 
various parts of the Group, including the Group Finance 
team, Company Secretariat, Group Communications, 
Investor Relations and the Sustainability team; ii) the 
Annual Report and Accounts had been reviewed by the 
Executive Directors; and iii) the Company had received 
confirmation from its external advisers that the Annual 
Report and Accounts adhered to the requirements of the 
Companies Act, the Code, the UK Listing Rules and other 
relevant regulations and guidance.
Conclusions 
The Committee concluded that the Annual Report and 
Accounts for the year ended 30 June 2024:
	• clearly, comprehensively and accurately reflects the Group 
and Company’s performance in the year under review;
	• contains an accurate description of the business model;
	• appropriately reflects the Group and Company’s purpose, 
strategy and culture;
	• includes consistent messaging and clear linkage between 
each of its sections; and
	• includes KPIs, which are consistent with the business 
plan and remuneration strategy.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Accordingly, we recommended to the Board that the 
FY24 Annual Report and Accounts is fair, balanced and 
understandable. The Board’s formal statement on the 
Annual Report and Accounts being fair, balanced and 
understandable is contained within the Statement of 
Directors’ Responsibilities on page 148.
Risk management and internal controls
During the year we renamed the Committee the Audit and 
Risk Committee and reviewed the annual cycle of work to 
extend its scope to monitor the Group’s risk management 
processes and activities. 
We monitor the Group’s risk management and internal control 
systems, including their effectiveness, on behalf of the Board. 
The key aspects are as follows:
	• a clear organisational structure with defined levels of 
authority and responsibility at all levels of the business;
	• financial and management reporting systems under which 
financial and operating performance is planned on a three-
year basis and budgeted annually. Financial and operating 
performance is consistently reviewed against budget 
and forecasts at divisional, regional and Group levels 
on a monthly basis, variances are explored and, where 
appropriate, changes made, and the information is used 
in the preparation of the Annual Report and Accounts;
	• regular risk updates from the Director of Audit and 
Risk to provide greater oversight of risk management 
activity, including the approach to risk management 
and risk identification; 
	• identification and review of principal operational risk 
areas to ensure they are embedded in the Group’s 
monthly management reporting system as routine 
aspects of managerial responsibility. Details of the 
risk management system and the principal risks are 
set out on pages 63 to 70;
	• assessment of compliance with risk management and 
internal control systems, including a consideration of 
controls over non-financial risks. This assessment is 
supported by the Group’s internal audit team, which is 
responsible for undertaking a risk-assessed annual audit 
plan, ad hoc audits and reporting to the Committee, 
and, if necessary, the Board, on the operation and 
effectiveness of those systems and any material 
failings. During the year we oversaw a detailed review 
of design risk controls and received regular updates on 
management’s plans and progress in implementing more 
effective controls in this area;
	• mapping of assurance procedures to the Group’s 
principal risks, to ensure that the mitigating controls 
are sufficiently robust; and
	• consideration and approval of the Group’s tax position 
and strategy.
The Group’s operations and financing arrangements expose 
it to a variety of financial risks that include the effects of 
changes in borrowing and debt profiles, Government policy, 
market prices, credit risks, liquidity risks and interest rates. 
There is a regular, detailed system for the reporting of daily 
cash balances and forecast cash flows from operations 
to senior management, including Executive Directors, to 
ensure that risks are promptly identified and appropriate 
mitigating actions taken. These forecasts are further stress 
tested at a Group level on a regular basis. In addition, the 
Group has in place a risk management programme that 
seeks to limit the adverse effects of the other risks on its 
financial performance, for example limiting its exposure to 
institutions with high credit ratings. Financing activities are 
delegated by the Board to the Treasury Operating Committee. 
Group Treasury operates according to treasury policies that are 
approved by the Board and the Treasury Operating Committee.
Our approach to risk management and internal control is 
based around the Group’s principal risks. In anticipation 
of the Audit Reform changes we have enhanced our risk 
management and internal control framework and assurance 
processes, resulting in a more robust process that 
debates risks (including a board risk workshop), considers 
mitigating actions and controls and oversees the assurance, 
including from internal audit, that gives comfort as to their 
operation. The process includes regular consideration of 
emerging and changing risk and the related evolution of 
our principal risks.
The Committee reviewed this model during the year and 
was satisfied that it is fit for purpose and will satisfy our 
obligations as the requirements of the 2024 UK Corporate 
Governance Code and the FRC’s minimum standard for 
Audit Committees are introduced.
117
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Role and activity of the Audit 
Committee continued
Risk management and internal controls 
continued
A deep dive into each of the Company’s Principal Risks will 
be presented to the Committee on rotation (being adaptable 
as necessary). At our meetings in June and August 2024 
Supply Chain Resilience (including consideration of modern 
slavery and human rights) and Government Regulation were 
debated by the Committee. In each case presentations 
were made by members of the management team, actions 
considered and next steps agreed.
During the year, in order to bring greater transparency to 
the assurance we receive and gain greater comfort over the 
Group’s management of risks and the accuracy of reporting, 
we reviewed:
	• a risk assurance map setting out the assurance already 
in place, using the three lines of defence model, to 
identify gaps or areas where improvement in assurance 
is required;
	• assurance mapping over the Group’s published financial 
and non-financial information. The Board made the 
decision to again appoint Deloitte to provide additional 
independent assurance over certain aspects of the 
Group’s climate-related disclosures, including TCFD 
and certain other non-financial information; and
	• the completion of the annual detailed fraud risk 
assessment exercise to identify, consider, and assess 
fraud risks in place across the Group and the associated 
controls and assurance in place to mitigate and 
manage these.
As Chair of the Committee, I have also considered the 
resource for assurance and the evolution of those resources 
over the past five years and I am satisfied that the assurance 
resources in place are appropriate for the size and 
complexity of the business. 
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Whistleblowing 
The Group has a clear whistleblowing policy and procedure, 
which is communicated to the workforce. Concerns can 
be raised by employees with managers, or can be reported 
anonymously to a confidential and independent hotline. 
The hotline is available 24 hours a day, and matters raised 
are notified to internal audit immediately by email. Matters 
requiring urgent attention (including corruption, human rights 
abuse and personal safety) are notified to the Director of 
Audit and Risk by phone immediately, including outside 
business hours. The internal audit function reviews matters 
raised, and ensures each matter is investigated or refers 
them to other relevant functions across the business, 
such as the Safety, Health and Environment or HR teams, 
to investigate as appropriate. Any substantive issues are 
raised with me as Chair of the Committee. The Director 
of Audit and Risk also updates the Committee on all 
significant whistleblowing incidents at each of its meetings. 
The Committee reviews the overall procedure, investigations 
and outcomes, as well as the availability and frequency of 
use of the whistleblowing hotline. 
As Chair of the Committee, I update the Board on 
whistleblowing reports and investigations on a regular basis, 
and the Board reviews the whistleblowing arrangements 
and discusses the most significant issues as appropriate.
Examples of whistleblowing reports received during the 
year included allegations of individual improper behaviour 
and minor theft of materials from site, all of which were 
thoroughly investigated and actions taken as appropriate. 
Internal audit 
Internal audit’s primary role is to provide independent, 
objective assurance to the Audit and Risk Committee 
as well as advisory support to help management make 
improvements across the business. The function is led by 
the Director of Audit and Risk who reports directly to the 
Chair of the Committee to maintain independence. 
The internal audit plan is driven by the Group’s strategy 
and principal risks and is approved six monthly by the 
Committee. In line with the approved audit plan, internal 
audit reviews the effectiveness and efficiency of the 
systems of risk management and internal control and 
monitors the activities of the Group in accomplishing 
established objectives. Reviews conducted in FY24 covered 
financial, operational and compliance controls as well as 
IT reviews. Following each review, a report is provided to 
management on the control framework in place together 
with appropriate improvement recommendations and 
follow-up processes ensure that recommendations are 
implemented in a timely manner. Progress against the 
internal audit plan and summaries of audit reviews are 
provided at each Committee meeting for review and discussion. 
The Director of Audit and Risk conducted a self-assessment 
during the year in order to assess the effectiveness of the 
function against the required IIA standards, professional 
practices and governance requirements and reported 
the results to the Committee, which concluded that the 
function continued to operate effectively. 
The Committee again considered the reporting line of the 
Director of Audit and Risk, and confirmed that it continued 
to be comfortable with the existing reporting line to the 
Chief Financial Officer given that the Director of Audit and 
Risk had regular formal meetings with the Chief Executive 
and any issues are reported to the Chief Executive in a timely 
manner. It was also comfortable with the independent 
relationship between the Director of Audit and Risk, the 
Chair of the Committee and the wider Committee. The 
Committee confirmed that it would continue to keep this 
reporting line under review.
External audit 
Audit performance and effectiveness
We annually review the external audit plan and process and 
again approved the audit of key risk areas earlier in the year 
to reduce pressure on the busy financial reporting period 
after year end.
In FY22 Deloitte was appointed, after a thorough tender and 
interview process, to provide assurance over our TCFD and 
certain other non-financial disclosures. The appointment 
and fees associated with this work are in accordance with 
our Auditor Independence and Non-Audit Fees Policy.
118
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

management. The Deloitte team expect to address the 
highlighted areas of focus in FY25.
During the audit, the external auditor challenged 
management’s judgements and assertions on the following 
matters in particular:
	• margin recognition and the related completed 
development provisions; and
	• valuation and completeness of provisions related to 
external wall systems and reinforced concrete frames on 
legacy developments.
Our response to these can be found in the relevant section 
of the table of significant issues on page 116.
We concluded that the external audit process as a 
whole had been conducted robustly, the external audit 
team selected to undertake the audit had done so 
thoroughly and professionally, and the external auditor 
had applied sufficient experience and understanding of 
the housebuilding industry, consulted with experts as 
necessary, and is of sufficient size to conduct the audit. 
Deloitte’s performance as external auditor to the Group 
during FY24 was therefore considered to be satisfactory.
In addition, we were satisfied that management had 
provided the external auditor with appropriate access to 
Barratt’s own people, systems, records and supporting 
information, whilst acting professionally and with appropriate 
challenge, enabling the audit to be conducted effectively.
Auditor independence and non‑audit fees 
 The Company’s policy on auditor independence and non-audit fees 
is available at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors/
corporate-governance 
The Company policy caps non-audit fees at 70% of the 
average audit fees over the previous three years. We 
continually monitor the ratio of non-audit to audit fees to 
ensure that it does not exceed this cap. For FY24, non‑audit 
fees (including audit-related assurance services) for the 
Company and its subsidiaries were £319k, representing 
26.2% of the total audit fee.
Non-audit fees based on the average of the previous three 
years’ audit fees were 29.9%. Further details of the audit 
and non-audit fees incurred by the Group can be found in 
note 3 on page 169. Non-audit fees incurred in FY24 were 
for work undertaken by the external auditor for the review 
of the half year report and also assurance provided over 
TCFD and certain financial and non-financial information 
disclosed in the Strategic Report and the unaudited section 
of the Remuneration Report.
This policy also sets out our duties as a Committee relating 
to the protection of the objectivity and independence of 
the external auditor. The pre-approval levels and conditions 
required for different non-audit services that might 
be required from the external auditor, together with 
prohibited services, are detailed in the Policy. It also 
sets out restrictions on the recruitment of employees 
from the external auditor. The policy was reviewed and 
updated in August 2023 to include a “third-party test”, 
which is the consideration of whether an objective, 
reasonable and informed third party would conclude that 
integrity or objectivity (and therefore independence) is 
not compromised. This analysis includes various factors 
such as the nature of the service, the level of fees and 
any other factors that may be relevant for a third party to 
understand the effectiveness of the safeguards and take 
into consideration both qualitative and quantitative factors. 
Following this change, non-audit services can only be 
provided by Deloitte if the third-party test is passed. 
The policy is in line with the auditor independence rules 
of the FRC’s Revised Ethical Standard 2019 and includes 
the FRC’s whitelist of permitted non-audit services. There 
are no conflicts of interest between the members of the 
Committee and the external auditor.
The Committee requires written confirmation annually 
from the external auditor that it remains independent. 
For FY24, the external auditor provided a comprehensive 
report to the Committee verifying that it had performed its 
audit and audit-related services in line with independence 
requirements and explaining why it believed that it 
remained independent within the requirements of the 
applicable regulations and its own professional standards. 
The report also explained why the ratio of audit to 
non-audit fees, and the extent and type of non-audit 
services provided, was appropriate. As a Committee we 
conducted our own review and endorsed the external 
auditor’s conclusions on compliance with the policy and 
independence of the external auditor.
Accordingly, we were satisfied that both the work 
performed by the external auditor, given its knowledge of 
the Group, and the level of non-audit fees paid to it, were 
appropriate and did not raise any concerns in terms of our 
external auditor’s independence.
Feedback from all stakeholders on the external audit. 
The external auditor’s fulfilment of the agreed audit 
plan for FY24.
Reports highlighting the material issues and 
critical accounting judgements and key sources of 
estimation uncertainty that arose during the conduct 
of the audit.
The external auditor’s objectivity and independence 
during the process, including its own representation 
about its internal independence processes.
The challenges raised by the external auditor during 
the audit.
External audit continued
Audit performance and effectiveness continued
In forming our conclusion on performance and effectiveness 
of the external audit, we reviewed amongst other matters:
I met with the leaders of the external audit team to assess 
their experience and understanding of Barratt. These interactions 
provided positive input on the effectiveness of the audit.
In assessing the effectiveness and performance of the 
external auditor, we also approved the Group’s approach 
to assessing audit quality. As in FY23, a questionnaire was 
circulated covering five significant audit areas. A wide range 
of internal stakeholders were included across the Group’s 
senior leadership. Four out of five areas were rated ‘good’, 
with some opportunity for improvement noted in project 
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
Role and activity of the Audit 
Committee continued
119
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

852
186
43
230
FY24 (£000)
£1,537
FY23 (£000)
£1,311
Total audit and 
non-audit fees
 Company audit 
 Subsidiaries audit
 Audit-related services
 Other services
FY22 (£000)
£1,189
680
262
37
210
Auditor rotation 
timeline
2007 
Deloitte appointed for 
FY08 audit
2017 
Deloitte reappointed 
following competitive tender
2026 
Competitive tender 
for FY28 audit, unless 
particular circumstances 
require an earlier tender
Role and activity of the 
Audit Committee 
continued
External audit continued
External audit tender
Deloitte was first appointed as external 
auditor to the Group in 2007, and was 
reappointed following a competitive tender 
in FY17. The Company has therefore complied 
with the provisions of the Statutory Audit 
Services for Large Companies Market 
Investigation (Mandatory Use of Competitive 
Tender Processes and Audit Committee 
Responsibilities) Order 2014 issued by the 
CMA on 26 September 2014. Jacqueline 
Holden has completed her second year as 
lead audit partner. Jacqueline was selected 
after an interview process involving me, 
supported by the then acting Chief Financial 
Officer. The external audit team’s second 
audit partner started for the FY20 audit and 
will be rotated for FY25. The new second 
partner has shadowed the team in FY24.
Under current regulations, the Company 
must appoint a new auditor for the audit 
of the year ended 30 June 2028. Given the 
continuing effectiveness of Deloitte in its 
role as external auditor, we currently believe 
it is in the best interests of shareholders 
for Deloitte to remain in role and for a 
competitive tender process to be completed 
in time for the FY28 audit. In December 
2023 we undertook a review of potential 
audit firms, both from the Big 4 and 
challenger firms that we could invite to 
tender for the Group’s audit when Deloitte’s 
tenure expires. The review focused on 
independence considerations and potential 
conflicts of interest given the requirement 
for the selected firm to be “clean” for FY27, 
a year ahead of their first audit in FY28. 
This will be kept under review in advance 
of the required tender.
Audit and Risk Committee Report continued
1,023
195
89
230
Whilst we currently intend for Deloitte to 
remain in role, we will continue to monitor 
its performance as external auditor and 
make recommendations accordingly.
The Group appointed UHY Hacker Young LLP 
as the auditor for certain of its subsidiaries 
and JVs with effect from the FY23 audits. 
This appointment followed a rigorous 
tender process. The timing of this audit 
work follows completion of the Group 
audit and therefore has no bearing on 
the scope of Deloitte’s audit. As well as 
realising some efficiency, this step provides 
the opportunity for one of the so called 
challenger audit firms to gain experience.
Assessment of the external auditor
Having considered the external auditor’s 
performance, we recommended to the 
Board that the external auditor remains 
independent, objective and effective in its 
role and therefore should be reappointed 
for a further year. On our recommendation, 
the Board is putting forward a resolution 
at this year’s AGM to reappoint Deloitte 
as external auditor for a further year. 
The recommendation of reappointment 
of Deloitte is free from influence by a 
third party and no contractual term of 
the kind mentioned in Article 16(6) of 
the Audit Regulation has been imposed 
on the Company whereby there would 
be a restriction on the choice to certain 
categories or lists of auditors.
This report forms part of the Corporate 
Governance Report and is signed on behalf 
of the Audit and Risk Committee by:
Jock Lennox
Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee  
3 September 2024
120
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Safety, Health and Environment Committee Report
Committee members1
Steven Boyes
Chris Weston
Chair of the Safety, Health and Environment Committee
Our approach to safety, 
health and the environment
Quick facts
	• One meeting during the year
	• All Committee members attended two SHE 
Operations Committee meetings during the year 
to keep updated on key developments and maintain 
oversight of progress against key actions 
	• The Committee Chair is invited to attend all SHE 
Operations Committee meetings
1	
In addition, Vince Coyle, Group Safety, Health and Environmental Director, is also a member 
of the Committee.
Chris Weston
 Attendance at each of meeting is set out on page 95
Focus in the reporting year 
	• Continued to monitor Injury Incidence Rate (IIR) and 
oversee the IIR improvement strategy 
	• Continued to review the requirements of the 
Building Safety Act and ensure our processes meet 
the legislation requirements
	• Strengthened support around mental wellbeing and 
occupational health 
	• Using technological advances to keep people on our 
sites safe
	• Ensuring that we are robust in our approach to protecting 
watercourses and preventing pollution
Priorities for FY25 
	• Continue to take action to improve our IIR
	• Further enhance activities around mental wellbeing 
and occupational health
	• Keep under review the requirements of the Building 
Safety Act and adapt accordingly
	• Continue to review our impact on the environment 
and how we mitigate against this
I am pleased to present this report which 
sets out the work of the SHE Committee 
throughout the financial year. 
The health and safety of our workforce, customers and the 
public, and the protection of the environment around our 
developments, has always been and will continue to be of 
paramount importance. We are therefore deeply saddened 
by the tragic accidental death of a sub-contractor at one 
of our sites in November 2023. We fully supported the 
investigation by the Health and Safety Executive which 
concluded that suitable safety arrangements were in place 
and that no action was to be taken against the Company. 
At the recent coroner’s inquest, the cause of death was 
recorded as “Accidental”. 
During the year, Lloyd’s Register Quality Assurance (LRQA) 
completed recertification audits against the health, safety 
and environmental international standards (ISO 45001 
and ISO 14001). Following the audit LRQA recommended 
our certification and noted that as an organisation 
we demonstrated a highly effective health, safety and 
environmental management system.
121
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Role and activities of the SHE Committee 
Our activities continue to focus on the prevention and 
mitigation of the key operational risks relating to health and 
safety, and the protection of the environment. By receiving 
reports and challenging those tasked with SHE performance 
where necessary, we help the business to improve its 
SHE standards. We support and oversee the direction 
and implementation of SHE Policy and procedures which 
encourage efficient working practices, and prevention of 
injury and illness, and support our continuous improvement 
strategy and ongoing sustainability of the Group.
We continue to work closely with the SHE Operations 
Committee, which is responsible for the implementation 
and oversight of the Group’s overall SHE improvement 
strategy on a day-to-day basis. 
After each Committee meeting, I report to the Board on the 
matters discussed and make recommendations as appropriate. 
Committee effectiveness
The Committee has a carefully planned agenda of items of 
business to ensure that all key items are covered during the 
year. I have an open, constructive and collaborative relationship 
with management and attend SHE Operations Committee 
meetings throughout the year to enhance my understanding 
of the operational issues faced by the workforce, and to 
discuss them, and ways to improve them, directly with those 
responsible for day-to-day SHE management. During the year 
I attended two SHE Operations Committee meetings. 
The Board evaluation for FY24 included an appraisal of 
the Committee’s performance. The appraisal concluded 
that the Committee was performing well with an excellent 
understanding of significant risk exposures relating to SHE 
matters and excellent oversight of compliance with the SHE 
management system. Driving continuous improvement and 
remaining conscious of the changing operating environment 
were identified as areas to focus on in FY25.
 Further details of the appraisal process can be found on page 109
Safety, Health and Environment Committee Report continued
FY24 areas of focus
Injury and ill health prevention has remained a key area of 
focus for the business throughout the year. Unfortunately, 
despite the ongoing action plan for continuous improvement, 
our Reportable Injury Incidence Rate (IIR) has increased this 
year, and is 302 per 100,000 persons against 289 in FY23. 
Our analysis indicates that the primary contributing factor 
for injuries is slips trips and falls, which are often attributed 
to inadequate housekeeping. During the year there has been 
a continued campaign to ensure “good housekeeping” which 
included awareness posters and briefings with specific 
emphasis on SHE Managers monitoring on site. This will 
be continued throughout FY25.
There has been an increased focus on SHE and required 
standards by our Divisional Leadership teams and site 
supervisors. We have also invited Groundworkers and 
Scaffolding contractors to seminars, focusing on performance 
updates and the standards that are expected from them on 
our sites. 
During FY24 near miss reporting has continued to improve, 
which is encouraging. In FY23 there were 647 near misses 
reported, and in FY24 this had increased to 1,480. This will 
remain an area that we will continue to drive in FY25, as 
learning about the potential for incidents will enable us to 
evaluate where we can implement processes to prevent a 
more serious event from occurring. 
Recognising the importance of protecting the environment 
that we are working in remains fundamental. In July 2022, 
the Environment Agency (EA) visited our Ladden Garden 
development and noted silt contamination in the brook 
adjacent to the development. In March 2024 the EA 
confirmed it had accepted our offer on an enforcement 
undertaking for the breach. As a result, £20,150 has been 
distributed to a number of local organisations that promote 
improvements in watercourses or the local environment. 
Following this incident we have conducted a full review of 
our environmental controls on site and introduced a site 
permit system to be in place for any dewatering activities. 
Our teams have also been trialling silt trap products that 
have shown to be more effective in preventing silt from 
entering the site drainage systems. 
Mental wellbeing and occupational health have been 
key focus areas throughout the year with the Committee 
updated on activities to strengthen support for colleagues 
and sub-contractors in these areas. During the year the 
Lighthouse Club, visited 55 of our sites and presented to 
over 1,700 colleagues to raise awareness of the charitable 
support services available to those in the construction industry. 
One of the most significant risks on our sites is managing 
people and plant interfaces, as we recognise any failures 
have the potential for a serious injury. This year we have 
been working with both of our telehandler providers to 
trial artificial intelligence (AI) technology to highlight to 
the driver and pedestrian if they are too close to a moving 
vehicle. The trials have been very successful and since 
January 2024, all new machines have this technology 
as standard.
Personal protective equipment (PPE) is essential for keeping 
people safe. However, the effectiveness of PPE is reliant on 
how well it fits the individual. In June 2024, we launched 
our new PPE catalogue. Amongst the new range we now 
have dedicated female PPE (including maternity wear), 
a wider range of footwear sizes and modesty tunics that 
enable colleagues to adhere to religious beliefs, and mental 
health first aiders (MHFA) can now be identified easily on 
site as they can have helmets with the MHFA logo.
During FY24 the Committee has reviewed the requirements 
of the new Building Safety Act. We have enhanced our existing 
processes and are continuing to work on responding to 
secondary legislation.
We have also made improvements to our offsite Group 
induction process, linking this to checking competency 
cards and site signing in. It is important to us that we 
ensure that persons working on our site are trained and 
competent and understand the risks that are present 
on our developments. We also recognise the potential of 
modern slavery so in FY24 we ran a campaign highlighting 
workers’ rights and how to raise concerns should someone 
see something they are unsure about.
I would like to thank the SHE team, our employees and 
sub-contractors for the great work that they undertake 
each day to keep our people safe.
This report forms part of the Corporate Governance Report 
and is signed on behalf of the SHE Committee by:
Chris Weston
Chair of the SHE Committee
3 September 2024
122
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Remuneration Report
Annual Statement from the Chair of the Remuneration Committee
Focus in the reporting year 
	• FY23 annual bonus and 2020 LTPP vesting outcomes
	• 2023 LTPP structure, performance conditions, weightings 
and targets
	• FY24 bonus targets and FY25 bonus structure and quantum
	• Remuneration implications of the Combination
Priorities for FY25 
	• Consider adjustments to in-flight performance conditions 
and targets to reflect the Combination
	• Consider if changes are required to the Remuneration 
Policy in light of the Combination
	• Monitor Executive Directors’ and senior management’s 
performance against targets, including synergy delivery
Remuneration Policy
The current Directors’ Remuneration Policy was approved at 
the Annual General Meeting in October 2023 with over 97% 
of shareholders voting in favour. In developing the Policy we 
considered a range of factors, including the Group’s purpose 
and strategic objectives, wider workforce remuneration 
arrangements and the views of our largest shareholders 
(with whom we consulted). 
FY24 performance and reward
The business has continued to deliver a strong operational 
performance throughout the year. In particular, we achieved 
14,004 total home completions (FY23: 17,206), whilst navigating 
a continuing challenging macroeconomic backdrop and 
political uncertainty.
The outcome for the FY24 annual bonus scheme was 89.9% 
of maximum. The 2021 LTPP award will vest at 15%. Further 
details can be found on pages 138 and 139. We carefully 
considered the incentive outcomes within the context of 
the underlying performance of the business. We ultimately 
decided that the outcomes were reflective of business 
performance. As a result, we have not used any discretion 
to determine these outcomes and have not adjusted any 
performance targets during the year.
Our approach 
to remuneration
Katie Bickerstaffe
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
Chris Weston
Caroline 
Silver
 
Jasi Halai
Jock Lennox 
Quick facts
	• Determines and agrees the policy for executive 
and senior management remuneration and ensures 
it takes account of the Group’s risk appetite and 
aligns to its long-term goals
	• Ensures remuneration is appropriate, enhances 
personal performance and rewards individual 
contributions towards the success of the Group
	• Designs and determines measures and targets for 
variable pay and approves payouts
	• Determines policy and scope of pension arrangements, 
share ownership and share retention policies, 
termination payments and compensation commitments
Committee members
Nigel Webb
Katie 
Bickerstaffe
 Members biographies and 
qualifications are set out on 
pages 89 to 92
 See page 95 for Committee 
meeting attendance
Statement from the Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee
I am pleased to present my report as Chair 
of the Committee and provide an overview 
of both Executive Directors and wider 
workforce remuneration for the financial 
year ended 30 June 2024 and how our 
Policy will be applied in FY25. 
123
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement from the Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee 
continued
FY24 performance and reward continued
2023 LTPP
In August 2023, we approved the structure, performance 
conditions and weightings for the 2023 LTPP and agreed 
the targets for the TSR and GHG emissions reduction 
performance conditions. However, given the prevailing 
market conditions at the time, we deferred setting the 
financial targets relating to the EPS and ROCE performance 
conditions and therefore deferred the grant of awards until 
later in the year. Market uncertainty continued throughout 
the year and in December 2023 we still did not consider it 
feasible to set realistic challenging but achievable financial 
targets for FY26. However, given that it would be considered 
highly unusual to further delay the LTPP, we agreed to grant 
the awards and determine the financial performance targets 
at a later date. The targets for Absolute Adjusted EPS and 
Underlying ROCE were agreed in June 2024 and can be 
found on page 140 and on our website: 
 www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors/corporate-governance 
FY25 remuneration
FY25 salary and fees
In light of the timing of the proposed Barratt Redrow combination 
(Combination), we have delayed conducting a benchmarking 
exercise until we are able to do so for the enlarged Group. 
For FY25 we have therefore decided to increase Executive 
Directors' salaries by 3% in line with the increase for 
the wider workforce. We believe that this increase is 
justified given the continued strength of our operational 
performance and the ongoing competitive landscape we 
face across the sector.
In addition, the Committee agreed a 3% increase in the 
base fee for the Chair. 
During the year, a committee of the Board comprising the Chair 
and the Executive Directors reviewed the Non‑Executive 
Directors’ fees and agreed to increase the base fee by 3% 
for FY25. Fees for members and Chairs of Committees 
remain unchanged.
FY25 annual bonus and 2024 LTPP
The performance measures for the FY25 annual bonus scheme 
are set out on pages 133 and 134 together with the rationale for 
selecting them. The key changes are the amended weightings 
of the quality and service measure and the expansion of 
the diversity and inclusion measure. We consider the actual 
targets to be commercially sensitive and will therefore disclose 
them with details of performance against them in the FY25 
Remuneration Report, in line with market practice.
The 2024 LTPP will be awarded to all eligible participants, 
including the Executive Directors, later this year. Within our 
Remuneration Policy, the Committee can make awards of 
up to 200% of salary to Executive Directors. The Committee 
continues to believe that TSR, Absolute Adjusted EPS, 
Underlying ROCE and GHG emissions reduction remain the 
most appropriate measures to align the Group’s performance 
with our strategy and the interests of stakeholders. Whilst 
we have considered standalone financial targets for the 2024 
LTPP, we are mindful that targets for our in-flight LTPP awards 
may need to be adjusted post completion of the Combination. 
It is our intention therefore that, once we have finalised a 
three‑year plan for the Combined Group, we will share these 
targets (hopefully in the second quarter of 2025) but for the 
moment have decided not to disclose these in this report.
Employees and remuneration
In setting our policy and agreeing outcomes for Executive 
Directors, we are mindful of the pay arrangements of the 
wider workforce.
The Group’s approach to colleague remuneration aims to 
promote the long-term sustainable success of the Company 
and attract, retain and motivate employees to support the 
achievement of the Group’s strategic key objectives. Our 
reward package is known within the housebuilding sector for 
being market leading, including private medical insurance for 
all employees and the FY23 salary supplement. Our annual 
salary review, which was effective from 1 July, saw a 3% 
increase across our wider workforce. 
We continue to seek the views of our Workforce Forum 
on our approach to pay. Further details on the Workforce 
Forum and the matters it discussed during FY24 can be 
found on pages 50 and 51.
We also continue to make an annual share award to 
colleagues below senior management via the Employee 
Long Term Incentive Plan (ELTIP) to recognise their 
dedication, commitment and loyalty. During the year we 
approved changes to the ELTIP rules and recommended 
that dividend equivalents be applied to the 2024 award.
Redrow combination 
During the financial year we spent considerable time 
discussing the impact of the Combination on the Group’s 
remuneration arrangements. 
As part of these discussions we also agreed the impact 
of the Combination on Redrow share awards and options, 
including how this would affect Matthew Pratt, to whom 
the Company’s Remuneration Policy will apply when he 
joins the Combined Board. Following this review we agreed 
that the remuneration package for Matthew would remain 
the same as his Redrow package except that he would be 
eligible to participate in the LTPP at a level of up to 200% 
of salary in line with the incumbent Executive Directors 
(instead of up to 150% of salary under his remuneration 
arrangements at Redrow). As set out in the Co-operation 
Agreement in respect of the Combination and in line with 
other participants in the Redrow long-term incentive plan, 
Matthew will be granted a “Transition Award” of equivalent 
value to the portion of his 2023 Redrow long-term, incentive 
plan award which lapsed as a result of completion of 
the Combination. Full details of Matthew's share awards 
will be included in next year's Remuneration Report.
Conclusion
Throughout the year, the Remuneration Policy operated as 
intended in terms of Company performance and quantum, 
and in line with the Code.
The Committee believes that the decisions it has taken in 
respect of FY24 pay outcomes and its proposed approach 
to remuneration for FY25 are in the best interests of its 
shareholders, align with the Group’s strategy, reflect the 
wider business and economic environment and are fair, 
reasonable and appropriate. I therefore hope that you 
will support this report at the AGM in October 2024. 
On behalf of the Committee and the Board, I would 
like to thank you for your continued support of our 
remuneration framework.
Katie Bickerstaffe
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
3 September 2024
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Statement from the Chair of the Remuneration Committee continued
124
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

The overview below outlines the remuneration outcomes for Executive Directors for FY24, 
together with the minimum, on-target and maximum (with and without share price growth) 
opportunities for FY25, the FY24 targets set for variable remuneration and our performance 
against them, and the alignment of our FY24 incentive performance measures with strategy. 
 Full details can be found in the Annual Report on Remuneration on pages 132 to 145
 Details of Executive Directors’ shareholding requirements and 
whether they have been met are given in the table on page 141
Executive Directors’ Remuneration Policy scenarios for FY25 and FY24 single figure outcomes
Notes:
	• Minimum pay is fixed pay only (i.e. salary + benefits + pension). 
	• On-target pay includes fixed pay, 50% of the maximum bonus (equal to 75% of salary) 
and 50% vesting of the LTPP awards (with grant levels of 200% of salary).
	• Maximum pay includes fixed pay and assumes 100% vesting of both the annual bonus 
and the LTPP awards.
	• Maximum pay plus 50% share price growth is the same as maximum pay for fixed pay 
and annual bonus but assumes a 50% increase in the share price over the performance 
period for the LTPP.
	• Matthew Pratt has been omitted from the scenarios above as he is not yet been 
appointed a Director of the Company. 
	• All amounts have been rounded to the nearest £1,000. Salary levels (which are the base 
on which other elements of the package are calculated) are based on those applying at 
1 July 2024. The value of taxable benefits is the cost of providing those benefits in the 
year ended 30 June 2024. The Executive Directors are also permitted to participate in 
HMRC tax advantaged all-employee share plans, on the same terms as other eligible 
employees, but they have been excluded from the above graph for simplicity. The LTPP 
awards allow participants to receive dividend equivalents but these are excluded from 
the scenario chart, other than for the single figure bar.
100%
100%
100%
39%
26%
26%
26%
32%
50%
27%
32%
27%
50%
32%
27%
50%
35%
35%
34%
43%
53%
44%
53%
43%
53%
39%
40%
25%
24%
25%
20%
20%
20%
41%
41%
43%
Minimum
On-target 
Maximum 
Maximum
plus 50% 
share price 
growth
Single figure 
FY24
Minimum
On-target 
Maximum 
Maximum
plus 50% 
share price 
growth
Single figure 
FY24
Minimum
On-target 
Maximum 
Maximum
plus 50% 
share price 
growth
Single figure 
FY24
(£)
5,000
4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
0
(£)
5,000
4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
0
(£)
5,000
4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
0
  Fixed pay 
  Other 
 Annual bonus 
  LTIP
Chief Executive
Chief Operating Officer & Deputy Chief Executive
Chief Financial Officer
976
2,482
3,989
4,850
2,268
1,824
1,384
778
1,993
3,207
3,901
606
1,534
2,461
2,991
9%
9%
7%
Remuneration overview
Remuneration Report continued
125
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

FY24 performance pay outcomes
Annual bonus outcome
Further details are set out on page 137 in the Annual Report on Remuneration.
Target
Threshold
Target
Maximum
Weighting 1
Outcome achieved 1
Adjusted profit before tax
£275m 
£350m 
£400m 
82.5%
70.1%
Actual £385.0m
Capital employed
£1,923m
£1,923m
£1,890m
15.0%
15.0%
Actual £1,805.3m
Quality and service 
(with health and 
safety underpin)2
(i) The number of divisions achieving minimum 94% SHE audit monitoring inspections gate on a rolling 12 months’ 
performance basis; (ii) for 67% of this element, the number of divisions achieving minimum 90% for the HBF eight-week 
National New Homes Customer Satisfaction Survey; and (iii) for the remaining 33% of this element, the number of divisions 
achieving minimum 82% for NHBC nine-month Customer Satisfaction Survey.
22.5%
19.7%
Divisions achieving 94% SHE audit monitoring gate: 29/29
Divisions achieving 90% eight-week score: 28/29
Divisions achieving 82% nine-month score: 20/29
Reduction of total waste 
generated (waste intensity) 
4.31 tonnes
4.22 tonnes
4.15 tonnes
15.0%
15.0%
Actual 3.83 tonnes per 100m2 of housebuild equivalent area
Diverse (gender and 
ethnicity) appointments 
32%
34%
36%
15.0%
15.0%
Actual 54%
1	
% of salary.
2	 The outcome is based on the proportion of divisions that meet all three performance criteria.
LTPP vesting outcome
Further details, including the share price used to calculate the estimated value, any value of share price increases and the value of dividend equivalents, are set out in Table 10 on page 
139 of the Annual Report on Remuneration.
2021 LTPP
Shares 
awarded
Number
Percentage of award vesting
Shares 
vesting 
Number
Estimated 
value 1 
£000
EPS
ROCE
TSR
Reduction
of GHG
emissions
Total
David Thomas
224,370
0%
0%
0%
15%
15%
33,655
162
Steven Boyes
180,987
0%
0%
0%
15%
15%
27,148
131
Mike Scott
117,7162
0%
0%
0%
15%
15%
17,657
85
1	
Based on a share price of £4.81, being the average share price during the three months to 30 June 2024. There was no share price appreciation from the date the shares were awarded.
2	 The number of shares over which the award has been granted has been calculated based on 200% of the participant’s salary as at the date of appointment, being £480,000 per annum. In accordance with the participant’s final offer letter dated 24 June 2021, the number of shares subject to the 
award has been pro-rated to reflect the length of the performance period commencing from the date of appointment.
Remuneration Report continued
Remuneration overview continued
126
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Alignment of FY24 incentive performance measures 
with our strategy and values
Annual bonus
Performance 
measure (weighting 
as % of salary)
Reason performance 
target selected
Alignment with strategic 
objectives
Alignment with values
Adjusted PBT
82.5%
Rewards performance 
against stretching 
targets and is a 
key measure of our 
performance.
	• Driving revenue 
	• Controlling build 
activity and 
managing our costs
	• Maintaining our 
highly selective 
approach to 
land buying
	• We make it happen
	• We do it right
Capital employed
15.0%
Ensures efficient use 
of available capital.
	• We make it happen
	• We do it together
	• We do it right
Quality and 
service (with 
a health and 
safety underpin)
22.5%
Ensures a focus on 
quality and service 
to our customers 
without compromising 
the health and safety 
of our employees, 
customers, suppliers, 
sub-contractors 
and members of 
the public.
	• Leading the 
industry around 
customer service, 
build quality, social 
responsibility and 
sustainability
	• We do it for 
our customers
	• We do it right
Reduction 
of waste
15.0%
Focuses individuals on 
reducing the amount 
of construction waste 
intensity, which is 
a key element of 
our overall carbon 
reduction and 
sustainability strategy.
	• We do it right
	• We make it happen
Diversity 
and inclusion
15.0%
Focuses individuals on 
ensuring that, as part 
of any recruitment 
process, they identify a 
short list of candidates 
which will help further 
improve diversity 
within the business. 
	• We do it together
	• We do it right
LTPP
Performance 
measure (weighting 
as % of total award)
Reason performance 
target selected
Alignment with strategic 
objectives 
Alignment with values
ROCE
40.0%
Key performance 
indicator measuring 
profitability and 
efficiency in using 
capital. 
	• Driving revenue 
	• Controlling build 
activity and 
managing our costs
	• Maintaining our 
highly selective 
approach to 
land buying
	• We make it happen
	• We do it together
	• We do it right
Adjusted 
Absolute EPS
15.0%
A key performance 
measure to 
track underlying 
operational 
performance 
over time.
	• We do it right
	• We make it happen
TSR
30.0%
A key measure of 
value created for 
our shareholders.
	• We make it happen
	• We do it right
Sustainability
15.0%
Supports our focus 
on leading the 
industry in terms 
of sustainability.
	• Leading the 
industry around 
customer service, 
build quality, social 
responsibility and 
sustainability
	• We do it right
	• We do it for 
our customers
Remuneration Report continued
Remuneration overview continued
127
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Our remuneration strategy
It is the motivation and engagement of our employees which 
makes our business operationally strong. It is therefore 
imperative that our remuneration strategy appropriately 
rewards our employees for their performance against 
the Group’s key performance indicators, whilst delivering 
sustainable shareholder value. 
In developing our Policy we pay due regard to:
	• the Group’s purpose and strategic priorities, and ensuring 
that targets support the achievement of these;
	• the performance, roles and responsibilities of each 
Executive Director and members of senior management;
	• arrangements that apply across the wider workforce, including 
average base salary increases and pension contributions;
	• information and surveys from internal and independent 
sources; and
	• the economic environment and underlying financial 
performance of the Group.
The aims of our Policy and the action taken during the year to achieve these are set out in the table below:
Aims of our Remuneration Policy
Implementation
Progress during the year
Promote the long-term sustainable 
success of the Company and be fully 
aligned with the performance and 
strategic objectives of the Group.
We set bonus and LTPP targets that align 
with performance and strategic objectives 
to promote the long-term sustainable 
success of the Company.
 See page 127
Attract, retain, motivate and competitively 
reward Executive Directors and senior 
management with the requisite 
experience, skills and ability to support 
the achievement of the Group’s key 
strategic objectives in any financial year.
We undertake regular benchmarking 
exercises to ensure our remuneration 
package is competitive and set appropriately 
stretching targets to maintain motivation. 
 See page 124
Take account of pay and employment 
conditions of employees across the 
Group whilst reflecting the interests 
and expectations of shareholders and 
other stakeholders.
We annually consider pay and performance 
conditions of the wider workforce and look 
to obtain feedback on our remuneration 
to ensure it reflects the interests of our 
shareholders and other key stakeholders. 
 See pages 130 and 131
Reward the delivery of profit and the 
achievement of the return on capital 
employed target, whilst ensuring 
that Executive Directors and senior 
management adopt a level of risk which 
is in line with the risk profile of the 
business as approved by the Board.
We ensure that the Company’s variable 
remuneration rewards the successful 
implementation of strategy through the 
alignment of performance targets with 
strategic KPIs and the Company’s risk profile.
 See pages 12 to 15
Ensure that there is no reward for 
failure and that termination payments 
(if any) are limited to those that the 
Executive Director (or member of senior 
management) is legally entitled to.
We apply a performance underpin to 
the annual bonus outcome. We also have 
discretion to override formulaic outcomes 
on the annual bonus and LTPP to ensure 
that remuneration is in line with Company 
and individual performance and that poor 
performance is not rewarded.   
Malus and clawback provisions also apply 
to annual bonus payments and to any share 
awards under the LTPP, DBP and ELTIP. 
 See page 129
Remuneration Report continued
Remuneration Policy
128
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Policy 
The Company’s current Directors’ Remuneration Policy (the 
“Policy”), was approved by shareholders at the 2023 AGM. 
The full version of the Policy can be found on pages 142 to 154 
of the 2023 Annual Report and Accounts, which is available 
on our website at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors. 
A description of how the Company implemented the Policy in 
FY24 can be found on pages 136 to 145 and details of how the 
Policy will be applied for FY25 are set out on pages 133 to 135.
Committee discretion
If an event occurs which results in the annual bonus plan 
or LTPP performance conditions and/or targets being 
deemed no longer appropriate (e.g. a material acquisition, 
divestment or wider market or economic circumstances 
that the Committee deem relevant), then the Committee 
has the ability to adjust appropriately the measures and/or 
targets, and/or to alter the weighting of the measures. 
The Committee also has the discretion to increase or decrease 
any annual bonus or LTPP awards (potentially reducing them 
to nil) in the event that the formulaic outcome is not reflective 
of overall Company performance or aligned with the underlying 
financial and/or non-financial performance of the Group, or 
where environmental incidents, health and safety incidents 
or other wider economic or market circumstances warrant 
an adjustment to the final outcome in order to determine 
a reasonable and appropriate result. The Committee also 
retains discretion to adjust LTPP vesting outcomes to avoid 
windfall gains in the event the share price has fallen materially 
before a given award is made. 
The Committee did not exercise its discretion in FY24. 
The Committee is mindful that it may need to exercise 
discretion to adjust targets for our in-flight LTPP awards 
post completion of the Combination with Redrow. 
Malus and clawback
Malus and clawback is applicable to any annual bonus paid 
or deferred for a period of three years beginning on the 
date of the award and to any share awards granted under 
the LTPP for a period of five years beginning on the date 
of the award. 
The mechanism applies in certain circumstances set 
out in the rules of the relevant plans, including material 
misstatement in the Group’s accounts, error, misconduct, 
material failure of risk management, reputational damage 
and corporate failure. 
 Full details of the circumstances under which malus and clawback apply can be found in the full 
Remuneration Policy set out in the FY23 Annual report and accounts on the Company’s website.
Change of Control
The rules of each share scheme operated by the Company contain provisions relating to a change of control. In the event 
that a change of control does occur any unvested options or awards will become vested on the date of the relevant event. 
However, the number of options or awards that vest will be prorated depending on the number of weeks completed within 
the relevant performance period and the level of performance conditions achieved during that period. The Committee has 
discretion to assess the performance outcome in respect of unvested awards and determine the extent to which unvested 
awards may vest. Options or awards which have already vested as at the date of the relevant event may still be exercised 
within the prescribed time scales set out in the rules.
How the Committee has addressed the requirements of the Code in determining 
Directors' Remuneration Policy and practices
Code requirement	
Clarity – remuneration arrangements 
should be transparent and promote 
effective engagement with shareholders 
and the workforce.
The main terms applying to variable remuneration for any year is set out clearly in the prior year’s 
Annual Report, together with performance targets (unless they are deemed to be commercially 
sensitive). Outcomes are aligned with strategic objectives using appropriate performance targets, 
which align with shareholder interests and the Group’s strategy and provide for the long-term 
success of the Company, in the interests of the workforce and other stakeholders.
Simplicity – remuneration structures 
should avoid complexity and their 
rationale and operation should be easy 
to understand.
The Company operates a UK market standard approach to remuneration which is familiar to 
stakeholders. Performance targets are readily understandable and published as part of the 
year‑end results.
Risk – remuneration arrangements 
should ensure reputational and other 
risks from excessive rewards, and 
behavioural risks that can arise from 
target-based incentive plans, are 
identified and mitigated.
The Committee has discretion to ensure that variable pay outcomes are in line with Company and 
individual performance. Share awards are subject to post-vesting holding periods, and malus and 
clawback as set out on page 129.
In line with the IA’s Guidelines on Responsible Investment Disclosure, the Committee is satisfied 
that the incentive structure and targets for Executive Directors do not raise any ESG risks by 
inadvertently motivating irresponsible or reckless behaviour. 
The Committee considers that no element of the remuneration package will encourage inappropriate 
risk taking within the Company. 
Predictability – the range of possible 
values of rewards to individual directors 
and any other limits or discretions 
should be identified and explained at 
the time of approving the policy.
Minimum, on-target and maximum outcomes for Directors are shown annually in this report. Limits 
and discretions for each type of reward are explained in the Policy table which can be found on 
pages 142 to 147 of the 2023 Annual Report.
Proportionality – the link between 
individual awards, the delivery of 
strategy and the long-term performance 
of the company should be clear. Outcomes 
should not reward poor performance.
The Company’s incentive plans reward the successful implementation of strategy through the 
alignment of performance targets with strategic KPIs. The performance underpin which applies 
to the annual bonus ensures that poor performance is not rewarded. The Committee also has 
discretion to override formulaic outcomes.
Alignment with culture – incentive 
schemes should drive behaviours 
consistent with company purpose, 
values and strategy.
Our remuneration strategy ensures that performance targets do not encourage inappropriate 
behaviours. The targets that are selected help align the interests of the workforce with those 
of the Company’s purpose, values and strategy as illustrated on page 127.
Remuneration Report continued
Directors’ Remuneration Policy
129
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of consideration of pay and employment conditions 
elsewhere across the Group
The level for all employees’ salaries is determined with reference to the rate of inflation, 
salaries for similar positions throughout the industry and general themes and trends in 
respect of remunerating employees. In determining the Policy for Executive Directors’ 
remuneration, and in determining the annual increase in base salary, the Committee takes 
into consideration the pay and employment conditions of all employees across the Group. 
While the Company did not explicitly consult with employees when drawing up the Policy, 
the Workforce Forum discussed remuneration strategy, including executive reward strategy, 
and was asked to provide feedback to management. 
The Company also operates a Sharesave scheme and makes conditional awards of 
shares to all eligible employees. This enables our employees to become shareholders 
in the Company, and to comment on the Group’s Policy in the same way as our other 
shareholders. During the year 1,767 employees signed up to the 2024 sharesave scheme 
and conditional awards were made to 7,732 employees under the ELTIP and LTPP.
To build the Committee’s understanding of reward arrangements applicable to the wider 
workforce, it is provided with data on the remuneration structure for senior management 
levels below the Executive Directors and the wider workforce, as well as benchmarking 
information. In addition, the Group provides several ways in which employees can ask 
questions and give feedback on such matters should they so wish. This includes the Employee 
Communications mailbox, personal development reviews, the Workforce Forum, a dedicated 
Workforce Forum email address and an email address for employees to directly contact the 
Designated Non-Executive Director for Workforce Engagement. 
During the year the Workforce Forum sought clarification on the application of the D&I 
performance condition for the annual bonus, noting that the Redrow Combination removed 
an element of hiring discretion from managers. The concern was noted, and Sally Austin, 
the Group HR Director, provided assurance that targets would be reasonable and realistic 
based on the level of recruitment expected in the next 12 months. Other feedback 
from colleagues in relation to remuneration included requests for greater clarity and 
transparency around bonus payments and better promotion of the benefits available to 
colleagues. See pages 50 and 51 for actions implemented in response to these requests.
The Committee reviews the feedback from colleagues, which provides further context in 
relation to pay and conditions throughout the organisation. 
Differences between the remuneration for Executive Directors 
and the wider workforce
The table on page 131 sets out the differences that exist between the Company’s Policy 
for the remuneration of Executive Directors and its approach to the payment of the 
wider workforce generally. In general, these differences arise from the development of 
remuneration arrangements that are market competitive for the various categories of 
individuals. They also reflect the greater emphasis placed on performance-related pay 
for Executive Directors. 
Consideration of stakeholders views 
Local 
communities and 
the environment
	• Compensation outcomes under the annual bonus and LTPP 
consider performance against the reduction of waste and 
greenhouse gas emissions, and diversity and inclusion measures. 
Sub-contractors 
and suppliers
	• Compensation outcomes under the annual bonus include a 
health and safety underpin. 
Customers
	• Compensation outcomes under the annual bonus consider 
performance against quality and service measures. 
Employees
	• Consistent remuneration principles apply to executives and 
employees including consistent benefit and pension provisions.
	• The Company operates a Sharesave scheme and makes conditional 
awards of shares to all eligible employees. This enables all 
employees to become shareholders in the Company.
	• Compensation outcomes under the annual bonus include 
a health and safety underpin. 
Regulators
	• Compensation decisions take into account compliance 
and conduct considerations.
	• Pay structures are aligned to regulatory best practice.
Shareholders
	• Compensation outcomes reflect key financial and 
non‑financial performance.
	• An appropriate portion of remuneration is paid in shares 
together with a mandated shareholding requirement to align 
interest with shareholders.
Remuneration Report continued
Directors’ Remuneration Policy continued
130
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Differences between the remuneration for Executive Directors and the wider workforce continued
Component of 
remuneration
Wider workforce
Executive Directors
Salary
Base salary of Executive Committee members is determined by the 
Committee. Salary for other colleagues is determined by management. 
Base salary is determined by the Committee. 
Bonus
A lower level of maximum annual bonus opportunity may apply to 
employees other than the Executive Directors. 
All colleagues, including Executive Directors, are subject to similar 
performance targets; however, the weightings against the various 
targets may vary.
Total bonus achievable as a % of salary: 150%
All colleagues, including Executive Directors, are subject to similar performance targets; 
however, the weightings against the various targets may vary.
Benefits
All colleagues are eligible for similar benefits, including private medical 
insurance, as the Executive Directors though levels may vary.
All colleagues are eligible for similar benefits, including private medical insurance, 
as the Executive Directors though levels may vary.
Pension
All colleagues who, under the rules of auto-enrolment are eligible, are auto 
enrolled into a workplace pension. Colleagues can opt out of the workplace 
pension and can elect to participate in the company’s pensions scheme. 
Executive Directors are enrolled into a workplace pension. If Executive Directors choose 
to opt out of the workplace pension they can elect to participate in the Company’s money 
purchase pension plan or receive a salary supplement in line with the wider workforce 
(currently 10%).
Deferred 
Bonus
One-third of any bonus earned by members of Senior Management will be 
deferred into shares for a period of three years and is normally subject to 
continued employment. 
One third of any bonus earned is deferred into shares for a period of three years 
and is normally subject to a continued employment condition. 
LTPP
A number of select employees at Senior Management level may also be 
invited to participate in the LTPP at the Committee’s discretion. Awards are 
subject to the achievement of stretching performance conditions measured 
over three financial years. 
Senior Managers and Executive Directors, are subject to similar performance 
targets; however, the weightings against the various targets may vary.
Awards include the right to receive dividend equivalents. 
Executive Directors are granted awards at the discretion of the Committee. Awards are 
subject to the achievement of stretching performance conditions measured over three 
financial years with a subsequent two year holding period.
Senior Managers and Executive Directors, are subject to similar performance targets; 
however, the weightings against the various targets may vary.
Awards include the right to receive dividend equivalents.
ELTIP
Over the last several years, employees below Senior Management have been 
awarded a smaller number of shares under the ELTIP.
To align with the LTPP, awards accrue dividend equivalents in cash or shares. 
This award is not available to Executive Directors.
Sharesave
Colleagues can save up to £500 per month for a three or five year 
savings period.
Executive Directors can save up to £500 per month for a three or five year savings period.
Statement of consideration of shareholder views
Each year we update our major shareholders on the Committee’s application of the Policy 
and our performance in advance of the publication of our Annual Report and Accounts. The 
Committee considers shareholder feedback received from this exercise and any additional 
feedback received during any meetings from time to time, as part of the Company’s annual 
review of the Policy. In addition, the Committee will seek to engage directly with major 
shareholders and their representative bodies ahead of any material changes being proposed 
to the Policy.
Remuneration Report continued
Directors’ Remuneration Policy continued
131
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

In this section, we provide an overview of the Committee and its advisers, as well as 
how the Policy was applied in FY24 and how it will be applied in FY25, together with the 
resulting payments to Directors. The Annual Report on Remuneration will be subject to an 
advisory vote at the 2024 AGM.
Membership and attendance at Committee meetings
Membership of the Committee comprises of all the Independent Non-Executive Directors 
and the Chair of the Board, and attendance at meetings during the year is set out on 
page 95. The Committee is chaired by Katie Bickerstaffe. The Executive Directors are not 
members of the Committee and no Director or senior manager is present at any Committee 
meeting when their own remuneration is being considered.
Advisers to the Remuneration Committee
In carrying out its principal responsibilities, the Committee has the authority to obtain the 
advice of external independent remuneration consultants and is solely responsible for their 
appointment, retention and termination. In line with best practice, the Committee assesses 
annually whether the appointment remains appropriate or if it should be put out to tender. 
The last such tender took place in 2017, resulting in PwC being appointed as the advisers 
to the Committee with effect from 1 January 2018. PwC is a signatory to the Remuneration 
Consultants Group’s Code of Conduct. 
In November 2023, PwC temporarily stood down as the Committee’s adviser to avoid a 
conflict of interest given the advice and support it was asked to provide for the Combination. 
During the period from July 2023 to November 2023, PwC provided advice to management 
and the Chair of the Committee on Restricted Stock Awards, the FY23 Remuneration Report, 
the 2023 Policy and market trends in remuneration and corporate governance changes. The 
fees payable to PwC are based on an annual fixed fee for a specified service with anything 
outside this scope being charged on a time and disbursement basis. PwC’s fees for services 
provided to the Committee during the year under review were £37,250 (FY23: £189,567).
In addition to remuneration advice, PwC also provides taxation, consultancy, corporate 
finance and internal audit services to the Group. PwC is a former independent adviser to 
the Sustainability Committee and our Business Safety Unit and continues to assist our 
Business Safety Unit with project management matters. PwC has no current connections 
with the Company (save as described in this section) nor with any individual Director.
Linklaters LLP was appointed as the Company’s advisers for the Combination and as part 
of their remit were asked to advise the Committee on the impact of the Combination on 
Barratt and Redrow share schemes and other incentives and remuneration disclosures. 
The fees paid to Linklaters LLP for their services to the Committee during the period under 
review were £26,226.  
Due to PwC’s conflict noted above, the Committee sought the services of an alternative 
adviser to support with market data on integration incentives and setting targets for 
the 2023 and 2024 awards. Following consideration of various options, Korn Ferry was 
appointed on the recommendation of the Group HR Director who had worked with them 
previously. Korn Ferry’s fees for services provided during FY24 were £21,607.
The Committee also receives input into its decision making from the Chief Executive, the 
Company Secretary and the Group HR Director, none of whom were present at any time 
when their own remuneration was being considered.
Role and main activities undertaken by the Committee during 
the financial year 
The Committee’s role is to determine and agree the Policy for Executive Directors 
and senior management whilst considering the remuneration of the wider workforce. 
It follows an annual work programme which was fully completed during the year. 
The Committee’s responsibilities, as delegated by the Board, are formally set 
out in its written Terms of Reference, which are available from our website at 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors/corporate-governance. 
Details of the annual evaluation of the Committee’s performance can be found on page 111 
and key activities undertaken in the year are set out in the table below:
Priorities
Work carried out and outcomes
Executive 
Directors’ 
remuneration
	• Considered salaries of Executive Directors and senior management 
for FY25 in the context of the remuneration of the wider workforce. 
The outcome of this review is set out on page 133.
	• Considered and agreed FY23 annual bonus and 2020 LTPP vesting outcomes. 
	• Considered and agreed the structure, performance conditions, weightings 
and targets for the 2023 LTPP (see page 139 for further details). 
	• Considered and agreed the structure and performance measures of 
the bonus scheme for FY24 (see page 137 for more details).
	• Considered the structure of the 2024 LTPP and determined it 
remained appropriate.
	• Considered the effect of the Co-operation Agreement on Redrow share 
awards and options and how this would apply to Matthew Pratt on 
joining the Board as an Executive Director.
	• Discussed future performance measures and targets for both the annual 
bonus and LTPP plans.
	• Considered the impact of the Combination on the operation of Barratt 
share plans.
Governance
	• Agreed a 3% increase in fees for the Chair in line with the increase for 
the wider workforce and the Executive Directors. 
	• Discussed and approved publication of the 2023 gender and ethnicity 
pay gap reports.
Annual Report on Remuneration
Remuneration Report continued
132
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of implementation of the 
Remuneration Policy for FY25
Executive Directors’ remuneration for FY25 will be based 
on the Policy approved by shareholders at the October 
2023 AGM. The Policy is set out on pages 142 to 154 of the 
2023 Annual Report and Accounts which is available on our 
website at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors/results
-reports-and-presentations/rp-2023.
Base salary
The Committee reviewed the salaries of the Executive 
Directors in June 2024, considering their individual and the 
Company's performance during the year, the annual salary 
review for other employees in the Group where average 
salary increases were at 3%, and the multiplier effect of an 
increase in base salary on the Directors’ package.  
Accordingly, the Committee believed that it was justified in 
awarding a salary increase of 3% for each of the Executive 
Directors, which is in line with the increase for the wider 
workforce. The Executive Directors’ salaries with effect 
from 1 July 2024 will therefore be:
Table 1 – Executive Directors’ salaries
Executive Director
Salary with effect
 from 1 July 2024
£000 1
Salary with effect
 from 1 July 2023
£000 1
David Thomas
861
836
Steven Boyes
694
674
Mike Scott
530
514
1	
Rounded to the nearest £000.
Pension
Each of the Executive Directors will continue to receive a 
pension contribution (or cash supplement) which is in line 
with the wider workforce, currently 10% of base salary.
Annual bonus
Executive Directors and senior management will participate 
in the Group’s annual bonus scheme in accordance with 
the Policy.
The Committee is of the view that the individual annual 
bonus performance targets are commercially sensitive. 
Therefore, in line with market practice, these will be 
disclosed, with performance against them, in next year’s 
Remuneration Report.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
The performance measures, their reasons for selection and the maximum bonus payment that can be earned against each 
of them expressed as a percentage of salary for FY25 will be:
Table 2 - FY25 annual bonus performance measures
Bonus measure
Definition
Reason for selecting
Weighting 
(% of salary
 maximum)
Financial performance measures
Adjusted Profit 
before tax - Group
Adjusted operating profit less all finance costs/
income and the Group’s share of the profits from 
its joint ventures. Where relevant, exceptional items 
are not included in adjusted profit before tax. The 
Remuneration Committee has the discretion to amend 
adjusted profit before tax should it be deemed necessary.
Rewards outperformance 
against stretching targets 
and is a key measure of our 
performance.
82.5
Average Work 
in Progress
Site work in progress and part exchange stock 
calculated over a three-point average which will be 
June 2024, December 2024 and June 2025.
Ensures efficient use of 
available capital.
15.0
Non-financial performance measures
Quality and service 
(with a health and 
safety underpin)
To qualify for this element of the bonus, Divisions must 
achieve or exceed a SHE monitoring inspections gate 
of 94% on a rolling 12 months’ performance basis and 
then achieve or exceed their customer service targets. 
A three-stage assessment will be applied to each 
Division. The criteria for achievement of this element 
will be as follows:
	• Initially, the Division needs to achieve a SHE 
monitoring inspections gate of 94% on a rolling 12 
months’ performance basis. If this score is achieved, 
then the Division will be considered for the customer 
service assessment.  
	• The Division needs to achieve a minimum score 
of 90% for the HBF 8-week National New Homes 
Customer Satisfaction survey (60% weighting).
	• If 90% for 8 weeks is achieved, the Division needs 
to achieve a minimum score of 83% for the NHBC 
9-month Customer Satisfaction survey (40% 
weighting). This will be reviewed and amended 
annually to continually improve our performance.
8-week and 9-month ‘Recommend’ performance will 
be measured on all valid surveys received during the 
financial year – 1st July to 30th June.
Ensures a focus on quality 
and service to our customers 
without compromising the 
health and safety of our 
employees, customers, 
suppliers, sub-contractors 
and members of the public.
22.5
133
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of implementation of the Remuneration Policy for FY25 continued
Annual bonus continued
Table 2 – FY25 annual bonus performance measures continued
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
Bonus measure
Definition
Reason for selecting
Weighting 
(% of salary
 maximum)
Non-financial performance measures continued
Diversity 
and inclusion
To qualify for this element of the bonus, the Group 
must achieve an increase in the average rate of diverse 
appointments (gender and ethnicity).
37% diverse appointments are required to achieve 
Minimum, 39% diverse appointments are required to 
achieve On Target, 41% appointments are required to 
achieve Stretch. 
For Executive Committee and RMD’s only – an 
additional target of 25% diverse representation of our 
Grade 4 population is also required. 
To focus individuals on 
ensuring that, as part of any 
recruitment process, they 
identify a range of candidates 
which will help further 
improve diversity within 
the business.
15.0
Reduction of waste
Our FY25 sustainability target is site waste reduction 
(tonnes of waste for every 100m2 of house build 
equivalent area). The target number will be set in 
accordance with Group, Division and site minimum 
performance levels.
Focus individuals on reducing 
the amount of construction 
waste intensity, which is a 
key element of our overall 
carbon reduction and 
sustainability strategy.
15.0
Total bonus achievable as a % of salary
150.0 1
1	
One-third of any bonus earned will be deferred into shares and held in the DBP. Dividend equivalents will accrue against any shares deferred into the DBP.
The Committee will continue to have an overriding discretion in respect of any bonus payment in accordance with 
its Policy. 
In addition, any bonus awarded for FY25 will be subject to the malus and clawback provisions set out on page 129.
LTPP
The Committee intends to grant an LTPP award to 
Executive Directors later this year (2024 LTPP). Under the 
Remuneration Policy and the rules of the LTPP, the award 
can be up to 200% of base salary. The Committee remains 
mindful of the need to avoid windfall gains for Executive 
Directors, as evidenced by its decision to reduce the 
quantum of the 2022 LTPP award grant. There has been 
little movement in the share price since October 2023 and 
therefore the Committee intends to grant an award of up to 
200% of base salary to Executive Directors. The Committee 
will, however, monitor the share price up until the day 
before the grant to determine the final quantum of the 
2024 LTPP. In addition, the Committee recognises that the 
2024 LTPP award should be subject to performance targets 
which are stretching and challenging whilst aligned with 
the long-term performance of the Group and its strategy, 
as well as the interests of shareholders. The performance 
conditions and their respective weightings for the 2024 
LTPP, as agreed by the Committee, are set out in the table 
on the following page. 
The Committee has set targets for each of the financial and 
non-financial performance conditions for the Barratt Group 
on a standalone basis. The Committee is however, mindful 
that these, together with the targets for all in-flight LTPP 
awards, may need to be adjusted to reflect the Combined 
Group post Completion. This will be considered by the 
Committee once the three-year plan for the Combined 
Group has been finalised. Accordingly, the Committee has 
agreed not to disclose the Barratt stand alone targets in 
this report but will communicate the adjusted targets at 
the appropriate time (currently anticipated to be the second 
quarter of 2025).
134
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of implementation of the Remuneration Policy for FY25 continued
LTPP continued
Table 3 – 2024 LTPP performance measures
Performance Measure
Definition
Reason Selected
Weighting 
(of total award)
TSR against 50+/50- 
comparator group
Company’s Total Shareholder Return over the 
Performance Period measured against two 
comparator groups (i) the ‘FTSE - the 
Company’s Total Shareholder Return over the 
Performance Period must be at least at the 
median of a ranking of the Total Shareholder 
Return of each of the members ranking 50 
above and 50 below the Company in the FTSE 
Index at the start of the Performance Period 
based on market capitalisation as at the day 
before the start of the Performance Period; 
and (ii) the ‘Housebuilder Index’ - the Company’s 
Total Shareholder Return over the Performance 
Period must be at least the Index average of 
the Housebuilder Index over the same period.
Ensures the comparator group 
remains current and relevant 
whilst factoring in the 
continued movement in the 
Company’s market capitalisation.
15%
TSR against a house 
builder index1
Ensures rewards are linked to 
outperformance of our peers.
15%
Absolute Adjusted EPS 
for financial year ending 
30 June 2027
Calculated by dividing the adjusted profit 
after tax for the year attributable to ordinary 
shareholders by the weighted average number 
of ordinary shares in issue during FY27, 
excluding those held by the Employee 
Benefit Trust which are treated as cancelled.
Ensures efficient and effective 
management of our business 
and align interests with those 
of shareholders.
15%
Underlying ROCE for the 
financial year ending 
30 June 2027
Calculated as earnings before amortisation, 
interest, tax, operating charges relating to the 
defined benefit pension scheme and adjusted 
items, divided by average net assets adjusted 
for goodwill, intangibles and land payables, 
tax, cash, loans and borrowings, retirement 
benefit assets/obligations, derivative financial 
instruments and legacy property provisions.
Ensures efficient and effective 
management of our business 
and align interests with those 
of shareholders.
40%
Reduction in 
GHG Emissions2
Reduction of our absolute Scope 1 and 2 
(operational) GHG emissions by 29% by 2025 
(from 2018 levels) and to net zero by 2040.
Ensures we focus on reducing 
our emissions by meeting 
our science-based target of 
a 29% reduction in absolute 
scope 1 and 2 greenhouse 
gas emissions.
15%
1	
The Housebuilder Index to comprise: Bellway, Berkeley Homes, Crest Nicholson, Persimmon, Taylor Wimpey and Vistry Group.
2	 Further information on scope 1 and 2 GHG Emissions can be found in the Strategic Report, pages 79 and 80.
The TSR, EPS and Underlying ROCE performance targets, 
will vest on a straight-line basis between threshold and 
maximum. For the GHG performance target, vesting will 
be on a straight-line basis between Below Threshold and 
Threshold, and on a straight-line basis between Threshold 
and Maximum. In addition, all LTPP awards are subject to 
a two-year post-vesting holding period and an overriding 
Committee discretion, as set out in the Policy table on page 146 
of the FY23 Annual Report and Accounts. The Committee 
retains discretion to adjust the number of shares vesting 
from the 2024 LTPP award to mitigate against any potential 
windfall gains. The 2024 LTPP will also be subject to the 
malus and clawback provisions noted on page 129.
Non-Executive Directors’ fees
During the year, a committee of the Board comprising the 
Chair and the Executive Directors reviewed Non‑Executive 
Directors’ fees and concluded that an increase of 3% should 
apply to the base fee paid to the Non‑Executive Directors. 
Fees for the Chairs and members of Committees remain 
unchanged. This increase is in line with the salary increase 
awarded to the Executive Directors and the wider workforce. 
Caroline Silver, as Chair, also received a 3% increase from 
1 July 2024. The annual fees payable to the Chair and 
Non‑Executive Directors with effect from 1 July 2024 are:
Table 4 – Non-Executive Directors’ fees
Role
Fee as at 
1 July 2024
£000
Fee as at 
1 July 2023
£000
Chair
375
364
Non-Executive Director base fee
72
70
Committee membership (per 
Committee)
3
3
Chair of Audit Committee
18
18
Chair of Remuneration Committee
18
18
Chair of Safety, Health and 
Environmental Committee
18
18
Senior Independent Director
18
18
Designated NED for Workforce 
Engagement1
0
0
1 	 As Caroline SIlver is currently the Designated NED for Workforce Engagement no additional 
fees are payable to her for this role. 
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
135
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Directors’ remuneration outcomes for the year ended 30 June 2024
Single figure of remuneration
The total remuneration for each of the Directors who served during the financial year ended 30 June 2024 is set out in Tables 5 and 6. The salary for all Directors is the amount received 
in the year.
Table 5 – Executive Directors’ single figure of remuneration (audited)
Base 
salary 
£000
Benefits
(taxable)1 
£000
Annual 
bonus 2
£000
LTPP3
£000
Sharesave 4
£000
Pension
benefits 
£000
Total5
remuneration
£000
Total5
fixed
remuneration
£000
Total5 
variable 
remuneration
£000
2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23 2023/24
2022/23
David Thomas
836
803
29
29
1,126
483
194
269
—
—
84
141
2,268
1,725
948
973
1,321
752
Steven Boyes
674
648
15
30
909
390
157
213
2
—
67
113
1,824
1,394
756
791
1,067
603
Mike Scott
514
494
23
18
693
297
102
62
—
—
51
49
1,384
920
589
561
795
359
Total
2,024
1,945
67
77
2,728
1,170
453
544
2
—
202
303
5,476
4,039
2,293
2,325
3,183
1,714
1	
Benefits (taxable) include the provision of a company car or car allowance, private medical insurance, some telephone costs and contributions towards obtaining independent financial and tax advice, and are provided based on market rates.
2	 Annual bonus for 2023/24 includes amounts deferred (see page 138).
3	 Performance conditions for the LTPP were tested after 30 June 2024. 15% of the award granted to each of the Executive Directors is due to vest in October 2024 (see pages 138 and 139 for further details). The market price of the shares has been calculated based on an average market value 
over the three months to 30 June 2024 £4.81 per share). None of the value of the award is attributed to share price growth. The values in the 2022/23 column have been re-calculated using a share price of £3.925 per share being the market value of the shares on the vesting date, 19 October 
2023, as opposed to the market price of £4.71 per share calculated based on an average market value over the three months to 30 June 2023 disclosed in last year’s Remuneration Report.
4	 The Sharesave shares granted in 2020 for Steven Boyes, which matured on 1 July 2023, were subject to a continued employment condition and completion of a savings contract. There are no performance conditions for Sharesave shares. The value calculated using the difference between the 
option price and the mid-market closing price of a share on the date of maturity is nil (relevant prices £4.56 and £4.14). Steven Boyes exercised these options on 31 December 2023 making a gain of £2,103 calculated using the difference between the option price and the mid-market closing price 
on 29 December 2023 being the last trading day before the date of exercise (relevant prices being £4.56 and £5.63).
5	 The total remuneration figures in the last three columns of the above table may not add up to the sum of the component parts, due to rounding.
Table 6 – Non-Executive Directors’ single figure of remuneration (audited)
Fees
£000
Benefits (taxable)
£000
Total
£000
2023/24
2022/23
2023/24
2022/23
2023/24
2022/23
Caroline Silver1
364
7
—
—
364
7
Katie Bickerstaffe
97
93
—
—
97
93
Jasi Halai1
83
40
—
—
83
40
Jock Lennox
115
110
—
—
115
110
Chris Weston
97
93
—
—
97
93
Nigel Webb2
60
—
—
—
60
—
John Allan
—
405
—
1
—
406
Nina Bibby
—
22
—
4
—
26
Sharon White
—
86
—
—
—
86
Total
816
856
—
5
816
861
1	
Caroline Silver and Jasi Halai were appointed to the Board with effect from 1 June and 1 January 2023 respectively. Their 2022/2023 fees therefore reflect a partial year. 
2	 Nigel Webb was appointed to the Board with effect from 1 October 2023 and his fees therefore reflect a partial year.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
136
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Directors’ remuneration outcomes for the year ended 
30 June 2024 continued
Annual bonus
For FY24, the business continued to focus on managing costs, with a strong emphasis on 
building sustainably whilst maintaining high customer service levels. The bonus measures 
were set accordingly. Financial targets were set taking into consideration internal and 
external consensus forecasts. 
As in previous years, Executive Directors had the potential to earn an annual bonus of up to 
150% of base salary. Achievement is based on the attainment of Group performance targets 
which are linked directly to the Group’s strategy. One-third of any bonus earned is deferred 
into shares (see page 138). The Group performance targets and performance against them 
for FY24 are set out in the table below. The Committee considers that the outcome reflects 
a fair, reasonable and appropriate level of reward, and the overall performance of the Group 
during FY24, and therefore no discretion was exercised in relation to the bonus outcomes. 
It also aligns to the bonus outcomes for the wider workforce below senior management.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
Table 7 – Annual bonus (audited)
Bonus target1
Reason performance target selected
Targets
Potential 
bonus 
weighting % 
of salary
Actual 
performance 
achievement
Bonus 
achieved
 % of
 salary
Bonus 
outcome % 
of maximum
Adjusted profit 
before tax
Rewards outperformance against stretching targets and is a key 
measure of our performance.
Threshold: £275m
Target: £350m 
Maximum: £400m
16.5%
41.25%
82.5%
£385m
70.1%
46.8%
Capital 
employed
Ensures efficient use of available capital.
Minimum and target: £1,923m
Maximum: £1,890m
7.5%
15.0%
£1,805.3m
15.0%
10.0%
Quality and 
service (with 
health and 
safety underpin)
Ensured a focus on quality and service to our customers without 
compromising the health and safety of our employees, customers, 
suppliers, sub-contractors and members of the public. 
A three-stage assessment is applied:
(i)	 a division must achieve SHE audit monitoring inspections 
gate on a rolling 12 months’ performance basis of 94% to be 
considered for the customer service element;
(ii)	 to earn 67% of this bonus element, the division must achieve 
90% or higher “recommend” score for the HBF eight-week 
National New Homes Customer Satisfaction Survey; and
(iii)	 to earn the remaining 33% of this bonus element, the division 
must also achieve 82% or higher score for the NHBC nine-month 
Customer Satisfaction Survey.
22.5%
SHE gate: 
29/29 divisions
Eight-
week score: 
28/29 divisions
Nine-month 
score: 
20/29 divisions
19.7%
13.1%
Construction 
waste reduction
Focuses individuals on reducing the amount of construction waste 
intensity, which is a key element of our overall carbon reduction and 
sustainability strategy.
Threshold: 4.31 tonnes
Target: 4.22 tonnes
Maximum: 4.15 tonnes
3.0%
7.5%
15.0%
3.83 tonnes
15.0%
10.0%
Diversity 
and inclusion
Focuses individuals on ensuring that, as part of any recruitment 
process, they identify candidates which will help further improve 
diversity within the business.
The Group must achieve an increase in the average rate of diverse 
appointments (gender and ethnicity) against a baseline of 20%. 
Threshold: 32%
Target: 34%
Maximum: 36%
3.0%
7.5%
15.0%
54.0%
15.0%
10.0%
Total outcome
134.8%
89.9%
1	
See definitions on pages 156 and 157 of the 2023 Annual Report and Accounts.
137
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Executive Directors’ deferred bonus 
Table 8 sets out the amount of bonus earned by each of 
the Executive Directors for FY24 and the split between cash 
(two-thirds of the bonus earned) and shares (one-third 
of the bonus earned). The number of shares that will be 
awarded will be calculated based on the average closing 
share price for the first five dealing days following the date 
on which the Group publishes its annual results and will be 
announced via the Regulatory Information Service when the 
shares are awarded. Deferred shares are held for a period 
of three years from the date they are awarded, subject 
normally to continued employment.
Table 8 – Executive Directors’ deferred bonus (audited)
FY24 deferred bonus
FY23 deferred bonus
Bonus 
earned
% of salary
Annual 
bonus
£000 
Bonus paid 
in cash
(two-thirds)
£000
Bonus
 deferred 
into shares
(one-third) 
£000
% of salary
deferred 
into shares
%
Bonus 
deferred 
into shares
£000
Number of 
shares
David Thomas
134.8
1,126
751
375
0
0
0
Steven Boyes
134.8
909
606
303
0
0
0
Mike Scott
134.8
693
462
231
0
0
0
Long-Term Performance Plans
Vesting of 2021 LTPP (included in FY24 single figure of remuneration)
The 2021 LTPP award was based on a three-year performance period to 30 June 2024 and will vest in October 2024. The award is subject to four performance conditions, 15% EPS, 
40% ROCE, 30% TSR (half of which is measured against a 50+/50- FTSE comparator group and the other half against a housebuilder index) and 15% for the reduction of GHG emissions. 
The resulting vesting levels are as follows:
Table 9 – Vesting of 2021 LTPP (audited)
Metric
Performance condition
Below Threshold
(0% vesting)
Threshold 
(25% vesting)
Maximum
(100% vesting)
Actual
Portion of 
award vesting
Absolute EPS for the financial year 
ended 30 June 2024 (15.0%)
EPS growth for the financial year ended 30 June 2024.
 <79 pence
79 pence
87 pence
12.7 pence 1 
0.0%
Underlying ROCE for the financial year 
ended 30 June 2024 (40.0%)
To increase Underlying ROCE for the financial year 
ended 30 June 2024.
 <19.0%
19.0%
22.0%
8.6%
0.0%
TSR (FTSE) (15.0%)
TSR against the 50 companies above and below the 
Company in the FTSE index measured over three 
financial years with a three-month average at the 
start and end of the performance period.
Below median Median ranking of 
47.0 TSR of 1.0%
Upper quartile 
ranking of 24.0 
TSR of 22.2%
Rank of 63.5 
TSR of (20.9%)
0.0%
TSR (housebuilder)2 (15.0%)
TSR of at least the index average of a housebuilder 
index measured over three financial years with a 
three-month average at the start and end of the 
performance period.
Below unweighted 
index average
Unweighted 
index average 
(TSR of (7.9)%)
Unweighted index 
average + 8% p.a. 
(TSR of 18.0%)
Below Threshold 
(TSR of (20.9)%)
0.0%
Reduction of GHG emissions (15.0%)
Based on the reduction of greenhouse gas emissions 
(the Greenhouse Gas Emissions Element) compared 
with 2018 levels. 
 <20.0% reduction
25.0%
30.0%
49.4%
15.0%
Total level of award vesting
15.0%
1	
The basic EPS of 11.8 pence has been re-based using the same rate of corporation tax and number of shares as was used in setting the 2021 LTPP targets. The re-based basic EPS used for the purpose of determining vesting, which is directly comparable to the 2021 targets, is 12.7 pence.
2	 The housebuilder index comprises: Bellway, Berkeley Homes, Countryside Partnerships, Crest Nicholson, Persimmon, Redrow, Taylor Wimpey and Vistry Group. On 11 November 2022, Countryside Partnerships was acquired by Vistry Group. At the time, both companies were members of the 
housebuilder index comparator group. The TSR performance for Countryside Partnerships has therefore been calculated based on the performance of Countryside Partnerships up to the date of the merger and then by tracking Vistry Group’s performance thereafter.
Directors’ remuneration outcomes for the year ended 30 June 2024 continued
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
138
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Directors’ remuneration outcomes for the year ended 30 June 2024 continued
Long-Term Performance Plans continued
Table 9 – Vesting of 2021 LTPP (audited)
Notwithstanding the extent to which each of the performance targets are met, the Committee had discretion to reduce the number of shares in respect of the awards if it considered 
that the Company’s underlying financial performance over the performance period did not warrant the level of vesting that would otherwise be achieved by reference to each of the TSR, 
EPS, Underlying ROCE and the reduction of GHG emissions performance targets. The Committee considered the underlying financial performance of the Group and was satisfied that 
given the continued strong performance in the Group’s financial results, the level of vesting was justified and is fair, reasonable and appropriate. There was no share price appreciation, 
and no discretion was exercised in relation to the share price. The Committee has therefore not exercised any discretion in relation to the LTPP vesting outcome. The 2021 LTPP has 
accrued dividend equivalents in accordance with the rules of the scheme. The amount of dividend equivalent to be paid, in cash, on vesting will be pro‑rated in line with the number 
of shares that vest. The gross number of shares to be released to each of the Executive Directors and the gross value of the dividend equivalents are as follows:
Table 10 – 2021 LTPP vesting outcomes (audited) 
Executive Director
Number of 
shares at
grant
Number 
of shares 
to lapse
Total number 
of shares 
to vest1
Estimated 
value of 
vested shares2
£000 
Value of 
dividend 
equivalents
 earned on 
vested shares2
£000
Total 
estimated 
value2,3
£000
David Thomas
224,370
190,715
33,655
162
33
194
Steven Boyes
180,987
153,839
27,148
131
26
157
Mike Scott4
117,716
100,059
17,657
85
17
102
1	
The relevant number of shares will be released to each participant as soon as is practicable following the vesting date. The awards are subject to a two-year post-vesting holding period commencing 1 July 2024.
2	 The estimated values of the vested shares and the dividend equivalents are based on the average share price during the three months to 30 June 2024 (£4.81 per share). There was no share price appreciation from the date the shares were awarded.
3 	 The total estimated value in the last column may not add up to the sum of component parts due to rounding
4	 The number of shares over which the award has been granted has been calculated based on 200% of the participant’s salary as at the date of appointment, being £480,000 per annum. In accordance with the participant’s final offer letter dated 24 June 2021, the number of shares subject to the  
award has been pro-rated to reflect the length of the performance period commencing from the date of appointment.
LTPP granted during the year (2023 LTPP)
In December 2023, the Committee granted the 2023 LTPP to Executive Directors. The 2023 LTPP is subject to four performance conditions, 30% TSR (half of which is measured against 
a 50+/50- FTSE comparator group and the other half against a housebuilder index), 15% Adjusted Absolute EPS, 40% Underlying ROCE and 15% reduction of GHG emissions. Further 
information on the reduction of GHG emissions and the progress against this target is given on pages 79 and 80. The levels of vesting against TSR and the reduction of GHG emissions will 
be measured over a three-year period commencing 1 July 2023, and against Absolute Adjusted EPS and Underlying ROCE for the financial year ending 30 June 2026. On completion of the 
performance period, assuming that shares vest, they will be subject to a further two-year holding period commencing on the vesting date. 
Table 11 – 2023 LTPP (audited)
Executive Director
Type of award
Basis of
award granted
Share price at
 date of grant 1
£
Number of 
shares over 
which award 
was granted
Face value 
of award
£000 
% of face value
 that would vest 
at threshold 
performance
Vesting 
determined by
performance over
David Thomas
Conditional award
200% of salary of £835,540
4.2748
390,914
1,671
25
Three financial 
years to 
30 June 2026
Steven Boyes
Conditional award
200% of salary of £673,985
4.2748
315,329
1,348
25
Mike Scott
Conditional award
200% of salary of £514,180
4.2748
240,563
1,028
25
1	
Based on the average of the closing prices, as derived from the London Stock Exchange Daily Official List, for each of the dealing days (excluding days within a prohibited period defined by the Market Abuse Regulation) in the period of three months ending on 20 December 2023, being the day 
before the date of the awards.
The targets applicable to the 2023 LTPP are as set out in Table 13. 
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
139
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

2022 and 2023 LTPP awards
The following tables show the targets set on grant for each of the 2022 and 2023 LTPP awards. 
Table 12 – 2022 LTPP award performance targets
Performance target
(weighting as % of maximum award)
Below threshold 
(0% vesting)
Threshold 
(25% vesting)
Maximum 
(100% vesting)
TSR FTSE1 (15.0%)
Below median
Median
Upper quartile
TSR housebuilder2 (15.0%)
Below unweighted index average
Unweighted index average
Unweighted index average +8% p.a.
Adjusted EPS (15.0%)
<73 pence
73 pence
81 pence
Underlying ROCE (40.0%)
<20.0%
20.0%
23.0%
GHG emissions reduction (15.0%)
<25% reduction
30% reduction
35% reduction
1	
The comparator group for TSR FTSE is each of the members ranking 50 above and 50 below the Company in the FTSE index.
2	 The housebuilder Index comprises: Bellway, Berkeley Homes, Countryside Partnerships, Crest Nicholson, Persimmon, Redrow, Taylor Wimpey and Vistry Group. On 11 November 2022, Countryside Partnerships was acquired by Vistry Group. At the time, both companies were members of the 
housebuilder index comparator group. The TSR performance for Countryside Partnerships has therefore been calculated based on the performance of Countryside Partnerships up to the date of the merger and then by tracking Vistry Group’s performance thereafter.
Table 13 – 2023 LTPP award performance targets
Performance target
(weighting as % of maximum award)
Below threshold 
(0% vesting)
Threshold 
(25% vesting)
Maximum 
(100% vesting)
TSR FTSE1 (15.0%)
Below median
Median
Upper quartile
TSR housebuilder2 (15.0%)
Below unweighted index average
Unweighted index average
Unweighted index average +8% p.a.
Absolute Adjusted EPS (15.0%)
<38 pence
38 pence
42 pence
Underlying ROCE (40.0%)
<11.0%
11.0%
13.0%
GHG emissions reduction (15.0%)
<29% reduction
33% reduction
38% reduction
1	
The comparator group for TSR FTSE is each of the members ranking 50 above and 50 below the Company in the FTSE index.
2	 The housebuilder index comprises: Bellway, Berkeley Homes, Crest Nicholson, Persimmon, Redrow, Taylor Wimpey and Vistry Group.
For the TSR, EPS and Underlying ROCE performance targets, vesting is on a straight-line 
basis between threshold and maximum. For the reduction of GHG emissions performance 
target, vesting is on a straight-line basis between 25% and 35% reduction for the 2022 
award, and between 29% and 38% for the 2023 award. The LTPP awards will accrue 
dividend equivalents in accordance with the rules of the scheme. The amount of dividend 
equivalent to be paid, in cash, on vesting will be pro-rated according to the number of 
shares that vest.
The Committee has the discretion to adjust the number of shares vesting from each LTPP 
award if it considers that the vesting outcome is not sufficiently reflective of the underlying 
performance of the Company and to mitigate against any potential windfall gains for the 
Executive Directors.
Statement of Directors’ shareholdings and share interests
For the financial year ended 30 June 2024, Executive Directors were required to hold shares 
in the Company equivalent in value to 200% of salary. The Executive Directors are expected 
to meet this requirement no later than the fifth anniversary of joining the Board, with progress 
being made towards its achievement throughout the period. The share price used for the 
purposes of determining the value of the shares is by reference to the higher of the share 
price paid on acquisition or vesting and the share price at the close of business on the 
London Stock Exchange on 30 June or the date of leaving, as applicable. Participants who 
have not built up the required level of shareholding by the fifth anniversary of joining the 
Board will not be eligible for inclusion in future share-based incentive schemes. In addition, 
they will not be allowed to sell any of the net of tax shares released from incentive schemes 
until they reach the levels specified, unless exceptional circumstances exist in the opinion 
of the Committee. 
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
140
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of Directors’ shareholdings and share interests continued
The Committee retains discretion to adjust the length of time in which the required amount 
of shareholding needs to be accrued to adjust for events out of the Director’s control. The 
Committee reserves the right to amend the percentage holding required by the Executive 
Directors depending on market conditions and best practice guidance. On 30 June 2024, 
David Thomas and Steven Boyes had met their shareholding requirements and Mike Scott 
has until 6 December 2026 to meet his.
Executive Directors are also subject to a two-year post-cessation shareholding requirement. 
They must hold the lower of their shareholding requirement (currently 200% of salary) or 
their actual shareholding on the date of leaving. The Committee has agreed that to ensure 
continued enforcement of the post-cessation shareholding requirement, a contractual 
agreement will be entered into by the Company and the relevant Executive Director at 
the point of leaving employment, under which the individual concerned will agree not to 
dispose of the shares prior to the completion of the post-cessation shareholding period.
The interests of the Directors serving during the financial year and their connected persons in 
the ordinary share capital of the Company at the end of FY24 are shown in the table below.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
Table 14 – Directors’ interests in shares as at 30 June 2024 (audited)
Other share interests
Options
Shareholding requirements
Beneficially
 owned 
Interests subject to
performance 
conditions (LTPP)
Interests not subject 
to performance
conditions (DBP)
Interests in 
Sharesave 
options 1
Shareholding 
requirement 
% of salary
Current 
shareholding 
% of salary 6
Shareholding 
requirement 
met?
Executive Directors
David Thomas
1,326,830
923,030
140,770
7,807 5
200%
792%
Yes
Steven Boyes
728,082 2
744,559
113,333 3
9,110 4,5
200%
552%
Yes
Mike Scott
69,832
547,661
—
4,128
200%
64%
No
Non-Executive Directors
Caroline Silver
10,000
The Chair and Non-Executive Directors are not awarded incentive shares and are not subject to 
a shareholding requirement.
Katie Bickerstaffe
8,489
Jasi Halai
12,581
Jock Lennox
10,000
Chris Weston
—
Nigel Webb
12,660
1	
All of these options were unexercised at 30 June 2024.
2 On 11 July 2024 the interest of Steven Boyes and his connected persons in the ordinary share capital of the Company increased by 153 shares following the vesting of awards made under the Company’s 2022 ELTIP to a person closely associated with Steven Boyes. The 153 increase represents the 
shares retained following the sale of shares to satisfy tax and National Insurance liabilities. Following this, Steven Boyes, beneficial interest in the Company’s shares was 728,235.
3	 Includes 112,758 DBP shares held by Steven Boyes and 575 awards under the Company’s ELTIP made to a person closely associated with Steven Boyes. On 11 July the person closely associated with Steven Boyes' exercised 271 ELTIP awards, following which the interest in shares not subject to 
performance conditions was 113,062. On 22 July 2024 the person closely associated with Steven Boyes was awarded 150 shares under the ELTIP, following which the interest in shares not subject to performance conditions was 113,212. The ELTIP is an all-employee award made to employees 
grade 4 and below.
4	 Includes options held by a person closely associated with Steven Boyes.
5	 During the year, David Thomas and a person closely associated with Steven Boyes were each granted 2,434 Sharesave options, exercisable for six months from 1 July 2027 at an option price of £3.81, representing a 20% discount on the average share price for the five business days immediately 
before the invitation to participate in the award (£4.753). The number of shares granted was based on the option price and the total savings amount forecast at the end of the respective savings periods. The face value of the options based on the average share price above was £11,569 for 
David Thomas and for the person closely associated with Steven Boyes. There are no performance targets associated with this Sharesave option.
6	 The share price used for the purposes of determining the value of the shares is £4.722, being the mid-market closing price on 30 June 2024. Shares counting towards the shareholding requirement include those beneficially owned and DBP shares. The value of DBP shares used is net of income 
tax and National Insurance contributions which the Directors would have to pay on exercise.
All conditional awards and share options are subject to an overriding Committee discretion, in that the Committee must be satisfied that the underlying financial performance of the 
Group over the performance period warrants the level of vesting as determined by applying the relevant targets. If the Committee is not of this view, it has the authority to reduce the 
level of vesting, including to nil, as it deems appropriate. 
141
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Executive Directors’ pension arrangements
The Company’s pension policy for Executive Directors is 
that on joining the Group they will be auto-enrolled unless 
they choose to opt out. On opting out, the Executive 
Director may choose to receive a cash supplement (which 
does not count for incentive purposes) and/or participate 
in the Company’s defined contribution money purchase 
pension plan. Each Executive Director has opted to receive 
a cash supplement in lieu of pension. From 1 January 2023 
all Executive Directors have received an amount equal to 
10% of base salary in line with the pension level available 
to the wider workforce. Only the base salary element of a 
Director’s remuneration is pensionable.
 Details of the cash supplements paid to the Executive Directors during the 
year can be found in Table 5 on page 136.
Defined benefit section (audited)
Steven Boyes is a deferred member of the defined benefit 
section of the Barratt Group Pension and Life Assurance 
Scheme (the Scheme), which was bought out by an insurer 
during FY21. As a result of the buyout, no employee (including 
Steven Boyes) has any current or prospective defined benefit 
pension or related benefit payable by the Group.
Payments to former Directors (audited)
Jessica White stepped down as a Director and Chief 
Financial Officer on 30 June 2021 and left the business on 
31 July 2021. The Committee determined that in line with 
the Policy and the rules of the relevant plans Jessica would 
be treated as a good leaver. 
As set out in the FY21 Remuneration Report, Jessica held 56,462 
shares under the 2020 LTPP. 11,066 of these shares vested on 
6 October 2023. The awards were valued using a share price of 
£4.22, being the market price of the shares on the vesting date. 
The value of the shares and dividend equivalent (paid in cash) 
was £46,699 and £11,232 respectively, such that the total value of 
the award on the vesting date was £57,931. No other payments to 
past directors were made during the year.
Payments for loss of office (audited)
No payments for loss of office have been made to former 
Directors during the year.
Chief Executive’s relative pay
The table below sets out: (i) the total pay, calculated in line with the single figure methodology; (ii) the annual bonus 
payout as a percentage of maximum; and (iii) long-term incentive vesting level for the Chief Executive over a ten-year period.
Table 15 – Chief Executive’s pay
Mark Clare
David Thomas
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Chief Executive’s 
total pay (£000)
7,363
3,155
3,331
2,720
3,727
1,251
3,761
2,738
1,725 
2,268
Bonus outturn 
(as a percentage 
of maximum 
opportunity) 
93.2
97.4
97.5
92.2
96.2
0
99.0
98.3
40.1
89.9
LTI vesting (as a 
percentage of 
maximum award)
100.0
100.0
100.0
76.4
92.8
19.4
80.0
59.3
19.6
15.0
TSR performance graph
The graph below, prepared in accordance with the reporting regulations, shows the TSR performance over the last 
ten years against the FTSE 100 and against an unweighted index of listed housebuilders. The Board has chosen 
these comparative indices as the Group and its major competitors are constituents of one or both of these indices. 
The TSR has been calculated using a fair method in accordance with the regulations.
Total shareholder return (value of £100 invested on 30 June 2014)
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
  Index of currently listed Housebuilders 
  FTSE 100 
  Barratt Developments
Source: Datastream by Refinitiv
Value (£)
June 2014
June 2015
June 2016
June 2017
June 2018
June 2019
June 2020
June 2021
June 2022
June 2023
June 2024
237
224
178
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
142
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Annual percentage change in remuneration of Directors compared to employees 
Table 16 shows the percentage change in salary, taxable benefits and annual bonus set out in the relevant single figure of remuneration tables paid to each Director compared to that 
of the average pay of all employees of Barratt Developments PLC, the Group parent company, in respect of the financial years ended 30 June 2020 to 30 June 2024, compared with their 
prior years.
Table 16 – Percentage change in remuneration 
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
FY20
Salary/
fees
% change
Benefits
% change
Annual
 bonus
% change
Salary/
fees
% change
Benefits
% change
Annual
 bonus
% change
Salary/
fees
% change
Benefits
% change
Annual
 bonus
% change
Salary/
fees
% change 1
Benefits
% change
Annual
 bonus
% change
Salary/
fees
% change
Benefits
% change
Annual
 bonus
% change
Executive Directors
David Thomas
4.1
0.0
133.1
2.9
3.6
(58.0)
3.0
7.7
2.5
2.2
(10.3)
100.0
0.3
16.0
(100.0)
Steven Boyes
4.0
(50.0)
133.1
3.0
(3.2)
(58.1)
5.0
(25.0)
4.4
2.2
11.1
100.0
0.2
(12.2)
(100.0)
Mike Scott2
4.0
27.8
133.3
78.3
100.0
(26.1)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Non-Executive Directors3
Caroline Silver4
3.1
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Katie Bickerstaffe4
4.3
N/A
N/A
1.1
N/A
N/A
41.5
0.0
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Jasi Halai4
5.1
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Jock Lennox
4.5
N/A
N/A
0.9
N/A
N/A
41.6
0.0
N/A
4.1
0.0
N/A
0.0
0.0
N/A
Chris Weston4
4.3
N/A
N/A
1.1
N/A
N/A
43.8
0.0
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nigel Webb4
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Average pay of all employees 
in Barratt Developments PLC
1.0
(6.2)
6.1
(2.6)
(12.1)
(32.6)
(1.1)
(11.3)
(3.2)
7.7
(3.5)
100.0
4.0
6.4
(100.0)
Average pay of all employees 
in the Group5
1.9
(1.7)
62.2
7.5
11.5
(39.5)
7.8
(2.1)
(3.2)
0.4
2.1
100.0
0.8
(1.5)
(100.0)
1	
The percentage changes in salary and fees of the Directors for FY21 takes into account a temporary 20% voluntary reduction in base salary in April and May 2020 covering the period our construction sites were temporarily closed as a consequence of COVID-19.
2	 Mike Scott was appointed as an Executive Director effective 6 December 2021; therefore, no percentage change in remuneration is displayed for years prior to FY23 and the change in fees reflects the annualised fees that would have been earned for FY22.
3	 The changes in fees of the Non-Executive Directors reflect the introduction of additional fees for Committee membership and increases in fees for Committee Chairs which took place for FY22 and were set out in detail on page 102 of the FY21 Annual Report and Accounts. 
4	 Katie Bickerstaffe and Chris Weston were appointed to the Board part way through FY21, Jasi Halai and Caroline Silver were appointed to the Board part way through FY23 and Nigel Webb was appointed to the Board part way through FY24. No percentage change in remuneration is displayed 
for the years they joined, and the changes in fees reflect the annualised fees that would have been earned for the year they joined the Board. The Change in fees for Caroline Silver reflect the annual Chair fee that would have been earned in FY23.
5	 Average pay using all employees in the Group is provided as a more meaningful figure, as the parent company employs only a very few senior employees. The figure represents the mean employee pay. As set out in the 2023 Remuneration Report, the average salary increase for the wider   
workforce on 1 July 2023 was 5.3%.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
143
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Chief Executive pay ratio
The table below compares the single total figure of remuneration for the Chief Executive 
with that of the Group employees who are paid at the 25th percentile (lower quartile), 
50th percentile (median) and 75th percentile (upper quartile) of its UK employee population.
Table 17 – Chief Executive pay ratio
Method
25th percentile pay ratio
Median pay ratio
75th percentile pay ratio
FY24
Option B
59:1
42:1
26:1
FY23
Option B
44:1
32:1
23:1
FY22
Option B
81:1
63:1
38:1
FY21
Option B
115:1
94:1
60:1
FY20
Option B
40:1
32:1
21:1
FY19
Option B
123:1
88:1
59:1
The remuneration figures for the employee at each quartile were determined with reference 
to the financial year ended 30 June 2024.
Under Option B of The Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018, the latest 
available gender pay gap data (i.e. from 5 April 2024) was used to identify the best equivalent 
for three Group UK employees whose hourly rates of pay are at the 25th, 50th and 75th 
percentiles for the Group. The Committee is comfortable that this approach provides 
a fair representation of the Chief Executive to employee pay ratios and is appropriate 
in comparison to alternative methods, balancing the need for statistical accuracy with 
internal operational resource constraints.
A full-time equivalent total pay and benefits figure for the FY24 financial year was then 
calculated for each of those employees. This was also sense checked against a sample of 
employees with hourly pay rates either side of the identified individuals to ensure that the 
appropriate representative employee is selected. The pay ratios outlined above were then 
calculated as the ratio of the Chief Executive’s single figure to the total pay and benefits of 
each of these employees.
Each employee’s pay and benefits were calculated using each element of employee 
remuneration on a full-time basis, consistent with the Chief Executive. No adjustments 
(other than the approximate uprating of pay elements to achieve full-time equivalent rates) 
were made, with the exception of annual bonuses where the amount paid during the year 
for the annual bonus and H2 bonus was used (i.e. in respect of FY23) as the FY24 employee 
figures had not yet been determined at the time this report was produced. No components 
of pay have been omitted.
The table below sets out the salary and total pay and benefits for the three identified 
quartile point employees:
Table 18
25th percentile 
(P25)
Median
(P50)
75th percentile 
(P75)
Salary
£36,005
£39,250
£59,715
Total pay and benefits
£38,650
£54,132
£87,585
The FY24 pay ratios are higher than last year due to an increase in the Chief Executive’s 
single figure of remuneration compared to FY23. The increase in the Chief Executive's pay 
is a result of an increase in annual bonus payout when compared to FY23. The median pay 
ratio has fluctuated since reporting began. This movement has primarily been driven by 
both changes in the Chief Executive's pay outcomes and the impact of the pandemic on 
outcomes in recent years. The Committee considers that the median pay ratio is consistent 
with the relative roles and responsibilities of the Chief Executive and the identified employee. 
Base salaries of all employees, including our Executive Directors, are set with reference to a range 
of factors including market practice, experience and performance in role. The Chief Executive’s 
remuneration package is weighted towards variable pay (including the annual bonus and LTPP) 
due to the nature of the role. This also means that the ratio is likely to fluctuate depending on 
the outcomes of incentive plans in each year (as illustrated by the ratios to date).
The Committee also recognises that, due to the nature of the Company’s business and 
the ways in which we employ our staff, the flexibility permitted within the regulations for 
identifying and calculating the total pay and benefits for employees, as well as differences 
in employment and remuneration models between companies, the ratios reported above 
may not be comparable to those reported by other companies.
Service contracts and letters of appointment 
The letters of appointment for Non-Executive Directors and service contracts for 
Executive Directors are available for inspection by any person at the Company’s 
registered office during normal office hours or are available on the Company’s website: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/investors.
As previously announced, we expect Matthew Pratt, Nicky Dulieu and Geeta Nanda to 
join the Board once either: (i) undertakings have been agreed with the Competition and 
Markets Authority (CMA) that address the CMA’s limited concerns in connection with the 
combination of Barratt and Redrow; or (ii) the CMA otherwise agrees to their appointment. 
As such, Matthew, Nicky and Geeta may join the Board either before the date of the AGM or 
after the date of the AGM, depending on the process with the CMA.
Provided that they are appointed as Directors by the Board prior to the date of the AGM, 
Matthew, Nicky and Geeta will seek election by shareholders for the first time at the 2024 
AGM. If they are not appointed as Directors by the Board prior to the date of the AGM, they 
will instead seek election by shareholders for the first time at the 2025 AGM. 
As Matthew, Nicky and Geeta have not yet been appointed they do not yet have service 
contracts (Matthew) or letters of appointment (Nicky and Geeta) but will duly sign such 
on their appointment to the Combined Board. 
The current Executive Directors have service contracts with the Company all with a rolling 
12-month notice period and are not fixed term. Details are included in the following table 
and their remuneration for FY24 is shown in the single figure table on page 136.
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
144
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Service contracts and letters of appointment continued
Table 19 – Executive Directors’ service contracts
Executive Director
Service contract date
Date of appointment
Notice period/
Unexpired term
David Thomas
16 January 2013
21 July 2009
12 months
Steven Boyes
21 February 2013
1 July 2001
12 months
Mike Scott
28 June 2021
6 December 2021
12 months
The Chair and each of the Non-Executive Directors are appointed for an initial three-year 
term under terms set out in a letter of appointment. Their appointments can be terminated 
by the Board without compensation for loss of office subject to the notice periods in 
their respective letters of appointment. The notice periods, applicable from either party, 
are three months for the Chair and one month for each of the Non-Executive Directors. 
The Chair and each of the Non-Executive Directors usually serve a second three-year 
term subject to performance review and can serve a further term of three years subject 
to rigorous review by the Chair and the Nomination Committee. Details of Non-Executive 
Directors’ letters of appointment are given in Table 20 below.
Table 20 – Non-Executive Directors’ letters of appointment
Non-Executive 
Director
Date elected/
re-elected at AGM
Date first 
appointed 
to the Board
Date last 
re-appointed 
to the Board
Unexpired 
term as at 
30 June 2024
Caroline Silver
18 October 2023
1 June 20231
N/A
23 months
Katie Bickerstaffe
18 October 2023
1 March 2021
1 March 2024
32 months
Jasi Halai
18 October 2023
1 January 2023
N/A
18 months
Jock Lennox
18 October 2023
1 July 2016
1 July 2022
12 months
Nigel Webb
18 October 2023
1 October 2023
N/A
27 months
Chris Weston
18 October 2023
1 March 2021
1 March 2024
32 months
1	
Appointed as Chair on 30 June 2023.
Non-executive directorships
Subject to Board approval, Executive Directors are permitted to accept one non-executive 
directorship outside the Company and retain any fees received from such a position. 
Board approval will not be given for any non-executive position where such appointment 
would lead to a material conflict of interest or would have an effect on the Director's 
ability to perform their duties to the Company. Neither Steven Boyes nor Mike Scott held 
any non-executive directorships with other companies during the year. David Thomas is 
a Non-Executive Director of the HBF and a Trustee at CentrePoint, the UK’s leading youth 
homelessness charity for which he does not receive fees. He also participates in various 
groups connected with the UK construction industry (in particular sustainability), for which 
no fee is paid.
Relative importance of spend on pay 
The following table shows the Group’s actual spend on pay (for all employees) relative to 
dividends and profit from operations:
Table 21 – Relative importance of spend on pay
FY24
£m
FY23
£m
% change
Employee costs (including Executive Directors)
524.0
527.2
(1)%
Profit from operations1
174.7
707.4
(75)%
Dividend distributions2
212.8
328.2
(35)%
Share buyback
—
201.3
N/A
1	
Profit from operations has been chosen as a metric to compare against as it shows how spend on pay is linked to the Group’s operating 
performance. The figure used is from the Consolidated Income Statement on page 159.
2	 For FY23 this includes the interim and final dividends paid in May and November 2023. For FY24, this includes the interim dividend paid in 
May 2024, and the proposed final dividend for payment in November 2024, the value of which has been calculated based on the number of 
shares in issue as of 30 June 2024.
Statement of shareholding vote at AGM
The latest resolution to approve the Directors’ Remuneration Policy (a binding vote, to 
remain in place for three years following its approval by shareholders) and the resolution 
to approve last year’s Annual Report on Remuneration (an advisory vote) were proposed to 
shareholders at the 2023 AGM. The following votes were received:
Table 22 – Shareholder votes on remuneration
Vote on Remuneration Policy
Vote on Remuneration Report
Number of
 votes
% of
votes cast
Number of
 votes
% of
votes cast
Votes cast in favour
624,689,860
97.64
625,027,962
97.68
Votes cast against
15,087,581
2.36
14,843,737
2.32
Number of votes cast
639,777,4411
100
639,871,6992
100
Votes withheld
135,984
—
41,726
—
1	
65.65% of the issued share capital.
2	 65.66% of the issued share capital.
This Remuneration Report was approved by the Board on 3 September 2024 and signed on 
its behalf by:
Katie Bickerstaffe
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
3 September 2024
Remuneration Report continued
Annual Report on Remuneration continued
145
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Other statutory disclosures
Directors’ Report
For the financial year ended 30 June 2024, the Strategic Report 
is set out on pages 1 to 88 and the Directors’ Report on 
pages 89 to 148. The table below sets out the location 
of information required to be disclosed in the Directors’ 
Report, which can be found in other sections of this Annual 
Report and Accounts and is incorporated by reference.
Information required
Page numbers
Arrangements under which a shareholder 
has waived or agreed to waive a dividend 
and details of the waiver1
 See page 191
Likely future developments in the business 
of the Group
 See pages 16 
to 21
Financial instruments
 See pages 
189 and 190
A description of the Company’s policies on 
employment of people with disabilities
 See page 31
A description of the Company’s employee 
engagement and involvement practices
 See pages 
50 and 51
Stakeholder engagement
 See pages 
50 to 57
Greenhouse gas emissions
 See pages 79 
and 80
Research and development activities
 See pages 21, 
37, 76 and 78
Post balance sheet events
 See page 199
1	
This item is a requirement of UK Listing Rules. All other items are requirements of Schedule 
7 of the Large and Medium-Sized Companies and Groups Regulations.
Dividends
An interim dividend of 4.4 pence per share was paid on 
17 May 2024 to those shareholders on the register on 
12  April 2024 (2023: 10.2 pence per share). The Directors 
recommend payment of a final dividend of 11.8 pence per 
share (2023: 23.5 pence per share) in respect of FY24. The 
final dividend will be paid, subject to shareholder approval 
at the 2024 AGM, on 1 November 2024 to shareholders on 
the register at close of business on 27 September 2024. 
Shareholders who wish to elect for the Dividend Reinvestment 
Plan should do so by 11 October 2024.
If approved, the total dividend for FY24 will be 16.2 pence 
per share (2023: 33.7 pence per share).
Annual General Meeting
The 2024 AGM will be held at the offices of Linklaters 
LLP, One Silk Street, London EC2Y 8HQ, on Wednesday 
23 October 2024 at 12 noon. The notice convening the 
AGM is set out in a separate letter to shareholders.
Political donations and expenditure
The Company made no political donations during the year 
in accordance with its policy. In keeping with the Company’s 
approach in prior years, shareholder approval is being sought 
at the 2024 AGM, as a precautionary measure, for donations 
and/or expenditure that may be construed as political by 
the wide definition of such terms provided under the Act.
Significant shareholdings
In accordance with the DTRs, all notifications received 
by the Company are published on the Company’s website, 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk, and via a Regulatory 
Information Service. As at 30 June 2024, the persons set 
out in the table below had notified the Company, pursuant 
to DTR 5.1, of their interests in the voting rights in the 
Company’s issued share capital:
Notifiable interests at 30 June 2024
Information 
required
Direct
 voting
 rights
Indirect
 voting
 rights
Other
 financial
 instruments
 with voting
 rights
Total 
voting
 rights 1
% of
 total
 voting
 rights 2
FMR LLC
0 69,616,891
0 69,616,891
7.14
BlackRock, 
Inc.
0 50,384,303
6,029,401 56,413,704
5.60
1	
Represents the number of voting rights last notified to the Company at 30 June 2024 by the 
respective shareholder in accordance with DTR 5.1.
2	 Based on the Total Voting Rights as at the relevant notification dates.
On 26 August 2024, Blackrock Inc, notified the Company 
that its interest in the voting rights in the Company’s 
issued share capital has increased from 5.60% to 6.49%. 
Subsequently, on 28 August 2024, Blackrock Inc notified 
the Company that its interests in the voting rights in the 
Company’s issued share capital had increased from 6.49% 
to 6.50%. As at 2 September 2024 the Company had not 
received any further notifications.
Directors
The Directors who served during the financial year are set 
out on pages 90 to 92.
Appointment and removal of Directors
The appointment and removal of Directors is governed by 
the Articles, the Act and related legislation. There shall be 
(unless otherwise determined by an ordinary resolution) no 
fewer than two and no more than 15 Directors appointed 
to the Board at any one time. Directors may be appointed 
by the Company by ordinary resolution or by the Board. In 
accordance with the Code and the Articles, at each AGM, 
all of the Directors shall retire from office at the date of the 
Notice of AGM and may offer themselves for reappointment 
by members. Directors may be removed before the expiration 
of their term of office by means set out in the Act and the 
Articles, including by special resolution.
Powers of the Directors including in 
relation to the allotment of shares
Subject to the Articles, the Act and any directions given 
by special resolution, the business of the Company is 
ultimately managed by the Board who may exercise all 
the powers of the Company, whether relating to the 
management of the business of the Company or otherwise. 
In particular, the Board may exercise all the powers of the 
Company to borrow money and to mortgage or charge any 
of its undertakings, property, assets and uncalled capital 
and to issue debentures and other securities and to give 
security for any debt, liability or obligation of the Company 
to any third party. At the AGM held on 18 October 2023, 
the Directors were given authority to allot shares up to 
an aggregate nominal value of £32,486,193 (representing 
approximately one-third of the nominal value of the Company’s 
issued share capital as at 5 September 2023), such authority 
to remain valid until the end of the 2024 AGM or, if earlier, 
until the close of business on 18 January 2025. A resolution 
to renew this authority will be proposed at the 2024 AGM.
146
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Directors’ indemnities and insurance
Qualifying third-party indemnity provisions are in place for 
the Directors, former Directors and the Company Secretary, 
together with those who hold or have held these positions 
as officers of other Group companies or of associate 
or affiliated companies and members of the Executive 
Committee, to the extent permitted by law and the Articles, 
in respect of liabilities incurred in the course of performing 
their duties. In addition, the Company maintains directors’ 
and officers’ liability insurance for each Director of the 
Group and its associated companies.
Capital structure
The Company has a single class of share capital, which is 
divided into ordinary shares of 10 pence each. All issued 
shares are in registered form and are fully paid. Details of 
the Company’s issued share capital as at 30 June 2024 can 
be found in note 22 on page 191. Details of the allotment of 
shares in relation to the Combination can be found in note 
31 on page 199.
Shareholder voting rights and restrictions 
on transfer of shares
All the issued and outstanding ordinary shares of the Company 
have equal voting rights with one vote per share. There are 
no special control rights attaching to them, save that the 
Trustees of the EBT may vote or abstain from voting on 
shares held in the EBT in any way they think fit and in doing 
so may consider both financial and non-financial interests 
of the beneficiaries of the EBT or their dependants. The 
Company is not aware of any agreements between holders 
of securities that may result in restrictions on the transfer 
of securities. The rights, including full details relating to 
voting of shareholders and any restrictions on transfer 
relating to the Company’s ordinary shares, are set out in the 
Articles and in the explanatory notes that accompany the 
Notice of the 2024 AGM. These documents are available on 
the Company’s website at www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk.
Shareholder authority for purchase 
of own shares
At the Company’s AGM held on 18 October 2023, shareholders 
authorised the Company to buy back up to an aggregate of 
97,458,579 ordinary shares of 10 pence each (representing 
approximately 10% of the Company’s issued share capital).
This authority is valid until the end of the 2024 AGM 
(at which a renewal of that authority will be sought) or, 
if earlier, until the close of business on 18 January 2025. 
Under the authority, there is a minimum and maximum 
price to be paid for such shares.
Any shares that are bought back may be held as treasury 
shares or, if not so held, will be cancelled immediately 
upon completion of the purchase, thereby reducing the 
Company’s issued share capital.
Articles of Association
The Articles may only be amended by a special resolution 
of shareholders. The Articles were last amended at the 
Company’s AGM held on 13 October 2021.
Approach to tax and tax governance
For all taxes, it is the Group’s aim to ensure it accurately 
calculates and pays the tax that is due at the correct time. 
Whilst the Group does seek to minimise its tax liabilities 
through legitimate routine tax planning, it does not participate 
in aggressive tax planning schemes. The Group also seeks 
to be transparent in its dealings with HMRC and has 
regular dialogue with its representatives to discuss both 
developments in the business and the ongoing tax position. 
In accordance with UK legislation, we have published 
details of our tax strategy, and this can be found at 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk.
The Chief Financial Officer retains overall responsibility 
for oversight of the tax affairs of the Group. Mike Scott, 
Chief Financial Officer, is the Senior Accounting Officer 
throughout the year ended 30 June 2024. The Senior 
Accounting Officer receives regular updates on tax matters. 
In addition, tax management and strategy are reviewed at 
least annually by the Audit and Risk Committee, with no 
changes proposed for the year ended 30 June 2024.
Change of control
The following significant agreements as at 30 June 2024 
contained provisions entitling the counterparties to exercise 
termination and/or other rights in the event of a change of 
control of the Company:
	• an RCF agreement containing change of control provisions 
which provide that, on a change of control of the Company, 
the relevant counterparties may require the Company to 
immediately repay all amounts outstanding and would not 
be obliged to fund any further drawdown of the facility 
(other than rollover loans); and
	• a note purchase agreement in respect of the Group’s 
£200m privately placed notes containing change of control 
provisions which provide that, on a change of control of 
the Company, the noteholders may require the Company 
to prepay at par all outstanding amounts under the notes.
In addition, the Company’s share plans contain provisions 
relating to a change of control. Outstanding awards and 
options would normally vest and become exercisable 
on a change of control subject to the satisfaction of any 
performance conditions at that time.
The Company is not aware of any other significant agreements 
to which it is a party that take effect, alter or terminate 
upon a change of control of the Company.
The Company does not have any agreements with any 
Director or employee that would provide compensation 
for loss of office or employment resulting from change 
of control following a takeover bid.
On behalf of the Board
Tina Bains
Company Secretary
3 September 2024
Other statutory disclosures continued
147
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
Financial Statements and accounting records
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual 
Report and Accounts including the Directors’ Remuneration 
Report and the Financial Statements in accordance with 
applicable law and regulations.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare Financial 
Statements for each financial year. Under that law the Directors 
are required to prepare the Group Financial Statements in 
accordance with United Kingdom adopted IAS. The Financial 
Statements also comply with IFRS as issued by the IASB. 
The Directors have also elected to prepare the Parent Company 
Financial Statements under United Kingdom adopted IAS. 
Under company law, the Directors must not approve the 
Financial Statements unless they are satisfied that they give 
a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company 
and the Group and of the profit or loss of the Company and 
the Group for that period.
IAS 1 requires that Financial Statements present fairly for 
each financial year the relevant entity’s financial position, 
financial performance and cash flows. This requires the 
faithful representation of the effects of transactions, other 
events and conditions in accordance with the definitions 
and recognition criteria for assets, liabilities, income 
and expenses set out in the IASB’s “Framework for the 
preparation and presentation of financial statements”. 
In virtually all circumstances, a fair presentation will be 
achieved by compliance with all applicable IFRS.
Directors are also required to:
	• properly select and apply accounting policies;
	• present information, including accounting policies, in a 
manner that provides relevant, reliable, comparable and 
understandable information;
	• provide additional disclosures when compliance with the 
specific requirements in IFRS are insufficient to enable 
users to understand the impact of particular transactions, 
other events and conditions on the entity’s financial 
position and financial performance; and
	• make an assessment of the Company’s and the Group’s 
(as the case may be) ability to continue as a going concern.
The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate 
accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain 
the Company’s and the Group’s transactions on an individual 
and consolidated basis and disclose with reasonable 
accuracy at any time the financial position of the Company 
and the Group and enable them to ensure that the Financial 
Statements comply with the Act. They are also responsible 
for safeguarding the assets of the Company and the Group 
and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention 
and detection of fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and 
integrity of the corporate and financial information included 
on the Company’s website. Legislation in the UK governing 
the preparation and dissemination of Financial Statements 
may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.
Fair, balanced and understandable
The Board considers, on the advice of the Audit and Risk 
Committee, that the Annual Report and Accounts, taken 
as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable, and 
provides the information necessary for shareholders to 
assess the Company and the Group’s position, performance, 
business model and strategy.
Disclosure of information to auditor 
In accordance with Section 418 of the Act, the Directors 
confirm that, so far as they are each aware, there is no 
relevant audit information that has not been brought 
to the attention of the Company’s auditor. Each Director 
has taken all reasonable steps that they ought to have 
taken in accordance with their duty as a Director to 
make themselves aware of any relevant audit information 
and to ensure that the Company’s auditor is aware of 
that information.
Directors’ Responsibility Statement
The Directors confirm that, to the best of each 
person’s knowledge:
a.	 the Group Financial Statements in the Annual Report 
and Accounts, which have been prepared in accordance 
with IAS in conformity with the requirements of the 
Companies Act 2006, and those of the Parent Company, 
which have been prepared in accordance with IAS in 
conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 
2006, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, 
financial position and profit or loss of the Company and 
Group taken as a whole; and
b.	 the Annual Report and Accounts includes a fair review of 
the development and performance of the business and 
the position of the Company and the Group taken as a 
whole, together with a description of the principal risks 
and uncertainties they face.
The Directors of the Company and their functions are listed 
on pages 90 to 92.
By order of the Board.
David Thomas
Chief Executive
3 September 2024
The Directors’ Report from pages 89 to 148 inclusive was 
approved by the Board on 3 September 2024 and is signed 
on its behalf by
Tina Bains
Company Secretary
148
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Financial Statements
150	 Independent Auditor’s Report
159	 Consolidated Income Statement and 
	
Statement of Comprehensive Income
160	 Statement of Changes in Shareholders’
	
Equity – Group
161	 Statement of Changes in Shareholders’
	
Equity – Company
162	 Balance Sheets 
163	 Cash Flow Statements 
165	 Notes to the Financial Statements
210 Definitions of alternative 
performance measures and 
reconciliation to IFRS (unaudited)
212	 Five-year record (unaudited) 
214	 Glossary
217	 Integrated reporting approach 
218	 Group advisers and Company information
Anson Gardens, Fradley
149
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Report on the audit of the Financial Statements
1. Opinion
In our opinion:
	• the Financial Statements of Barratt Developments PLC (the ‘Company’) and its 
subsidiaries (the ‘Group’) give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and 
of the Company’s affairs as at 30 June 2024 and of the Group’s profit for the year 
then ended;
	• the Group Financial Statements have been properly prepared in accordance with 
United Kingdom adopted International Accounting Standards; 
	• the Company Financial Statements have been properly prepared in accordance 
with United Kingdom adopted International Accounting Standards and as applied 
in accordance with the provisions of the Companies Act 2006; and
	• the Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements 
of the Companies Act 2006.
We have audited the Financial Statements which comprise:
	• the Consolidated Income Statement and Statement of Comprehensive Income;
	• the Group and Company Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity;
	• the Group and Company Balance Sheets;
	• the Group and Company Cash Flow Statements; and
	• the related notes 1 to 32.
The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their preparation is applicable 
law and United Kingdom adopted International Accounting Standards and, as regards 
the Company Financial Statements, as applied in accordance with the provisions of the 
Companies Act 2006.
2. Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (ISAs (UK)) 
and applicable law. Our responsibilities under those standards are further described in the 
auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the Financial Statements section of our report. 
Independent Auditor’s Report
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
We are independent of the Group and the Company in accordance with the ethical 
requirements that are relevant to our audit of the Financial Statements in the UK, including 
the Financial Reporting Council’s (the ‘FRC’s’) Ethical Standard as applied to listed public 
interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with 
these requirements. The non-audit services provided to the Group and Company for the 
year are disclosed in note 3 to the Financial Statements. We confirm that we have not 
provided any non-audit services prohibited by the FRC’s Ethical Standard to the Group or 
the Company.
We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to 
provide a basis for our opinion.
3. Summary of our audit approach
Key audit matters
The key audit matters that we identified in the current 
year were:
	• Margin recognition; and
	• Costs associated with legacy properties.
Materiality
The materiality that we used for the Group Financial 
Statements was £40.0m which was determined on the 
basis of net assets.
Scoping
Our scoping focused on the audit work of the 
housebuilding component. All audit work was completed 
directly by the Group audit engagement team.
Significant changes 
in our approach
In the current year we changed our basis of materiality 
from adjusted profit to net assets. Further details of this 
change are detailed in section 6.1.
150
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Report on the audit of the Financial Statements 
continued
4. Conclusions relating to going concern
In auditing the Financial Statements, we have concluded that the Directors’ use of the 
going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the Financial Statements is 
appropriate.
Our evaluation of the Directors’ assessment of the Group’s and Company’s ability to 
continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting included:
	• understanding the relevant controls relating to the assessment of the appropriateness of 
the going concern assumption;
	• assessing the Group’s financing facilities including the nature of the facilities, repayment 
terms and compliance with loan covenants;
	• challenging assumptions used in the going concern model by analysing the current and 
forecast performance of the combined Group by assessing management’s assumptions 
against market data;
	• understanding the impact of the acquisition of Redrow plc on the going concern 
assessment for the combined Group following completion on 21 August 2024, including 
understanding the impact of changes in ownership clauses on banking facilities held by 
the Redrow business;
	• assessing the wider macro-economic environment over the going concern period, with 
respect to interest and inflation rates and their impact on house price and build cost 
assumptions, and whether this has been appropriately reflected in the forecasts;
	• evaluating management’s sensitivity analysis;
	• assessing identified potential mitigating actions and the appropriateness of the inclusion 
of these in the going concern assessment;
	• assessing the historical accuracy of forecasts; and
	• assessing the appropriateness of the going concern disclosures in the Financial 
Statements.
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties 
relating to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt 
on the Group’s and Company’s ability to continue as a going concern for a period of at least 
twelve months from when the Financial Statements are authorised for issue.
In relation to the reporting on how the Group has applied the UK Corporate Governance 
Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the Directors’ 
statement in the Financial Statements about whether the Directors considered it 
appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the Directors with respect to going concern 
are described in the relevant sections of this report.
5. Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most 
significance in our audit of the Financial Statements of the current period and include the 
most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) that 
we identified. These matters included those which had the greatest effect on: the overall 
audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the 
engagement team.
These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the Financial Statements as 
a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on 
these matters.
5.1. Margin recognition
Key audit matter 
description
In FY24, adjusted gross margin was 16.5% (FY23: 21.2%).
The Group’s valuation and cost allocation framework determines the 
total profit forecast for each site. This allows the land and build costs 
of a development to be allocated to each individual unit, ensuring the 
forecast margin per unit is equalised across a development. At each 
year-end, management considers if an adjustment for house prices 
and build cost assumptions is required and this is where fraud could 
potentially occur. This cost allocation framework drives the recognition 
of costs, and hence profit, as each unit is sold, which is the key 
estimate in the Income Statement.
For each development there is estimation uncertainty in:
	• Estimating the inputs included within a site budget, including future 
revenues and costs to complete, in order to determine the level of 
profit that each unit of the development will deliver;
	• Determining future house price inflation and build cost inflation;
	• Appropriately allocating costs such as site-wide development costs 
so that the gross profit margin (in percentage terms) achieved on 
each individual unit is equal; and
	• Recording the variation when a deviation from the initial budget 
occurs and ensuring such variations are appropriately recognised 
to those units impacted by the deviation.
These estimates impact the carrying value of inventory on the Balance 
Sheet and therefore the profit recognised on each unit sold which 
aggregate to form the overall reported margin which is a key reporting 
metric for the Group. Accordingly, we consider the recognition of cost 
per unit and therefore the appropriate margin to be a key audit matter.
Refer to page 116 (Audit and Risk Committee Report) and notes 1 
and 3 (Financial Statement disclosures including the related critical 
accounting judgements and key sources of estimation uncertainty).
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
151
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

How the scope 
of our audit 
responded to the 
key audit matter
Our work included the following:
	• Tested the relevant controls governing inventory costing which 
include site valuations, land acquisition feasibilities, expenditure and 
ongoing margin review;
	• Visited a sample of sites and verified the work completed to 
date. On a sample basis, agreed the cost incurred to source 
documentation to verify work in progress;
	• On a sample of sites, made enquiries with management to support 
their cost to complete estimates and obtained external supporting 
evidence regarding costs to complete;
	• Evaluated key estimates in the margin calculation, such as the 
current and forecast macro-economic conditions such as future 
sales volumes, house prices and construction build costs;
	• Analysed margins on a site-by-site and divisional basis to identify 
material movements in the site margins compared to prior year. We 
evaluated and assessed the material variances through enquiries 
with management and obtaining corroborative evidence; 
	• Used bespoke data analytic techniques to analyse costs to complete. 
This enabled us to analyse the cost category composition for each 
site and comparing to Group averages. We performed enquiries and 
obtained corroborative evidence for exceptions identified; 
	• Analysed the cost per square foot of plots sold at a divisional level 
for the current year and compared this to cost per square foot in 
previous years, to analyse for any unusual trends which required 
corroboration from management; and
	• Assessed the information provided by management as well as potentially 
contradictory evidence obtained by the audit team during the course 
of the audit to assess the appropriateness of margin recognised. 
Key observations
Based on the procedures performed, we concluded that the Group’s 
cost allocation framework was reasonable for the intended purpose of 
recognising appropriate margins on plot completion. Accordingly, we 
determined that margin was recognised appropriately in the year.
5.2 Costs associated with legacy properties
Key audit matter 
description
There is ongoing challenge and public scrutiny in relation to fire 
safety and cladding related issues at legacy developments. The 
Group has recognised a number of provisions in relation to changing 
building regulations and remediation of structural defects identified. 
The provisions also include the expected cost to address necessary 
fire-safety issues on all buildings of 11 metres and above following 
the adoption of the UK Government industry pledge by Barratt 
in April 2022 and the signing of the Self-Remediation Terms and 
Contract in March 2023.
We identified a key audit matter in relation to costs associated with 
legacy properties as the amount provided by the Group could be 
incomplete or not valued accurately for the remediation required. 
The accounting for these provisions involves a number of key 
assumptions when estimating the future costs, which are:
	• determining which buildings the Group has an obligation to 
remediate at the Balance Sheet date; and
	• the cost of the future works.
At the end of the financial year the Group holds provisions of 
£730.3m (2023: £612.3m) in relation to legacy properties. During the 
year, the Group incurred a net charge of £179.0m (2023: £217.1m) 
and utilisation of £91.5m (2023: £32.9m) in relation to remediation 
costs. The additional provisions recorded have been recognised as 
an adjusted item and excluded from adjusted profit measures, as 
explained in note 4. 
Refer to page 116 (Audit and Risk Committee Report) and notes 
1 and 19 to the Financial Statements, including the disclosures 
relating to this key source of estimation uncertainty.
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
Report on the audit of the Financial Statements 
continued
5. Key audit matters continued
5.1. Margin recognition continued
152
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

How the scope 
of our audit 
responded to the 
key audit matter
Our work included the following:
	• obtained an understanding of controls relevant to the recognition 
and estimation of costs associated with legacy properties;
	• assessed how the value of the provision has been determined and 
whether a present obligation to rectify the properties existed at 
the Balance Sheet date;
	• validated a sample of cost estimates to underlying support 
such as third-party estimates, quotations or agreements 
and held discussions with internal structural engineers and 
external construction project managers in order to challenge 
management’s estimates; 
	• assessed the estimated liability by understanding and challenging 
management’s assumptions regarding the costs of remediation 
per plot, the number of plots to be remediated, the time period 
for the work to be completed and the discount factor applied to 
the overall provision;
	• challenged the completeness of the provision, including through 
inquiry with internal legal counsel and the Group’s internal 
Building Safety Unit, and by testing the key assumptions including 
the number of buildings with potential legal liability and the 
estimated liability per unit; and
	• assessed the appropriateness of the disclosure included within 
the Financial Statements in relation to provisions and contingent 
liabilities, including consideration of costs classified as adjusted 
items and the disclosure of the assumptions and associated 
sensitivities in relation to the key sources of estimation uncertainty.
Key observations
Based on the procedures performed we concluded the provision 
recorded to be appropriate based on information available at 30 
June 2024. Additionally, we are satisfied with the disclosure of this 
provision as a key source of estimation uncertainty within notes 1 and 
19 of the Financial Statements.
6. Our application of materiality
6.1. Materiality
We define materiality as the magnitude of misstatement in the Financial Statements that 
makes it probable that the economic decisions of a reasonably knowledgeable person 
would be changed or influenced. We use materiality both in planning the scope of our audit 
work and in evaluating the results of our work.
Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the Financial 
Statements as a whole as follows:
Group financial statements
Parent company financial 
statements
Materiality
£40.0m
(2023: £45.0m)
£36.0m
(2023: £40.5m)
Basis for determining 
materiality
Our determined materiality 
represents 0.7% of net assets. 
In the prior year, materiality 
was determined using 5.1% 
of adjusted profit before 
tax. Adjusted profit before 
tax is disclosed in the table 
following the Consolidated 
Income Statement and 
Statement of Comprehensive 
Income on page 159.
The materiality determined 
in the current year is the 
equivalent of 10.4% of 
adjusted profit before tax.
Our basis for materiality was 
determined based upon 3% 
(2023: 3%) of the Company’s 
net assets, capped at 
90% (2023: 90%) of Group 
materiality.
Rationale for the 
benchmark applied
We changed the basis of 
materiality in the current 
period to reflect the ongoing 
market volatility which means 
that adjusted profit before 
tax is no longer a stable and 
appropriate measure. The 
Group’s net assets provide 
a more stable benchmark, 
reflecting that the Balance 
Sheet is a key focus for 
users to assess any impact 
caused by the current 
market volatility on the 
Group’s financial position and 
operating model. 
Net assets was used as the 
benchmark because it is the 
primary measure used by 
shareholders in assessing the 
performance of the entity, 
which acts as a holding 
company. The benchmark 
provides a stable basis as 
there are volatile earnings 
between periods.
Report on the audit of the Financial Statements 
continued
5. Key audit matters continued
5.2 Costs associated with legacy properties continued
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
153
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Report on the audit of the Financial Statements 
continued
6. Our application of materiality continued
6.2. Performance materiality
We set performance materiality at a level lower than materiality to reduce the probability 
that, in aggregate, uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceed the materiality for 
the Financial Statements as a whole. 
Group financial statements
Company financial statements
Performance materiality
70% (2023: 70%) of 
Group materiality
70% (2023: 70%) of 
Company materiality
Basis and rationale 
for determining 
performance 
materiality
In determining performance materiality, we considered the 
following factors: 
	• Our risk assessment, including our assessment of the 
Group’s overall control environment and that we consider it 
appropriate to rely on controls over a number of business 
processes; and
	• Our past experience of the audit, which has indicated a 
low number of corrected and uncorrected misstatements 
identified in prior periods.
6.3. Error reporting threshold
We agreed with the Audit and Risk Committee that we would report to the Committee 
all audit differences in excess of £2.0 million (2023: £2.25 million), as well as differences 
below that threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. We also 
report to the Audit and Risk Committee on disclosure matters that we identified when 
assessing the overall presentation of the Financial Statements.
7. An overview of the scope of our audit
7.1. Identification and scoping of components
Our Group audit was scoped by obtaining an understanding of the Group and its 
environment, including Group-wide controls, and assessing the risks of material 
misstatement at the Group level. The entire Group is audited by one audit engagement 
team, led by the Senior Statutory Auditor. Controls are common across the Group and we 
identified one financially significant component, the housebuilding business, which takes 
into consideration all of the Group’s housebuilding divisions, as well as the head office 
consolidation. Our audit scope resulted in 98.7% of revenue, 98.0% of profit before tax and 
96.0% of net assets being subject to full scope audit procedures (2023: 100% of revenue, 
100% of profit before tax and 100% of net assets). We performed analytical procedures at a 
Group level over the remaining entities in the Group, being the Group’s joint ventures, and 
additionally tested the consolidation.
The housebuilding component was set a specific component materiality, considering its 
relative size and any component-specific risk factors such as internal control findings 
and history of error. The component materiality applied was £26.6 million (2023: two 
components were identified, the housebuilding business and the Group’s joint ventures, 
with component materiality set in the range of £15.8m to £29.9m). 
7.2. Our consideration of the control environment
We obtained an understanding of the relevant internal controls over key audit matters, 
relating to margin recognition and legacy properties. We obtained an understanding of other 
relevant controls which we would expect in a housebuilder, namely those over land and 
work in progress and those over subcontractor and other expenses.
We assessed entity level controls at a Group level relating to the risk assessment process, 
monitoring of internal controls and information systems. This resulted in a more granular 
review of management’s whistleblowing policy, code of ethics, HR and culture policy and 
fraud risk assessment.
In the current year, we have tested controls relating to margin recognition, land and work 
in progress. Based on our work performed we adopted a controls reliance approach to our 
testing in these areas.
The Group IT landscape contains a number of IT systems, applications and tools used 
to support business processes and reporting. We reconfirmed our understanding of the 
Group’s IT controls and performed testing of General IT Controls (GITCs) of three key 
applications that support financial reporting processes, being TM1, COINs and Homebuilder, 
which included controls surrounding user access management and change management. 
Based on our work performed we adopted a controls reliance approach to GITCs of 
these applications.
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
154
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Report on the audit of the Financial Statements 
continued
7. An overview of the scope of our audit continued
7.3. Our consideration of climate-related risks
As part of our audit we have made enquiries of management to understand the process 
they have adopted to assess the potential impact of climate change on the financial 
statements. As disclosed on page 67 the Group considers climate change to be a 
fundamental component of its Government Regulation and political principal risk within the 
business, with specific climate risk assessment criteria used by the Group set out on pages 
76 to 78. 
We have read the climate change related disclosures within the other information included 
in the Annual Report to consider whether they are materially consistent with the Financial 
Statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit. 
8. Other information
The other information comprises the information included in the Annual Report, other than 
the Financial Statements and our auditor’s report thereon. The Directors are responsible 
for the other information contained within the Annual Report.
Our opinion on the Financial Statements does not cover the other information and, except 
to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, we do not express any form of 
assurance conclusion thereon.
Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether the 
other information is materially inconsistent with the Financial Statements or our knowledge 
obtained in the course of the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated.
If we identify such material inconsistencies or apparent material misstatements, we are 
required to determine whether this gives rise to a material misstatement in the Financial 
Statements themselves. If, based on the work we have performed, we conclude that there 
is a material misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact.
We have nothing to report in this regard.
9. Responsibilities of Directors
As explained more fully in the Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities, the Directors are 
responsible for the preparation of the Financial Statements and for being satisfied that 
they give a true and fair view, and for such internal control as the Directors determine is 
necessary to enable the preparation of Financial Statements that are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
In preparing the Financial Statements, the Directors are responsible for assessing the 
Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing as applicable, 
matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless 
the directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the Company or to cease operations, 
or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
10. Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the Financial 
Statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the Financial Statements 
as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to 
issue an auditor’s report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level 
of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) 
will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from 
fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could 
reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis 
of these Financial Statements.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements is 
located on the FRC’s website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description 
forms part of our auditor’s report.
11. Extent to which the audit was considered capable of detecting 
irregularities, including fraud
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. 
We design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material 
misstatements in respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent to which our 
procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud is detailed below. 
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
155
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Report on the audit of the Financial statements 
continued
11. Extent to which the audit was considered capable of detecting 
irregularities, including fraud continued
11.1. Identifying and assessing potential risks related to irregularities
In identifying and assessing risks of material misstatement in respect of irregularities, 
including fraud and non-compliance with laws and regulations, we considered the following:
	• the nature of the industry and sector, control environment and business performance 
including the design of the Group’s remuneration policies, key drivers for Directors’ 
remuneration, bonus levels and performance targets;
	• the Group’s own assessment of the risks that irregularities may occur either as a result 
of fraud or error;
	• results of our enquiries of management, internal audit, internal legal counsel, the 
Directors and the Audit and Risk Committee about their own identification and 
assessment of the risks of irregularities, including those that are specific to the 
Group’s sector; 
	• any matters we identified having obtained and reviewed the Group’s documentation of 
their policies and procedures relating to:
•	 identifying, evaluating and complying with laws and regulations and whether they were 
aware of any instances of non-compliance;
•	 detecting and responding to the risks of fraud and whether they have knowledge of any 
actual, suspected or alleged fraud;
•	 the internal controls established to mitigate risks of fraud or non-compliance with 
laws and regulations;
	• the matters discussed among the audit engagement team and relevant internal 
specialists, including tax, valuations, IT and fraud specialists, regarding how and where 
fraud might occur in the financial statements and any potential indicators of fraud.
As a result of these procedures, we considered the opportunities and incentives that 
may exist within the organisation for fraud and identified the greatest potential for 
fraud in margin recognition, specifically any adjustments for house prices and build cost 
assumptions. In common with all audits under ISAs (UK), we are also required to perform 
specific procedures to respond to the risk of management override.
We also obtained an understanding of the legal and regulatory framework that the Group 
operates in, focusing on provisions of those laws and regulations that had a direct effect 
on the determination of material amounts and disclosures in the Financial Statements. The 
key laws and regulations we considered in this context included the UK Companies Act, 
Listing Rules, Building Safety Regulations and tax legislation.
In addition, we considered provisions of other laws and regulations that do not have a 
direct effect on the Financial Statements but compliance with which may be fundamental 
to the Group’s ability to operate or to avoid a material penalty. These included 
environmental and health and safety regulations.
11.2. Audit response to risks identified
As a result of performing the above, we identified margin recognition as a key audit matter 
related to the potential risk of fraud. The key audit matters section of our report explains the 
matter in more detail and also describes the specific procedures we performed in response 
to that key audit matter. 
In addition to the above, our procedures to respond to risks identified included the following:
	• reviewing the Financial Statement disclosures and testing to supporting documentation 
to assess compliance with provisions of relevant laws and regulations described as 
having a direct effect on the Financial Statements;
	• enquiring of management, the Audit and Risk Committee, in-house and external legal 
counsel concerning actual and potential litigation and claims;
	• performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships that 
may indicate risks of material misstatement due to fraud;
	• reading minutes of meetings of those charged with governance and reviewing internal 
audit reports;
	• in addressing the risk of fraud through management override of controls, testing the 
appropriateness of journal entries and other adjustments; assessing whether the 
judgements made in making accounting estimates are indicative of a potential bias; 
and evaluating the business rationale of any significant transactions that are unusual 
or outside the normal course of business.
We also communicated relevant identified laws and regulations and potential fraud risks 
to all engagement team members including internal specialists, and remained alert to any 
indications of fraud or non-compliance with laws and regulations throughout the audit.
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
156
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Report on other legal and regulatory requirements
12. Opinions on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act 2006
In our opinion the part of the directors’ remuneration report to be audited has been 
properly prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit:
	• the information given in the strategic report and the directors’ report for the financial 
year for which the Financial Statements are prepared is consistent with the Financial 
Statements; and
	• the Strategic Report and the Directors’ Report have been prepared in accordance with 
applicable legal requirements.
In the light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and the Company and their 
environment obtained in the course of the audit, we have not identified any material 
misstatements in the Strategic Report or the Directors’ Report.
13. Corporate Governance Statement
The Listing Rules require us to review the Directors’ statement in relation to going concern, 
longer-term viability and that part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the 
Group’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified for 
our review.
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the 
following elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is materially consistent with 
the Financial Statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit: 
	• the Directors’ statement with regards to the appropriateness of adopting the going 
concern basis of accounting and any material uncertainties identified set out 
on page 85;
	• the Directors’ explanation as to its assessment of the Group’s prospects, the period 
this assessment covers and why the period is appropriate set out on pages 85 to 87;
	• the Directors’ statement on fair, balanced and understandable set out on page 148;
	• the Board’s confirmation that it has carried out a robust assessment of the emerging 
and principal risks set out on page 64;
	• the section of the Annual Report that describes the review of effectiveness of risk 
management and internal control systems set out on pages 63 and 64; and
	• the section describing the work of the Audit and Risk Committee set out on pages 
114 and 115.
14. Matters on which we are required to report by exception
14.1. Adequacy of explanations received and accounting records
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:
	• we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit; or
	• adequate accounting records have not been kept by the Company, or returns adequate 
for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or
	• the Company Financial Statements are not in agreement with the accounting records 
and returns.
We have nothing to report in respect of these matters.
14.2. Directors’ remuneration
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are also required to report if in our opinion certain 
disclosures of Directors’ remuneration have not been made or the part of the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report to be audited is not in agreement with the accounting records 
and returns.
We have nothing to report in respect of these matters.
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
157
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Report on other legal and regulatory requirements 
continued
15. Other matters which we are required to address
15.1. Auditor tenure
Following the recommendation of the Audit and Risk Committee, we were appointed by the 
shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held in 2007 to audit the Financial Statements 
for the year ending 30 June 2008 and subsequent financial periods. The period of total 
uninterrupted engagement including previous renewals and reappointments of the firm is 
17 years, covering the years ending 30 June 2008 to 30 June 2024.
15.2. Consistency of the audit report with the additional report to the Audit 
and Risk Committee
Our audit opinion is consistent with the additional report to the Audit and Risk Committee 
we are required to provide in accordance with ISAs (UK).
16. Use of our report
This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with 
Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so 
that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required to state to 
them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by 
law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the 
Company’s members as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we 
have formed.
As required by the Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) Disclosure Guidance and Transparency 
Rule (DTR) 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R, these financial statements form part of the Electronic 
Format Annual Financial Report filed on the National Storage Mechanism of the FCA in 
accordance with DTR 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R. This Auditor’s Report provides no assurance over 
whether the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report has been prepared in compliance 
with DTR 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R. 
Jacqueline Holden FCA (Senior statutory auditor)
For and on behalf of Deloitte LLP
Statutory Auditor
London, United Kingdom
3 September 2024
Independent Auditor’s Report continued
to the members of Barratt Developments PLC
158
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Continuing operations
Notes
2024
£m
2023
 £m
Revenue
2
4,168.2
5,321.4
Cost of sales
(3,658.7)
(4,346.5)
Gross profit
509.5
974.9
Administrative expenses
3
(336.9)
(270.8)
Part-exchange income
333.7
140.0
Part-exchange expenses
(331.6)
(136.7)
Profit from operations
3
174.7
707.4
Finance income
6
47.2
23.8
Finance costs
6
(53.7)
(34.9)
Net finance costs
6
(6.5)
(11.1)
Share of post-tax profit from joint ventures
12
2.3
8.8
Profit before tax
170.5
705.1
Tax
7
(56.4)
(174.8)
Profit for the year being total comprehensive income 
recognised for the year
114.1
530.3
Profit and total comprehensive income for the year attributable 
to the owners of the Company
114.1
530.3
Earnings per share from continuing operations
Basic
8
11.8p
53.2p
Diluted
8
11.6p
52.6p
There was no other comprehensive income in either year.
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
Consolidated Income Statement and Statement of Comprehensive Income
Year ended 30 June 2024
Adjusted items:
Gross profit
Profit from 
operations
Share of post-tax 
profit from joint 
ventures
Profit before tax
Notes
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Reported 
profit
509.5
974.9
174.7
707.4
2.3
8.8
170.5
705.1
Cost 
associated 
with legacy 
properties
4
180.0
158.2
180.0
158.2
12.6
23.7
192.6
181.9
Legacy 
property 
recoveries
4
(0.5)
(2.7)
(0.5)
(2.7)
—
—
(0.5)
(2.7)
Costs incurred 
in respect of 
the all-share 
offer for the 
share capital 
of Redrow plc
4
—
—
22.4
—
—
—
22.4
—
Adjusted 
profit
689.0
1,130.4
376.6
862.9
14.9
32.5
385.0
884.3
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
159
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Share
 capital 
(note 22)
£m
Share
 premium
 £m
Merger
 reserve
 (note 23)
 £m
Capital
 redemption
 reserve
 (note 24)
 £m
Own
 shares
 (note 25)
 £m
Share-
based
 payments
 (note 26)
 £m
Group
 retained
 earnings
 due to
 share-
holders
 of the
 Company
 £m
Total
 Group
 retained
 earnings
 due to
 share-
holders
 of the
 Company
 £m
Non-
controlling
 interests
 (note 27)
 £m 
Total
 equity
 £m
At 1 July 2022
102.2
253.4
1,109.0
—
(27.0)
29.0
4,163.9
4,165.9
0.8
5,631.3
Profit for the year being total comprehensive income recognised for the 
year ended 30 June 2023
—
—
—
—
—
—
530.3
530.3
—
530.3
Dividend payments (note 9)
—
—
—
—
—
—
(360.0)
(360.0)
—
(360.0)
Distributions to non-controlling interests
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(0.3)
(0.3)
Issue of shares
—
0.1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.1
Buyback and cancellation of shares
(4.8)
—
—
4.8
—
—
(201.3)
(201.3)
—
(201.3)
Share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
10.2
—
10.2
—
10.2
Purchase of own shares by EBT
—
—
—
—
(14.0)
—
—
(14.0)
—
(14.0)
Transfers in respect of share options
—
—
—
—
17.8
(18.3)
(0.7)
(1.2)
—
(1.2)
Tax on share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
(0.1)
1.4
1.3
—
1.3
At 30 June 2023
97.4
253.5
1,109.0
4.8
(23.2)
20.8
4,133.6
4,131.2
0.5
5,596.4
Profit for the year being total comprehensive income recognised for the 
year ended 30 June 2024
—
—
—
—
—
—
114.1
114.1
—
114.1
Dividend payments (note 9)
—
—
—
—
—
—
(270.6)
(270.6)
—
(270.6)
Distributions to non-controlling interests
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(0.4)
(0.4)
Share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
19.9
—
19.9
—
19.9
Purchase of own shares by EBT
—
—
—
—
(23.3)
—
—
(23.3)
—
(23.3)
Transfers in respect of share options
—
—
—
—
9.6
(12.1)
4.7
2.2
—
2.2
Tax on share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
0.8
—
0.8
—
0.8
At 30 June 2024
97.4
253.5
1,109.0
4.8
(36.9)
29.4
3,981.8
3,974.3
0.1
5,439.1
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
Statement of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity
Group
160
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Share
 capital
(note 22)
 £m
Share
 premium
 £m
Merger
 reserve
 (note 23)
 £m
Capital
 redemption
 reserve
 (note 24)
£m
Own
 shares
 (note 25)
 £m
Share-
 based
 payments
 (note 26)
 £m
Retained
 earnings
 £m
Total
 retained
 earnings
 £m
Total
 equity
 £m
At 1 July 2022
102.2
253.4
1,109.0
—
(27.0)
29.0
2,216.7
2,218.7
3,683.3
Profit for the year being total comprehensive income recognised for the year ended 
30 June 2023
—
—
—
—
—
—
501.9
501.9
501.9
Dividend payments (note 9)
—
—
—
—
—
—
(360.0)
(360.0)
(360.0)
Issue of shares
—
0.1
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.1
Buyback and cancellation of shares
(4.8)
—
—
4.8
—
—
(201.3)
(201.3)
(201.3)
Share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
10.2
—
10.2
10.2
Purchase of own shares by EBT
—
—
—
—
(14.0)
—
—
(14.0)
(14.0)
Transfers in respect of share options
—
—
—
—
17.8
(18.3)
(6.7)
(7.2)
(7.2)
Tax on share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.5
0.5
0.5
At 30 June 2023
97.4
253.5
1,109.0
4.8
(23.2)
20.9
2,151.1
2,148.8
3,613.5
Profit for the year being total comprehensive income recognised for the year ended 
30 June 2024
—
—
—
—
—
—
511.0
511.0
511.0
Dividend payments (note 9)
—
—
—
—
—
—
(270.6)
(270.6)
(270.6)
Share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
19.9
—
19.9
19.9
Purchase of own share for EBT
—
—
—
—
(23.3)
—
—
(23.3)
(23.3)
Transfers in respect of share options
—
—
—
—
9.6
(12.1)
3.5
1.0
1.0
Tax on share-based payments
—
—
—
—
—
0.1
—
0.1
0.1
At 30 June 2024
97.4
253.5
1,109.0
4.8
(36.9)
28.8
2,395.0
2,386.9
3,851.6
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
Statement of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity
Company
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
161
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Group
Company
Notes
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Assets
Non-current assets
Other intangible assets
10
184.5
194.9
—
—
Goodwill
10
852.9
852.9
—
—
Investments in subsidiary 
undertakings
11
—
—
3,095.4
3,090.1
Investments in jointly controlled 
entities
12
158.5
129.8
—
—
Property, plant and equipment
13
57.5
58.1
4.4
6.1
Right-of-use assets
14
41.2
45.1
1.3
4.2
Deferred tax assets
7
—
—
2.2
2.6
Trade and other receivables
16
3.4
2.9
76.1
76.1
1,298.0
1,283.7
3,179.4
3,179.1
Current assets
Inventories
15
5,278.2
5,238.0
—
—
Trade and other receivables
16
201.9
182.1
182.6
15.9
Current tax assets
31.8
31.1
—
1.6
Cash and cash equivalents
17
1,065.3
1,269.1
827.6
1,005.0
6,577.2
6,720.3
1,010.2
1,022.5
Total assets
7,875.2
8,004.0
4,189.6
4,201.6
Liabilities
Non-current liabilities
Loans and borrowings
17
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
Trade and other payables
18
(172.0)
(188.7)
—
—
Lease liabilities
14
(29.4)
(33.1)
(0.7)
(2.9)
Deferred tax liabilities
7
(45.0)
(53.5)
—
—
Provisions
19
(543.2)
(477.9)
—
—
(989.6)
(953.2)
(200.7)
(202.9)
Balance Sheets
At 30 June 2024
Group
Company
Notes
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Current liabilities
Loans and borrowings
17
—
(3.4)
—
—
Trade and other payables
18
(1,055.1)
(1,127.4)
(128.2)
(383.9)
Lease liabilities
14
(13.4)
(13.1)
(0.6)
(1.3)
Current tax liabilities
—
—
(8.5)
—
Provisions
19
(378.0)
(310.5)
—
—
(1,446.5)
(1,454.4)
(137.3)
(385.2)
Total liabilities
(2,436.1)
(2,407.6)
(338.0)
(588.1)
Net assets
5,439.1
5,596.4
3,851.6
3,613.5
Equity
Share capital
22
97.4
97.4
97.4
97.4
Share premium
253.5
253.5
253.5
253.5
Merger reserve
23
1,109.0
1,109.0
1,109.0
1,109.0
Capital redemption reserve
24
4.8
4.8
4.8
4.8
Total retained earnings
3,974.3
4,131.2
2,386.9
2,148.8
Equity attributable to the owners 
of the Company
5,439.0
5,595.9
3,851.6
3,613.5
Non-controlling interests
27
0.1
0.5
—
—
Total equity
5,439.1
5,596.4
3,851.6
3,613.5
The Financial Statements of Barratt Developments PLC (registered number 00604574) were 
approved by the Board and authorised for issue on 3 September 2024.
Signed on behalf of the Board:
David Thomas	
	
Mike Scott
Chief Executive	
	
Chief Financial Officer
Parent Company Income Statement
In accordance with the provisions of Section 408 of the Companies Act 2006, a separate 
Income Statement for the Company has not been presented. The Company’s profit for 
the year was £511.0m (2023: £501.9m).
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
162
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Group
Company
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities (page 164)
96.2
465.5
(442.6)
20.0
Investing activities:
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
13
(7.2)
(23.1)
(1.1)
(2.6)
Proceeds from the disposal of property, plant and equipment
0.3
0.1
—
—
Increase in amounts invested in jointly controlled entities
12
(38.3)
(18.1)
—
—
Repayment of amounts invested in jointly controlled entities
12
4.8
40.2
—
—
Distributions received from jointly controlled entities
12
7.1
34.8
—
0.1
Dividends received from subsidiaries
—
—
516.0
500.0
Interest received
45.3
21.5
42.9
19.8
Net cash inflow from investing activities
12.0
55.4
557.8
517.3
Financing activities:
Dividends paid to equity holders of the Company
9
(270.6)
(360.0)
(270.6)
(360.0)
Distribution made to non-controlling interest
27
(0.4)
(0.3)
—
—
Purchase of own shares for the EBT
(23.3)
(14.0)
(23.3)
(14.0)
Buy back and cancellation of shares
—
(201.3)
—
(201.3)
Proceeds from issue of share capital
—
0.1
—
0.1
Payment of dividend equivalents
(0.5)
(1.2)
(0.5)
(1.2)
Proceeds from the exercise of Sharesave options
2.7
—
2.7
—
Repayment of lease liabilities
14
(16.5)
(13.9)
(0.9)
(1.3)
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(308.6)
(590.6)
(292.6)
(577.7)
Net decrease in cash, cash equivalents and bank overdrafts
(200.4)
(69.7)
(177.4)
(40.4)
Cash, cash equivalents and bank overdrafts at the beginning of the year
1,265.7
1,335.4
1,005.0
1,045.4
Cash, cash equivalents and bank overdrafts at the end of the year
17
1,065.3
1,265.7
827.6
1,005.0
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
Cash Flow Statements
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
163
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Reconciliation of profit/(loss) from operations to cash flow from operating activities
Group
Company
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Profit/(loss) from operations
174.7
707.4
(12.4)
8.2
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
13
7.5
6.1
2.8
3.1
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
14
15.2
12.3
0.9
1.3
Amortisation of intangible assets
10
10.4
10.5
—
—
(Reversal of impairment)/impairment of inventories
15
(2.2)
4.7
—
—
Share-based payments expense/(credit)
26
19.9
10.2
6.0
(0.3)
Imputed interest on long-term payables
6
(40.2)
(21.4)
—
—
Imputed interest on lease arrangements
6
(1.8)
(1.2)
—
—
Amortisation of facility fees
6
(1.6)
(1.9)
(1.6)
(1.9)
Total non-cash items
7.2
19.3
8.1
2.2
(Increase)/decrease in inventories
(38.0)
48.9
—
—
(Increase)/decrease in receivables
(19.6)
60.4
(157.8)
(0.2)
(Decrease)/increase in payables1
(87.2)
(337.6)
(254.4)
37.5
Increase in provisions
19
132.8
163.4
—
—
Total movements in working capital and provisions
(12.0)
(64.9)
(412.2)
37.3
Interest paid
(10.1)
(10.4)
(26.1)
(27.7)
Tax paid
(63.6)
(185.9)
—
—
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
96.2
465.5
(442.6)
20.0
1 The working capital movements in land payables include non-cash movements due to imputed interest. Imputed interest is included within non-cash items in the statements above.
The notes on pages 165 to 209 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.
Cash Flow Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
164
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Notes to the Financial Statements
Year ended 30 June 2024
1.  Basis of preparation
Introduction
The Financial Statements for the Group and Company have been prepared in accordance 
with UK adopted IAS in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and 
in accordance with UK adopted IFRS. The Financial Statements have been prepared under 
the historical cost convention as modified by the revaluation of share-based payments. 
 Group accounting policies
The significant Group accounting policies are included within the relevant notes to 
the Financial Statements on pages 165 to 209.
 Critical accounting judgements and key sources of estimation uncertainty
The preparation of Financial Statements in conformity with UK adopted IFRS requires 
the use of estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets 
and liabilities at the date of the Financial Statements, and the reported amounts 
of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Although these estimates are 
based on the Directors’ best knowledge of the amounts, actual results may ultimately 
differ from those estimates. The Directors have made no individual critical accounting 
judgements that have a significant impact upon the Financial Statements, apart from 
those involving estimations.
The most significant estimates made by the Directors in these Financial Statements, 
which are the key sources of estimation uncertainty that may have a significant risk 
of causing a material difference to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within 
the next financial year, are:
•	 Margin recognition — see note 3; and
•	 Costs associated with legacy properties — see note 19. 
Basis of consolidation
The Group Financial Statements include the results of Barratt Developments PLC (the 
Company), a public company limited by shares and incorporated in the United Kingdom, 
and all of its subsidiary undertakings, made up to 30 June. The Financial Statements of 
subsidiary undertakings are consolidated from the date that control passes to the Group, 
and up to the date control ceases.
Control is achieved when the Group becomes entitled to the variable returns of the 
subsidiary and becomes exposed to its risks, and has the power to affect these risks and 
returns. Acquired entities are accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. 
All transactions with subsidiaries and intercompany profits or losses are eliminated 
on consolidation.
Going concern
In determining the appropriate basis of preparation of the Financial Statements, the 
Directors are required to consider whether the Group can continue to meet its liabilities 
and other obligations for the foreseeable future.
The Group’s business activities, together with factors that the Directors consider are 
likely to affect its development, financial performance and financial position, are set out 
in the Strategic Report on pages 1 to 87. The material financial and operational risks and 
uncertainties that may affect the Group’s performance and their mitigation are outlined on 
pages 63 to 70, and financial risks including liquidity, market, credit and capital risks are 
outlined in note 30 to the Financial Statements.
At 30 June 2024, the Group held cash of £1,065.3m and total loans and borrowings 
of £200.0m, comprising £200.0m Sterling USPP notes maturing in August 2027. These 
balances, set against pre-paid facility fees, comprise the Group’s net cash of £868.5m, 
presented in note 17.
Should further funding be required, the Group has a committed £700.0m RCF, subject to 
compliance with certain financial covenants, that matures in November 2028, with a further 
one-year extension period through to November 2029, if agreed between the Group and 
its lenders.
As such, in consideration of its net current assets of £5,130.7m, the Directors are satisfied that 
the Group has sufficient liquidity to meet its current liabilities and working capital requirements.
Long-term housing market fundamentals reflect a significant imbalance between housing 
supply and demand. Despite this imbalance, the housing market in FY24 remained constrained 
by significant macro-economic headwinds including higher interest rates and inflation, 
affecting economic growth, consumer confidence and mortgage affordability. Whilst 
there are positive signs, including recent reductions in interest rates and positive political 
messaging on improving the planning system and delivering new housing, uncertainty 
remains over the general economic outlook and the outcome of industry-specific challenges 
such as further building safety costs or greenhouse gas emissions legislation along with 
material cost inflation and supply chain disruption. These, and other disruptions, could 
result in flat or negative economic growth, reduced buyer confidence, reduced mortgage 
availability and affordability, falls in house prices or land values and cost increases 
associated with raw materials, suppliers, subcontractors and employees.
On 21 August 2024 the Group acquired the full share capital of Redrow plc in an all share 
transaction. In accordance with standard practice, the Competition and Markets Authority 
(the CMA) has issued an Initial Enforcement Order requiring the Barratt and Redrow 
businesses to continue to operate independently until the CMA has formally accepted 
the undertakings proposed by the parties in response to the findings of its phase 1 
investigation, or otherwise agrees to integration taking place. The sharing of competitively 
sensitive information between the businesses is prohibited while the Enforcement Order is 
in place. In recognition of the need for the pre-acquisition business to be able to support 
itself independently, the Directors have considered the ability to continue trading of both 
the group of companies that existed prior to the acquisition (the ‘Barratt group’) and the 
new group including Redrow plc and its subsidiaries (the ‘combined group’).
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
165
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

1.  Basis of preparation continued
Going concern continued
To assess the Barratt group’s resilience to more adverse outcomes, its forecast 
performance was sensitised to reflect a series of scenarios based on the Barratt group’s 
principal risks and the downside prospects for the UK economy and housing market 
presented in the latest available external economic forecasts. The Directors consider the 
principal risks of the Barratt group to be applicable to the combined group. A combined 
group forecast was therefore sensitised to the same scenarios, with no synergies assumed. 
For the purposes of this assessment, it was assumed that the financing facilities available 
to the combined group were those currently available to the Barratt group, and that all 
associated financial covenants would apply. It was assumed that the combined group 
would undertake mitigating actions in response to the challenging circumstances modelled, 
primarily a reduction in investment in land and work in progress in line with the fall in 
expected sales, without preventing the combined group’s ability to grow over the long term.
The above analysis included a reasonable worst-case scenario in which the principal risks 
manifest in aggregate to a severe but plausible level. This assumed that average private 
selling prices fall by 5%, sales volumes fall by 15% and construction costs increase by 2% in 
addition to the base forecasts, in addition to the implementation of a building safety levy, 
further increases in legacy property costs and the acceleration of regulatory changes to 
reduce indirect greenhouse gas emissions.
The effects were modelled over the 12 months from the date of the signing of these 
Financial Statements, alongside reasonable mitigation that the Barratt and combined 
groups would expect to undertake in such circumstances, primarily reductions 
in investment in inventories and uncommitted land spend in line with the fall in 
expected sales. 
In all scenarios, including the reasonable worst case, the Barratt group and combined 
group are able to comply with the financial covenants, operate within current facilities and 
meet liabilities as they fall due for a period of at least 12 months from the date of signing 
of these Financial Statements. The Group has a policy of maintaining a £150m headroom 
on its available facilities and both the Barratt group and combined group would remain in 
compliance with this policy throughout the review period.
Accordingly, the Directors consider there to be no material uncertainties that may cast 
significant doubt on the Group’s ability to continue to operate as a going concern. They 
have formed a judgement that, at the time of approving the Financial Statements, there is 
a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational 
existence for the foreseeable future, being at least 12 months from the date of signing of 
these Financial Statements. For this reason, they continue to adopt the going concern basis 
in the preparation of these Financial Statements.
Application of accounting standards
During the year ended 30 June 2024, the Group has applied accounting policies 
and methods of computation consistent with those applied in the prior year.
During the year, the Group has adopted the following new and revised standards 
and interpretations which have had no material impact on the Financial Statements:
	• Amendments to IAS 1: Disclosure of material accounting policies;
	• Amendments to IAS 8: Definition of accounting estimates;
	• Amendments to IAS 12: Deferred tax related to assets and liabilities arising from 
a single transaction; and
	• Amendments to, and initial application of IFRS 17: Insurance Contracts.
Impact of standards and interpretations in issue but not yet effective
At the date of approval of these Financial Statements, there were a number of standards, 
amendments and interpretations that have been published and are mandatory for the 
Group’s accounting periods beginning on or after 1 July 2024 and later periods. None of 
these are expected to have a material impact on the Group. The Group has not early 
adopted any standard, amendment or interpretation.
2.  Revenue
The Group’s revenue derives principally from the sale of the homes we build.
 Revenue from the sale of residential and commercial properties
Revenue is recognised at legal completion in respect of the total proceeds of building 
and development. Revenue is measured at the fair value of consideration received or 
receivable and represents the amounts receivable for the property, net of discounts 
and VAT.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
166
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

2.  Revenue continued
 Revenue on contracts recognised over time
The Group considers all contracts with commercial customers and registered providers 
for affordable housing on a contract-by-contract basis and determines the appropriate 
revenue recognition based on the particular terms of that contract. For the majority of 
such contracts, there is a single performance obligation for which revenue is recognised at a 
point in time, when construction has been completed and control is transferred to the 
customer. The Group recognises revenue over time in relation to certain contracts with 
registered providers only in circumstances in which control of the associated land is 
transferred to the customer before or during construction. Revenue is only recognised 
from the point at which control of the associated land is transferred, considering the 
rights to economic benefit as well as legal title. Revenue is recognised because the 
construction activity enhances an asset that is controlled by the customer.
Where the outcome of a contract on which revenue is recognised over time can be 
estimated reliably, revenue is recognised by reference to the stage of completion of 
contract activity at the balance sheet date. This is normally measured by surveys 
of work performed to date. The Group is satisfied that it is appropriate to measure 
performance by reference to surveys of work performed to date, because these 
surveys identify the extent to which benefits have been transferred to the customer. 
Variations to, and claims arising in respect of, such contracts are included in revenue 
to the extent that they have been agreed with the customer. Where the outcome of 
a contract on which revenue is recognised over time cannot be estimated reliably, 
revenue is recognised to the extent of contract costs incurred. When it is probable 
that the total costs on a contract will exceed total contract revenue, the expected loss 
is immediately recognised as an expense in the Income Statement.
 Other revenue
Revenue from separate contracts related to the development of homes is recognised 
on completion of the performance obligation to which it relates and is included in 
other revenue. Revenue from warranties is recognised on a straight-line basis over the 
warranty period. Revenue from commercial contract management fees is recognised 
in the period in which it becomes receivable and is included within other revenue. 
Revenue from planning promotion agreements is recognised at the point at which 
contractual obligations are satisfied.
An analysis of the Group’s continuing revenue is as follows:
Residential completions1
Revenue
2024 
Number
2023 
Number
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Revenue from private residential 
sales
10,666
12,456
3,668.5
4,578.5
Revenue from affordable 
residential sales
2,802
3,922
463.1
655.8
Revenue from commercial sales
—
—
21.9
64.7
Revenue from planning promotion 
agreements
—
—
12.9
20.4
Sundry revenue
—
—
1.8
2.0
13,468
16,378
4,168.2
5,321.4
1	
Residential completions exclude JV completions of 536 homes (2023: 828) in which the Group has an interest.
Included within Group revenue is £218.2m (2023: £192.7m) of revenue from construction 
contracts on which revenue is recognised over time by reference to the stage of completion 
of work on the contracts (note 20). Of this amount, £8.9m (2023: £4.0m) was included in 
the contract liability balance at the beginning of the year.
Revenue includes £564.6m (2023: £274.5m) of revenue generated where the sale has 
been achieved using part-exchange incentives. Proceeds received on the disposal of 
part‑exchange properties are presented separately on the face of the Income Statement 
and are not included in revenue on the basis that they are incidental to the main 
revenue‑generating activities of the Group.
3.  Profit from operations
Profit from operations includes all of the revenue and costs derived from the Group’s 
operating businesses. Profit from operations excludes finance costs, finance income, 
the Group’s share of profits or losses from JVs and tax.
The Group’s principal activity is housebuilding. None of the other business activities 
undertaken by the Group, individually or in aggregate, account for more than 10% of 
the Group’s revenue, profit or total assets and do not meet the IFRS 8 thresholds for 
disclosure. The operating results of these activities are not presented separately to the 
Board. Therefore, no segmental information is presented in these Financial Statements.
167
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

3.  Profit from operations continued
 Margin recognition
In order to determine the profit that the Group is able to recognise on its 
developments in a specific period, the Group allocates site-wide development costs 
between homes built in the current year and in future years. It also has to estimate 
costs to complete on such developments and make estimates relating to future sales 
price margins on those developments and homes. In making these assessments there 
is a degree of inherent uncertainty.
The Group’s site valuation process determines the forecast profit margin for each site. 
The valuation process acts as a method of allocating land costs and construction work 
in progress costs of a development to each individual plot and drives the recognition 
of costs in the Income Statement as each plot is sold. Any changes in the forecast 
profit margin of a site from changes in sales prices or costs to complete are recognised 
across all homes sold in both the current period and future periods. This ensures that 
the forecast site margin achieved on each individual home is equal for all current year 
completions and future plots across the development.
Management has performed a sensitivity analysis to assess the impact of a change in 
estimated future costs or forecast selling prices for developments on which sales were 
recognised in the year. A 2% increase in the forecast costs to complete would increase 
site-cost allocation in cost of sales in 2024 by £24.9m, resulting in a reduction in 
gross margin of 60 bps. A 3% decrease in forecast private sales prices would increase 
site‑cost allocation in cost of sales in 2024 by £43.6m, resulting in an reduction in 
gross margin of 100 bps.
 Depreciation of right-of-use assets
Right-of-use assets are depreciated in the Income Statement in equal instalments 
to the earlier of the end of the lease term or the end of the useful life of the asset.
 Part-exchange income and expenses
Income on the sale of a part-exchange property is recognised at legal completion 
at the fair value of consideration received or receivable for the property.
Part-exchange properties are recognised in inventories at the lower of cost, being 
their fair value at acquisition, and their net realisable value. The amount of any write 
down of inventories to net realisable value, or reversal of a previous write down, is 
recognised in the Income Statement in the period in which it occurs.
The carrying amount of a part-exchange property is recognised as an expense in the 
period in which the related income is recognised. Maintenance costs are recognised 
in the Income Statement in the period in which they are incurred.
Profit from operations is stated after charging/(crediting):
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Cost of inventories recognised as an expense in cost 
of sales
3,241.6
3,907.3
Employee costs (including Directors)
5
524.0
527.2
Adjusted items:
Costs associated with legacy properties
4
180.0
158.2
Amounts associated with legacy properties recovered 
from third parties
4
(0.5)
(2.7)
Costs incurred in respect of the all-share offer for the 
share capital of Redrow plc
4
22.4
—
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
13
7.5
6.1
Depreciation of right-of-use-assets
14
15.2
12.3
Amortisation of intangible assets
10
10.4
10.5
Profit from operations is stated after charging the Directors’ emoluments disclosed in the 
Remuneration Report on pages 123 to 145 and in note 5.
The Group does not recognise income from supplier rebates until it can be calculated 
reliably and it is certain that it will be received from suppliers. During the year, £34.6m 
(2023: £32.8m) of supplier rebate income was included within profit from operations.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
168
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

3.  Profit from operations continued
Administrative expenses
Administrative expenses of £336.9m (2023: £270.8m) include sundry income of £14.8m 
(2023: £16.7m), which principally comprises management fees receivable from JVs, 
the sale of freehold reversions, forfeit deposits and ground rent receivable.
Auditor’s remuneration
The remuneration paid to Deloitte LLP, the Group’s principal auditor, is disclosed below:
2024 
£000
2023
 £000
Fees payable to the Company’s auditor for the audit of the 
Company and Consolidated Financial Statements
1,023
852
Fees payable to the Company’s auditor for the audit of the 
Company’s subsidiaries
195
186
Total audit fees
1,218
1,038
Audit-related assurance services1
89
43
Other services2
230
230
Total fees for other services
319
273
Total fees related to the Company and its subsidiaries
1,537
1,311
1	
Audit-related assurance services comprise the review of the Interim Report.
2	 Other services comprise assurance services over selected ESG metrics and compliance with the recommendations of the TCFD and review 
procedures over selected non-financial disclosures in the Annual Report.
Details of the Group’s policy on the use of the Company’s principal auditor for non-audit 
services and auditor independence are set out in the Audit and Risk Committee Report on 
pages 112 to 120. No services were provided under contingent fee arrangements.
In addition to the remuneration paid to the Company’s auditor for services related to the 
Company and its subsidiaries, the auditor received the following remuneration from JVs in 
which the Group participates:
2024 
£000
2023
 £000
The audit of the Group’s JVs pursuant to legislation1
—
80
Total fees related to joint ventures
—
80
1	
The Group’s JVs are no longer audited by the Group auditor.
4.  Adjusted items
 Adjusted items
In determining whether an item should be presented as an adjustment to IFRS measures, 
the Group considers items that are material to the Group in aggregate and have arisen 
from one-off or unusual circumstances that could not reasonably have been expected 
to arise from normal trading. If an item meets these criteria the Board then exercises 
judgement as to whether the item should be classified as an allowable adjustment to 
IFRS. Examples of events that may give rise to the classification of items as adjusted 
are charges or credits in respect of legacy properties, the restructuring of existing and 
newly acquired businesses, and certain government grants.
The Directors use these adjusted measures, along with IFRS measures, to assess the 
operational performance of the Group as detailed in the key performance indicators 
section of the Strategic Report on pages 12 to 15.
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Adjusted items in cost of sales:
Costs incurred in respect of legacy properties
180.0
158.2
Amounts in respect of legacy properties recovered from 
third parties
(0.5)
(2.7)
Total adjusted items in cost of sales
179.5
155.5
Adjusted items in administrative expenses:
Costs incurred in respect of the all-share offer for the share 
capital of Redrow plc
22.4
—
Adjusted items in share of post-tax profit from joint ventures:
Costs incurred in respect of legacy properties by joint ventures
12.6
23.7
Total adjusted items
214.5
179.2
Costs incurred in respect of legacy properties
The adjusted costs in the year, associated with Group legacy properties, comprise additions 
to provisions of £182.5m, provision releases of £3.5m, a charge of £1.0m due to the revaluation of 
the provisions at the reporting date and reimbursements recognised directly in the Income 
Statement of £0.5m. In addition £12.6m of net costs in respect of JV legacy properties were 
incurred in the year. Further details of provisions movements are provided in note 19.
169
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

4.  Adjusted items continued
Costs incurred in respect of the acquisition of Redrow plc
On 7 February 2024, the Group announced an offer to acquire the entire share capital 
of Redrow plc through an all-share transaction. The transaction was approved by the 
shareholders of both groups on 15 May 2024 and legally completed on 21 August 2024 as 
disclosed in note 31. In the course of progressing the transaction, during the year the Group 
has incurred £22.4m in adviser fees. The total costs that will be incurred are expected to 
be material in aggregate.
5.  Key management, employees and retirement benefit obligations
Key management and employees
Key management personnel, as defined under IAS 24: ‘Related Party Disclosures’, have been 
identified as the Board of Directors, as the controls operated by the Group ensure that all 
key decisions are reserved for the Board. Detailed disclosures of individual remuneration, 
pension entitlements and share options for those Directors who served during the year are 
given in the audited sections within the Remuneration Report on pages 136 to 142.
A summary of key management remuneration is as follows:
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Salaries and fees (including pension compensation)
3.0
3.1
Social security costs1
0.8
1.0
Performance bonus
2.7
1.2
Benefits
0.1
0.1
Share-based payments2
1.8
(0.3)
Total
8.4
5.1
1	
Excluded from the Executive Directors’ and Non-Executive Directors’ single figure of remuneration tables on page 136.
2	 IFRS 2: ‘Share-Based Payments’ charge/(credit) attributable to key management.
Total employee numbers and costs are as follows: 
Group
Company
2024 
Number
2023 
Number
2024 
Number
2023 
Number
Average employee numbers 
(excluding sub-contractors and 
including Directors)
6,451
7,031
499
490
Group
Company
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Employee costs 
(including Directors):
Wages and salaries 
including bonuses
429.8
443.2
50.5
47.8
Redundancy costs
3.1
2.0
1.3
0.4
Social security costs
50.0
52.6
7.1
6.8
Other pension costs
21.2
19.2
2.4
2.1
Share-based payments
26
19.9
10.2
6.0
(0.3)
Employee costs for 
the year
524.0
527.2
67.3
56.8
The majority of the costs of the Company’s employees are charged to other Group companies.
Retirement benefit obligations
The Group operates several defined contribution pension schemes.
 Defined contribution schemes
The Group’s contributions to the schemes are charged in the Income Statement in the 
year in which the scheme members become entitled to contributions.
The Group operates defined contribution retirement benefit schemes for all qualifying 
employees, under which it pays contributions to independently administered funds. 
Contributions are based upon a fixed percentage of the employee’s pay and once these 
have been paid, the Group has no further obligations under these schemes.
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Contributions during the year:
Group defined contribution schemes’ Consolidated Income 
Statement charge
21.2
19.2
At the balance sheet date, there were outstanding contributions of £3.2m (2023: £2.8m), 
which were paid on or before the due date.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
170
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

6.  Net finance costs
 Finance costs and income
The Group recognises finance costs and income on bank borrowings, deposits and other 
borrowings in the Income Statement in the period to which they relate. Imputed interest 
on discounted assets, including land purchased on deferred terms and leased assets, is 
charged to the Income Statement over the period of settlement or lease period respectively.
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Finance income:
Finance income on short-term bank deposits
(44.9)
(22.0)
Other interest receivable
(2.3)
(1.8)
(47.2)
(23.8)
Finance costs:
Interest on loans and borrowings
9.4
9.3
Imputed interest on long-term payables
40.2
21.4
Finance charge on leased assets
1.8
1.2
Amortisation of facility fees
1.6
1.9
Other interest payable
0.7
1.1
53.7
34.9
Net finance costs
6.5
11.1
The weighted average interest rates (excluding fees) paid in the year were as follows:
Group
Company
2024 
%
2023 
%
2024 
%
2023 
%
USPP notes
2.8
2.8
2.8
2.8
7.  Tax
All profits of the Group are subject to UK tax.
The current year tax charge has been provided for, by the Group and the Company, at a standard 
effective rate, inclusive of RPDT, of 29.0% (2023: 24.5%). The closing deferred tax assets 
and liabilities have been provided in these Financial Statements at a rate of 25.0%-29.0% 
(2023: 20.5%-29.0%) on the temporary differences giving rise to these assets and liabilities.
 Tax
The tax currently payable is based on the taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit 
differs from net profit as reported in the Income Statement because it excludes 
items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and it further 
excludes items that are never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current 
tax is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted at 
the balance sheet date.
 Deferred tax
Deferred tax is the tax expected to be payable or recoverable on differences 
between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the Financial Statements 
and the corresponding tax bases used in the computation of taxable profit, and is 
accounted for using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax is measured on 
a non‑discounted basis using the tax rates and laws that have then been enacted or 
substantively enacted by the balance sheet date, and is charged or credited to the 
Income Statement, except when it relates to items charged or credited directly to 
other comprehensive income or equity, in which case the deferred tax is also dealt 
with in other comprehensive income or equity.
Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences 
and deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that taxable 
profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences can be utilised. 
Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference arises from 
goodwill or from the initial recognition (other than in a business combination) of 
other assets and liabilities in a transaction that affects neither the taxable profit nor 
the accounting profit. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary 
differences arising on investments in subsidiaries and interests in JVs, except where 
the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable 
that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date 
and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits 
will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered. Deferred tax assets 
and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax 
assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to taxes levied by the same 
tax authority and the Group intends to settle its current tax assets and liabilities on 
a net basis.
171
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

7.  Tax continued
Tax recognised in the Income Statement
The tax expense represents the sum of the tax currently payable and deferred tax.
Analysis of the tax charge for the year
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Current tax:
UK corporation tax on profits for the year
54.8
147.2
RPDT for the year
6.1
26.0
Adjustments in respect of previous years
3.2
(6.7)
64.1
166.5
Deferred tax:
Origination and reversal of temporary differences
(6.1)
1.8
Adjustment in respect of previous years
(1.6)
7.2
Impact of change in tax rates
—
(0.7)
(7.7)
8.3
Tax charge for the year
56.4
174.8
Factors affecting the tax charge for the year
The tax rate assessed for the year is higher (2023: higher) than the standard effective 
rate of tax in the UK of 29.0% (inclusive of corporation tax and RPDT) (2023: 24.5%). 
The differences are explained below:
2024
 £m
2023
 £m
Profit before tax
170.5
705.1
Profit before tax multiplied by the standard rate of tax of 29.0% 
(inclusive of corporation tax and RPDT) (2023: 24.5%)
49.4
172.7
Effects of:
Other items including non-deductible expenses and non-
taxable income
8.0
4.5
Additional tax relief for land remediation costs
(2.6)
(2.2)
Adjustment in respect of previous years
1.6
0.5
Impact of change in tax rates
—
(0.7)
Tax charge for the year
56.4
174.8
Tax recognised in equity
In addition to the amount charged to the Consolidated Income Statement, a net current 
and deferred tax credit of £0.8m (2023: £1.3m) was recognised directly in equity.
Factors affecting future tax charges
The Organisation for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) Pillar Two model rules 
are designed to ensure that large multinational groups incur a 15% minimum effective tax 
rate in each jurisdiction in which they operate. Pillar Two legislation was enacted in the 
UK in June 2023 and will be effective for the Group’s financial year beginning 1 July 2024. 
The Group has applied the mandatory temporary exception under IAS 12 in relation to the 
accounting for deferred taxes arising from the implementation of the Pillar Two legislation.
The Group operates in the UK and is subject to tax at 29.0% on all its residential development 
activities, comprising UK corporation tax (25.0%) and UK residential property developer tax 
(4.0%). The Group has performed an assessment of the Group’s potential exposure to Pillar 
Two income taxes in the UK and, based on the assessment, the Group does not expect a 
potential exposure to Pillar Two top-up taxes. Management is not currently aware of any 
circumstances under which this might change
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
172
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

7.  Tax continued
Deferred tax
All deferred tax relates to the UK and is stated on a net basis as the Group has a legally 
enforceable right to set off the recognised amounts and intends to settle on a net basis. 
The Group recognised a net deferred tax liability with the following movements in the year:
Group
Share
 options
 £m
Losses
£m
Brands
£m
Accelerated
capital
 allowances
£m
Customer
 contracts
 £m
Other
 (net)
 £m
Total
 £m
At 1 July 2022
3.8
—
(31.7)
0.5
(24.7)
7.0
(45.1)
Year ended 30 June 2023:
Income Statement 
(charge)/credit
(0.9)
—
0.1
(11.5)
3.4
0.6
(8.3)
Amounts taken 
directly to equity
(0.1)
—
—
—
—
—
(0.1)
At 30 June 2023
2.8
—
(31.6)
(11.0)
(21.3)
7.6
(53.5)
Comprising:
Deferred tax assets
2.8
—
—
—
—
7.6
10.4
Deferred tax liabilities
—
—
(31.6)
(11.0)
(21.3)
—
(63.9)
Year ended 30 June 2024:
Income Statement 
credit/(charge)
2.2
2.2
0.2
(0.2)
2.1
1.2
7.7
Amounts taken 
directly to equity
0.8
—
—
—
—
—
0.8
At 30 June 2024
5.8
2.2
(31.4)
(11.2)
(19.2)
8.8
(45.0)
Comprising:
Deferred tax assets
5.8
2.2
—
—
—
8.8
16.8
Deferred tax liabilities
—
—
(31.4)
(11.2)
(19.2)
—
(61.8)
The deferred tax liability in respect of indefinite life and other brands represents 
the amount of tax that would become due if the brands were sold at their book value. 
There is no intention to sell the indefinite life brands in the foreseeable future and it is 
not anticipated that any of the deferred tax liability in respect of the indefinite life brands 
will reverse in the 12 months following the balance sheet date. The deferred tax asset in 
respect of share schemes represents an estimate of the future tax deduction available on 
the exercise or vesting of awards under those schemes.
While it is anticipated that an element of the remaining deferred tax assets and liabilities 
will reverse during the 12 months following the balance sheet date, at present it is not 
possible to accurately quantify the value of all of these reversals.
In addition to the deferred tax liability shown above, the Group has not recognised 
a deferred tax asset of £10.2m (2023: £9.6m) in respect of capital and other losses 
amounting to £35.1m (2023: £33.3m) because these are not considered recoverable 
in the foreseeable future.
The Company recognised a deferred tax asset with the following movements in the year:
Company
Share
 options
 £m
Accelerated
capital
 allowances
£m
Other
 (net)
 £m
Total
 £m
At 1 July 2022
1.3
1.4
0.5
3.2
Year ended June 2023:
Income Statement (charge)/credit
(0.4)
(0.5)
0.3
(0.6)
At 30 June 2023
0.9
0.9
0.8
2.6
Comprising:
Deferred tax assets
0.9
0.9
0.8
2.6
Year ended 30 June 2024:
Income Statement credit/(charge)
0.3
—
(0.8)
(0.5)
Amounts taken directly to equity
0.1
—
—
0.1
At 30 June 2024
1.3
0.9
—
2.2
Comprising:
Deferred tax assets
1.3
0.9
—
2.2
173
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

8.  Earnings per share 
The earnings per share from continuing operations were as follows:
2024 
Pence
2023 
Pence
Basic earnings per share
11.8
53.2
Diluted earnings per share
11.6
52.6
Adjusted basic earnings per share
28.3
67.3
Adjusted diluted earnings per share
27.8
66.5
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit for the year attributable to 
ordinary shareholders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares 
in issue during the year, excluding those held by the EBT that do not attract dividend 
equivalents and which are treated as cancelled.
Diluted earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit for the year attributable to 
ordinary shareholders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares 
in issue adjusted to assume conversion of all potentially dilutive share options from the 
start of the year.
Adjusted basic and adjusted diluted earnings per share exclude the impact of adjusted 
items and any associated net tax amounts.
2024
2023
Profit attributable to ordinary shareholders of the 
Company (£m)
114.1
530.3
Adjusted items (£m)
214.5
179.2
Tax on adjusted items (£m)
(54.4)
(39.3)
Adjusted profit attributable to ordinary shareholders of 
the Company (£m)
274.2
670.2
Weighted average number of shares in issue (million)
974.6
1,000.1
Weighted average number of shares in EBT (million)
(5.8)
(3.8)
Weighted average number of shares for basic earnings 
per share (million)
968.8
996.3
Weighted average number of shares in issue (million)
974.6
1,000.1
Adjustment to assume conversion of all potentially 
dilutive shares (million)
12.5
8.4
Weighted average number of shares for diluted earnings 
per share (million)
987.1
1,008.5
9.  Dividends
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Amounts recognised as distributions to equity shareholders 
in the year:
Final dividend for the year ended 30 June 2023 of 23.5p 
(2022: 25.7p) per share
228.0
259.8
Interim dividend for the year ended 30 June 2024 of 4.4p 
(2023: 10.2p) per share
42.6
100.2
Total dividends distributed to equity shareholders in the year
270.6
360.0
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Proposed final dividend for the year ended 30 June 2024 of 
11.8p (2023: 23.5p) per share1
170.2
227.9
1	
The cost of the proposed dividend is calculated based upon the number of shares ranking for dividend at the balance sheet date, as adjusted, 
in the current year, for the issue of shares used in the acquisition of Redrow plc.
The final dividend of 11.8 pence per share was approved by the Board on 3 September 2024 
and has not been included as a liability as at 30 June 2024. 
10.  Goodwill and intangible assets
 Goodwill
Goodwill arising on consolidation (see note 32 for the Group policy on consolidation) 
represents the excess of the fair value of the consideration over the fair value of the 
separately identifiable net assets and liabilities acquired.
Goodwill arising on the acquisition of subsidiary undertakings and businesses is 
capitalised as an asset but reviewed for impairment at least annually.
For the purpose of impairment testing, goodwill is allocated to each of the Group’s 
cash-generating units, or groups of cash-generating units, expected to benefit from 
the synergies of the combination at acquisition. Cash-generating units to which 
goodwill has been allocated are tested for impairment. If the recoverable amount of 
the cash‑generating unit is less than the carrying amount of the unit, the impairment 
loss is allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill allocated to the 
unit and then to the other assets of the unit pro rata on the basis of the carrying 
amount of each asset in the unit. Any impairment loss is recognised immediately 
in the Income Statement and is not subsequently reversed.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
174
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

10.  Goodwill and intangible assets continued
Group
Goodwill
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Cost
At 1 July and 30 June
877.4
877.4
Accumulated impairment losses
At 1 July and 30 June
24.5
24.5
Carrying amount
At 30 June
852.9
852.9
The Group’s goodwill relating to the acquisition of Wilson Bowden Limited in 2007 has a 
carrying value of £792.2m and goodwill relating to the 2019 acquisition of Oregon Timber 
Frame Limited has a carrying value of £13.7m, both relating to the housebuilding business.
In addition, the Group has goodwill of £47.0m relating to the Group’s land promotion 
business, following the 2022 acquisition of Gladman Developments Limited.
Other intangible assets 
 Brands
The Group has capitalised, as intangible assets, brands that have been acquired. 
Acquired brand values are calculated using discounted cash flows. Where a brand is 
considered to have a finite life, it is amortised over its useful life on a straight‑line 
basis. Where a brand is capitalised with an indefinite life, it is not amortised. The factors 
that contribute to the durability of brands capitalised are that there are no material legal, 
regulatory, contractual, competitive, economic or other factors that limit the useful life 
of these intangible assets. Internally generated brands are not capitalised.
The Group carries out an annual impairment review of its indefinite life brand as part 
of the review of the carrying value of goodwill, by performing a value in use calculation, 
using a discount factor based upon the Group’s pre-tax weighted average cost of capital.
 Customer contracts
The Group has capitalised, as intangible assets, acquired customer contracts. 
Customer contracts are valued at the present value of future cash flows less 
contributory asset charges and are amortised on a straight-line basis in line with 
contract relationships at the acquisition date.
Group
Brands
Customer 
contracts
Total
Other intangible assets
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
Cost
At 1 July
118.7
118.7
98.9
98.9
217.6
217.6
Acquired in the year
—
—
—
—
—
—
Amounts written off
—
—
—
—
—
—
At 30 June
118.7
118.7
98.9
98.9
217.6
217.6
Amortisation
At 1 July
8.7
8.1
14.0
4.1
22.7
12.2
Amortisation in the year
0.5
0.6
9.9
9.9
10.4
10.5
Amounts written off
—
—
—
—
—
—
At 30 June
9.2
8.7
23.9
14.0
33.1
22.7
Carrying amount
At 30 June
109.5
110.0
75.0
84.9
184.5
194.9
The Group does not amortise the housebuilding brand acquired with Wilson Bowden, being 
David Wilson Homes, valued at £100.0m, as the Directors consider that this brand has an 
indefinite useful economic life due to the Group intending to hold and support the brand 
for an indefinite period, and there are no factors that would prevent it from doing so.
In 2022, the Group acquired brands valued at £10.8m and customer contracts valued 
at £98.9m with Gladman Developments Limited. The customer contracts are amortised 
on a straight-line basis over the expected life of the contracts; the brands acquired are 
amortised on a straight-line basis over a 20-year period.
The cost of brands disclosed above also includes £0.9m acquired with Oregon Timber 
Frame Limited in 2019 and £7.0m in respect of Wilson Bowden Developments Limited, 
both of which have been fully amortised or impaired in previous periods. 
Impairment of goodwill and indefinite life brand
The Group conducts an annual impairment review of goodwill and its indefinite life brand, 
David Wilson Homes.
175
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

10.  Goodwill and intangible assets continued
 Impairment of goodwill and indefinite life brand
Impairment reviews for goodwill and the Group’s indefinite life brand require an 
estimation of the value in use of the cash-generating units to which these assets 
are allocated. The value in use calculations require an estimate of expected future 
cash flows, including the anticipated growth rate of revenue and costs, and require 
the determination of a suitable discount rate to calculate the present value of the 
cash flows. The financial forecasts used reflect the outcomes that management 
considers most likely, based on the information available at the date of signing of 
these Financial Statements.
Goodwill and indefinite life brand allocated to housebuilding
An impairment review was performed at 30 April 2024 by comparing the value in use of 
the housebuilding business to the carrying value of its tangible and intangible assets and 
allocated goodwill.
The value in use was determined by discounting the expected future cash flows of the 
housebuilding business. The cash flows until 30 June 2027, being the three-year period 
aligned to the Group’s operating cycle, were determined using the Group’s approved 
detailed business plan and the cash flows for FY28 and FY29 were based on management 
projections based on expected volumes, selling prices and margins, taking into account 
available land purchases and work in progress levels. The cash flows for subsequent years 
were extrapolated in perpetuity using an estimated growth rate of 2.1% (2023: 1.0%).
The key assumptions for the value in use calculation for the housebuilding business were:
	• expected changes in selling prices for completed houses and the related impact on 
operating margin: these are determined on a site-by-site basis in the Group’s approved 
business plan dependent upon local market conditions and product type. For subsequent 
years, these have been estimated at a Group level based upon past experience and 
expectations of future changes in the market, considering external market forecasts;
	• sales volumes: these are determined on a site-by-site basis in the Group’s approved 
business plan dependent upon local market conditions, land availability and planning 
permissions. For subsequent years, these have been estimated at a Group level based 
on past experience and expectations of future changes in the market, taking into account 
external market forecasts;
	• expected changes in site costs to complete: these are determined on a site-by-site 
basis in the Group’s approved business plan dependent upon the expected costs of 
completing all aspects of each individual development. For subsequent years, these have 
been estimated at a Group level based on past experience and expectations of future 
changes in the market, taking into account external market forecasts; and
	• discount rate: this is a pre-tax rate reflecting the Group’s target capital structure, risks 
appropriate to the housebuilding business and current market assessments of the time 
value of money. A rate of 14.2% (2023: 15.0%) is considered by the Directors to be the 
appropriate pre-tax discount rate.
The result of the value in use exercise concluded that the recoverable value of goodwill 
and intangible assets allocated to the housebuilding business exceeded its carrying value 
by £819.7m (2023: £1,176.0m) and there has been no impairment.
Goodwill allocated to land promotion
An impairment review was performed at 30 June 2024 by comparing the value in use of 
the land promotion business to the carrying value of its tangible and intangible assets 
and allocated goodwill.
The value in use was determined by discounting the expected future cash flows of the 
land promotion business. The operating cycle for the land promotion business extends over 
a longer period than the housebuilding business, with land sales completing at the point 
in an economic cycle that generates the most profit. Inventories held at the current date 
may generate cash inflows in the medium to long term and, as a result, management’s 
forecasts extend up to ten years from the reporting date. It is therefore appropriate to 
consider projections over a longer period in the value in use calculation. Cash flows until 
30 June 2033 were determined using the business’s approved forecast, dependent upon 
expected site permissions and best estimates for targeted site sales, anticipated spend 
and overhead inflation. Due to the sensitivity of cash flows of the land promotion business 
to the economic cycle, the cash flows for years subsequent to 2033 were based on average 
sales receipts from the final five years of the forecast, adjusted for expected increases in 
cost, extrapolated in perpetuity using an estimated growth rate of 2.1% (2023: 1.0%). 
The key assumptions for the value in use calculation were the expected sales values 
achieved under land promotion agreements, based on current market values for similar 
land, costs required to fulfil customer contracts, and the discount rate of 13.2% (2023: 14.3%), 
being a pre-tax rate reflecting the risks appropriate to the land promotion business and 
current market assessments of the time value of money.
The result of the value in use exercise concluded that the recoverable amount of goodwill 
allocated to the land promotion business exceeded its carrying value by £52.6m (2023: £13.1m) 
and there has been no impairment. An increase in the discount rate of 220 bps would 
reduce the headroom of the recoverable amount over the carrying value to £nil.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
176
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

11.  Company investments in subsidiary undertakings
 Company investments
The Company’s interests in subsidiary undertakings are accounted for at cost less 
accumulated provision for impairment, which is reviewed annually.
Where share-based payments are granted to the employees of subsidiary undertakings 
by the Company, they are treated as a capital contribution to the subsidiary and the 
Company’s investment in the subsidiary is increased accordingly.
Company
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Cost:
Cost at the beginning of the year
3,177.7
3,180.1
Increase/(decrease) in investment in subsidiaries 
related to share-based payments
5.3
(2.4)
At 30 June
3,183.0
3,177.7
Impairment:
At beginning of the year and at 30 June
87.6
87.6
Net book value:
At 30 June
3,095.4
3,090.1
12.  Investments in jointly controlled entities
A jointly controlled entity (joint venture or JV) is an entity, including unincorporated entities 
such as partnerships, in which the Group holds an interest with one or more other parties 
where a contractual arrangement has established joint control over the entity.
The Group has no associated entities.
 Jointly controlled entities
Investments in jointly controlled entities are accounted for using the equity method 
of accounting.
The Group’s share of the profit or loss of jointly controlled entities increases or 
decreases the carrying amount of the investment and long-term interests.
Group
Investments in JVs
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
At the beginning of the year
129.8
177.9
Increase in amounts invested in JVs
38.3
18.1
Repayment of investments in JVs
(4.8)
(40.2)
Dividends received from JVs
(7.1)
(34.8)
Share of post-tax profit for the year from JVs
2.3
8.8
At 30 June
158.5
129.8
There are no losses in any of the Group’s JVs that have not been recognised by the Group.
177
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

12.  Investments in jointly controlled entities continued
During the year the Group entered into a new JV agreement, Bollo Lane LLP. At 30 June 2024, the Group had interests in the following JVs:
JV
Percentage
 owned
Voting 
rights
 controlled
Country of 
registration
Principal
 place of
 business
Principal 
activity
Financial 
year end 
date
51 College Road LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Alie Street LLP1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Barratt Metropolitan LLP2
75.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Barratt Wates (East Grinstead) Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Holding company
30 June
Barratt Wates (East Grinstead No.2) Limited1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Barratt Wates (Horley) Limited2
78.5%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Barratt Wates (Lindfield) Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Barratt Wates (Worthing) Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
BDWZest Developments LLP1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Holding company
31 March*
BDWZest LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Holding company
31 March*
Blackhorse Road Properties LLP2
51.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Bollo Lane LLP2
51.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Brooklands Milton Keynes LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
DWH/Wates (Thame) Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Enderby Wharf LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Famous Five Glenfield Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
30 June
Fulham Wharf LLP1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Fulham Wharf One Limited1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
31 March*
Fulham Wharf Two Limited1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
31 March*
Harrow View LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Infinity Park Derby LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Commercial development
30 June
Nine Elms LLP¹
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Nine Elms One Limited1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
31 March*
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
178
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

JV
Percentage
 owned
Voting 
rights
 controlled
Country of 
registration
Principal
 place of
 business
Principal 
activity
Financial 
year end 
date
Nine Elms Two Limited1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
31 March*
Old Sarum Park Properties Limited
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
30 June
Queensland Road LLP1
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
Ravenscraig Limited²
33.3%
33.3%
Scotland
UK
Commercial development
31 December*
Ravenscraig Town Centre LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Dormant
30 June
Sovereign BDW (Hutton Close) LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Sovereign BDW (Newbury) LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Wembley Park Properties LLP²
51.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
30 June
Wichelstowe LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Housebuilding
31 March*
ZestBDW LLP
50.0%
50.0%
England and Wales
UK
Holding company
31 March*
*	 JV prepares financial statements which are non-coterminous with the Group in order to comply with the terms of its JV agreement and to align with the year end and requirements of our JV partners.
Judgements applied in determining the classification of joint arrangements
1.	 The Group’s interests in a number of the entities classified as JVs are held indirectly: Barratt Wates (East Grinstead) No. 2 Limited is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Group’s JV, Barratt Wates (East Grinstead) Limited, and is therefore classified as a JV of the Group. BDWZest Developments LLP, 
Alie Street LLP, Queensland Road LLP, Fulham Wharf LLP and Nine Elms LLP form a group of limited liability partnerships jointly owned (directly or indirectly) by BDWZest LLP and ZestBDW LLP, both of which are JVs of the Group. Nine Elms One Limited and Nine Elms Two Limited are wholly 
owned subsidiaries of Nine Elms LLP, and Fulham Wharf One Limited and Fulham Wharf Two Limited are wholly owned subsidiaries of Fulham Wharf LLP. All of these entities are therefore classified as JVs of the Group.
2.	 The Group holds five JV investments (Barratt Wates (Horley) Limited, Barratt Metropolitan LLP, Wembley Park Properties LLP, Blackhorse Road Properties LLP and Bollo Lane LLP) not in equal share, and one (Ravenscraig Limited) with more than one other party. However, in each case, the Group 
has equal voting rights and control over the activities of the companies with the other parties. In addition, the Group and the other parties to the agreements only have rights to the net assets of these companies through the terms of the contractual arrangements. These entities are therefore 
classified as JVs.
Registered offices
The registered office of all of the entities in the preceding table, with the exception of those listed below, is: Barratt House, Cartwright Way, Forest Business Park, Bardon Hill, Coalville, 
Leicestershire LE67 1UF.
Enderby Wharf LLP: Here East, 13 East Bay Lane, 3rd Floor Press Centre, Queen Elizabeth Park, London E15 2GW.
Sovereign BDW (Hutton Close) LLP and Sovereign BDW (Newbury) LLP: Sovereign House, Basing View, Basingstoke RG21 4FA. 
Ravenscraig Limited: 15 Atholl Crescent, Edinburgh EH3 8HA.
12.  Investments in jointly controlled entities continued
179
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

12.  Investments in jointly controlled entities continued
Summarised financial information relating to the Group’s JVs is as follows:
Harrow View 
LLP
Wichelstowe 
LLP
Wembley Park 
Developments 
LLP
Barratt 
Metropolitan 
LLP
Fulham Wharf 
LLP
Brooklands 
Milton Keynes 
LLP
Other JVs
Group total
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
£m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
2024
 £m
2023
£m
Income
24.9
62.2
58.4
34.0
27.0
7.0
47.8
104.5
—
—
33.8
60.5
13.6
58.7
205.5
326.9
Adjusted expenditure
(25.4) (53.7)
(49.4)
(27.8) (20.4)
(7.5)
(46.1)
(91.4)
2.2
—
(22.4) (38.8)
(13.6)
(47.1)
(175.1) (266.3)
(Cost)/credit associated with legacy properties
—
—
—
—
—
—
(10.0)
(3.3)
9.2
(42.3)
—
—
(19.4)
—
(20.2) (45.6)
Interest (payable)/receivable
—
—
(2.3)
(2.5)
(0.3)
—
—
—
0.7
(0.1)
—
—
0.2
(0.2)
(1.7)
(2.8)
(0.5)
8.5
6.7
3.7
6.3
(0.5)
(8.3)
9.8
12.1
(42.4)
11.4
21.7
(19.2)
11.4
8.5
12.2
Tax
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.1
—
0.1
Profit/(loss) for the year, being total comprehensive income/(expense)
(0.5)
8.5
6.7
3.7
6.3
(0.5)
(8.3)
9.8
12.1
(42.4)
11.4
21.7
(19.2)
11.5
8.5
12.3
Group share of profit/(loss) for the year recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement
(0.3)
4.2
3.4
1.9
3.2
(0.2)
(6.2)
7.4
6.0
(21.2)
5.7
10.9
(9.5)
5.8
2.3
8.8
Dividends received from JVs in the year
1.5
3.6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
5.3
11.8
0.3
19.4
7.1
34.8
Current assets
116.9
98.5
26.0
28.1
41.0
32.9
145.9
109.7
27.5
30.6
5.4
15.6
73.1
60.9
435.8
376.3
Non-current assets
—
—
—
—
0.1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
7.2
9.6
7.3
9.6
Current liabilities
(7.8)
(11.4)
(5.8)
(14.5)
(11.0)
(8.9) (143.2) (98.7)
(30.2) (45.3)
(4.6)
(15.6)
(54.9) (26.7) (257.5) (221.1)
Non-current liabilities
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(42.4) (43.5)
(42.4) (43.5)
Net assets/(liabilities) of JVs
109.1
87.1
20.2
13.6
30.1
24.0
2.7
11.0
(2.7)
(14.7)
0.8
—
(17.0)
0.3
143.2
121.3
Cash and cash equivalents included in the above net assets
8.4
10.1
8.8
3.2
3.5
6.6
37.7
12.1
25.8
29.3
4.6
10.8
19.1
23.3
107.9
95.4
Group share of net assets/(liabilities) recognised in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet at 30 June
54.5
43.6
10.1
6.8
15.4
12.1
2.0
8.2
(1.3)
(7.4)
0.4
—
(8.9)
—
72.2
63.3
Adjusted expenditure is the total expenditure of the JV less adjusted items as defined in note 4.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
180
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

12.  Investments in jointly controlled entities continued
A reconciliation of the Group’s share of net assets to the carrying value of investments 
included in the Balance Sheet is presented below:
Group
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Group share of the net assets of its JVs
72.2
63.3
Group loans to JVs
86.3
66.5
At 30 June
158.5
129.8
The Group has made loans, net of loss allowances, of £86.3m (2023: £66.5m) to its JVs, 
which are presented within Group investments. The loss allowances for Group loans to JVs 
are equal to 12-month expected credit losses unless there has been a significant increase 
in credit risk since the date of initial recognition, in which case, the loss allowance is equal 
to the lifetime expected credit loss.
A significant increase in credit risk is judged to have occurred if a review of available 
information indicates an increased probability of default. At 30 June 2024, the loss 
allowance is immaterial (2023: immaterial).
Included within the Group’s share of net assets of JVs is a proportion of the loans to the 
JVs (net of fair value adjustments made in one JV), calculated using the Group’s ownership 
share, of £85.3m (2023: £63.6m).
During the year, the Group entered into a number of transactions with its JVs in respect of 
funding and development management services (with charges made based on the utilisation 
of these services) in addition to the provision of construction services. Further details on 
these transactions are provided in note 29. The Group and Company have a number of 
contingent liabilities relating to their JVs. Further details on these are provided in note 28.
The transfer of funds from the Group’s JVs to the Group is determined by the terms of the 
JV agreements, which specify how available funds should be applied in repaying loans and 
capital, and distributing profits to the partners.
13.  Property, plant and equipment
 Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment is carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and 
accumulated impairment losses. Depreciation is provided to write off the cost of the 
assets on a straight-line basis to their residual value over their estimated useful lives. 
Residual values and asset lives are reviewed annually.
Freehold properties are depreciated on a straight-line basis over 25 years. Freehold 
land is not depreciated. Plant is depreciated on a straight-line basis over its expected 
useful life, which ranges from one to seven years.
Group
Company
Property 
£m
Plant and
 equipment
 £m
Total 
£m
Property 
£m
Plant and
 equipment
 £m
Total 
£m
Cost
At 1 July 2022
29.1
53.7
82.8
0.2
26.0
26.2
Additions
8.4
14.7
23.1
—
2.6
2.6
Disposals
—
(1.6)
(1.6)
—
—
—
At 30 June 2023
37.5
66.8
104.3
0.2
28.6
28.8
Additions
1.0
6.2
7.2
—
1.1
1.1
Disposals
(0.2)
(0.7)
(0.9)
—
—
—
At 30 June 2024
38.3
72.3
110.6
0.2
29.7
29.9
Depreciation
At 1 July 2022
3.4
38.2
41.6
0.2
19.4
19.6
Charge for the year
0.4
5.7
6.1
—
3.1
3.1
Disposals
—
(1.5)
(1.5)
—
—
—
At 30 June 2023
3.8
42.4
46.2
0.2
22.5
22.7
Charge for the year
0.8
6.7
7.5
—
2.8
2.8
Disposals
(0.2)
(0.4)
(0.6)
—
—
—
At 30 June 2024
4.4
48.7
53.1
0.2
25.3
25.5
Net book value
At 30 June 2023
33.7
24.4
58.1
—
6.1
6.1
At 30 June 2024
33.9
23.6
57.5
—
4.4
4.4
Authorised future capital expenditure that was contracted but not provided for in these 
Financial Statements amounted to £4.4m (2023: £3.5m).  
181
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

14.  Leases
 Leases
A right-of-use asset and a lease liability are recognised at the commencement date 
of a lease. The right-of-use asset is initially measured at cost comprising the initial 
amount of the lease liability plus payments made before the lease commenced and 
any direct costs less any incentives received. The right-of-use asset is subsequently 
depreciated using the straight-line method from the commencement of the lease 
to the earlier of the end of the lease term or the end of the useful life of the asset. 
The right-of-use asset is also reduced for impairment losses, if any, and adjusted for 
certain remeasurements of the lease liability.
The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of the lease payments 
at the commencement date discounted using the Group’s incremental borrowing 
rate of between 1% and 7% and is subsequently measured at amortised cost using 
the effective interest method. The lease liability is remeasured when there is a 
change in the future lease payments, and a corresponding adjustment is made 
to the right‑of‑use asset.
The Group has elected not to recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for 
short-term leases of plant and machinery with a lease term of 12 months or less, 
and leases of low value including leases of office equipment. The lease payments 
associated with these leases are recognised as an expense on a straight-line basis 
over the lease term.
The Group and Company lease assets including land and buildings, vehicles, plant and 
machinery, and office equipment. Information about leases for which the Group or 
Company is a lessee is presented below.
Group
Company
Right-of-use assets
Land and
 buildings 
£m
Other
 £m
Total 
£m
Land and
 buildings 
£m
Other
 £m
Total 
£m
Balance at 1 July 2023
28.4
16.7
45.1
2.7
1.5
4.2
Balance at 30 June 2024
24.3
16.9
41.2
—
1.3
1.3
Net additions/
(disposals) during 
the year including 
remeasurements
1.7
9.6
11.3
(2.4)
0.4
(2.0)
Group
Company
Lease liabilities included in the Balance Sheet
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Current
13.4
13.1
0.6
1.3
Non-current
29.4
33.1
0.7
2.9
42.8
46.2
1.3
4.2
A maturity analysis of the contractual undiscounted cash flows associated with these lease 
liabilities is presented in note 30. 
Group
Amounts recognised in the Income Statement
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Interest on lease liabilities
1.8
1.2
Depreciation of right-of-use land and buildings
5.8
6.4
Depreciation of other right-of-use assets
9.4
5.9
Expenses relating to short-term and low-value leases
20.7
34.5
The total Group cash outflow for leases in the current year was £37.2m (Company: £0.9m) 
(2023: £48.4m (Company: £1.3m)), of which £16.5m (Company: £0.9m) (2023: £13.9m 
(Company: £1.3m)) related to the repayment of lease liabilities recognised in the 
Balance Sheet.
15.  Inventories
 Inventories
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Land held for 
development, including land in the course of development, is initially recorded at 
cost. Where, through deferred purchase credit terms, the carrying value differs from 
the amount that will ultimately be paid in settling the liability, this difference is 
charged as a finance cost in the Income Statement over the period of settlement.
Cost of construction work in progress comprises direct materials, direct labour costs 
and those overheads that have been incurred in bringing the inventories to their 
present location and condition. Overhead costs include, but are not limited to, roads 
and other infrastructure costs required for a site and local contributions and physical 
works contributions required under planning permissions granted for our developments.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
182
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

15.  Inventories continued
 Inventories continued
Due to the scale of the Group’s developments, the Group has to allocate site-wide 
development costs between homes built in the current year and in future years. 
It also has to estimate costs to complete on such developments. In making these 
assessments, there is a degree of inherent uncertainty. The Group has developed 
internal controls to assess and review carrying values and the appropriateness of 
estimates made. Further information is included in the margin recognition section 
of note 3.
Work in progress on promotion agreements comprises direct fees and labour costs 
incurred in investigating, designing, master planning, obtaining planning permission 
and ultimately securing sales agreements for land on behalf of landowners. The satisfaction 
of promotion agreements is largely dependent upon the grant of planning consent; 
therefore, management assesses the likelihood of attaining these consents when 
assessing their carrying values.
Group
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Land held for development
3,233.6
3,139.9
Construction work in progress
1,829.4
1,907.1
Promotion agreements work in progress
111.5
97.7
Part-exchange properties and other inventories
103.7
93.3
5,278.2
5,238.0
The Company had no inventories in 2024 or 2023.
Nature and carrying value of inventories
The Group’s principal activities are housebuilding and commercial development. 
The majority of the development activity is not contracted prior to the development 
commencing. Accordingly, the Group has in its Balance Sheet at 30 June 2024 current 
assets that are not covered by a forward sale. The Group’s internal controls are designed 
to identify any developments where the balance sheet value of land and work in progress 
is more than the projected lower of cost or net realisable value. During the year, the Group 
has conducted six-monthly reviews of the net realisable value of specific sites identified 
as at high risk of impairment, based upon a number of criteria including low site profit 
margins and sites with no forecast completions. Where the estimated net realisable value 
of a site was less than its current carrying value, the Group has impaired the land and work 
in progress value.
During the year, due to performance variations, changes in assumptions and changes to 
viability on individual sites, there were gross impairment charges of £9.2m (2023: £16.7m) 
and gross impairment reversals of £11.4m (2023: £12.0m), resulting in a net impairment 
reversal of £2.2m (2023: £4.7m charge) included within cost of sales.
The key estimates in these six-monthly reviews are those used to estimate the realisable 
value of a site, which is determined by forecast sales rates, expected sales prices and 
estimated costs to complete.
The Directors consider all inventories to be essentially current in nature, although the 
Group’s operational cycle is such that a proportion of inventories will not be realised within 
12 months. It is not possible to determine with accuracy when specific inventory will be 
realised, as this will be subject to a number of variables such as consumer demand and 
planning permission delays.
Inventories include £9.0m (2023: £11.0m) in respect of properties currently occupied under 
the refugee support scheme.
16.  Trade and other receivables
 Trade and other receivables
Trade and other receivables are financial assets with fixed or determinable payments 
that are not quoted in an active market. They are included in current assets, except 
for those with maturities greater than 12 months after the balance sheet date, which 
are classified as non-current assets. Amounts recoverable on certain construction 
contracts where revenue is recognised over time are included in trade receivables and 
stated at cost plus attributable profit less any foreseeable losses. Payments received 
on account for these construction contracts are deducted from amounts recoverable 
on these contracts.
Trade and other receivables are initially recognised at their transaction price, being 
fair value, and subsequently measured at amortised cost, being their nominal value 
less a loss allowance for expected credit losses, which are assessed on the basis of 
an average weighting of the risk of default. Any impairment is recognised immediately 
in the Income Statement.
For this purpose, a default is determined to have occurred if the Group becomes aware 
of evidence that it will not receive all contractual cash flows that are due or if payment 
has not been received within 60 days of the due date. After this time, it is probable 
that contractual cash flows will not be fully recovered.
The Group does not hold any collateral over these balances.
Trade receivables are receivables and contract assets arising from the Group’s contracts 
with customers. The loss allowance is equal to the lifetime expected credit loss, 
assessed on an individual basis.
183
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

16.  Trade and other receivables continued
 Trade and other receivables continued
The loss allowances for other receivables and amounts due from subsidiary undertakings 
are equal to 12-month expected credit losses unless there has been a significant increase 
in credit risk since the date of initial recognition, in which case the loss allowance is 
equal to the lifetime expected credit loss. A significant increase in credit risk is judged 
to have occurred if a review of available information indicates an increased probability 
of default, or if contractual payments are more than 30 days past due.
Where amounts due from subsidiary undertakings can be satisfied by the subsidiaries 
through the recovery of a debt from fellow subsidiaries with strong capacity to meet 
that debt, the amount is considered to have low credit risk at the reporting date and 
it is therefore assumed that the credit risk has not significantly increased.
Trade and other receivables that are more than two years overdue are deemed to have 
no reasonable expectation of recovery and are written off in the Financial Statements, 
but are still subject to enforcement activity. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously 
written off are credited to the Income Statement.
Group
Company
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Non-current assets
Amounts due from 
subsidiary undertakings
—
—
76.1
76.1
Contract assets
20
1.0
0.5
—
—
Other receivables
2.4
2.4
—
—
3.4
2.9
76.1
76.1
Current assets
Trade receivables
72.2
70.7
—
—
Contract assets
20
5.9
20.8
—
—
Amounts due from 
subsidiary undertakings
—
—
169.0
2.9
Other receivables
111.0
74.0
5.5
4.3
Prepayments and accrued 
income
12.8
16.6
8.1
8.7
201.9
182.1
182.6
15.9
Other receivables include £27.8m (2023: £37.1m) receivable from joint ventures.
The carrying values of trade and other receivables are stated after allowance for expected 
credit losses. The movements in the loss allowances for the year were as follows:
Trade receivables and
 contract balances
Other receivables
Lifetime expected
 credit losses
 (individually assessed)
12-month
expected credit
losses
Loss allowance
Notes
Group
 £m
Company
 £m
Group
 £m
Company
 £m
Loss allowance at 1 July 2023
8.1
—
0.3
—
Charge for the year
21
2.0
—
0.3
—
Amounts written off
—
—
—
—
Recoveries of amounts previously 
written off
21
(3.2)
—
(0.1)
—
Loss allowance at 30 June 2024
6.9
—
0.5
—
Movements in loss allowances are principally a result of the derecognition and origination 
of financial assets in the year. The loss allowances written off are equal to the gross 
carrying amounts of the assets written off in the year. The Directors consider that the 
carrying amount of trade receivables approximates to their fair value.
The expected credit losses on the Company amounts due from subsidiary undertakings are 
not material to the Financial Statements. The subsidiaries are able to pay their liabilities as 
they fall due and the probability of default is insignificant.
Further disclosures relating to financial assets are set out in note 21.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
184
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

17.  Net cash
Net cash is defined as cash and cash equivalents, bank overdrafts, interest-bearing 
borrowings and prepaid fees. Net cash at 30 June is shown below:
Group
Company
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Cash and cash equivalents
1,065.3
1,269.1
827.6
1,005.0
Drawn debt
Borrowings:
Sterling US private placement notes
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
Bank overdrafts
—
(3.4)
—
—
Total borrowings, being total drawn debt
(200.0)
(203.4)
(200.0)
(200.0)
Prepaid fees
3.2
3.7
3.2
3.7
Net cash
868.5
1,069.4
630.8
808.7
Total borrowings at 30 June are analysed as:
Non-current borrowings
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
(200.0)
Current borrowings
—
(3.4)
—
—
Total borrowings, being total drawn debt
(200.0)
(203.4)
(200.0)
(200.0)
Movement in net cash is analysed as follows:
Group
Company
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents
(203.8)
(83.6)
(177.4)
(40.4)
Repayment/(drawdown) of borrowings:
Loans and borrowings drawdowns
—
(3.4)
—
—
Loans and borrowings repayments
3.4
17.3
—
—
Other movements in borrowings:
Movement in prepaid fees
(0.5)
0.5
(0.5)
0.5
Movement in net cash in the year
(200.9)
(69.2)
(177.9)
(39.9)
Opening net cash
1,069.4
1,138.6
808.7
848.6
Closing net cash
868.5
1,069.4
630.8
808.7
Changes in liabilities arising from financing activities are shown below:
Group
Company
Total
borrowings
£m
Lease
liabilities
£m
Total 
£m
Total
borrowings
£m
Lease
liabilities
£m
Total 
£m
Liabilities from 
financing activities at 
1 July 2022
(217.3)
(37.1)
(254.4)
(200.0)
(4.2)
(204.2)
Financing cash flows
—
13.9
13.9
—
1.3
1.3
Other movements
13.9
(23.0)
(9.1)
—
(1.3)
(1.3)
Liabilities arising from 
financing activities at 
30 June 2023
(203.4)
(46.2)
(249.6)
(200.0)
(4.2)
(204.2)
Financing cash flows
—
16.5
16.5
—
0.9
0.9
Other movements
3.4
(13.1)
(9.7)
—
2.0
2.0
Liabilities arising from 
financing activities at 
30 June 2024
(200.0)
(42.8)
(242.8)
(200.0)
(1.3)
(201.3)
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents are held at floating interest rates linked to the UK bank rate 
and money market rates as applicable. Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash held by 
the Group and short-term bank deposits with an original maturity of three months or less 
from inception and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
Cash, cash equivalents and bank overdrafts, as presented in the Cash Flow Statement, 
are analysed as follows:
Group
Company
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Cash and cash equivalents
1,065.3
1,269.1
827.6
1,005.0
Bank overdrafts included in loans and 
borrowings
—
(3.4)
—
—
Cash, cash equivalents and bank overdrafts
1,065.3
1,265.7
827.6
1,005.0
Further disclosures relating to financial assets are set out in note 21.
185
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

17.  Net cash continued
Borrowings and facilities
 Loans and borrowings
Interest-bearing loans and overdrafts are initially recognised at fair value less directly 
attributable transaction costs and subsequently measured at amortised cost, being the 
amount recorded at recognition plus accrued interest applied to the account less any 
repayments made.
All debt facilities at 30 June 2024 are unsecured.
The principal features of the Group’s committed debt facilities at 30 June 2024 
and 30 June 2023 were as follows:
Amount drawn
Facility
30 June 2024
30 June 2023
Maturity
Committed facilities:
RCF
£700.0m
—
—
17 November 
2028
Fixed rate Sterling USPP notes
£200.0m
£200.0m
£200.0m
22 August 
2027
The Group also uses various bank overdrafts and uncommitted borrowing facilities that are 
subject to floating interest rates linked to SONIA and money market rates as applicable.
Weighted average interest rates are disclosed in note 6.
18.  Trade and other payables
 Trade and other payables
Trade and other payables are not interest bearing and are initially recorded at fair value. 
Subsequent measurement is at amortised cost.
Trade and other payables on extended terms, particularly in respect of land, are 
recorded at their fair value at the date of acquisition of the asset to which they relate 
by discounting at prevailing market interest rates at the date of recognition. The discount 
to nominal value, which will be paid in settling the deferred purchase terms liability, 
is amortised over the period of the credit term and charged to finance costs using the 
“effective interest rate” method.
Group
Company
Notes
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
Non-current liabilities
Land payables
165.0
185.2
—
—
Other payables
7.0
3.5
—
—
172.0
188.7
—
—
Current liabilities
Trade payables
252.7
310.3
2.8
1.1
Land payables
307.8
321.5
—
—
Contract liabilities
20
69.4
89.2
—
—
Amounts due to subsidiary 
undertakings
—
—
91.3
354.2
Accruals
399.2
381.3
34.1
28.6
Other tax and social security
14.8
17.0
—
—
Other payables
11.2
8.1
—
—
1,055.1
1,127.4
128.2
383.9
The carrying amount of trade payables approximates to their fair value.
Accruals include a social security accrual relating to share-based payments (note 26). 
Other payables classified as non-current liabilities at 30 June 2024 include amounts 
accrued for payment of the CITB levy and other sundry accruals.
The Group has £179.3m (2023: £244.4m) of payables secured by legal charges on land 
and buildings included within inventories. Other non-current payables are unsecured 
and non‑interest bearing.
Further disclosures relating to financial liabilities are set out in note 21.
19.  Provisions
 Provisions
Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present obligation (legal or constructive) 
as a result of a past event, and it is probable that the Group will be required to settle that 
obligation. Provisions are measured at the Directors’ best estimate of the expenditure 
required to settle the obligation at the balance sheet date and are discounted to 
present value where the effect is material.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
186
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

19.  Provisions continued
Group
Costs in
 relation
to
 completed
developments
£m
Legacy
 properties
- EWS and
associated
 review
£m
Legacy
 properties
- reinforced
concrete
frames
£m
Total 
£m
At 1 July 2023
176.1
535.9
76.4
788.4
Additions
67.7
125.9
56.6
250.2
Sites reclassified to completed 
developments
15.0
—
—
15.0
Releases
(20.5)
—
(3.5)
(24.0)
Revaluation due to the present value 
and timing of cash flows
—
(0.6)
1.6
1.0
Imputed interest
—
26.3
3.2
29.5
Utilisation in the year
(47.4)
(59.4)
(32.1)
(138.9)
At 30 June 2024
190.9
628.1
102.2
921.2
Group
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Current
378.0
310.5
Non-current
543.2
477.9
921.2
788.4
The Company had no provisions in either year.
Costs in relation to completed developments
Following the legal completion and handover to customers of all units on a site, the 
Group may retain obligations which are not settled for a number of years. These include 
costs in relation to the adoption of roads or public open space by local authorities, other 
contractual obligations to third parties and, in certain cases, the costs of remedial works 
where defects have been identified.
Whilst a proportion of this cost will not be realised within 12 months, the Group has an 
obligation to complete the works immediately should it be requested to do so. The balance 
in total is therefore considered to be current in nature. All outstanding issues on completed 
developments are resolved as soon as is practicable.
 Costs associated with legacy properties
External wall systems and associated review
On 13 March 2023, the Group signed the Self-Remediation Terms and Contract, 
codifying the commitments previously made under the Building Safety Pledge to 
undertake, or to fund, remediation or mitigation works on external wall systems (EWS) 
on all buildings of 11 metres or above in England and Wales that it has developed or 
refurbished in the 30 years preceding the date of the Building Safety Pledge, and to 
reimburse the Government’s Building Safety Fund wherever they have contributed 
to such activities. The Group has provided for the cost of fulfilling this commitment, 
as well as assisting with remedial work identified at a limited number of other legacy 
properties where it has a legal liability to do so, where relevant build issues have 
been identified, or where it is considered probable that such build issues exist.
30 June 2023
Identified for 
review
Review 
confirmed
 no remediation,
 or remediation 
completed
30 June 2024
Under review:
Buildings above 18 metres
168
6
(28)
146
Buildings between 11 
and 18 metres
110
20
(14)
116
Total buildings
278
26
(42)
262
Developments
89
14
(11)
92
The Group continues to review all of its current and legacy buildings where it has used 
EWS or cladding solutions, assessing the action required in line with the latest updates 
to Government guidance, as it applies, to multi-storey and multi-occupied residential 
buildings. All our buildings, including those incorporating EWS or cladding solutions, 
were signed off by approved inspectors as compliant with the relevant Building 
Regulations at the time of completion.
This is a complex area requiring significant estimates with respect to the estimates 
for the number of buildings affected, the individual remediation requirements of each 
building and the costs associated with that remediation (see also note 28). 
Following contact from building owners regarding potential issues, a net further 
26 buildings with a height of over 11 metres were added to the scope of works in the 
period (2023: 65 buildings). This reflects a reduction in the rate at which new buildings 
are being identified in comparison to the period immediately following the signature 
of the Self-Remediation Terms and Contract on 13 March 2023. At 30 June 2024, of 
the 262 buildings in the portfolio under review, 137 were at tender or site mobilisation 
or were in the process of being remediated (2023: 278 buildings, of which 63 were at 
tender or site mobilisation or were in the process of being remediated).
187
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

19.  Provisions continued
 Costs associated with legacy properties continued
External wall systems and associated review continued
As investigations into, and remediation of, the remaining buildings in the programme 
continue under the PAS9980 regime, it is possible that a limited number will require 
more extensive remediation than initially expected, which will represent a higher cost 
per unit than the population average. Whilst existing provisions have more than covered 
the additional costs on such properties, we have received higher than expected tender 
returns in the year relating to future remediations. In addition, we have seen costs from 
the Building Safety Fund continue to be higher than initially communicated to us. The 
Group has increased its overall EWS provision by £56.4m to reflect its revised estimates.
During the second half of the year it was identified following further investigation 
that, due to the unique unitised curtain wall system used in their construction, there 
is no testing methodology available to certify under PAS9980 the fire safety of three 
buildings on one development. This wall system has not been used in any other of the 
Group’s buildings. As a result, it is now expected that the wall system will need to be 
replaced, which will be undertaken in a manner that minimises disruption to residents. 
The cost of these works is estimated to be £69.5m based on the current expected 
method of remediation, though due to the unique nature of the building, this estimate 
may vary as the process is further developed.
It is now assumed that the majority of work on the remaining buildings in the portfolio 
will be completed over the next five years. This depends on a number of factors including 
timely engagement of building owners and remediation work being delivered in line 
with our estimated timings. Accordingly, the provision has been revalued to its present 
value, considering the effect of inflation and a discount rate of 4.0% based on gilt rates 
at the reporting date (2023: 4.7%), resulting in a release through cost of sales of £0.6m 
(2023: charge of £7.5m).
The investigation of the works required at many of the buildings is at an early stage and 
therefore it is possible that the scope of work required could change. If government 
legislation and regulation further evolve, or if the estimated timing of work is affected 
by building owner engagement or contractor availability, these estimates will change. 
In relation to the Group’s obligations under the Scottish Safer Buildings Accord, signed 
on 31 May 2023, and the Housing (Cladding Remediation) (Scotland) Act, passed on 
21 June 2024, the external wall provision is recorded on the basis that the standard 
of remediation required in Scotland is consistent with England and Wales. This will be 
determined when the final contract with the Scottish Government is signed (see note 28).
The estimates are based on key assumptions that will be updated as work and 
time progress. The sensitivity of the provision held at the balance sheet date to 
the following possible movements in key assumptions is shown below:
Sensitivity
Increase/(decrease)
 in provisions at
 30 June 2024 
£m
10% increase in estimated cost
60.8
5% increase in the number of buildings
28.5
100 bps increase in discount rate
(13.6)
Reinforced concrete frames
As announced in July 2020, we took the decision to pay for required remedial action on 
the reinforced concrete frame at the Citiscape development in Croydon and undertook 
an associated review of 27 other developments designed by the same engineering firm 
or its associated companies. This review is substantially complete and remediation 
work is ongoing. As work progresses, estimates of costs to complete are reassessed 
and the provision updated accordingly.
In the prior year, structural issues were separately found at two developments where 
reinforced concrete frames were designed for us by a different engineering firm to 
that employed at Citiscape. Following further analysis undertaken during the second 
half of the year and as preliminary work on those developments has progressed, it 
is now considered probable that extensive remediation will be required. Based on a 
high-level risk review, an additional £56.6m has been provided at the reporting date. 
Further analysis must be undertaken to determine both the exact locations within 
the developments which will need to be remediated and the nature of the work to 
be performed in each case, which may result in revisions to the estimated costs 
and time frame of delivery.
Management has made estimates as to the future costs, the extent of the remedial 
works required and the costs of providing alternative accommodation to any residents 
affected by the remedial works. These Financial Statements have been prepared based 
on currently available information, including known costs and quotations where possible. 
However, the extent, cost and timing of remedial work may change as work progresses.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
188
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

20.  Contract assets and liabilities
 Contract assets and liabilities
Contract assets relate to amounts due from customers primarily for construction 
work completed but not invoiced at the balance sheet date in relation to contracts 
where revenue is recognised over time. These amounts are included in trade and other 
receivables. The Group has taken advantage of the practical expedient in paragraph 94 
of IFRS 15 to immediately expense the incremental costs of obtaining contracts where 
the amortisation period of the assets would have been one year or less.
Contract liabilities relate to payments received from the customer on the contract, 
and/or amounts invoiced to the customer in advance of the Group performing its 
obligations on contracts where revenue is recognised either over time or at a point 
in time. These amounts are included within trade and other payables.
Significant changes in contract assets and liabilities are as follows:
Contracts on which
revenue is recognised
over time
Contracts on which
revenue is recognised
at a point in time
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
At 1 July:
Amounts included within trade and 
other payables
(9.6)
(4.2)
(79.6)
(120.1)
Amounts included within trade and 
other receivables
21.3
13.3
—
—
11.7
9.1
(79.6)
(120.1)
Movements in the year:
Performance obligations satisfied in the year
218.2
192.7
3,950.0
5,128.7
Amounts invoiced in the year
(226.9)
(190.1)
(3,870.4)
(5,008.6)
Movements in retentions
(0.3)
—
—
—
Cash received for performance obligations 
not yet satisfied
—
—
(65.2)
(79.6)
At 30 June
2.7
11.7
(65.2)
(79.6)
Analysed as:
Amounts included within trade and 
other payables
(4.2)
(9.6)
(65.2)
(79.6)
Amounts included within trade and 
other receivables
6.9
21.3
—
—
Further revenue of £74.6m (2023: £104.3m) is expected to be recognised in future years in 
respect of contracts on which revenue is recognised over time, of which 66.6% (2023: 86.8%) 
is expected to be recognised within 12 months of the balance sheet date.
The Company had no contract assets or liabilities in either year.
21.  Financial instruments
 Recognition
Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognised on the Balance Sheet in accordance 
with IFRS 9 when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument.
The Group derecognises a financial asset only when the contractual rights to the cash 
flows from the asset expire or it transfers the financial asset and substantially all the 
risks and rewards of ownership of the asset to another entity.
The Group derecognises a financial liability only when the Group’s obligations are 
discharged or cancelled or they expire.
 Classification and measurement
All non-derivative financial assets are classified in accordance with IFRS 9 as 
“subsequently measured at amortised cost”. All non-derivative financial liabilities 
are classified as “subsequently measured at amortised cost”.
Financial assets and liabilities subsequently measured at amortised cost are initially 
recognised at fair value determined based on discounted cash flow analysis using 
current market rates for similar instruments. They are subsequently measured at 
amortised cost using the “effective interest rate” method. Financial assets are also 
measured after recognition of any impairment, which is included within administrative 
expenses in the Income Statement.
Financial liabilities are classified as current liabilities unless the Group has an unconditional 
right to defer settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the balance sheet date.
 Impairment
A loss allowance is recognised for expected credit losses on financial assets as described 
in note 16. Any impairment is recognised immediately in the Income Statement.
189
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

21.  Financial instruments continued
Financial assets
The carrying values and fair values of the Group and Company financial assets are as follows:
Group
Company
Notes
Fair
value
£m
2024
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2023
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2024
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2023
Carrying
value
£m
Cash and cash 
equivalents
17 1,065.3 1,065.3
1,269.1
1,269.1
827.6
827.6 1,005.0 1,005.0
Measured at 
amortised cost:
Trade and 
other 
receivables¹
133.8
133.8
118.7
118.7
4.6
4.6
2.7
2.7
Intercompany 
receivables
16
—
—
—
—
245.1
245.1
79.0
79.0
Total financial 
assets
1,199.1
1,199.1
1,387.8
1,387.8
1,077.3
1,077.3
1,086.7
1,086.7
1	
Excludes amounts recoverable on contracts, prepayments and accrued income, and tax and social security.
Financial liabilities
The carrying values and fair values of the Group and Company financial liabilities are as follows:
Group
Company
Notes
Fair
value
£m
2024
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2023
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2024
Carrying
value
£m
Fair
value
£m
2023
Carrying
value
£m
Measured at 
amortised 
cost:
Bank 
overdrafts
17
—
—
3.4
3.4
—
—
—
—
Loans and 
borrowings
17
184.2
200.0
170.7
200.0
184.2
200.0
170.7
200.0
Trade and 
other 
payables¹
991.5 1,025.9 1,086.6
1,119.5
20.6
20.6
18.1
18.1
Intercompany 
payables
18
—
—
—
—
91.3
91.3
354.2
354.2
Lease 
liabilities
14
42.8
42.8
46.2
46.2
1.3
1.3
4.2
4.2
Total financial 
liabilities
1,218.5
1,268.7 1,306.9
1,369.1
297.4
313.2
547.2
576.5
1	
Excludes deferred income, payments received in excess of amounts recoverable on contracts, tax and social security and other non-
financial liabilities.
The fair values of liabilities in the above table have been determined using discounted cash 
flows based on observable market data other than quoted prices in active markets for 
identical liabilities.
Trade and other payables include items secured by legal charges as disclosed in note 18.
Financial instruments gains and losses
The net (gains)/losses recorded in the Consolidated Income Statement, in respect of 
financial instruments (excluding interest shown in note 6), were as follows:
Notes
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Financial assets measured at amortised cost
Trade receivables - loss allowance charge
16
2.3
5.6
Recoveries of amounts previously written off
16
(3.3)
(2.0)
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
190
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

22.  Share capital
 Equity instruments
Ordinary share capital is recorded at the proceeds received, net of direct issue costs, 
and is classified as equity.
Ordinary share capital
Allotted and issued ordinary shares
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
10p each fully paid: 974,592,261 (2023: 974,584,613) ordinary 
shares
97.4
97.4
Options over the Company’s shares granted during the year
2024 
Number
2023 
Number
LTPP
4,497,287
4,028,187
Sharesave
2,549,465
6,637,568
DBP
107,057
920,887
ELTIP
1,972,714
1,792,966
9,126,523
13,379,608
Allotment/cancellation of shares during the year
2024 
Number
2023 
Number
At 1 July
974,584,613 1,022,562,819
Buyback and cancellation of shares in the year
—
(47,985,293)
Issued to satisfy exercises under Sharesave schemes
7,648
7,087
At 30 June
974,592,261
974,584,613
23.  Merger reserve
The merger reserve comprises the non-statutory premium arising on shares issued as 
consideration for the acquisition of subsidiaries where merger relief under Section 612 
of the Companies Act 2006 applies.
24.  Capital redemption reserve
During the prior year the Company purchased 47,985,293 of its own shares in the market 
which were then cancelled. The nominal value of these shares was transferred to the 
capital redemption reserve.
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
At 1 July
4.8
—
Amounts transferred in respect of own shares purchased and 
cancelled during the year
—
4.8
At 30 June
4.8
4.8
25.  Own shares reserve
The own shares reserve represents the cost of shares in Barratt Developments PLC 
purchased in the market or issued by the Company and held by the EBT on behalf of the 
Company in order to satisfy options and awards that have been granted by the Company.
The EBT has agreed to waive all, or any future right to dividend payments on shares 
held within the EBT and these shares do not count in the calculation of the weighted 
average number of shares used to calculate EPS until such time as they are vested to 
the relevant employee.
2024 
2023 
Ordinary shares in the Company held in the EBT (number)
8,063,747
4,998,602
Cost of shares held in the EBT (£m)
36.9
23.2
Market value of shares held in the EBT at 472.2p (2023: 413.5p) 
per share (£m)
38.1
20.7
During the year, the EBT purchased 5,000,000 (2023: 2,951,352) shares in the market and 
disposed of 1,351,813 (2023: 3,254,817) shares, which were used to satisfy the vesting of 
ELTIP and LTPP awards in both years and also the DBP awards in 2023. A further 583,042 
shares were used in settlement of exercises under Sharesave schemes (2023: 18,101).
191
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Outstanding equity-settled share-based payments 
At 30 June 2024, the following options were outstanding:
Date of grant
Option price 
Pence
2024 
Number
Not exercisable after
Sharesave
9 April 2019 – 5-year plan
519
74,561
31 December 2024
7 April 2020 – 5-year plan
456
159,756
31 December 2025
7 April 2021 – 3-year plan
604
452,347
31 December 2024
7 April 2021 – 5-year plan
604
50,748
31 December 2026
6 April 2022 – 3-year plan
436
1,472,868
31 December 2025
6 April 2022 – 5-year plan
436
188,081
31 December 2027
12 April 2023 – 3-year plan
347
4,339,352
31 December 2026
12 April 2023 – 5-year plan
347
1,292,765
31 December 2028
3 April 2024 – 3-year plan
381
2,064,681
31 December 2027
3 April 2024 – 5-year plan
381
428,205
31 December 2029
Total Sharesave options
10,523,364
LTPP
14 October 2021 – Executive
—
1,034,903
—
14 February 2022 – Executive
—
117,716
—
12 October 2022 – Executive
—
1,756,646
—
21 December 2023 – Executive
—
2,125,301
—
14 October 2021 – Senior management
—
1,072,815
—
12 October 2022 – Senior management
—
1,903,806
—
21 December 2023 – Senior management
—
2,301,468
—
Total LTPP awards
10,312,655
26.  Share-based payments
The Group issues equity-settled share-based payments to certain employees.
 Share-based payments
Equity-settled share-based payments are measured at the fair value of the equity 
instrument at the date of grant. Fair value is measured either using Black Scholes or 
Monte Carlo models depending on the characteristics of the scheme. Valuations have 
also been adjusted for any post-vesting holding period with the adjustment calculated 
using a Finnerty and Chaffe model.
The fair value is expensed in the Income Statement on a straight-line basis over the 
vesting period, based on the Group’s estimate of shares that will eventually vest where 
non-market vesting conditions apply. Non-market vesting conditions are taken into account 
in the estimate of the fair value of the equity instruments.
Analysis of the Consolidated Income Statement charge:
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Equity-settled share-based payments:
LTPP
7.6
(2.2)
Sharesave
4.6
3.6
DBP
2.9
2.7
ELTIP
4.8
6.1
19.9
10.2
As at 30 June 2024, an accrual of £3.7m (2023: £2.7m) was recognised in respect of social 
security liabilities on share-based payments.
Share-based payments reserve
The share-based payments reserve represents the obligation of the Group in relation to 
equity-settled share-based payment transactions. Details of movements in the share‑based 
payments reserve are shown on the Statement of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
192
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

26.  Share-based payments continued
Outstanding equity-settled share-based payments continued
Date of grant
Option price 
Pence
2024 
Number
Not 
exercisable
 after
DBP
24 September 2021
—
637,949
—
12 October 2022
—
878,493
—
25 September 2023
—
107,057
—
Total DBP awards
1,623,499
ELTIP
15 July 2021
—
155
—
15 July 2022
—
1,362,056
—
17 July 2023
—
1,707,838
—
Total ELTIP awards
3,070,049
Total
25,529,567
Further information relating to the share-based payment schemes
Sharesave
Under the Sharesave, participants are required to make monthly contributions to an HMRC 
approved savings contract with a bank or building society for a period of three or five 
years. On entering into the savings contract, participants are granted an option to acquire 
ordinary shares in the Company at an exercise price determined under the rules of the 
Sharesave. The Sharesave is open to all eligible employees as determined by the Board 
and is not subject to the satisfaction of any performance conditions.
LTPP
The grant of awards under the LTPP is at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee 
taking into account individual performance and overall performance of the Group. Vesting 
under this scheme is dependent upon performance conditions including TSR, EPS, ROCE 
and GHG emissions. Further details can be found in the Remuneration Report on pages 
134 and 135.
DBP
Deferred shares are held in accordance with the DBP as approved by the shareholders 
at the 2015 AGM. The DBP is currently utilised to hold shares awarded in respect of any 
bonus earned in excess of 100% of base salary. Further details can be found on page 138.
ELTIP
The Board approved the 2023 Award in July 2023 and the 2022 Award in July 2022 under 
the ELTIP. The Awards were made to all eligible employees employed as at 17 July 2023 
and 15 July 2022 respectively. Participants will be entitled to receive shares in the Company 
when the 2022 Award vests on 1 July 2024, and participants of the 2023 Award will be 
entitled to receive shares in the Company when the Award vests on 1 July 2025. Senior 
management is not eligible to participate in the ELTIP. The Awards are not subject to the 
satisfaction of any performance condition other than that participants remain employed 
by the Group and have not resigned before the end of the vesting period.
Number and weighted average exercise price of outstanding share-based payments
The number and weighted average exercise prices of options and awards made under the 
Group’s share option schemes were as follows:
2024
2023
LTPP
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Outstanding at 1 July
—
8,947,593
—
7,823,199
Forfeited during the year
—
(2,593,279)
—
(1,161,682)
Reinstated
—
—
—
8,989
Exercised during the year
—
(538,946)
—
(1,751,100)
Granted during the year
—
4,497,287
—
4,028,187
Outstanding at 30 June
—
10,312,655
—
8,947,593
Exercisable at 30 June
—
—
—
—
2024
2023
Sharesave
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Outstanding at 1 July
398
11,322,268
474
8,945,381
Forfeited during the year
423
(2,757,679)
532
(4,235,493)
Exercised during the year
454
(590,690)
461
(25,188)
Granted during the year
381
2,549,465
347
6,637,568
Outstanding at 30 June
384
10,523,364
398
11,322,268
Exercisable at 30 June
—
—
—
—
193
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

26.  Share-based payments continued
Number and weighted average exercise price of outstanding share-based 
payments continued
2024
2023
DBP
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Outstanding at 1 July
—
1,528,406
—
1,225,640
Forfeited during the year
—
(11,964)
—
(25,123)
Exercised during the year
—
—
—
(592,998)
Granted during the year
—
107,057
—
920,887
Outstanding at 30 June
—
1,623,499
—
1,528,406
Exercisable at 30 June
—
—
—
—
2024
2023
ELTIP
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Weighted
 average
 exercise
 price in
 pence
Number of
award units
Outstanding at 1 July
—
2,373,943
—
1,879,686
Forfeited during the year
—
(463,741)
—
(387,990)
Exercised during the year
—
(812,867)
—
(910,719)
Granted during the year
—
1,972,714
—
1,792,966
Outstanding at 30 June
—
3,070,049
—
2,373,943
Exercisable at 30 June
—
—
—
—
The weighted average share price, at the date of exercise, of share options exercised during 
the year was 460.3 pence (2023: 368.8 pence). The weighted average life for all schemes 
outstanding at the end of the year was 1.9 years (2023: 2.1 years).
Fair value of options and awards granted in the year
Weighted average fair value of options granted
Weighted average fair value of 
options granted
Valuation model
2024 
Pence
2023 
Pence
Sharesave
Black Scholes model
112.3
132.9
LTPP
Black Scholes and Monte Carlo models1
473.1
260.7
DBP
Black Scholes model
471.1
324.1
ELTIP
Black Scholes model
366.4
399.7
1	
The TSR portion of the award is valued using a Monte Carlo model. Other elements of the award are valued using a Black Scholes model. The 
valuations have also been adjusted for any post-vesting holding period with the adjustment calculated using a Finnerty and Chaffe model.
Inputs used to determine fair value of options
The weighted average inputs to the valuation models were as follows:
Grants 2024
Grants 2023
ELTIP
Sharesave
LTPP
DBP
ELTIP
Sharesave
LTPP
DBP
Average share 
price
408p
466p
563p
472p
471p
467p
325p
325p
Average exercise 
price
—
381p
—
—
—
347p
—
—
Expected volatility 32.9%
29.1%
32.3%
31.7%
37.3%
37.6%
44.8%
38.2%
Expected life
2.0
 years
3.5
years
3.0
years
3.0
years
2.0
 years
3.5
 years
3.0
 years
3.0
 years
Risk-free interest 
rate
5.30%
4.34%
3.60%
4.51%
4.14%
3.28%
4.17%
4.35%
Expected 
dividends
5.4%
4.1%
—
—
8.2%
5.9%
—
—
Expected volatility was determined by reference to the historical volatility of the Group’s 
share price over a period consistent with the expected life of the options. The expected 
life used in the models has been adjusted, based on the Directors’ best estimate, for the 
effects of non-transferability, exercise restrictions and behavioural considerations.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
194
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

27.  Non-controlling interests
Group
Movement in non-controlling interest share of net assets recognised in 
the Consolidated Balance Sheet
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
At 1 July
0.5
0.8
Distribution of profits to non-
controlling partner
(0.4)
(0.3)
Share of profit for the year recognised in the Consolidated 
Income Statement
—
—
At 30 June
0.1
0.5
There are no significant restrictions on the ability of the Group to access or use assets 
and settle liabilities. Detailed arrangements for each subsidiary are laid out in the relevant 
shareholder and partnership agreements.
28.  Contingent liabilities
Contingent liabilities related to subsidiaries
The Company has guaranteed certain bank borrowings of its subsidiary undertakings.
Certain subsidiary undertakings have commitments for the purchase of trading stock 
entered into in the normal course of business.
In the normal course of business, the Group has given counter-indemnities in respect of 
performance bonds and financial guarantees. At 30 June 2024 the bonds and guarantees 
amount to £419.9m (2023: £412.7m) and, at the date of these Financial Statements, the 
possibility of cash outflow is considered minimal and no provision is required.
External wall systems
As disclosed in note 19, on 13 March 2023, the Group signed the Self-Remediation Terms 
and Contract and is continuing to undertake a review of all of its current and legacy 
buildings where it has used EWS or cladding solutions. Approved inspectors signed off 
all of our buildings, including the EWS or cladding used, as compliant with the relevant 
building regulations at the time of completion.
At 30 June 2024, the Group held provisions of £628.1m (2023: £535.9m) in relation to EWS 
and associated reviews, based on management’s best estimate of the cost and timing 
of remediation of in-scope buildings. It is possible that as remediation work proceeds, 
additional remedial works are required which do not relate to EWS or cladding solutions. 
Such works may not have been identified from the reviews and physical inspections 
undertaken to date and may only be identified when detailed remediation work is in 
progress. Therefore, the nature, timing and extent of any such costs were unknown 
at the balance sheet date.
It is also possible that the number of buildings requiring remediation may increase. 
This could occur because buildings which hold valid EWS1 certificates are found to require 
remediation or because investigatory works identify remediation not previously identified.
In addition, we recognise that the retrospective review of building materials and fire safety 
matters continues to evolve. The Financial Statements have been prepared based on 
currently available information and regulatory guidance. However, these estimates may be 
updated if government legislation and regulation further evolve.
On 31 May 2023 the Group signed the Scottish Safer Buildings Accord, committing to resolve 
life‑critical fire safety defects in multi‑occupancy residential domestic or part‑domestic 
buildings, over 11 metres, built by us as a developer in the period of 30 years to 1 June 2022. 
This Accord is not legally binding, but we are committed to working in good faith with the 
Scottish Government to agree a legal form contract. The Group has undertaken preliminary 
cost assessments at multi-occupancy buildings over 11 metres in Scotland at which fire 
safety defects have been identified. The Group’s EWS provision at 30 June 2024 reflects 
the outcome of these assessments. The estimates are based on the assumption that the 
standard of remediation required in Scotland is consistent with that in England and Wales. 
The Housing (Cladding Remediation) (Scotland) Act 2024, which became law on 21 June 2024, 
has provided a framework on which the remediation programme in Scotland can be based, 
but requires secondary legislation and further contractual agreement with developers to 
determine the details. The estimated cost may vary depending on the final form of the 
developer remediation contract agreed with the Scottish Government.
During the year, warranty providers received claims under warranties for building safety 
matters on three developments historically delivered by the Group. Further investigation 
is required to determine whether the nature and extent of any remediation work is 
incremental to that already expected and we expect this process to be completed within 
the next financial year.
Reinforced concrete frames
As disclosed in note 19, the Group is undertaking remediation at developments designed 
by certain engineering firms or associated companies. The Financial Statements have been 
prepared based on currently available information; however, the detailed review is ongoing 
and the extent and cost of any remedial work may change as this work progresses.
We are actively seeking to recover costs from third parties in respect of EWS and 
reinforced concrete frames; however, there is no certainty regarding the extent of any 
financial recovery.
Contingent liabilities related to JVs
The Group has given counter-indemnities in respect of performance bonds and financial 
guarantees to its JVs totalling £5.0m at 30 June 2024 (2023: £9.5m).
The Group has also given a number of performance guarantees in respect of the obligations 
of its JVs, requiring the Group to complete development agreement contractual obligations 
in the event that the JVs do not perform as required under the terms of the related contracts. 
At 30 June 2024, the probability of any loss to the Group resulting from these guarantees 
is considered to be remote.
195
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

28.  Contingent liabilities continued
Contingent liabilities related to legal claims
Provision is made for the Directors’ best estimates of all known material legal claims and 
all legal actions in progress. The Group takes legal advice as to the likelihood of success 
of claims and actions and no provision is made (other than for legal costs) where the 
Directors consider, based on such advice, that claims or actions are unlikely to succeed, 
or a sufficiently reliable estimate of the potential obligations cannot be made.
Contingent liability in respect of the investigation by the Competition 
and Markets Authority
On 26 February 2024, the Competition and Markets Authority (CMA) launched an investigation 
under Chapter I of the Competition Act 1998 into suspected breaches of competition law 
by eight housebuilders, relating to the exchange of competitively sensitive information, 
including the Company and its subsidiaries. We continue to co-operate with the CMA in its 
investigation. The timing of the conclusions of this investigation and any potential impact 
on the Group is unknown.
29.  Related party transactions
Directors of Barratt Developments PLC and remuneration of key personnel
The Board and certain members of senior management are related parties within the 
definition of IAS 24 (Revised): ‘Related Party Disclosures’ and the Board members are 
related parties within the definition of Chapter 11 of the UK Listing Rules. There is no 
difference between transactions with key personnel of the Company and transactions 
with key personnel of the Group.
Disclosures related to the remuneration of key personnel as defined in IAS 24 are given 
in note 5.
There have been no related party transactions as defined in Listing Rule 11.1.5R for the year 
ended 30 June 2024.
Transactions between the Company and its subsidiaries and a former JV
The Company has entered into transactions with its subsidiary undertakings in respect of 
funding and Group services which include management accounting and audit, sales and 
marketing, IT, company secretarial, architects and purchasing. Recharges are made to the 
subsidiaries based on their utilisation of these services.
Company
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Transactions between the Company and its subsidiaries and 
former JV during the year:
Charges in respect of management and other services provided 
to subsidiaries
158.0
142.7
Net interest paid by the Company on net loans from subsidiaries
16.9
18.4
Dividends received from subsidiary undertakings
516.0
500.0
Distribution received from a former JV of the Company1
—
0.1
Balances at 30 June:
Amounts due by the Company to subsidiary undertakings
91.3
354.2
Amounts due to the Company from subsidiary undertakings
245.1
79.0
1	
The Company’s only JV, Rose Shared Equity LLP, was wound up during the prior year. Prior to this, it made a final distribution to its members.
The Company and its subsidiaries have entered into counter-indemnities in the normal 
course of business in respect of performance bonds.
Transactions between the Group and its JVs
The Group has entered into transactions with its JVs as follows:
Group
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Transactions between the Group and its JVs during the year:
Charges in respect of development management and other 
services provided to JVs
10.3
8.4
Net interest charges in respect of funding provided to JVs
2.1
1.6
Dividends received from JVs
7.1
34.8
Balances at 30 June:
Funding loans and interest due from JVs net of impairment
86.3
66.5
Other amounts due from JVs
27.8
37.1
Loans and other amounts due to JVs
(0.6)
(0.5)
Changes in the amounts invested by the Group in joint ventures are shown in note 12.
In addition, one of the Group’s subsidiaries, BDW Trading Limited, contracts with a number 
of the Group’s JVs to provide construction services. The Group’s contingent liabilities 
relating to its JVs are disclosed in note 28.
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
196
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

30.  Financial risk management
The Group’s approach to risk management and the principal operational risks of the business 
are detailed on pages 63 to 70. The Group’s financial assets and financial liabilities are 
detailed in note 21.
The Group’s operations and financing arrangements expose it to a variety of financial risks, 
of which the most material are: liquidity risk, the availability of funding at reasonable 
margins, credit risk and interest rates. There is a regular, detailed system for the reporting 
and forecasting of cash flows from operations to senior management including Executive 
Directors to ensure that liquidity risks are promptly identified and appropriate mitigating 
actions are taken by the Treasury department. These forecasts are further stress tested 
at a Group level on a regular basis to ensure that adequate headroom within facilities and 
banking covenants is maintained. In addition, the Group has a risk management programme 
that seeks to limit the adverse effects of the other risks on its financial performance.
The Board approves treasury policies and certain day-to-day treasury activities have been 
delegated to a centralised Treasury Operating Committee, which in turn regularly reports 
to the Board. The Treasury department implements guidelines that are established by the 
Board and the Treasury Operating Committee.
Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will be unable to meet its liabilities as they fall due. 
The Group actively maintains a mixture of long-term and medium-term committed facilities 
that are designed to ensure that the Group has sufficient available funds for operations.
The Group’s borrowings are typically cyclical throughout the financial year and peak in 
April to May, and October to November of each year, due to seasonal trends in income. 
Accordingly, the Group maintains sufficient facility headroom to cover these requirements. 
On a normal operating basis, the Group has a policy of maintaining a minimum headroom 
of £150.0m. The Group identifies and takes appropriate actions based on its regular, 
detailed system for the reporting and forecasting of cash flows from its operations. 
The Group’s drawn debt, excluding fees, represented 22.2% (2023: 22.6%) of available 
committed facilities at 30 June 2024. In addition, the Group had £1,065.3m (2023: £1,269.1m) 
of cash and cash equivalents.
The Group was in compliance with its financial covenants at 30 June 2024. The Group’s 
resilience to its principal risks has been modelled, together with possible mitigating 
actions, over a three-year period, considering the prospects of the combined group. At the 
date of approval of the Financial Statements, the Group’s internal forecasts indicate that 
it will be able to operate within its current facilities and remain in compliance with these 
covenants for the foreseeable future, being at least 12 months from the date of signing 
these Financial Statements.
One of the Group’s objectives is to minimise refinancing risk. The Group has a policy that 
the average maturity of its committed bank facilities and private placement notes is a 
minimum of two years with a target of two to three years. At 30 June 2024, the average 
maturity of the Group’s committed facilities was 4.1 years (2023: 4.4 years).
The Group maintains certain committed floating rate facilities with banks to ensure 
sufficient liquidity for its operations. The undrawn committed facilities available to the 
Group, in respect of which all conditions precedent had been met, were as follows:
Group
Company
Expiry date
2024
 £m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023
 £m
In more than two years but not 
more than five years
700.0
700.0
700.0
700.0
In addition, the Group had undrawn, uncommitted overdraft facilities available at 30 June 2024 
of £37.0m (2023: £37.0m).
The expected undiscounted cash flows of the Group and Company financial liabilities, by 
remaining contractual maturity at the balance sheet date, were as follows:
Group
Notes
Carrying
amount
£m
Contractual
 cash flow
£m
Less 
than
1 year
£m
1-2
 years
£m
2-5
 years
£m
Over 5
 years
£m
2024
Loans and borrowings 
(including bank overdrafts)¹
21
200.0
219.3
5.5
5.5
208.3
—
Trade and other payables2
21 1,025.9
1,045.7
862.0
131.0
42.3
10.4
Lease liabilities
21
42.8
47.7
13.6
10.9
16.0
7.2
1,268.7
1,312.7
881.1
147.4
266.6
17.6
2023
Loans and borrowings 
(including bank overdrafts)¹
21
203.4
224.9
5.5
5.5
213.9
—
Trade and other payables2
21
1,119.5
1,140.1
937.8
133.0
67.4
1.9
Lease liabilities
21
46.2
50.3
13.3
11.4
18.8
6.8
1,369.1
1,415.3
956.6
149.9
300.1
8.7
1	
The Group is party to banking agreements that include a legal right of offset, which enables the overdraft balances of £nil (2023: £3.4m) to be 
settled net with cash balances. These balances have been excluded from contractual cash flows.
2	 Excludes deferred income, payments received in excess of amounts recoverable on contracts, tax and social security and other non-financial liabilities.
The Group had no derivative financial instruments at 30 June 2024 or 30 June 2023.
197
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

30.  Financial risk management continued
Liquidity risk continued
Company
Notes
Carrying
amount
£m
Contractual
 cash flow
£m
Less 
than
1 year
£m
1–2 
years
£m
2–5 
years
£m
Over 5
 years
£m
2024
Loans and borrowings 
(including bank overdrafts)
21
200.0
219.3
5.5
5.5
208.3
—
Trade and other payables1
21
20.6
20.6
20.6
—
—
—
Intercompany payables
21
91.3
91.3
91.3
—
—
—
Lease liabilities
21
1.3
1.4
0.7
0.4
0.3
—
313.2
332.6
118.1
5.9
208.6
—
2023
Loans and borrowings 
(including bank overdrafts)
21
200.0
224.9
5.5
5.5
213.9
—
Trade and other payables¹
21
18.1
18.1
18.1
—
—
—
Intercompany payables
21
354.2
354.2
354.2
—
—
—
Lease liabilities
21
4.2
4.3
1.3
1.2
1.8
—
576.5
601.5
379.1
6.7
215.7
—
1	
Excludes tax and social security and other non-financial liabilities.
The Company had no derivative financial instruments at 30 June 2024 or 30 June 2023.
Market risk (price risk)
Interest rate risk
The Group has both interest-bearing assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Floating rate 
borrowings expose the Group to cash flow interest rate risk, and fixed rate borrowings 
expose the Group to fair value interest rate risk.
The Group has a conservative treasury risk management strategy and the Group’s interest 
rates are set using fixed rate debt instruments.
Due to the level of the Group’s interest cover ratio, and in accordance with the Group’s 
policy to hedge a proportion of the forecast RCF drawings based on the Group’s three-year 
plan, no interest rate hedges are currently required.
The exposure of the Group’s financial liabilities to interest rate risk is as follows:
Group
Floating rate
financial
 liabilities
 £m
Fixed rate
financial
 liabilities
 £m
Non-interest
-bearing
financial
 liabilities
£m
Total
 £m
2024
Financial liability exposure to 
interest rate risk
—
200.0
1,068.7
1,268.7
2023
Financial liability exposure to 
interest rate risk
—
200.0
1,169.1
1,369.1
The Group retained a strong cash position throughout the year and, therefore, the Group 
did not draw on its RCF during the year and the use of other facilities was minimal. 
No interest was paid by the Group on floating rate borrowings in 2024 or 2023.
Sterling USPP notes of £200.0m were issued on 22 August 2017 with a fixed coupon of 
2.77% and a ten-year maturity. These fixed rate notes expose the Group and Company to 
fair value interest rate risk.
The exposure of the Company’s financial liabilities to interest rate risk is as follows:
Company
Floating rate
financial
 liabilities 
 £m
Fixed rate
financial
 liabilities
 £m
Non-interest
-bearing
financial
 liabilities 
£m
Total
 £m
2024
Financial liability exposure 
to interest rate risk
77.8
200.0
35.4
313.2
2023
Financial liability exposure to 
interest rate risk
340.7
200.0
35.8
576.5
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
198
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

30.  Financial risk management continued
Market risk (price risk) continued
Interest rate risk continued
The Company’s floating rate financial liabilities comprise interest-bearing loans from other 
Group undertakings, on which interest was charged at a rate of 4.0% throughout the year 
(2023: 4.0%).
Sensitivity analysis
In the year ended 30 June 2024, if UK interest rates had been 1.0% higher/lower (considered 
to be a reasonably possible change based on forecast Bank of England interest rates) and 
all other variables were held constant, the Group’s pre-tax profit would increase/decrease 
by £7.8m, the Group’s post-tax profit would increase/decrease by £5.9m and, as such, the 
Group’s equity would increase/decrease by £5.9m.
Credit risk
In the majority of cases, the Group receives cash on legal completion for private sales 
and receives advance stage payments from registered providers for affordable housing. 
The Group has £1,065.3m (2023: £1,269.1m) on deposit or in current accounts with 14 
(2023: 14) financial institutions. Other than this, neither the Group nor the Company has 
a significant concentration of credit risk, as their exposure is spread over a large number 
of counterparties and customers.
The Group manages credit risk through its credit policy. This limits its exposure to financial 
institutions with high credit ratings, as set by international credit rating agencies, and 
determines the maximum permissible exposure to any single counterparty.
The maximum exposure to any counterparty at 30 June 2024 was £141.2m (2023: £181.3m) 
of cash on deposit with a financial institution. The carrying amount of financial assets 
recorded in the Financial Statements, net of any allowance for losses, represents the 
Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk.
As at 30 June 2024, the Company was exposed to £245.1m (2023: £79.0m) of credit risk 
in relation to intercompany loans, which are considered to be of low credit risk and fully 
recoverable, as well as financial guarantees, performance bonds and the bank borrowings 
of subsidiary undertakings. Further details are provided in notes 28 and 29.
Capital risk management (cash flow risk)
The Group’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard its ability to continue as a 
going concern in order to provide returns for shareholders and meet its liabilities as they 
fall due while maintaining an appropriate capital structure.
The Group manages its share capital as equity, as set out in the Statement of Changes 
in Shareholders’ Equity, and its bank borrowings (being overdrafts and bank loans) and 
its private placement notes as other financial liabilities, as set out in note 21. The Group 
is subject to the prevailing conditions of the UK economy and the quantum of the Group’s 
earnings is dependent upon the level of UK house prices. UK house prices are determined 
by the UK economy and economic conditions, employment levels, interest rates, consumer 
confidence, mortgage availability and competitor pricing. The Group’s approach to the 
management of the principal operational risks of the business is detailed on pages 63 to 65.
Other methods by which the Group can manage its short-term and long-term capital 
structure include: adjusting the level of dividend payments to shareholders (assuming the 
Company is paying a dividend); issuing new share capital; arranging debt to meet liability 
payments; and selling assets to reduce debt.
31.	 Post balance sheet events
On 21 August 2024, the Company acquired the full share capital of Redrow plc in an all 
share transaction. On 23 August 2024, the Company issued 476,309,120 new ordinary shares 
as consideration for this transaction.
In accordance with standard practice, the CMA has issued an Initial Enforcement Order 
requiring the Barratt and Redrow businesses to continue to operate independently until 
the CMA has formally accepted the undertakings proposed by the parties in response to its 
limited concerns, or otherwise agrees to integration taking place.
Due to the short time between the completion of the acquisition and the signing of these 
Financial Statements, the fair values of the consideration and the assets and liabilities 
acquired are still being assessed.
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings
 Consolidation
The Financial Statements of subsidiary undertakings are consolidated from the date 
when control passes to the Group, as defined in IFRS 3, using the acquisition method 
of accounting up to the date control ceases. All of the subsidiaries’ identifiable assets 
and liabilities, including contingent liabilities, existing at the date of acquisition 
are recorded at their fair values. All changes to those assets and liabilities, and 
the resulting gains and losses that arise after the Group has gained control of the 
subsidiary are included in the Income Statement. All intra-Group transactions and 
intercompany profits or losses are eliminated on consolidation.
The entities listed on the following pages, are subsidiaries of the Company or Group. All are 
registered in England and Wales or Scotland, with the exception of SQ Holdings Limited, 
which is registered in Guernsey. Unless otherwise stated, the results of these entities are 
consolidated within these Financial Statements.
199
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption
The following UK subsidiaries will take advantage of the audit exemption set out within Section 
479A of the Companies Act 2006 for the year ended 30 June 2024. The undertakings listed 
below are 100% owned, either directly or indirectly, by Barratt Developments PLC.
Subsidiary
Company number
Acre Developments Limited
SC091934
Base East Central Rochdale LLP
OC318544
Base Hattersley LLP
OC318541
Base Regeneration LLP
OC318540
Basildon Regeneration (Barratt Wilson Bowden) Limited
05876010
BDW (F.R.) Limited
05876012
BDW (F.R. Commercial) Limited
05876013
BDW North Scotland Limited
SC027535
BLLQ LLP
OC411400
BLLQ2 Limited
12373138
David Wilson Homes Limited
00830271
Milton Park Homes Limited
03787306
Wilson Bowden Limited
02059194
Yeovil Developments Limited
05285388
In accordance with Section 479C of the Companies Act 2006, the Company will guarantee 
the debts and liabilities of the UK subsidiary undertakings listed in the preceding table. 
As at 30 June 2024, the total sum of these debts and liabilities is £60.7m.
At 30 June 2024 the Group owned 100% of the ordinary share capital of the following subsidiaries:
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Acre Developments Limited
2
A
Advance Housing Limited
1
A
Ambrose Builders Limited
1
A
Barratt Bristol Limited
1
Barratt Central Limited
1
Barratt Chester Limited
1
A
Barratt Commercial Limited
1
Barratt Construction (Southern) Limited
1
A
Barratt Corporate Secretarial Services Limited
1
Barratt Developments (International) Limited
1
Barratt Dormant (Atlantic Quay) Limited
1
A
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Barratt Dormant (Blackpool) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (Harlow) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (Tyers Bros. Oakham) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (Walton) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (Tyers Bros. Oakham) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (WB Construction) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (WB Developments) Limited 
1
A
Barratt Dormant (WB Properties Developments) Limited
1
A
Barratt Dormant (WB Properties Northern) Limited
1
A
Barratt East Anglia Limited
1
A
Barratt East Midlands Limited
1
Barratt East Scotland Limited
58
A
Barratt Eastern Counties Limited
1
A
Barratt Edinburgh Limited
2
A
Barratt Evolution Limited
1
A
Barratt Falkirk Limited
2
A
Barratt Leeds Limited
1
Barratt London Limited
1
Barratt Manchester Limited
1
A
Barratt Newcastle Limited
1
A
Barratt North London Limited
1
Barratt Northampton Limited
1
Barratt Northern Limited
1
Barratt Norwich Limited
1
A
Barratt Poppleton Limited
1
A
Barratt Preston Limited
1
A
Barratt Properties Limited
1
A
Barratt Redrow Limited
1
Barratt Scottish Holdings Limited
2
A
Barratt South London Limited
1
Barratt South Wales Limited
1
Barratt South West Limited
1
A
Barratt Southern Counties Limited
1
Barratt Southern Limited
1
Barratt Southern Properties Limited
1
A
Barratt Special Projects Limited
1
A
Barratt St Mary’s Limited
1
A
Barratt St Paul’s Limited
1
A
Barratt Sutton Coldfield Limited
1
A
Barratt Trade And Property Company Limited
2
A
Barratt Urban Construction (East London) Limited
1
A
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
200
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Barratt Urban Construction (Northern) Limited
1
A
Barratt Urban Construction (Scotland) Limited
2
A
Barratt West Midlands Limited
1
Barratt West Scotland Limited
2
Barratt Woking Limited
1
A
Barratt York Limited
1
Bart 225 Limited
1
A
Basildon Regeneration (Barratt Wilson Bowden) Limited
1
A
BDW (F.R.) Limited
1
A
BDW (F.R. Commercial) Limited
1
A
BDW North Scotland Limited
51
BDW Trading Limited
1
Bradgate Development Services Limited
1
A
Broad Oak Homes Limited
1
A
C V (Ward) Limited
1
A
Crossbourne Construction Limited
1
A
David Wilson Estates Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (Anglia) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (East Midlands) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (Home Counties) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (North Midlands) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (Northern) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (South Midlands) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (Southern) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes (Western) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Land (No 10) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Land (No 11) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Land (No 13) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Land (No 14) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Land (No 15) Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Services Limited
1
A
David Wilson Homes Yorkshire Limited
1
A
Decorfresh Projects Limited
1
A
Dicconson Holdings Limited
1
A
E. Barker Limited
1
A
E. Geary & Son Limited
1
A
English Oak Homes Limited
1
Francis (Springmeadows) Limited
1
A
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Frenchay Developments Limited
1
A
G.D. Thorner (Construction) Limited
1
A
G.D. Thorner (Holdings) Limited
1
A
Gladman Developments Limited
1
A
Glasgow Trust Limited
2
A
Hartswood House Limited
1
Hawkstone (South West) Limited
1
A
Idle Works Limited
1
A
J.G.Parker Limited
1
A
James Harrison (Contracts) Limited
2
A
Janellis (No.2) Limited
1
A
Kealoha 11 Limited
1
A
Kealoha Limited
1
A
Kingsoak Homes Limited
1
Knightsdale Homes Limited
1
Lindmere Construction Limited
1
A
Marple Development Company Limited
1
A
Milton Park Homes Limited
1
A
Norfolk Garden Estates Limited
1
A
North West Land Developments Limited
1
A
Oregon Contract Management Limited
51
A
Oregon Timber Frame Limited
51
A
Oregon Timber Frame (England) Limited
1
A
Redbourne Builders Limited
1
A
Roland Bardsley Homes Limited
1
A
Scothomes Limited
2
A
Scottish Homes Investment Company, Limited
2
A
Skydream Property Co. Limited
1
A
Squires Bridge Homes Limited
1
A
Squires Bridge Limited
1
A
Swift Properties Limited
1
A
The French House Limited
1
A
Tomnik Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Commercial Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Construction Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Developments Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Estates Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Group Services Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Homes (Holdings) Limited
1
A
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
201
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Trencherwood Homes (Midlands) Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Homes (South Western) Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Homes (Southern) Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Homes Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Housing Developments Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Investments Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Land Holdings Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Land Limited
1
A
Trencherwood Retirement Homes Limited
1
A
Vizion (Milton Keynes) Limited
1
A
Ward Holdings Limited
1
A
Ward Homes (London) Limited
1
A
Ward Homes (North Thames) Limited
1
A
Ward Homes (South Eastern) Limited
1
A
Ward Homes Group Limited
1
A
Ward Homes Limited
1
A
Ward Insurance Services Limited
1
A
Wards Construction (Industrial) Limited
1
A
Wards Construction (Investments) Limited
1
A
Wards Country Houses Limited
1
A
Waterton Tennis Centre Limited
29
A
William Corah & Son Limited
1
A
William Corah Joinery Limited
1
A
Wilson Bowden (Atlantic Quay Number 2) Limited
1
A
Wilson Bowden (Ravenscraig) Limited
1
Wilson Bowden City Homes Limited
1
A
Wilson Bowden Developments Limited
1
A
Wilson Bowden Group Services Limited
1
A
Wilson Bowden Limited
1
Yeovil Developments Limited
1
A
Subsidiaries of the Group which are management companies limited by guarantee:
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
28-33 Imperial Park Management Company Limited
26
A, B
254-257 Scholars Place Management Company Limited
45
A, B
Abbey Gate Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Abbey View Residents Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Abbotts Green (Woolpit) Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Abbotts Meadow (Steventon) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Adderbury Fields Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Aldhelm Court Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Amberswood Rise Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Ambler’s Meadow (East Ardsley) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Applegarth Manor (Oulton) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Applegate (Sittingbourne) Management Company Limited
11
A, B
Ashridge Grange (Wokingham) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Ashtree Grove Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Aylesham (Central) Residents Management Company Limited
11
A, B
Aylesham Village (Barratt) Residents Management Company Limited
49
A, B
B5 Central Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Baggeridge Village Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Barrow Farm Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Barum Knoll, Barnstaple Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Beaufort Park (Wootton Bassett) Management Limited
50
A, B
Beavans House Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Beck Lane, Sutton-in-Ashfield (The Hawthorns) Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Beeston Quarter Apartments (Beeston) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Belle Vue (Doncaster) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Bentley Fields Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Bermondsey Heights Residents Energy Management Company Limited
4
A, B
Bermondsey Heights Residents Management Company Limited
4
A, B
Berry Acres (Paignton) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Bilberry Chase Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Birds Marsh View Chippenham Apartment Resident Management 
Company Limited
13
A, B
Bishop Fields (Hereford) Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Bishop Park (Henfield) Management Company Limited
53
A, B
Bishops Green (Wells) Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Bishop’s Hill Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Blackberry Park Residents Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Blackdown Heights (Crimchard) Management Company Limited
31
A, B
Blackhorse View Energy Centre Management Company
1
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
202
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Blackhorse View Residents Management Company
1
A, B
Blackwater Reach (Southminster) Management Company Limited
52
A, B
Blossomfields Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Bluebell Woods (Wyke) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Blythe House Management Company Limited
39
A, B
Bodington Manor (Adel) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Bowds House Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Braid Park (Tiverton) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Brindsley (Old Mill Farm) Management Company Limited
60
A, B
Broken Stone Road (Blackburn) Residents Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Brooklands (Milton Keynes) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Brookside Meadows Phase 1B Residents Management Company Limited
41
A, B
Brookwood Meadows (Westham) Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Brue Place Residents Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Bruneval Gardens (Wellesley) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Brun Lea Heights Resident Management Company Limited
64
A, B
Buckley Gardens (Melksham) Management Company Limited
59
A, B
Bure Meadows (Aylsham) Management Company Limited
10 
A, B
Burlington Road Residents’ Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Calder Rise Residents Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Canal Quarter Resident Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Cane Hill Park (Coulsdon) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Cane Hill Park (Gateway) Management Company Limited
53
A, B
Canes Meadow (Brixton) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Canford Paddock (Poole) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Carlton Green (Carlton) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Castle Hill (DWH1) Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Castlegate & Mowbray Park Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Cedar Ridge Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Central Area Heat Company Limited
12
A, B
Centurion Meadows (Burley) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Centurion Village Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Ceres Rise Residents Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Chalkers Rise (Peacehaven) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Chapel Gate (Launceston) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Charfield Gardens Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Cherry Blossom Meadow (Newbury) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
City Heights Apartments (Leicester) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Clements Gate (Poringland 2) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Clipstone Park (Leighton Buzzard) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Coat Grove (Martock) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Colliers Court (Speedwell) Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Compass Point (Swanage Grammar School) 
Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Compass Point (Swanage) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Constable Gardens (Residents) Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Corinthian Place Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Cottam Gardens Resident Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Cringleford Heights Management Company Limited
61
A, B
Croft Gardens (Phase 2) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Daracombe Gardens Management Company Limited
33
A, B
Darwin Green Management Company Limited
54
A, B
De Cheney Gardens Management Company Limited
30
A, B
De Havilland Place (Hatfield) Limited
22
A, B
De Lacy Fields KM8 Management Company Limited
5
A, B
De Lacy Fields KM12 Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Delamere Park (Nunney) Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Dickens Gate (Staplehurst) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Dida Gardens (Didcot) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Donnington Heights (Newbury) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Doseley Park Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Drayton Meadows Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Drovers Court (Micklefield) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Dunmore Road (Abingdon) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Dunstall Park (Tamworth) Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Earls Park Management Company Limited
30
A, B
East Ham Market Energy Centre Management Company
54
A, B
East Ham Market Residents Management Company
54
A, B
Eastman Village Energy Centre Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Eastman Village Residents Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Ecclesden Park (Angmering) Management Company Limited
18
A, B
Edwalton (Sharp Hill) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Eldebury Place (Chertsey) Management Company Limited
53
A, B
Elderwood (Bannerdale) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Elm Tree Park (Rainworth) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Elworthy Place (Wiveliscombe) Management Company Limited
31
A, B
Elysian Fields (Adel) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Embden Grange (Tavistock) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
203
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Emmet’s Reach (Birkenshaw) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Ersham Park (Hailsham) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Fairfield Croft Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Fairfield (Stony Stratford) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Fairway Gardens (Rustington) Management Company Limited
28
A, B
Farrier Place – Canford Paddock Phase 2 (Poole) 
Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Ferris House Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Fiddington Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Filwood Park Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Finchwood Park Management Company Limited
7
A, B
Folliott’s Manor Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Forest Walk, Whiteley Management Company Limited
48
A, B
Foundry Lea (Bridport) Management Company Limited
31
A, B
Fradley Manor Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Franklin Gardens (Darwin Green) Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Freemen’s Meadow Residents Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Garnett Wharf (Otley) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Gateway Residents Management Company Limited
58
A, B
Gerway Management Limited
40
A, B
Gilden Park (Old Harlow) Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Gillies Meadow (Basingstoke) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Glenvale Park Management Company Limited
43
A, B
Grange Park (Hampsthwaite) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Great Dunmow Grange Management Company Limited
18
A, B
H2363 Limited
50
A, B
Hallam Park Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Hampton Water Management Company Limited
15
A, B
Hanwood Park Community Partnership Limited
17
A, B
Harbour Place (Bedhampton) Management Company Limited
35
A, B
Harbourside (East Quay Apartments 13–21 & 31–39) 
Management Company Limited
29
A, B
Harclay Park Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Harlow Gateway Limited
25
A, B
Hartley Brook (Netherton) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Haskins House Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Hawley Gardens Management Company Limited
36
A, B
Hawthorn Grove (Westham) Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Hawthorn Rise (Newton Abbot) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Hayes Village Energy Centre Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Hayes Village Resident Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Heather Croft (Pickering) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Helme Ridge (Meltham) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Henbrook Gardens Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Hendon Waterside Energy Centre Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Hendon Waterside Residents Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Heron House (Wichelstowe) Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Hesslewood Park Management Company Limited
10 
A, B
Hewenden Ridge (Cullingworth) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Hidcote House Management Company Limited
39
A, B
High Elms Park (Hullbridge) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
High Forest (New Waltham) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
High Street Quarter Energy Centre Management Company Limited
1
A, B
High Street Quarter Residents Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Highgrove Gardens (Romsey) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Hillside Gardens (Orchard RW) Residents Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Hollygate Park (Cotgrave) Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Infinity Park Derby Management Limited
1
A, B
Honeymans Helm (Highworth) Management Company Limited
59
A, B
Inglewhite Meadows Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Inkersall Road (Chesterfield) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Jenkins House Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Keeper’s Meadow Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Kennett Heath Management Limited
8
A, B
Kilners Grange (Tongham) Management Company Limited
53
A, B
Kingfisher Meadow (Horsford) Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Kingfisher Meadows Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Kingsbourne (Nantwich) Community Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Kingsbrook Estate Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Kings Chase Residents Management Company Limited
25
A, B
Kings Lodge (Hatfield) Management Company Limited
25
A, B
Kingsdown Gate (Swindon) Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Kingsley Meadows (Harrogate) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Kingston Grange House Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Kipling Road (Ledbury) Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Knights Park (Watton) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Knights Rise (Temple Cloud) Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Knights View (Landgold) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
KP (Macclesfield) Residents Management Company Limited
26
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
204
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
KW (Site B) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Ladden Garden Village Apartment Blocks BCD 
Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Ladden Garden Village Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Lakeside Walk (Hamworthy) Management Company Limited
35
A, B
Lancaster Gardens Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Lancaster Gardens (Phase 2) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Langham Mews Management Company Limited
44
A, B
Languard View (Dovercourt) Residents Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Lavender Grange (Stondon) Residential Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Lavendon Fields (Olney) Residents Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Lay Wood (Devizes) Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Letcombe Gardens (Grove) Management Company Limited
41
A, B
Linmere (Houghton Regis) Residents Management Company Limited
15
A, B
Lock Keeper’s Gate (Low Barugh) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Locksbridge Park (Andover) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Lockwood Fields (Chidswell) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Lubbesthorpe R5 Management Company Limited
60
A, B
Lucerne Fields (Ivybridge) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Luneside Mills Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Lyde View Residents Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Macclesfield Road Management Company Limited
36
A, B
Madgwick Park Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Marham Park Management Company Limited
18
A, B
Market Warsop (Stonebridge Lane) Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Marston Park (Marston Moretaine) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Martello Lakes (Barratt) Resident Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Martello Lakes (Hythe) Resident Management Company Limited
11
A, B
Martingale Chase (Newbury) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Meadowburne Place (Willingdon) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Meadowfields (Boroughbridge) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Meadow View Watchfield Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Melton Mowbray (Kirby Lane) Management Company Limited
60
A, B
Merlin Gate (Newent) Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Mill Brook (Westbury) Management Company Limited
59
A, B
Millbrook Park (Phase 9) Energy Centre Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Millbrook Park (Phase 9) Residents’ Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Mill Springs (Whitchurch) Management Company Limited
34
A, B
Minerva (Apartments) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Monarchs Keep (Bursledon) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Montague Park No2 (Buckhurst Farm) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Monument House Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Moorland Gate (Bishops Lydeard) Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Mortimer Park (Driffield) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Mortimer Park Phase 2 and Porters Way Residential Management 
Company Limited
9
A, B
Mortimer Place (Hatfield Peverel) Residents Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Morton Meadows (Thornbury) Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Nant Y Castell (Caldicot) Management Company Limited
33
A, B
Needham’s Grange Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Needingworth Park Residents Management Company Limited
56
A, B
Nerrols Grange (Taunton) Management Company Limited
13
A, B
Netherwood (Darfield) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Newbery Corner Management Company Ltd
13
A, B
New Heritage (Bordon) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
New Mill Quarter (BL) Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
New Mill Quarter Estate Resident Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Nightingale Woods (Wendover) Residential Management Company Limited
42
A, B
Niveus Walk Management Company Limited
7
A, B
North Abington Management Company Limited
41
A, B
Northfield Park (Patchway) Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Northstowe Residents Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Northwalls Grange (Taunton) Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Norton Farm Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Notton Wood View (Royston) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Oak Hill Mews Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Oakfield Village Estate Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Oakhill Gardens (Swanmore) Management Company Limited
18
A, B
Oaklands (Pontefract) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Oatley Park Management Company Limited
62
A, B
Okement Park (Okehampton) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Olive Park Residents Management Company Limited
17
A, B
Orchard Gate (Kingston Bagpuize) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Orchard Green Estate Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Orchard Meadows (Appleton) Management Company Limited
45
A, B
Oughtibridge Valley (Oughtibridge) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Overstone Gate Residents Management Company Limited
56
A, B
Parc Fferm Wen (St Athen) Management Company Limited
33
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
205
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Parish Brook Residents Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Park Farm (Thornbury) Community Interest Company
30
A, B
Patch Meadows (Somerton) Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Pates House Management Company Limited
39
A, B
Pavilion Square (Phase 2) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Pavilion Square (Pocklington) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Peasedown Meadows Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Pebble Walk (Hayling Island) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Pembridge Park (Phase 2) Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Pembroke Park (Cirencester) Management Company Limited
30
A, B
Pen Bethan (Falmouth) Management Company Limited
18
A, B
Penndrumm (Looe) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Penning Ridge (Penistone) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Pentref Llewelyn (Penllergaer) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Perry Court (Faversham) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Phase 3 Clark Drive LGV Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Phase 3 Clark Drive 2 LGV Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Phase 6 Apartments LGV Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Phoenix And Scorseby Park Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Phoenix Quarter — Apt — Management Company Limited
49
A, B
Phoenix Quarter Estate Management Company Limited
49
A, B
Pinewood Park (Formby) Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Pinn Brook Park (Monkerton) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
PL2 Plymouth (2016) Limited
40
A, B
Poppy Fields (Cottingham) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Portman Square West Village Reading Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Preston Grange Residents Management Company Limited
3 
A, B
Priestley House Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Priory Fields (Pontefract) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Prospect Rise (Whitby) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Quarter Jack Park Management Company Limited
55
A, B
Quarter Jack Park (Wimborne) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Raleigh Holt (Barnstaple) Management Company Limited
41
A, B
Ramsey Park Residents Management Company Limited
56
A, B
Ravenhill Park Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Redhayes Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Redwood Heights (Plymouth) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Residents Management Company (Beaconside) Limited
57
A, B
Richmond Park (Whitfield) Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Ridgeway Views Energy Centre Management Company
54
A, B
Ridgeway Views Residents Management Company
54
A, B
River Meadow (Stanford in the Vale) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
River Whitewater Management Company (Hook) Limited
10
A, B
Riverdown Park (Salisbury) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Riverside Grange (Farmbridge) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Romans Edge Godmanchester Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Romans’ Quarter (Bingham) Residential Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Rose and Lillies Residents Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Rosewood Park Bexhill Residents Management Company Limited
8
A, B
RV North Petherton Residents Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Ryebank Gate (Yapton) Management Company Limited
28
A, B
Salters Brook (Cudworth) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Sandridge Place (Melksham) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Saunderson Gardens Management Co Limited
10
A, B
Sawbridge Park (Sawbridgeworth) Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Saxon Corner (Emsworth) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
Saxon Dean (Silsden) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Saxon Fields (Cullompton) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Saxon Fields (Thanington) Management Company Limited
11
A, B
Saxon Gate (Leonard Stanley) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Saxon Gate (Stamford Bridge) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Saxon Mills (Hassocks) Management Company Limited
53
A, B
Scotgate Ridge (Honley) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Shaftmoor Land Residents Management Company Limited
20
A, B
Silkwood Gate (Wakefield) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Spinney Fields Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Spitfire Green (Manston) Residents Management Company Limited
49
A, B
Spring Valley View (Clayton) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Springfield Place Resident Management Company Limited
4
A, B
St Andrews View (Morley) Management Co. Limited
54
A, B
St James Gardens (Wick) Management Company Limited
29
A, B
St James Management Company Limited
9
A, B
St Johns View Residents Management Company Limited
57
A, B
St Rumbolds Fields Management Company Limited
16
A, B
St. Andrews Place (Morley) Management Co. Limited
54
A, B
St. John’s Walk (Hoylandswaine) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
St. Mary’s Park (Hartley Wintney) Management Company Limited
25
A, B
St. Oswald’s View (Methley) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
206
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Stallard House Management Company Limited
39
A, B
Stewarts Reach and Wolds View Residential Management Company Limited
63
A, B
Stotfold Park Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Summersfield (Papworth) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Sundial Place Residents Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Swallows Field (Hemel Hempstead) Management Company Ltd
22
A, B
Swan Mill (Newbury) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Swinbrook Park (Carterton) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
Sydney Place (Crewe) Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Talbot and Clockmakers Management Company Limited
23
A, B
Tarka Ridge (Yelland) Management Company Limited
41
A, B
Templar’s Chase (Wetherby) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
The Acorns and Hunters Wood Management Company Limited
54
A, B
The Belt Open Space Management Co Limited
63
A, B
The Bridleways (Eccleshill) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
The Causeway Park (Petersfield) Management Company Limited
34
A, B
The Chase (Newbury) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
The Chocolate Works Management Company Limited
37
A, B
The Courtyard (Darwin Green) Management Company Limited
16
A, B
The Furlongs (Westergate) Management Company Limited
46
A, B
The Glassworks (Catcliffe) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
The Grange (Lightcliffe) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
The Meads (Frampton Cotterell) Management Company Limited
13
A, B
The Mounts Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
The Old Meadow Management Company Limited
41
A, B
The Orchards (Hildersley) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
The Paddocks (Skelmanthorpe) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
The Paddocks (Southmoor) Management Company Limited
12
A, B
The Pastures (Knaresborough) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
The Pavilions Management Company (Southampton) Limited
46
A, B
The Pavilions Resident Management Company Limited
23
A, B
The Poppies (Maidstone) Residents Management Company Limited
11
A, B
The Spires (Chesterfield) Management Company Limited
26
A, B
The Vineyards Management Company Limited
30
A, B
The Woodlands (Sturry) Management Company Limited
11
A, B
Thornbury Gardens Dinnington Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Townsend Landing (Henstridge) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Tranby Fields Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Treledan (Saltash) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Trumpington Meadows Residents Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Trumpington (Phase 8—11) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Trumpington Vista Management Company Limited
16
A, B
Union Park (Falmouth) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Upton Gardens Energy Centre Management Company
1
A, B
Upton Gardens Residents Management Company
54
A, B
Victoria Heights (Alphington) Management Company Limited
40
A, B
Wadsworth Gardens (Cleckheaton) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Waite House Management Company Limited
1
A, B
Waldmers Wood Management Company Limited
57
A, B
Warboys Management Company Limited
38
A, B
Waterside (The Quays Barry) Management Company Number 1 Limited
29
A, B
Waterside (The Quays Barry) Management Company Number 2 Limited
29
A, B
Waterside (The Quays Barry) Management Company Number 3 Limited
29
A, B
Waterside Trentham Residents Management Company Limited
36
A, B
Watkin Road Energy Centre Management Company
1
A, B
Watkin Road Residents Management Company
1
A, B
Wayland Fields Residents Management Company Limited
14
A, B
WBD (Kingsway Management) Limited
1
A, B
Weavers Chase (Golcar) Management Company Limited
9
A, B
Webheath (Redditch) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Wedgwood Residents Management Company Limited
5
A, B
Wendel View Residents Management Company Limited
56
A, B
Westbridge Park (Auckley) Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Westminster View (Clayton) Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Weston Meadows, Calne Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Whalley Road (Barrow) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
White Lias House Management Company Limited
23
A, B
White Post Farm Midsomer Norton Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Whittingham Residents Management Company Limited
36
A, B
Whittlesey Lakeside (Cambridge) Management Company Limited
21
A, B
Wichelstowe Estate Management CIC
1
A, B
Wigmore Park Management Company Limited
10
A, B
Willow Grove (Stopsley) Management Company Limited
8
A, B
Willow Grove (Wixams) Management Company Limited
54
A, B
Willow Lane (Beverley) Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Willow Lane (Beverley) Phase 2 Management Company Limited
19
A, B
Willowmead (Wiveliscombe) Management Company Limited
50
A, B
Winnington View Management Company Limited
26
A, B
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
207
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Subsidiary
Registered
 office
Notes
Winnington Village Community Management Company Limited
26
A, B
Winnycroft Residents Management Company Limited
32
A, B
Withies Bridge Management Company Ltd
30
A, B
Woodhall Grange Management Company Limited
6
A, B
Woodland Heath Residential Management Company Limited
14
A, B
Wychwood Park (Haywards Heath) Management
53
A, B
Other subsidiary entities:
Subsidiary
Registered 
office
Notes
Class of
 share held 
% of shares
 owned
Base East Central Rochdale LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
Base Hattersley LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
Base Regeneration LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
Base Werneth Oldham LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
BLLQ LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
BLLQ2 Limited
1
A
Ordinary
100%
SQ Holdings Limited
53
A
Ordinary
90%
Vizion (MK) Properties LLP
1
A
N/A
N/A
Ash Tree Court Management Co. Ltd
1
A, D
Ordinary
0%
Aspects Management Company Limited
27
A
Ordinary
50%
Buckshaw Village Management Company Limited
8
A
Ordinary
50%
Foxcote Mead Management Company Limited
1
A
Ordinary
100%
GWQ Management Limited
24
A, C
Ordinary
0%
Hazelmere Management Company Limited
1
A, D
Ordinary
0%
Interlink Park Management Company Limited
1
A, D
Ordinary
0%
Meridian Business Park Extension Management 
Company Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
2%
Newbury Racecourse Management Limited
12
A, D
Ordinary
0%
Nottingham Business Park Management Company 
Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
2%
Nottingham Business Park (Orchard Place) 
Management Company Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
2%
Optimus Point Management Company Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
0%
Pye Green Management Company Limited
20
A, C
Ordinary
17%
Riverside Exchange Management Company 
Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary/
preference
22%
Runshaw Management Company Limited
8
A
Ordinary
100%
Stoneyfield Management Limited
1
A
Ordinary
100%
WBD (Riverside Exchange Sheffield B) Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
100%
WBD Riverside Sheffield Building K Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
100%
West Village Reading Management Limited
12
A, D
Ordinary
0%
Willow Farm Management Company Limited
1
A, C
Ordinary
3%
32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Audit exemption continued
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
208
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

32.  Group subsidiary undertakings continued
Registered office
1.
Barratt House, Cartwright Way, Forest Business Park, Bardon Hill, Coalville, Leicestershire LE67 1UF
2.
Buchanan Gate, Cumbernauld Road, Stepps, Glasgow G33 6FB
3.
111 West Street, Faversham, Kent ME13 7JB
4.
Barratt East London, 3rd Floor Press Centre, Here East, 13 East Bay Lane, Stratford, London E15 2GW
5.
One Eleven, Edmund Street, Birmingham, West Midlands B3 2HJ
6.
Unit 11, Omega Business Park, Omega Business Village, Thurston Road, Northallerton, North Yorkshire 
DL6 2NJ
7.
Discovery House, Crossley Road, Stockport, Greater Manchester, England SK4 5BH
8.
RMG House, Essex Road, Hoddesdon, Hertfordshire EN11 0DR
9.
Gateway House, 10 Coopers Way, Southend-on-Sea, Essex SS2 5TE
10. Vantage Point, 23 Mark Road, Hemel Hempstead, Hertfordshire HP2 7DN
11.
Weald House, 88 Main Road, Sundridge, Kent, United Kingdom TN14 6ER
12. Cygnet House, Cygnet Way, Hungerford, Berkshire RG17 0YL
13. Units 1, 2 & 3 Beech Court, Wokingham Road, Hurst, Reading RG10 0RU
14. Barratt House, 7 Springfield Lyons Approach, Chelmsford, Essex CM2 5EY
15. The Maltings, Hyde Hall Farm, Sandon, Hertfordshire SG9 0RU
16. 2 Hills Road, Cambridge, Cambridgeshire CB2 1JP
17.
Unit A5 Optimum Business Park, Optimum Road, Swadlincote, Derbyshire, England, DE11 0WT
18. Fisher House, 84 Fisherton Street, Salisbury SP2 7QY
19. 6 Alpha Court, Monks Cross Drive, York, North Yorkshire, YO32 9WN
20. 60 Whitehall Road, Halesowen B63 3JS
21. Unit 1 Forder Way, Cygnet Park, Hampton, Peterborough, United Kingdom, PE7 8GX
22. Wellstones House, Wellstones, Watford, Hertfordshire WD17 2AF
23. Remus 2, 2 Cranbook Way, Solihull Business Park, Solihull, West Midlands B90 4GT
24. Wallis House, Great West Road, Brentford, Middlesex TW8 9BS
25. Firstport Property Services Limited, Marlborough House, Wigmore Place, Wigmore Lane, Luton LU2 9EX
26. Chiltern House, 72–74 King Edward Street, Macclesfield, Cheshire SK10 1AT
27. 100 Avebury Boulevard, Milton Keynes, England MK9 1FH
28. 41a Beach Road, Littlehampton, West Sussex, England DN17 5JA
29. Oak House, Village Way, Cardiff CF15 7NE
30. Unit 2 Beech Court, Wokingham Road, Hurst, Twyford, Berkshire RG10 0RQ
31. Vanguard House, Yeoford Way, Marsh Barton, Exeter EX2 8HL
32. Barratt House, 710 Waterside Drive, Aztec West, Almondsbury, Bristol BS32 4UD
33. Whittington Hall, Whittington Road, Worcester WR5 2ZX
34. Building 4, Dares Farm Business Park, Farnham Road, Ewshot, Farnham, Surrey GU10 5BB
35. Ground Floor, Cromwell House, 15 Andover Road, Winchester, Hampshire SO23 7BT
36. 4 Brindley Road, City Park, Manchester M16 9HQ
37. Watson, Glendevon House, 4 Hawthorn Park, Coal Road, Leeds, West Yorkshire LS14 1PQ
38. Cumberland Court, 80 Mount Street, Nottingham, Nottinghamshire, United Kingdom NG1 6HH
39. Ashford House, Grenadier Road, Exeter, Devon EX1 3LH
40. Woodwater House, Pynes Hill, Exeter, Devon EX2 5WR
41. Unit 7, Astra Centre, Edinburgh Way, Harlow, Essex, England CM20 2BN
42. 5th Floor Halo, Counterslip, Bristol, United Kingdom BS1 6AJ
43. Barratt House, Sandy Way, Grange Park, Northampton NN4 5EJ
44. Unit 7, Hockliffe Business Park, Watling Street, Hockliffe, Leighton Buzzard, Bedfordshire LU7 9NB
45. 377–379 Hoylake Road, Moreton, Wirral, Merseyside CH46 0RW
46. 128 Pyle Street, Granary Court, Newport, Isle of Wight PO30 1JW
47. Woodland Place, Wickford Business Park, Hurricane Way, Wickford SS11 8YB
48. 154–155 Great Charles Street, Queensway, Birmingham B3 3LP
49. Thamesbourne Lodge, Station Road, Bourne End, Buckinghamshire SL8 5QH
50. 1 West Point Court, Great Park Road, Bradley Stoke, Bristol BS32 4PY
51. Blairton House, Old Aberdeen Road, Balmedie, Aberdeen, Scotland AB23 8SH
52. C/O East Block Group, The Colchester Centre, Hawkins Road, Colchester, Essex CO2 8JX
53. Compton House, The Guildway, Old Portsmouth Road, Guildford GU3 1LR
54. Queensway House, 11 Queensway, New Milton, Hampshire BH25 5NR
55. Tollbar House Tollbar Way, Hedge End, Southampton, United Kingdom SO30 2UH
56. 1a Fortune Close, Riverside Business Park, Northampton NN3 9HT
57. Unit 7, Portal Business Park, Eaton Lane, Tarporley, Cheshire CW6 9DL
58. Aurora House, Part 3rd Floor 71-75 Uxbridge Road, Ealing, London, England W5 5SL
59. Wellington House, Great Park Road, Bradley Stoke, Bristol BS32 4PY
60. 72–74 King Edward Street, Macclesfield, Cheshire SK10 1AT
61. Second Floor Lakeside 300, Broadland Business Park, Norwich, Norfolk, England NR7 0WG
62. Unit 1, Great Park Road, Bradley Stoke, Bristol, United Kingdom BS32 4PY
63. Sunnybank Farm, St. Johns Chapel, Bishop Auckland, England DL13 1QZ
64. Adamson House, Wilmslow Road, Manchester, England M20 2YY
Notes
A	 Owned through another Group company.
B	 Entity is limited by guarantee and is a temporary member of the Group. Assets are not held for the benefit of the Group and the entity has no 
profit or loss in the year.
C	 The Group is a minority shareholder but has voting control.
D	 The Group does not own any shares but has control via directors who are employees of the Group.
209
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Notes to the Financial Statements continued
Year ended 30 June 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

The Group uses a number of APMs that are not defined within IFRS. The Directors use 
these APMs, along with IFRS measures, to assess the operational performance of the Group 
as detailed in the key performance indicators section of the Strategic Report on pages 12 
to 15. These APMs may not be directly comparable with similarly titled measures reported 
by other companies and they are not intended to be a substitute for, or superior to, IFRS 
measures. Definitions of adjusted items are presented in note 4 and adjusted performance 
measures are reconciled to IFRS measures on page 159. Definitions and reconciliations of 
the other financial APMs used to IFRS measures are included below:
Gross margin is defined as gross profit divided by revenue:
2024 
2023 
Revenue per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
4,168.2
5,321.4
Gross profit per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
509.5
974.9
Gross margin
12.2%
18.3%
Adjusted gross margin is defined as adjusted gross profit divided by revenue:
2024 
2023 
Revenue per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
4,168.2
5,321.4
Adjusted gross profit per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
689.0
1,130.4
Adjusted gross margin
16.5%
21.2%
Operating margin is defined as profit from operations divided by revenue:
2024 
2023 
Revenue per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
4,168.2
5,321.4
Profit from operations per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
174.7
707.4
Operating margin
4.2%
13.3%
Adjusted operating margin is defined as adjusted profit from operations divided by revenue:
2024
2023 
Revenue per Consolidated Income Statement (£m)
4,168.2
5,321.4
Adjusted profit from operations per Consolidated Income 
Statement (£m)
376.6
862.9
Adjusted operating margin
9.0%
16.2%
ROCE is calculated as earnings before amortisation, interest, tax and operating adjusting 
items for the year, divided by average net assets adjusted for goodwill and intangibles, tax, 
net cash, derivative financial instruments and provisions in relation to legacy properties.
2024
£m
2023
£m 
Profit from operations
174.7
707.4
Amortisation of intangible assets
10.4
10.5
Net cost associated with legacy properties
179.5
155.5
Costs incurred in respect of the all-share offer for the 
share capital of Redrow plc per note 4
22.4
—
Share of post-tax profit from JVs and associates
2.3
8.8
Adjusted cost related to JV legacy properties
12.6
23.7
Earnings before amortisation, interest, tax and adjusted items
401.9
905.9
30 June
 2024
£m
31 December
 2023
£m 
30 June
 2023
£m 
31 December
 2022
£m 
30 June
 2022
£m 
Group net assets per 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
5,439.1
5,439.6
5,596.4
5,656.6
5,631.3
Less:
Other intangible assets per 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
(184.5)
(189.7)
(194.9)
(200.1)
(205.4)
Goodwill per Consolidated 
Balance Sheet
(852.9)
(852.9)
(852.9)
(852.9)
(852.9)
Current tax assets
(31.8)
(27.3)
(31.1)
(0.1)
(9.9)
Deferred tax liabilities
45.0
50.4
53.5
44.0
45.1
Cash and cash equivalents
(1,065.3)
(949.9)
(1,269.1)
(1,166.5)
(1,352.7)
Loans and borrowings
200.0
200.3
203.4
202.0
217.3
Provisions in relation to 
legacy properties
730.3
646.0
612.3
485.3
479.5
Prepaid fees
(3.2)
(3.8)
(3.7)
(4.6)
(3.2)
Capital employed
4,276.7
4,312.7
4,113.9
4,163.7
3,949.1
Three point average capital 
employed
4,234.4
4,075.6
2024
2023
Earnings before amortisation, interest, tax and adjusted items 
(from table above) (£m)
401.9
905.9
Three point average capital employed (from table above) (£m)
4,234.4
4,075.6
ROCE
9.5%
22.2%
Definitions of alternative performance measures and reconciliation to IFRS (unaudited)
210
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Underlying ROCE is calculated as ROCE (above) with net assets also adjusted for 
land payables:
30 June
 2024
£m
31 December
 2023
£m 
30 June
 2023
£m 
31 December
 2022
£m 
30 June
 2022
£m 
Capital employed (from ROCE 
table above)
4,276.7
4,312.7
4,113.9
4,163.7
3,949.1
Adjust for land payables
472.8
367.2
506.7
622.3
733.6
Capital employed adjusted 
for land payables
4,749.5
4,679.9
4,620.6
4,786.0
4,682.7
Three point average capital employed 
adjusted for land payables
4,683.3
4,696.4
2024
2023
Earnings before amortisation, interest, tax and adjusted items (from 
table above) (£m)
401.9
905.9
Three point average capital employed adjusted for land payables 
(from table above) (£m)
4,683.3
4,696.4
Underlying ROCE
8.6%
19.3%
For the purpose of determining the Executive Directors’ annual bonus (page 127), capital 
employed is adjusted for land, land payables, trade payables and inventories currently 
occupied under the refugee support scheme:
30 June
 2024
£m
31 December
 2023
£m 
30 June
 2023
£m 
31 December
 2022
£m 
30 June
 2022
£m 
Capital employed (from ROCE 
table above)
4,276.7
4,312.7
4,113.9
4,163.7
3,949.1
Adjust for land
(3,233.6)
(2,979.1)
(3,139.9)
(3,253.7)
(3,339.9)
Adjust for land payables
472.8
367.2
506.7
622.3
733.6
Adjust for trade payables
252.7
186.9
310.3
220.4
324.0
Adjust for inventories currently 
occupied under the refugee 
support scheme
(9.0)
(11.3)
(11.0)
—
—
Capital employed adjusted for 
land, land payables, trade payables 
and inventories currently occupied 
under the refugee support scheme
1,759.6
1,876.4
1,780.0
1,752.7
1,666.8
Three point average capital 
employed adjusted for land, land 
payables, trade payables and 
inventories currently occupied 
under the refugee support scheme
1,805.3
1,733.2
Adjusted earnings for adjusted basic earnings per share and adjusted diluted earnings per 
share are calculated by excluding adjusted items and any associated net tax amounts from 
profit attributable to ordinary shareholders of the Company:
2024
£m
2023
£m 
Profit attributable to ordinary shareholders of the Company
114.1
530.3
Net cost associated with legacy properties per note 4
179.5
155.5
Costs incurred in respect of the all-share offer for the
share capital of Redrow plc per note 4
22.4
—
Cost associated with JV legacy properties per note 4
12.6
23.7
Tax impact of adjusted items
(54.4)
(39.3)
Adjusted earnings
274.2
670.2
Net cash is defined in note 17.
Total indebtedness is defined as net (cash)/debt and land payables:
2024
£m
2023
£m
Net cash
(868.5)
(1,069.4)
Land payables
472.8
506.7
Total indebtedness
(395.7)
(562.7)
TSR is a measure of the performance of the Group’s share price over a period of three 
financial years. It combines share price appreciation and dividends paid to show the total 
return to the shareholders expressed as a percentage.
Definitions of alternative performance measures and reconciliation to IFRS (unaudited) continued
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
211
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Financial five year record
Note
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Private wholly owned home completions
9,568
13,134
13,327
12,456
10,666
Affordable wholly owned home completions
2,466
3,383
3,835
3,922
2,802
Wholly owned completions (homes)
12,034
16,517
17,162
16,378
13,468
Joint venture completions (homes)
570
726
746
828
536
Total home completions including JVs
12,604
17,243
17,908
17,206
14,004
Wholly owned completions average 
selling price (£000)
280.3
288.8
300.2
319.6
306.8
Revenue (£m)
3,419.2
4,811.7 5,267.9
5,321.4 4,168.2
Gross profit (£m)
614.3
1,010.0
899.9
974.9
509.5
Gross profit margin (%)
18.0%
21.0%
17.1%
18.3%
12.2%
Adjusted gross profit (£m)
631.4
1,114.7
1,308.1
1,130.4
689.0
Adjusted gross profit margin (%)
18.5%
23.2%
24.8%
21.2%
16.5%
Profit from operations (£m)
493.4
811.1
646.6
707.4
174.7
Operating profit margin (%)
14.4%
16.9%
12.3%
13.3%
4.2%
Adjusted profit from operations (£m)
507.3
919.0 1,054.8
862.9
376.6
Adjusted operating margin (%)
14.8%
19.1%
20.0%
16.2%
9.0%
Net finance costs (£m)
(29.9)
(26.6)
(27.6)
(11.1)
(6.5)
Share of post-tax income from joint ventures
28.3
27.7
23.3
8.8
2.3
Profit before tax
491.8
812.2
642.3
705.1
170.5
Adjusted profit before tax
505.7
919.7 1,054.8
884.3
385.0
Five year record (unaudited) 
Financial five year record
Note
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Basic earnings per share (pence)
39.4
64.9
50.6
53.2
11.8
Adjusted earnings per share (pence)
40.5
73.5
83.0
67.3
28.3
Dividend (interim paid and 
final proposed) (pence)
—
29.4
36.9
33.7
16.2
Special cash payment proposed 
per share (pence)
—
—
—
—
—
Total shareholder return (TSR) over 
three financial years (%)
6.1%
59.8%
(4.9%)
10.6%
(20.9)%
Tangible shareholders’ funds (£m)
3,931.9
4,545.1
4573.0 4,548.6 4,401.7
Tangible net assets per share at year 
end (pence)
386.1
446.3
447.2
466.7
451.6
Total shareholders’ funds (£m)
4,840.3
5,452.1
5,631.3 5,596.4
5,439.1
Total net assets per share at year end 
(pence)
475.3
535.4
550.7
574.2
558.1
Year-end net (debt)/cash (£m)
308.2
1,317.4
1,138.6 1,069.4
868.5
Year-end total land payables (£m)
791.9
658.3
733.6
506.7
472.8
Year-end total net (indebtedness)/surplus 
(£m)
(483.7)
659.1
405.0
562.7
395.7
Average net cash across the financial 
year (£m)
348.3
821.0
957.4
759.1
732.3
Three point average capital employed (£m)
3,457.6
3,414.5 3,625.8 4,075.6 4,234.4
Return on capital employed (ROCE) (%)
15.5%
27.8%
30.0%
22.2%
9.5%
Total land investment (£m)
15
3,112.3 2,946.3 3,339.9
3,139.9 3,233.6
Proportion of total land investment funded 
by land creditors (%)
25.4%
22.3%
22.0%
16.1%
14.6%
Weighted average shares in issue during 
the year (m)
1,018.2
1,018.3
1,021.9
1,000.1
974.6
Weighted average shares in issue during 
the year less EBT (m)
1,013.9
1,016.4
1,018.7
996.3
968.8
Number of ordinary shares in issue at 
year end (m)
22 1,018.3
1,018.3
1,022.6
974.6
974.6
212
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Non-financial five year record
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
SHE audit compliance
96%
97%
97%
96%
97%*
Injury Incidence Rate
256
416
262
289
302*
Average training days per employee (days/employee)
4.1
3.9
3.3
4.1
4.1
Employee turnover (%)
10%
12%
17%
15%
13%
Employee engagement index (%)
84.2%
N/A
79.4%
84.4%
74.9%
Number of employees at 30 June
6,655
6,329
6,837
6,728
6,270
Proportion female (%)
31%
31%
32%
31%
32%
Graduates, apprentices and trainees on programmes
492
426
391
483
353
Number of senior managers
286
283
328
331
332
Proportion female (%)
14%
16%
17%
18%
20%
Number of PLC Directors
8
9
9
8
9
Proportion female (%)
38%
44%
33%
37%
33%
Legally completed build area (100m2)
12,197
16,439
16,402
15,609
13,097
Carbon intensity (tonnes per 100m2 legally 
completed build area)
1.80
1.78
1.53
1.60
1.26*
Waste intensity (tonnes per 100m2 legally 
completed build area)
7.70
5.89
4.97
4.31
3.64*
Waste intensity (tonnes per 100m2 house build 
equivalent area)
6.93
6.29
4.83
4.34
3.83*
Diversion of construction waste from landfill (%)
96%
95%
96%
96%
97%*
Electricity on renewable tariffs (%)
68.0%
72.0%
76.0%
87.0%
94.0%
Average active sales outlets (inc. JVs)
366
343
332
367
346
Customer service (HBF Customer Satisfaction Survey)
5 star
5 star
5 star
5 star
5 star
NHBC Pride in the Job Awards (number awarded)
92
93
98
96
89
Owned and unconditional land bank (plots)
68,393
66,601
67,687
59,248
57,632
Conditional land bank (plots)
11,931
11,041
13,239
11,142
8,607
Owned and controlled land bank (plots)
80,324
77,642
80,926
70,390
66,239
JV owned and controlled land bank (plots)
5,400
4,661
4,548
4,356
4,631
Total owned and controlled land bank including 
JVs (plots)
85,724
82,303
85,474
74,746
70,870
Land bank years owned (years)
5.7
4.0
3.9
3.6
4.3
Land bank years controlled (years)
1.0
0.7
0.8
0.7
0.6
Non-financial five year record
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Land bank total years (owned and controlled) (years)
6.7
4.7
4.7
4.3
4.9
Average selling price of homes in land bank at 
year end (£000)
276
289
322
331
328
Land approvals (plots)
9,441
18,067
19,089
(812) 12,439
Land approvals (£m)
368.1
876.8
1,396.1
(14.9)
646.9
Planning consents secured in the year (plots)
14,768
14,280
14,988
12,969
9,026
Strategic land plots converted to owned and 
controlled land bank (plots)
3,137
3,507
1,663
777
3,723
Strategic land bank (acres)
13,271
13,754
15,537
16,431
16,865
Expenditure on physical improvement works 
benefiting local communities (£m)
477
572
699
726
536
School places provided (number)
2,211
3,591
5,346
3,327
4,632
Home completions from strategically sourced 
land (homes)
2,929
4,172
4,530
3,938
3,290
Proportion of home completions from 
strategically sourced land (%)
24.3%
25.3%
26.4%
24.0%
24.4%
Home completions using MMC (homes)
2,652
4,393
4,846
5,578
4,668
Proportion of home completions using MMC (%)
21%
25%
27%
32%
33%
Proportion of home completions using 2016 
and later house type range (%)
60.2%
65.3%
77.0%
71.0%
84.0%
Proportion of home completions EPC rated “B” 
or above (%)
99%
99%
99%
99%
99%
Average DER for completed properties (kgCO2/m2/yr)
16.59
16.21
15.89
16.02
15.78*
Average SAP rating of home completions
84
85
85
85
85
Note: Additional granularity and more detailed sustainability metrics are available on our website at: 
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/sustainability/performance-data/data.
Deloitte LLP (‘Deloitte’) have provided independent third-party limited assurance in 
accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) 
and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the 
International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over selected metrics in the 
above table identified with an *. For Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which 
includes details of the selected metrics assured, our full Carbon Reporting Methodology 
Statement, our ESG Basis of Reporting and a full breakdown of scope 3 GHG emissions, see 
our website www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk/building-sustainably/our-publications-and-
policies/publications.
Five year record (unaudited) continued
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
213
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Act
The Companies Act 2006
Active outlet
A site with at least one plot for sale
AGM
Annual General Meeting
APM
Alternative performance measure
APPG
All-Party Parliamentary Group
Articles
The Company’s Articles of Association
ASP
Average selling price
Barratt
Barratt Developments PLC and its subsidiary undertakings
BEIS
Department for Business, Energy and Industrial Strategy
BNG
Biodiversity Net Gain
BREEAM
Building Research Establishment Environmental Assessment Methodology
BRIs
Builder Responsible Items
Building for Life 12
This is the industry standard, endorsed by the government, for well-
designed homes and neighbourhoods that local communities, local 
authorities and developers are invited to use to stimulate conversations 
about creating good places to live
Building Regulations
The requirements relating to the erection and extension of buildings 
under UK Law
Capital employed
Average net assets adjusted for goodwill and intangibles, tax, cash, loans 
and borrowings, prepaid fees, provisions in respect of legacy properties and 
derivative financial instruments
CDP
Charity that runs the global system for disclosure of environmental impacts 
for investors, companies, cities, states and regions
CEO
Chief Executive
CFO
Chief Financial Officer
CITB
Construction Industry Training Board
CMA
Competition and Markets Authority
Code
UK Corporate Governance Code issued in July 2018 
(copy available from www.frc.org.uk)
Glossary
COINS
Construction Industry Solutions (software used by the Group)
Connected Persons
As defined in the EU Market Abuse Regulation
Contribution margin Housebuild revenue less land and directly attributable build and site costs, 
divided by housebuild revenue
COO
Chief Operating Officer
COVID-19
Coronavirus Disease 2019
DBP
Deferred Bonus Plan
DTRs
Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules
EBT
Barratt Developments Employee Benefit Trust
ELTIP
Employee Long Term Incentive Plan
EMC
Ethnic Minority Communities
EPC
Energy Performance Certificate
EPS
Earnings per share
ESG
Environmental, Social and Governance
EU
European Union
EWS
External Wall System
FCA
Financial Conduct Authority
FHS
Future Homes Standard
Foundation
The Barratt Developments PLC Charitable Foundation
FRAEW
Fire Risk Appraisal of External Wall construction
FRC
Financial Reporting Council
FSC
Forest Stewardship Council
FTSE
Financial Times Stock Exchange
Future Homes 
Standard
Changes to Building Regulations under the Future Homes and Buildings 
Standard to reduce carbon emissions from the use of new homes
FY
Financial year ended 30 June
214
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

GDP
Gross Domestic Product
GHG
Greenhouse Gas
GM
General Meeting
HBF
Home Builders Federation
HMRC
HM Revenue & Customs
Housebuild 
equivalent area
Measure of construction activity in the year, calculated by multiplying 
the designed plot floor area of each individual unit by the proportion 
of the total build work required for that unit completed in the period.
HR
Human Resources
HVO
Hydrotreated Vegetable Oil
IAS
International Accounting Standards
IASB
International Accounting Standards Board
IEA
International Energy Agency
IFRS
International Financial Reporting Standards
IIA
Institute of Internal Auditors
IIR
Injury incidence rate
IIRC
International Integrated Reporting Council
ISAs
International Standards on Auditing
ISAE
International Standard on Assurance Engagements
ISO
International Organisation for Standardisation
JVs
Joint ventures
KPI
Key performance indicator
LGBTQ+
Lesbian, gay, bisexual, transgender, queer and other gender expressions
LTPP
Long-Term Performance Plan
LTV
Loan to Value
MMC
Modern methods of construction
MP
Member of Parliament
MWh
Megawatt Hours
NED
Non-Executive Director
Net cash
Cash and cash equivalents, bank overdrafts, interest-bearing borrowings 
and prepaid fees
Net tangible assets
Group net assets less other intangible assets and goodwill
NGFS
Network for Greening the Financial System
NHBC
National House Building Council
NPPF
The National Planning Policy Framework
Ofcom
The regulator and competition authority for the UK communications industries
OHSAS
Occupational Health and Safety Assessment Series
Operating margin
Profit from operations divided by revenue
Oregon
Oregon Timber Frame Limited, Oregon Timber Frame (England) Limited 
and Oregon Contract Management Limited
Paris Agreement
International treaty on climate change adopted on 12 December 2015 
and entered into force on 4 November 2016
PAS 9980
Code of practice setting out a method for the completion of a Fire 
Risk Appraisal of External Wall construction
PBT
Profit before tax
PEFC
The Programme for the Endorsement of Forest Certification
PRS
Private rented sector
PwC
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
RCF
Revolving Credit Facility
REGO
Renewable Energy Guarantees of Origin
RIs
Reportable Items - defects found during NHBC inspections
ROCE
Return on capital employed calculated as described on page 210
RPDT
Residential Property Developer Tax
Glossary continued
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
215
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

RSPB
Royal Society for the Protection of Birds
SAP
Standard Assessment Procedure -quantifies a dwelling’s energy use per 
unit floor area
SASB
Sustainability Accounting Standards Board
SBTi
Science Based Targets Initiative
SDLT
Stamp Duty Land Tax
SECR
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting
Sharesave
Savings-Related Share Option Scheme
SHE
Safety, Health and Environment
Site ROCE
Site operating profit (site trading profit less allocated administrative 
overheads) divided by average investment in site land and work in progress
SONIA
Sterling Overnight Interest Average
SUDS
Sustainable Urban Drainage Systems
TCFD
Task Force for Climate-related Financial Disclosures
tCO2e
Tonnes of carbon dioxide equivalent
the Barratt group
Barratt Developments PLC and its subsidiary undertakings prior to the 
acquisition of Redrow plc
the Combination
The acquisition of Redrow plc by Barratt Developments PLC and, subject 
to CMA approval, the integration of the Redrow and Barratt businesses
the combined group
The new group of companies comprising the Barratt group as defined 
above, and Redrow plc and its subsidiaries
the Company
Barratt Developments PLC
the Group
Barratt Developments PLC and its subsidiary undertakings as at 30 June 2024
Total completions
Unless otherwise stated, total completions quoted include JVs
Total indebtedness
Net (cash)/debt and land payables
TSR
Total shareholder return
Underlying ROCE
ROCE as defined on page 210, with net assets also adjusted for land 
payables as shown on page 211
UN SDGs
United Nations Sustainable Development Goals
USPP
US Private Placement
VAT
Value Added Tax
WIP
Work in progress
Glossary continued
216
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Reporting approach
Our integrated report is primarily prepared for our shareholders; however, through our 
activities we create value for a range of other stakeholders.
Reporting frameworks
Our integrated reporting is guided by various codes and standards outlined in the 
table here.
Report scope and boundary
Our Integrated Report covers the performance of Barratt Developments PLC for the financial 
year ended June 2024.
The report extends beyond financial reporting and includes non-financial performance, 
opportunities and risks that may have a significant influence on our ability to create value.
Integrated reporting framework 
The primary purpose of an integrated report is to explain to providers of financial capital 
how an organisation creates value over time. An integrated report benefits all interested 
stakeholders including employees, customers, suppliers, business partners, local 
communities, legislators, regulators and policy-makers.
The IIRC’s vision is to align capital allocation and corporate behaviour to wider goals of 
financial stability and sustainable development through the cycle of integrated reporting 
and thinking.
Sustainability frameworks
Framework
The International Integrated Reporting Council’s Integrated Reporting 
Purpose
Framework that is focused on articulating the value creation of an entity over time.
Framework
United Nations Sustainable Development Goals
Purpose
Outward-looking framework that covers the areas of the UN’s 2030 Agenda focused on 
people, planet and prosperity.
The 17 UN SDGs define global sustainable development priorities and aspirations for 2030 and 
seek to mobilise global efforts around a common set of goals and targets.
The UN SDGs call for worldwide action among governments, business and civil society to 
end poverty and create a life of dignity and opportunity for all, within the boundaries of the 
planet. The UN SDGs were launched in 2015 by the UN.
Framework
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) recommendations
Purpose
Recommendations for disclosing clear, comparable and consistent information about the 
risks and opportunities presented by climate change.
Our primary disclosures aligning with TCFD recommendations as we continue on our journey 
towards full alignment, are made through the CDP Climate survey, which we submit on an 
annual basis. In 2018 the CDP Climate Survey format was aligned to TCFD recommendations. 
Other TCFD related disclosures can be found within the content of this integrated report, and 
on the sustainability section of our corporate website.
Legal requirements
Framework
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)
Purpose
Global framework for how companies prepare and disclose their financial statements.
Framework
Companies Act 2006
Purpose
Company law in the UK.
Framework
UK Corporate Governance Code
Purpose
The standards of good practice for listed companies on board composition and 
development, remuneration, shareholder relations, accountability and audit.
Framework
Streamline Energy and Carbon Reporting (SECR)
Purpose
Disclosures required by the UK Government on a company’s energy consumption and 
greenhouse gas emissions.
Integrated reporting approach
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
217
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Registrars
Equiniti Group
Aspect House
Spencer Road
Lancing, West Sussex
BN99 6DA 
Tel: 0371 384 2657
Statutory auditor
Deloitte LLP
London
Solicitors
Slaughter and May
Linklaters LLP
Brokers and investment bankers
UBS AG and Barclays Bank plc
Registered office
Barratt Developments PLC
Barratt House
Cartwright Way
Forest Business Park
Bardon Hill
Coalville
Leicestershire
LE67 1UF
Tel: 01530 278278
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk
Company information
Registered in England and Wales.
Company number 00604574
Financial calendar
Announcement	
2024 
Annual General Meeting and Trading update
23 October 2024
2025 
Interim Results Announcement
12 February 2025
2025 
Annual Results Announcement
17 September 2025
Group advisers and Company information
218
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Notes
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements
219
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Notes
220
Barratt Developments PLC Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Governance
Financial Statements

Barratt Developments PLC’s commitment to environmental issues 
is reflected in this Annual Report, which has been printed on Magno 
Satin, an FSC® certified material. This document was printed by Park 
Communications using its environmental print technology, which 
minimises the impact of printing on the environment. Vegetable-based 
inks have been used and 99% of dry waste is diverted from landfill. 
The printer is a CarbonNeutral® company.
Both the printer and the paper mill are registered to ISO 14001
CBP026683

Barratt Developments PLC
Barratt House
Cartwright Way
Forest Business Park
Bardon Hill
Coalville
Leicestershire
LE67 1UF
Tel: 01530 278278
www.barrattdevelopments.co.uk